CashFlowManagement BA En
Transcript of CashFlowManagement BA En
Product DocumentationSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Cash Flow Management
PUBLIC
Table Of Contents
1 Cash Flow Management .................................................................................. 10
2 Business Background ...................................................................................... 11
2.1 Outgoing Payments ............................................................................................................... 11
2.1.1 Outgoing Payments ............................................................................................................... 11
2.1.2 Determination of Payment Method / Reservation .................................................................. 14
2.1.3 Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments ................................................................. 16
2.1.4 Externally Initiated Outgoing Payments ................................................................................ 21
2.1.5 Internally Initiated Manual Outgoing Payments ..................................................................... 25
2.1.6 Creating User-Defined Payment File Formats ...................................................................... 30
2.2 Incoming Payments ............................................................................................................... 31
2.2.1 Incoming Payments ............................................................................................................... 31
2.2.2 Automatic Incoming Payments .............................................................................................. 35
2.2.3 Manual Incoming Payments .................................................................................................. 40
2.2.4 Incoming Payments by SEPA Direct Debit ............................................................................ 47
2.3 Special Business Transactions ............................................................................................. 52
2.3.1 Canceling a Supplier Invoice ................................................................................................. 52
2.3.2 Canceling a Customer Invoice .............................................................................................. 53
2.3.3 Customer Payments by Credit Card ...................................................................................... 54
2.3.4 Customer Remittance Advices .............................................................................................. 62
2.3.5 Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices ........................................................... 65
2.3.6 Supplier Remittance Advices ................................................................................................ 67
2.3.7 Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing ................................................................................... 70
3 Payables .......................................................................................................... 73
3.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 73
3.1.1 Open Items Payables ............................................................................................................ 73
3.1.2 Supplier Account Monitor ...................................................................................................... 74
3.1.3 Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials ........................................................................... 78
3.1.4 Down Payments Made in Financials ..................................................................................... 81
3.1.5 Foreign Currency Remeasurement ....................................................................................... 82
3.1.6 Reclassification ..................................................................................................................... 84
3.2 Suppliers View ....................................................................................................................... 86
3.2.1 Quick Guide for Suppliers (in Payables) ............................................................................... 86
3.3 Automatic Payments View ..................................................................................................... 88
3.3.1 Quick Guide for Automatic Payments (Payables) ................................................................. 88
3.3.2 Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal ............................................................................. 90
3.4 Payment Clearing View ......................................................................................................... 90
2 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Table Of Contents
3.4.1 Quick Guide for Payment Clearing (Payables) ...................................................................... 90
3.4.2 Clear An Outgoing Payment Manually .................................................................................. 92
3.4.3 Using the Open Items Table .................................................................................................. 93
3.4.4 Finding Open Items for Externally-Initiated Payments .......................................................... 94
3.5 Periodic Tasks ....................................................................................................................... 95
3.5.1 Quick Guide for Payment Runs (Payables) ........................................................................... 95
3.5.2 Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Payables ................................................................ 96
3.5.3 Messages in the Payment Run Application Log .................................................................... 99
3.5.4 Quick Guide for Balance Confirmation Runs (Payables) ...................................................... 101
3.5.5 Create a Balance Confirmation Run ...................................................................................... 103
3.5.6 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Payables) ........................................... 104
3.5.7 Quick Guide for Reclassification (in Payables) ..................................................................... 107
3.5.8 Central Bank Reporting ......................................................................................................... 110
3.5.8.1 Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting ............................................................................... 110
3.5.8.2 Perform Central Bank Reporting .......................................................................................... 112
3.5.8.3 Related Information ............................................................................................................... 114
3.5.8.3.1 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — Austria .................................. 114
3.5.8.3.2 Configuration: Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting –
Austria ................................................................................................................................... 117
3.5.8.3.3 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — France .................................. 118
3.5.8.3.4 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — Germany .............................. 120
3.6 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 122
3.6.1 Aging List for Payables .......................................................................................................... 122
3.6.2 Forecast List for Payables ..................................................................................................... 124
3.6.3 Details to Items of Suppliers .................................................................................................. 126
3.6.4 Details to Open Items of Suppliers ........................................................................................ 127
3.6.5 Payment Statistics - Suppliers ............................................................................................... 128
3.6.6 Payment Statistics – Cash Discount ..................................................................................... 129
3.6.7 Supplier List ........................................................................................................................... 131
4 Receivables ..................................................................................................... 132
4.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 132
4.1.1 Open Items Receivables ....................................................................................................... 132
4.1.2 Customer Account Monitor .................................................................................................... 133
4.1.3 Automatic Dunning ................................................................................................................ 138
4.1.4 Down Payments Received in Financials ............................................................................... 140
4.1.5 Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials ...................................................................... 142
4.1.6 Refund of Payments Received .............................................................................................. 144
4.2 Customers View .................................................................................................................... 146
4.2.1 Quick Guide for Customers (in Receivables) ........................................................................ 146
4.2.2 Create a SEPA Direct Debit Mandate ................................................................................... 148
4.3 Automatic Payments View ..................................................................................................... 150
4.3.1 Quick Guide for Automatic Payments (Receivables) ............................................................ 150
4.3.2 Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal ............................................................................. 152
4.4 Payment Clearing View ......................................................................................................... 152
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Table Of Contents PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 3
4.4.1 Quick Guide for Payment Clearing (Receivables) ................................................................. 152
4.4.2 Clear an Incoming Payment Manually ................................................................................... 154
4.5 Dunning View ........................................................................................................................ 155
4.5.1 Quick Guide for Dunning ....................................................................................................... 155
4.5.2 Edit and Execute Dunning ..................................................................................................... 155
4.6 Periodic Tasks ....................................................................................................................... 156
4.6.1 Quick Guide for Dunning Runs .............................................................................................. 156
4.6.2 Create a Dunning Run ........................................................................................................... 159
4.6.3 Quick Guide for Payment Runs (Receivables) ...................................................................... 159
4.6.4 Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Receivables ........................................................... 161
4.6.5 Quick Guide for Balance Confirmation Runs (Receivables) .................................................. 164
4.6.6 Create a Balance Confirmation Run ...................................................................................... 165
4.6.7 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Receivables) ...................................... 166
4.6.8 Quick Guide for Reclassification (In Receivables) ................................................................ 169
4.6.9 Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting ............................................................................... 173
4.7 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 174
4.7.1 Aging List for Receivables ..................................................................................................... 174
4.7.2 Forecast List for Receivables ................................................................................................ 175
4.7.3 Dunning History - Customers ................................................................................................ 177
4.7.4 Dunning History - Documents ............................................................................................... 178
4.7.5 Dunning Statistics .................................................................................................................. 179
4.7.6 Details to Items of Customers ............................................................................................... 180
4.7.7 Details to Open Items of Customers ..................................................................................... 181
4.7.8 Customer List ........................................................................................................................ 183
4.7.9 Account Financial Data ......................................................................................................... 183
4.7.10 SEPA Mandate List ............................................................................................................... 185
4.7.11 Accounts Receivable – Pledging of Open Items ................................................................... 186
5 Payment Management .................................................................................... 188
5.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 188
5.1.1 Payment Allocation and Clearing .......................................................................................... 188
5.1.2 Credit Card Chargebacks ...................................................................................................... 190
5.1.3 Cash Outpayments - Switzerland .......................................................................................... 193
5.2 Payment Monitor View .......................................................................................................... 194
5.2.1 Payment Monitor Quick Guide .............................................................................................. 194
5.3 Payment Allocation View ....................................................................................................... 200
5.3.1 Quick Guide for Payment Allocation ..................................................................................... 200
5.3.2 Allocate a Payment Manually ................................................................................................ 202
5.3.3 Memo Line Analysis Rules .................................................................................................... 203
5.3.4 Search Memo Lines for Invoice Numbers ............................................................................. 206
5.3.5 Assign an Account to a Rule for Analyzing Memo Lines ....................................................... 209
5.3.6 Creation of Memo Line Analysis Rules for Common Use Cases .......................................... 211
5.3.7 Rule Types For Analyzing Memo Lines ................................................................................. 216
5.4 Petty Cash View .................................................................................................................... 217
5.4.1 Quick Guide for Petty Cash ................................................................................................... 217
4 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Table Of Contents
5.4.2 Enter an Incoming Cash Payment ......................................................................................... 219
5.4.3 Create An Outgoing Cash Payment ...................................................................................... 221
5.4.4 Transfer Cash ........................................................................................................................ 222
5.5 Deposits View ........................................................................................................................ 223
5.5.1 Quick Guide for Check Deposits ........................................................................................... 223
5.5.2 Quick Guide for Lockbox Batches ......................................................................................... 225
5.5.3 Quick Guide for Bill of Exchange Deposits ............................................................................ 227
5.5.4 Quick Guide for Bill of Exchange Cashings ........................................................................... 230
5.6 Remittance Advices View ...................................................................................................... 233
5.6.1 Quick Guide for Remittance Advices ..................................................................................... 233
5.6.2 Enter a Remittance Advice .................................................................................................... 235
5.7 Periodic Tasks View .............................................................................................................. 236
5.7.1 Quick Guide for Payment Media Runs .................................................................................. 236
5.7.2 Create a Payment Media Run ............................................................................................... 238
5.7.3 Quick Guide for Payment Deposit Runs ................................................................................ 239
5.7.4 Quick Guide for Credit Card Settlement Runs ...................................................................... 240
5.7.5 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Cash) ................................................. 242
5.7.6 Quick Guide for Direct Debit Rejection Runs ........................................................................ 245
5.8 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 246
5.8.1 Payment Statistics - Customers ............................................................................................ 246
5.8.2 Checkbook Register .............................................................................................................. 247
6 Liquidity Management ..................................................................................... 249
6.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 249
6.1.1 Cash Position ........................................................................................................................ 249
6.1.2 Bank Directory ...................................................................................................................... 250
6.1.3 Bank Directory Upload for Six Interbank Clearing – Switzerland .......................................... 252
6.1.4 Bank Statements ................................................................................................................... 253
6.1.5 Bank Transfers ...................................................................................................................... 255
6.1.6 Bank Payment Advice .......................................................................................................... 257
6.1.7 Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checks ......................................................... 257
6.1.8 Monitoring Payment Allocation Processing ........................................................................... 259
6.1.9 Master Data ........................................................................................................................... 260
6.1.9.1 Clearing Houses and Clearing House Accounts ................................................................... 260
6.1.9.2 Bank Directory ...................................................................................................................... 262
6.1.9.3 Banks and Bank Accounts .................................................................................................... 264
6.1.9.4 ISR Payments - Switzerland .................................................................................................. 268
6.1.10 Liquidity Forecasts ................................................................................................................ 268
6.1.10.1 Liquidity Check ...................................................................................................................... 268
6.1.10.2 Liquidity Forecast .................................................................................................................. 269
6.1.10.3 Forecast Planning Item ......................................................................................................... 272
6.1.11 Payment Formats .................................................................................................................. 274
6.1.11.1 Electronic Bank Statement File Formats ............................................................................... 274
6.1.11.2 Electronic Payment Formats ................................................................................................. 274
6.1.11.3 Manual Payment Formats ..................................................................................................... 275
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Table Of Contents PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 5
6.2 Master Data View .................................................................................................................. 276
6.2.1 Quick Guide for Master Data (in Liquidity Management) ...................................................... 276
6.3 Cash Position View ............................................................................................................... 281
6.3.1 Cash Position Quick Guide ................................................................................................... 281
6.4 File Management View .......................................................................................................... 282
6.4.1 File Management Quick Guide .............................................................................................. 282
6.5 Bank Statements View .......................................................................................................... 285
6.5.1 Bank Statements Quick Guide .............................................................................................. 285
6.6 Payment Monitor View .......................................................................................................... 287
6.6.1 Payment Monitor Quick Guide .............................................................................................. 287
6.7 Bank Payment Advices View ................................................................................................. 293
6.7.1 Quick Guide for Bank Payment Advices ............................................................................... 293
6.8 Liquidity Forecast View ......................................................................................................... 294
6.8.1 Liquidity Forecasts Quick Guide ............................................................................................ 294
6.8.2 Create and Refresh the Liquidity Forecast ............................................................................ 295
6.9 Bank Transaction Status Notifications View .......................................................................... 297
6.9.1 Quick Guide for Bank Transaction Status Notifications ......................................................... 297
6.10 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 298
6.10.1 Cash Position by Payment Method ....................................................................................... 298
6.10.2 Cash Position by Transaction Source ................................................................................... 301
6.10.3 Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level ...................................................................................... 303
6.10.4 Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method ................................................................................. 306
6.10.5 Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency .......................................................................... 308
6.10.6 Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source ............................................................................. 310
7 Tax Management ............................................................................................. 314
7.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 314
7.1.1 Tax Management Work Center ............................................................................................. 314
7.1.2 Tax Returns ........................................................................................................................... 315
7.1.2.1 Tax Register .......................................................................................................................... 315
7.1.2.2 Tax Codes and Tax Events ................................................................................................... 315
7.1.2.3 Example Scenario for Tax Returns ....................................................................................... 316
7.1.2.4 Status of Tax Returns ............................................................................................................ 317
7.1.2.5 Generic Tax Return As Tax Return Type .............................................................................. 318
7.1.2.6 Tax Due Date of Tax Items ................................................................................................... 319
7.1.2.7 Tax Reporting ........................................................................................................................ 321
7.1.2.8 Subsequent Reporting of Tax Items ...................................................................................... 321
7.1.2.9 Chamber Contribution Fee Calculation - Austria ................................................................... 322
7.1.2.10 Import Of Services – India ..................................................................................................... 322
7.1.2.11 Challan Processing - India .................................................................................................... 322
7.1.2.12 Purchase of Capital Goods - India ........................................................................................ 322
7.1.2.12 ............................................................................................................................................... 322
7.1.2.13 Prepayment of service tax - india .......................................................................................... 323
7.1.2.14 prepayment of VAT - India .................................................................................................... 323
7.1.2.15 Separate payment of CST and VAT - India ........................................................................... 323
6 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Table Of Contents
7.1.2.16 Service Tax Return - India ..................................................................................................... 323
7.1.2.17 Tax ABATEMENT — INDIA .................................................................................................. 323
7.1.2.18 Withholding Tax - India .......................................................................................................... 324
7.1.2.19 Import of goods - India .......................................................................................................... 324
7.1.2.20 Stock Transfer - India ............................................................................................................ 324
7.1.2.21 Unregistered Dealer Purchase - India ................................................................................... 324
7.1.2.22 withholding tax 27Q - INDIA .................................................................................................. 324
7.1.3 Tax Payments ....................................................................................................................... 325
7.1.3.1 Example Scenario for Tax Payments .................................................................................... 325
7.1.3.2 Status of Tax Payments ........................................................................................................ 325
7.1.4 Tax Transactions and Tax Postings ...................................................................................... 326
7.1.4.1 Example Scenario for Tax Entries ......................................................................................... 326
7.1.4.2 Goods and Services Granted Free of Charge ....................................................................... 327
7.1.4.3 Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method) ...................................................................... 331
7.1.4.4 Intra-Community Movement .................................................................................................. 332
7.1.4.5 Taxable Business Transactions Abroad ................................................................................ 333
7.1.4.6 Calculation of tax abroad for B2C sales ................................................................................ 334
7.1.4.7 Calculation of tax abroad for services ................................................................................... 336
7.1.4.8 Different Tax Rates in Invoices ............................................................................................. 338
7.1.4.9 Discounts: Cash Discounts and Bonuses ............................................................................. 339
7.1.4.10 Exchange Rate Differences in Journal Entries ...................................................................... 341
7.1.5 Tax Determination ................................................................................................................. 342
7.1.5.1 Tax Determination ................................................................................................................. 342
7.1.5.1.1 Tax Determination ................................................................................................................. 342
7.1.5.1.2 Tax Determination Details ..................................................................................................... 347
7.1.5.1.2.1 Master Data for Tax Determination ....................................................................................... 347
7.1.5.1.2.2 Elements of Tax Determination ............................................................................................. 349
7.1.5.1.2.3 Tax Exemption Certificate Processing .................................................................................. 354
7.1.5.1.2.4 Tax Determination with Reverse Charge Mechanism ........................................................... 355
7.1.5.1.2.5 Third-Party Order Processing Taxation ................................................................................. 358
7.1.5.1.2.6 Tax on Goods and Services - Configuration Guide ............................................................... 359
7.1.5.1.3 Tax Determination — US ...................................................................................................... 361
7.1.6 Access to Tax Data by Tax Authorities (GDPdU) .................................................................. 362
7.2 Tax Authorities View .............................................................................................................. 363
7.2.1 Quick Guide for Tax Authorities (Tax Management) ............................................................. 363
7.3 Manual Tax Entries View ....................................................................................................... 364
7.3.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Entries (US) ................................................................. 364
7.3.2 Quick Guide for VAT Entries ................................................................................................. 365
7.3.3 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Base Amount Entries (US) ............................................... 367
7.4 Tax Returns View .................................................................................................................. 368
7.4.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Returns (US) ................................................................ 368
7.4.2 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Returns (US) ..................................................................... 372
7.4.3 Quick Guide for VAT Returns ................................................................................................ 372
7.4.4 Quick Guide for EC Sales Lists ............................................................................................. 374
7.4.5 Quick Guide for GST Returns – Australia ............................................................................. 376
7.4.6 Quick Guide for Service Tax Returns - India ......................................................................... 378
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Table Of Contents PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 7
7.4.7 Quick Guide for Tax Adjustments — India ............................................................................ 379
7.4.8 Quick Guide for A-29 Reports – Mexico ................................................................................ 380
7.5 Tax Payments View ............................................................................................................... 382
7.5.1 Quick Guide for Tax Payments ............................................................................................. 382
7.6 Periodic Tasks ....................................................................................................................... 388
7.6.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Return Runs (US) ........................................................ 388
7.6.2 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Return Runs (US) ............................................................. 390
7.6.3 Quick Guide for VAT Return Runs ........................................................................................ 391
7.6.4 Quick Guide for EC Sales List Runs ..................................................................................... 393
7.6.5 Quick Guide for GST Return runs – Australia ....................................................................... 395
7.6.6 Quick Guide for Service Tax Return Runs – India ................................................................ 396
7.6.7 Quick Guide for A-29 Report Runs – Mexico ........................................................................ 398
7.7 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 399
7.7.1 Open VAT / Sales Tax Items ................................................................................................. 399
7.7.2 Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items ........................................................................................... 400
7.7.3 All VAT / Sales Tax Items ...................................................................................................... 401
7.7.4 VAT / Sales Tax Calculation Overview .................................................................................. 402
7.7.5 Withholding Tax Items ........................................................................................................... 403
8 Travel and Expenses ....................................................................................... 405
8.1 Business Background ............................................................................................................ 405
8.1.1 Travel Advances .................................................................................................................... 405
8.1.2 Review and Approval of Expense Reports ............................................................................ 407
8.1.3 Rule of 183 - Austria .............................................................................................................. 408
8.1.4 Rule of 5/5/15 - Austria .......................................................................................................... 408
8.1.5 Nonmonetary Compensation - Germany ............................................................................... 409
8.2 Expense Reports View .......................................................................................................... 410
8.2.1 Expense Reports Quick Guide .............................................................................................. 410
8.2.2 Create New Expense Report on Behalf ................................................................................ 412
8.3 Expense Arrangements View ................................................................................................ 413
8.3.1 Expense Arrangements Quick Guide .................................................................................... 413
8.4 Expense Settlement Recalculation View ............................................................................... 414
8.4.1 Quick Guide for Expense Settlement Recalculation Runs .................................................... 414
8.5 Mileage Accumulation View .................................................................................................. 415
8.5.1 Mileage Accumulation Quick Guide ...................................................................................... 415
8.6 Day Accumulation View ......................................................................................................... 416
8.6.1 Quick Guide for Day Accumulation - Austria ......................................................................... 416
8.7 Reports .................................................................................................................................. 417
8.7.1 Expense Reports By Cost Object .......................................................................................... 417
8.7.2 Expense Reports – Overview ................................................................................................ 418
8.7.3 Expense Reports – Receipts and Reimbursements .............................................................. 420
8.7.4 Expense Reports - Taxable and Tax-Exempt Amounts for Payroll ....................................... 421
8.7.5 Expense Reports – Input VAT Refund .................................................................................. 422
8.7.6 Expense Reports – Itinerary .................................................................................................. 423
8.7.7 Expense Reports - Overview of Trips to Communities in Austria ......................................... 424
8 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Table Of Contents
8.7.8 Expense Reports - Taxable and Tax-Exempt Amounts for Austria ...................................... 425
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Table Of Contents PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 9
1 Cash Flow Management
Overview
Cash flow management in the SAP Business ByDesign solution supports your organization in tracking and optimizing
cash flow and keeping tight control of receivables, payables, payments, and liquidity. Automation speeds the collection
of receivables, and analytical functions assess your cash position in real time. SAP Business ByDesign helps you
optimize your liquidity, so you have sufficient financial resources available at all times.
Relevance
The Cash Flow Management business area is relevant if you need support for:
● Payables/receivables
● Payment and liquidity management
● Tax management
● Travel and expenses
Benefits
● Your core operations become fully integrated.
Nearly every business process supported by the SAP Business ByDesign solution is connected to the financials
area. Data flows automatically to financial activities such as payables and receivables processing and to accounting
activities such as inventory accounting. This deep integration enables innovative functions for automating revenue
recognition as well as for forecasting and analyzing profitability.
● You have better control over receivables, payables, payments, and liquidity.
Liquidity management functions in SAP Business ByDesign let you optimize your working capital. You can assess
cash positions in real time, identify critical issues, and generate new tasks for financial personnel responsible for
addressing these issues. This results in shortened cash cycles. The software can also help you optimize your
payment processes by taking advantage of early payment discounts that may reduce cash flow in the short term –
but ultimately save you money and contribute directly to the bottom line.
● You can collaborate more closely with your business partners along the value chain.
With cash flow management software in SAP Business ByDesign, you can cut costs and react faster to business
changes. Comprehensive integrated functionality – such as support for payment reminders, payment advices, and
electronic bank transfers or statements – enables you to streamline and accelerate your financial operations. SAP
Business ByDesign provides the holistic and flexible collaboration functionality you need to seamlessly connect and
communicate with your business ecosystem – for example, with banks, clearing houses, tax authorities, and lockbox
providers. Note: If Cash Flow Management is not activated the master data of e.g. tax authorities, banks or clearing
houses can also be entered in the Business Partner Data work center.
● Tasks become more automated – and your employees’ performance accelerates.
SAP Business ByDesign enables you to automate routine tasks whenever possible. For example, the software
automatically supports clearing, dunning, and payment processes. When exceptions occur, SAP Business ByDesign
proactively alerts the responsible employee and may offer suggestions or additional functions; for example, during
the clearing process the software proactively provides potential matches of open items and incoming payments.
10 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Cash Flow Management
2 Business Background
2.1 Outgoing Payments
2.1.1 Outgoing Payments
Overview
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
Examples of outgoing payments:
● Payment of trade payables
● Purchase of physical products and services
● Payments of insurance contributions and fees
● Expense reimbursements
● Tax payments
● Repayment of loans
● Private withdrawals
The system differentiates between automatic outgoing payments and manual outgoing payments. You find the
outgoing payments in the Payment Management work center in the Payment Monitor. The same payment methods are
available for both types of outgoing payments:
● Checks
● Bank transfers
● Direct debits
You do not see the direct debit as a payment method in the outgoing payments since you do not need to initiate
it yourself.
● Bill of exchange
The bill of exchange payment method is not released for Germany.
● Petty cash transactions
Petty cash transactions are not in the payment monitor, but instead, in the Petty Cash view. These
transactions are used only with manual payments.
Prerequisites
Configuration
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 11
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
In the Business Configuration work center in the task list included in the Fine-Tune phase, you have made the following
settings relevant for cash flow management:
● Bank Account and Payment Method Determination and Prioritization for Automatic Payments:
You define which account you want to use for which payment methods. You also assign a priority to the bank
accounts and payment methods that is used for automatic payments. You can set this priority either including or
excluding payment amounts.
● Electronic Bank Statements:
The import format used for electronic bank statements corresponds to the format of the file that is sent by the bank.
The import format contains business transaction codes that determine the transaction type involved. The business
transaction codes have to be assigned to internal system codes so that the transaction types can be displayed
correctly in the form of the corresponding incoming and outgoing payments. SWIFT MT940 is the common import
format in Germany. Suppliers – Payment Terms.
● Suppliers – Payment Terms:
You define the payment terms that exist in your company, namely the payment targets and discount amounts. You
can also add additional terms. Depending on the strategy you use, invoices are automatically included in the
payment proposal list at either an earlier or later date, together with the complete or reduced invoice amount.
● Business Task Management for Processing Payments and Clearings:
For incoming payments grouped by payment methods and for particular users, you can specify the payment amount
from which an approval process is triggered. The approval request is then sent to the person responsible for making
approvals.
● Payment Strategies
You can define whether to always apply the available cash discounts or whether to generally use the maximum
discount available. You can also define grace days that are taken into account during the payment run.
● Clearing Strategies:
You specify the amount up to which the system tolerates differences between the invoice amount and actual
payment amount collected by the supplier, and automatically clears the payables with the outgoing payments. If
the difference amount is exceeded, the system issues a message (if you have made this setting in configuration).
Furthermore, you define how a payment amount should be distributed when multiple open items need to be cleared
(by due date, for example). If you create multiple clearing strategies, you need to define the strategy that you want
to use as standard. You can also define strategies for specific companies, customers, or suppliers. This strategy
is only used for externally-initiated outgoing payments (by direct debit from the supplier).
Master Data
● Bank Data:
You create your own bank data in the Liquidity Management work center under My Banks .
● Definition of Supplier Data and Payment Methods:
You define this data in the Payables work center under Suppliers Suppliers . Choose New to create a
new supplier or select one of the existing suppliers and choose Edit -> Financial Data to change the data of an
existing supplier.
In the payment data, you enter which companies use this supplier. With the account determination group, you
determine which payables account is used during posting. You can also determine which payment method you
want to use to pay supplier invoices. When you assign the company to a supplier, the subledger account is created
12 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
automatically in the background. If you do not assign a company, the subledger account is automatically created
with the first invoice or credit memo entered for this supplier.
Process Flow
Automatic Outgoing Payments
You can have the system generate a payment proposal list, which contains the items to be paid and cleared according
to the configured payment strategy. You can edit the proposed payments, such as remove items from them or change
the payment amount.
To make changes, navigate to the Payables work center to the Automatic Payments view. Select a payment and click
Edit . Once you have checked the details, click Execute Payment . If your configuration settings require an approval to
be made, the system triggers the approval process.
You can reset payment proposals that have already been released and also reset generated payments, provided that
they were not confirmed by the bank statement on the bank account. Items that you temporarily remove from the current
payment proposal are taken into account in the next payment run, unless they are blocked for payment in the meantime.
To create the payment medium, navigate to the Payment Management work center. There you can generate a payment
file or print a check. You can also create the payment medium manually and indicate this accordingly in the system (SetAs Manually Created). You can automate and schedule the creation of payment media with the payment media run.
The process flow described for an outgoing payment relates to internally initiated automatic outgoing payments.
However, outgoing payments can also be externally initiated, for example if they are triggered by your suppliers. The
automatic debit procedure belongs to this type of payment.
Manual Outgoing Payments
You can create and edit internally-initiated manual outgoing payments. You do this in the Payables or Payment
Management work centers:
The Payment Management work center enables you to create outgoing payments using the payment monitor for supplier
payables or other payments that you can post directly to a general ledger account.
The Payables work center enables you to create manual outgoing payments using the supplier account monitor for
supplier payables.
1. Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Suppliers Supplier Accounts . Select a supplier and choose
View .
The Supplier Account Monitor screen appears.
2. You can perform manual outgoing payment by selecting the required invoice and choosing Pay Manually By and
the required payment method (for example, outgoing check, outgoing bank transfer).
In the payment window displayed, you can also add or remove invoices, credit memos, or on account payments
that have already been made.
Enter the required data. Different data is required depending on the payment method (for example, bank transfer
or check). Some relevant fields are described below: ● Currency
The currency in which the payment should be made. The postings at all bank accounts are made in local
currency. You can manage bank accounts in foreign currency and make payments in foreign currency. Foreign
currency remeasurement takes place in the general ledger and cannot be seen on the individual bank
accounts. For more information, see Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Cash) [242], Quick
Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Receivables) [166] and Quick Guide for Foreign Currency
Remeasurement (Payables) [104].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 13
● Debit Value Date
The date on which the payment is debited. The value date can differ from the posting date of the payment.
This entry is important as this is the posting date of the debit according to the bank statement, that is, posting
to the bank clearing account takes place on this date. If you do not enter a date here, the system proposes
today's date. If you enter bank statements, you must change this date to the appropriate posting date.
● Credit Value Date
The credit value date represents the planned incoming payment at the recipient and is transferred to the bank.
The bank transfers the payment to the recipient on this day.
● Company and Bank Details (from which the payment should be made)
You change your own bank data in the Liquidity Management work center under Master Data My
Banks .
● Payee and Payee Bank Information
You define the financial data in the master data of the supplier.
Optionally, you can still enter the execution date and the transaction date for bank transfers. The execution
date shows the bank when the outgoing payment should be executed. The transaction date represents the
date on which the system creates the posting and sends the file to the bank.
3. Release the payment.
If your configuration settings require an approval to be made, the approval process is initiated.
You can also choose whether you want to print the document (for example, check) or whether the payment medium
exists already and you only want to represent the posting in the system.
See Also
Open Items Payables [73]
Determination of Payment Method / Reservation [14]
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Bank Statements [253]
2.1.2 Determination of Payment Method / Reservation
Overview
The payment method specifies how you execute payments, for example, by check or bank transfer. You create the
payment method settings for internally initiated payments and your company's account information.
You specify the payment method at the following locations:
● In the customer or supplier master data
● In the open items
You also define the detailed information (for example, the account number and bank code for a bank transfer).
The system accesses this data when creating the payment proposal list:
If you have not specified a payment method in the master data, you can enter the payment method in the open items
when processing the payment proposal list. The payment method specified in the open items, overrides the payment
method specified in the master record. You can also specify a payment method in the open items that is not contained
in the master record.
14 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
If multiple payment methods are specified in the master data but none in the open items, the system examines in the
sequence in which the payment methods were entered, whether the payment methods specified for the payment run
can be performed. The system attempts to determine the optimal (most favorable and quickest) payment method.
For disbursements in foreign currencies, the system checks whether the payment methods allow disbursements to
suppliers, customers, or banks abroad. For collections in foreign currencies, the payment method for foreign currency
payments must be allowed.
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Fine-Tuning
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Determination of Payment Method / Reservation is activated in your solution configuration. To find this activity, go to
the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase and select the following activities from the activity list.
● Payment methods of the country under Global Settings for Payments: Definitions that are necessary country-
specific for a payment method. This is necessary for all payment methods that are used in a country by your
company. For example, if you have companies in Germany, France, and the United States, you define the payment
method Check separately for each country.
● Payment methods of the company under Bank Account and Payment Method Determination and Prioritization
for Automatic Payments Prioritize Bank Accounts and Payment Method based on Amount : Define the payment
methods used for each company with maximum and minimum amounts.
Supplier Master Data
If you have agreed a payment method with a business partner, for example, you can specify this directly in the master
record.
You can also specify multiple payment methods in the master record from which the system selects one payment method
during the payment run. It does this according to the payment method specified in the document (for example, invoice
or credit memo) or one of the payment methods specified in configuration during bank prioritization.
To specify payment methods in the master record, choose Payables Suppliers , select a supplier and click
Edit . Then choose Financial Data Payment Data . Under Payment Methods, you can select all payment
methods that you have defined in configuration for your company.
Customer Master Data
You define a payment method in the customer master record if you want to execute internally initiated payments. This
concerns, for example, an agreement with the customer to debit customer invoices directly from the customer's account
by direct debit with mandate. If you define payment methods in the customer master data, these payments are also
included in the payment proposal list.
Choose Receivables Customers and click Go . Choose a customer, then click Edit and choose Financial
Data Payment Data . Under Payment Methods, you can select all payment methods that you have defined in
configuration for your company.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 15
Features
Payment Methods in Open Items
You can specify the payment method for each disbursement during invoice entry. This payment method then appears
automatically in the payment proposal list. However, if no payment method was specified, the standard payment method
from the master data appears in the payment proposal list. You can change this payment method when processing the
payment proposal list with any other payment method that is defined in the master record.
To change the payment method in open items, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payables work center, choose Automatic Payments.
This view displays the Payment Proposal List, that is, all due open items.
2. Select the payment for which you want to change or enter the payment method and choose Edit .
The Payment Proposal:<Payment Proposal Number> screen is displayed.
3. Enter a payment method under Payment Method or change the existing payment method. If a payment method is
entered explicitly in the item to be paid, this entry takes precedence over the entries in the master record.
4. Save your entries.
Payment Reservation
To execute the payment, there must be an Allocation of Liquidity in case the company is in a precarious financial
situation. When allocating the liquidity, the system checks whether there is sufficient liquidity for the disbursement at
the bank and reserves the relevant amount for this payment. For important payments, you can decide that there should
be no allocation of liquidity. In this case, the payment is made regardless of the availability of liquid funds.
2.1.3 Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments
Overview
In your role as an accounts payable accountant, you require functions to process national and international outgoing
payment transactions made with suppliers and other creditors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management and Payables work centers. When you create a payment, you can specify the payment method
and other details, such as the house bank account from which to pay, the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the
bank processing date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all
payment transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payee.
As the accounts payable accountant for your company, you initiate the automatic creation and editing of outgoing
payments in the Payables work center. Here you create a payment run, which is used to generate a payment proposal
list based on the payment strategy configured and the selection criteria chosen. Possible selection criteria are:
● Company
● Date of the next payment run; if required, taking account of your configuration settings for the payment strategy
Specify this date if you want to perform the payment run once only. If you schedule the payment run to be performed
on a recurring basis, the system determines the appropriate date.
● Suppliers and other creditors
● Currency
● Bank processing date
16 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Specify the requested payment date (for bank transfers and direct debits only). Depending on working days, the
bank may make the payment later. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run periodically.
● Posting date
The default posting date is the execution date of the run. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run
periodically.
In your role as accounts payable accountant, you can edit the payment proposals and then release them for payment
creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually
for the same or an overlapping selection of suppliers.
You can execute the payment run manually often as you want.
The system supports the following forms of payment:
● Outgoing check, with the option of including payment advices
● Outgoing wire transfer
● Outgoing bank transfer, with the option of including payment advices
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your outgoing payment
processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following activities in the Business Configuration work center under Activity List Fine-
Tuning Cash Flow Management :
● Business Task Management for Bank Statement Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity Payment Approvals (optional)
● Outgoing Checks (mandatory)
● Outgoing Wire Transfers (mandatory)
● Outgoing Bank Transfers (mandatory)
● Outgoing Payment Advices (mandatory)
● Bank Groups (mandatory)
● Global Settings for Payment (optional)
● Basic Settings for Liquidity Management (mandatory)
● Payment Block Reasons (optional)
● Import Formats for Bank Statements (mandatory)
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 17
● Release Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Liquidity Forecast Profiles (optional)
● Clearing Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
Master Data
● You have defined a country in which your company is registered.
● You have set up the bank details of your bank accounts for your suppliers' and creditors' accounts.
● You have made a payment agreement with your suppliers and creditors.
● You have defined the supported payment formats for your bank.
● You have ensured that your bank accounts are active and have the desired payment methods assigned to them.
Process Flow
The following section explains the steps that need to be performed to use the automatic payment process and to process
the relevant open items.
The process flow describes the individual steps that are specific to an automated outgoing payment by bank transfer.
The process flow is the same for outgoing payments using other payment methods.
Creating the Invoice
1. Your company's purchasing department has requested services or ordered goods from a supplier, for example,
with a purchase order from the Purchase Requests and Orders work center.
2. The supplier from which your company procures the ordered goods or requested services issues a supplier invoice
and sends it to your company.
The supplier invoice contains a reference to preceding documents, for example, to an underlying
purchase order and an underlying goods receipt and external services document. In addition, the system
provides functions for the payment of supplier invoices without preceding documents. In this case, you
can enter additional invoices or credit memos for each supplier account in the supplier account monitor.
3. In your role as accounts payable accountant, you want to clear the open items of the supplier invoice.
For more information, see:
● Purchase Request Processing
● Purchase Order Processing
● Processing Goods and Services Receipts
● Supplier Invoice Types
● Processing Supplier Invoices Without Reference
● Processing Supplier Invoices with Reference
Triggering the Automated Payment Process
1. Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Periodic Tasks Payment Runs .
2. Choose New then Payment Run. Define for which supplier(s) and with which criteria you want to schedule a
payment run to clear open items. You create a new payment run based on these criteria.
Possible selection criteria are: ● Posting date
18 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
● Bank processing date
● Include on account payments
● Company
● Supplier from / to ID
You can define a value range and thus select multiple suppliers for one payment run.
If you do not select a supplier, the system selects all the suppliers entered in the system for the
payment run.
● Currency
● Next payment run date
3. Activate the payment run and choose Schedule.
4. The Schedule Job screen appears. Choose when the payment run should be executed. You have the following
options: ● Start Immediately
The system starts the payment run directly after you have saved your entries.
● Single Run
The system starts the payment run on the date and at the time you have specified.
● Run After Job
The system starts the payment run depending on another payment run. That is, the payment run starts directly
after completion of the payment run that you selected from the selection list.
The system starts the payment run and generates a payment proposal list using the values defined in configuration.
Note that the time it takes for the payment run to execute varies depending on the number of items to
be paid.
5. In the Payables work center in the Automatic Payments view, display the payment proposals that have been created
with the suppliers to be paid and your company's other creditors to which payables exist.
If the displayed payment proposals are not up-to-date or cannot be edited manually, the system deletes
these payment proposals. Therefore, you can no longer view these proposals in the Automatic
Payments view.
For more information, see:
● Open Items Payables [73]
Automatic Creation and Release of the Payment Medium
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and navigate to the Payment Monitor view to display the edited
payment and its status.
2. Within the Payment Management work center, go to the Periodic Tasks view and choose Payment Media Runs.
3. Define for which payments and with which criteria, you want to schedule a payment media run. Possible selection
criteria are: ● Payment method
● Payment media
● Payment format
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 19
● Business partner (for example, supplier or customer)
You can define a value range and then select multiple business partners or a payment processing
date for one payment media run.
If you do not select a business partner or payment processing date, the system selects all business
partners entered in the system regardless of possible payment processing dates for the payment
media run.
● Company
● Currency
4. Start the predefined payment media run manually if required, or schedule the run periodically. To do this, go to the
Job Scheduler screen and choose Activate and Schedule.
You can activate a payment media run directly on the Job Scheduler screen or from the payment media
run overview in the Periodic Tasks view.
You can use the payment media run for the standard payment methods bank transfer and check. The system
generates the following tasks depending on the selected payment method: ● If you have selected the standard payment method bank transfer, the system generates a file for a German
domestic bank transfer, for example, in DTAUSDE0 format. You can transfer this file to your bank using specific
bank software.
● If you have selected the standard payment method check, the system generates a print file. You can print this
print file of the check and send it to your suppliers to clear your payables.
You can also print checks directly in the Payment Management work center within the Payment
Monitor view.
At present, the system only supports print files for checks; processing bank checks is not possible.
For more information, see Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices [65].
5. Download the file from the system and save a local copy.
You need the local copy to transfer the outbound file to your bank. The file is transferred using specific
bank software that you should have received from your bank.
6. Transmit the local outbound file online to your bank using the required bank software.
Editing the Bank Statement
1. Within the Liquidity Management work center, navigate to the Bank Statements view.
2. Enter your bank statement data in the system.
To ensure a timely update of your bank balances, we recommend saving the bank statement as a local
bank statement file on the day after the online transfer.
Depending on the standard processes in your company, you have the following options to enter bank statement
data in your system: ● Electronic Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted Online
Once you have uploaded the locally-saved bank statement file, the system transfers the file data automatically.
● Manual Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted on PaperEnter the bank statement items from the local copy manually in your system, taking account of references to
preceding documents (for example, invoices).
3. If the bank statement was released, the relevant payment is indicated as confirmed.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
20 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
2.1.4 Externally Initiated Outgoing Payments
Overview
As accounts payable accountant it is your task to process your company's national and international outgoing payment
transactions made with suppliers and other creditors. This also includes clearing payments that your suppliers have
collected from your company. The system makes all required functions available in the Payables, Payment
Management, and Liquidity Management work centers.
The system supports the following standard payment methods:
● Direct debits
● Credit card collections
● Bill of exchange payables
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Scoping
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Outgoing payment processes are activated in your solution configuration. To do this, go to the Business Configuration
work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Payables and Receivables Processing is selected
within Cash Flow Management.
In the Questions step, expand the Cash Flow Management scoping element, select Payables and Receivables
Processing and answer the questions.
Fine-Tuning
You must have performed the following fine-tune activities in the Business Configuration work center: choose the
Implementation Projects view, select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune
phase, choose Cash Flow Management and perform the following activities in the activity list:
● Business Task Management for Processing of Payments and Clearings (optional)
● Business Task Management for Bank Statement Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment Processing (optional)
● Bank Groups (mandatory)
● Global Settings for Liquidity Management (mandatory)
● Import Formats for Bank Statements (mandatory)
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 21
● Release Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Clearing Strategy (mandatory)
Master Data
● You have defined a country in which your company is registered.
● You have set up your bank accounts.
Process Flow
The following section explains the precautionary and processing steps that need to be performed to clear open items
from payments collected by suppliers.
The process flow describes the individual steps that are specific to clearing an outgoing payment by direct debit. The
process flow is the same for outgoing payments using other payment methods and payment procedures.
Creating the Invoice and Collecting the Direct Debit Payment
1. Your company's purchasing department has requested services or ordered goods from a supplier, for example,
with a purchase order from the Purchase Requests and Orders work center.
2. The supplier of the ordered goods or requested services issues an invoice and sends it to your company.
The invoice contains a reference to preceding documents, for example, to an underlying purchase order
and an underlying goods receipt and external services document. In addition, the system provides
functions for the payment of invoices without preceding documents.
3. To clear the open items from the invoice, your supplier collects the outstanding amount for the ordered goods or
requested services by direct debit from your company's bank.
Managing the Direct Debit Payment in the Bank Statement
1. In your role as accounts payable accountant, you receive a bank statement from your company's bank. An item of
the bank statement refers to the payment made to your suppliers by direct debit.
2. You want to enter and manage the direct debit payment in the form of a bank statement item in your system.
3. Navigate to the Liquidity Management work center and choose the Bank Statements view.
Here you can view all of your company's bank statements that were manually entered or automatically generated
by the system.
4. To create a bank statement that represents the direct debit payment as an item, click New and choose Bank
Statement .
5. On the following Bank Statement: <Bank Statement Number> screen in the Enter General Data step, enter the
general data for the direct debit payment. The system requires this data for later payment clearing.
You do not have to manually make all entries for each payment separately. Depending on your settings, the system
automatically proposes the following values: ● Statement ID
The system assigns sequential bank statement IDs if nothing else is planned in configuration.
● Opening Balance
The system derives the opening balance on your company's bank account from the balance of the previous
bank statement.
You need to manually enter the following values of the bank statement item that refer to the payment made to your
suppliers by direct debit. ● Bank Name
● Closing Balance
22 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Entering the closing balance on your company's bank account is necessary to define the amount that
was paid by direct debit. The system manages the difference from the opening balance and the closing
balance on your company's bank account as the payment.
6. Once you have entered the data, go to item selection (step Select Items) by choosing Next . The system displays
an overview of all internally initiated transactions that were already entered for the selected bank statement.
The system does not show any transactions for externally initiated outgoing payments here. You have
to enter these in your system first as separate transactions.
7. Enter the direct debit payment as a new transaction. You want to manage this payment as an item of the newly
created bank statement. Make sure that you enter all required values. This includes data on the following tab pages:
8. Choose Next to go to the step Create and Edit Items, and enter the required values. Choose the Item Details
action to enter the following additional data: ● Transaction Data
You use the specified transaction data to manage the transaction type, original currency amount, business
partner (supplier), document ID, value date, and account owner, for example.
● References
You use the entered references to manage the internal invoice reference ID, document date, or amount to be
paid, for example. This means that you define to which invoice(s), which already exist for your supplier in the
system, the direct debit payment refers.
We recommend entering references to the edited invoices that were paid by direct debit. The system
automatically transfers these references for later payment clearing.
You can enter a cash discount and deductions for other reasons within later payment clearing.
● Note to Payee (optional)
You use the specified note to payee to manage additional information about the direct debit payment that you
are editing. This information is used to uniquely assign the payment to the items in your accounts payable
accounting system.
9. Once you have entered the data, you can check your bank statement for which you have entered the direct debit
payment as a new transaction. You can then finish processing and release the bank statement. To do this, during
the Check, choose the actions Check, Save Draft, Release, and in the confirmation step the action Close.
Based on the entries that you have made on the transaction type and supplier, the system recognizes the
transaction as an outgoing payment that is managed as a bank statement item. The system forwards this
information to the Payables work center where the bank statement is processed further.
Clearing the Direct Debit Payment
1. Go to the Payables work center to trigger payment clearing for the items of the edited bank statement.
If you have specified references when you entered your bank statement on the edited invoices that were
paid by direct debit, the system automatically performs payment clearing. Manual processing is therefore
not required.
Therefore, we recommend that you specify references directly when you enter your bank statements.
The higher degree of automation increases the efficiency of your accounting processes and reduces the
costs that arise from the processing effort.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 23
2. If manual triggering of payment clearing is required, the system offers you the following functions depending on the
processes in your company and your configuration settings: ● Manual Payment Clearing
This process of payment clearing refers to a selected payment. You use this process in the following cases: ○ No references were entered in the system.
○ There is an overpayment.
○ A different payer was entered.
● Supplier Account MaintenanceThis process of payment clearing refers to all payments that exist in the system for a selected supplier.
3. Depending on the selected process of payment clearing, choose one of the alternatives described in the following
sections. Perform the process steps listed.
Manual Payment Clearing
1. Navigate within the Payables work center to the Payment Clearing view and display the items that were entered in
your system.
2. Select the item of the direct debit payment that you want to clear and choose Edit .
Items that you want to clear must have the status Open or Partially Cleared.
On the following Manual Payment Clearing: <Payment Clearing Number> screen, the system displays the details
on the selected item on the Manual Clearing tab page. This includes the payment amount, not assigned payment
amount, taken cash discount, other deductions, or payment type. Furthermore, the system displays a list of all the
open items that you can use for payment clearing.
Items proposed by the system that are based on amount, references, or payment clearing, are
automatically preselected in the open item list. You can override this preselection if required.
3. On the Manual Clearing tab page in the Open Items list, select the invoice(s) that you want to clear with the direct
debit payment.
You can clear an invoice completely or partially with a payment: ● Partial Clearing of an Invoice
The invoice amount is greater than the amount that was actually collected by direct debit.
If you clear the invoice with the payment, there is a residual item.
● Clearing Multiple InvoicesThe individual invoice amounts are smaller than the amount that was actually collected by direct debit.
If you clear multiple invoices with the payment, the system combines as many invoices until the invoice
amounts are similar to the actual payment amount.
4. Once you have completed processing, the prerequisites for payment clearing have been met. Choose Actions
Clear to trigger the process of payment clearing for the selected invoice(s).
Depending on your configuration settings, you can enter a cash discount or a deduction for another reason
(for example, defect or delayed delivery) to your invoice here. An additional approval may then be required
by a manager of the organizational unit.
Supplier Account Maintenance
1. Navigate within the Payables work center to the Suppliers view and choose the Supplier Accounts screen.
2. In the displayed worklist, select the supplier account from which the direct debit payment was initiated. To do this,
choose Display Account.
24 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
On the following Supplier Account Monitor: <Supplier Name and Number> screen on the Trade Payables tab page,
the system displays the detailed view of the selected supplier account.
3. Start account maintenance and select the invoice(s) that you want to clear with the direct debit payment. Then
choose Clear Manually .
You can clear an invoice completely or partially with a payment: ● Partial Clearing of an Invoice
The invoice amount is greater than the amount that was actually collected by direct debit. If you clear the
invoice with the payment, there is a residual item.
● Clearing Multiple InvoicesThe individual invoice amounts are smaller than the amount that was actually collected by direct debit. If you
clear multiple invoices with the payment, the system combines as many invoices until the invoice amounts are
similar to the actual payment amount.
You can view the items of the selected invoice using Open Item Details . The system displays all
items regardless of their status. You can select a cleared item and go directly to the related payment
clearing process using View Clearing Document. This could be necessary, for example, to view the
items or to cancel payment clearing.
4. The New Manual Clearing screen appears. On the Manual Clearing tab page, select the direct debit payment with
which you want to clear previously selected invoice(s).
Depending on your configuration settings, you can enter a cash discount or a deduction for another
reason (for example, defect or delayed delivery) to your payment here. An additional approval may then
be required by a manager of the organizational unit.
During the manual payment clearing process described above, you can enter a cash discount or other
deduction for an invoice but not for a payment.
5. Once you have made the selection, choose Clear . The system automatically closes payment clearing using the
selected items.
See Also
Outgoing Payments [11]
Incoming Payments [31]
2.1.5 Internally Initiated Manual Outgoing Payments
Overview
In your role as an accounts payable accountant, you require functions to process national and international outgoing
payment transactions made with suppliers and other creditors. The system makes these functions available in several
work centers. All special features can be defined, such as settings for the payment forms and payment methods, payment
formats or data media. The system also enables you to monitor payment transactions with a complete record of the
processing status of all relevant payment processes.
You initiate the manual creation and editing of outgoing payments for your company in the Payables work center or
directly in the Payment Management work center.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 25
In the Payables work center, you can use the supplier account display to create individual payments. Once
a payment has been created, you can go to the Payment Management work center to view your company’s
accounts payable.
The system supports the following forms of payments:
● Outgoing check, with the option of including payment advices
● Outgoing cash payment
For more information, see Quick Guide for Petty Cash [217].
● Outgoing wire transfer
● Outgoing credit card payment
For more information, see Credit Card Chargebacks [190].
● Outgoing refund of incoming payment
For more information, see Refund of Payments Received [144].
● Outgoing bank transfer, with the option of including payment advices
● Bill of exchange payable
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your outgoing payment
processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following activities in the Business Configuration work center under Activity List Fine-
Tuning Cash Flow Management :
● Business Task Management for Bank Statement Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Credit Card Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity Payment Approvals (optional)
● Outgoing Checks (mandatory)
● Outgoing Wire Transfers (mandatory)
● Outgoing Bank Transfers (mandatory)
● Outgoing Payment Advices (mandatory)
● Bank Groups (mandatory)
● Global Settings for Payment (optional)
● Basic Settings for Liquidity Management (mandatory)
● Payment Block Reasons (optional)
● Import Formats for Bank Statements (mandatory)
26 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
● Release Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Credit Card Types (optional)
● Liquidity Forecast Profiles (optional)
● Clearing Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Allocation (optional)
Master Data
● You have defined a country in which your company is registered.
● You have set up the bank details of your bank accounts for your suppliers' and creditors' accounts.
● You have made a payment agreement with your suppliers and creditors and have made other related settings.
● You have defined the supported payment formats for your bank.
● You have made sure that your bank accounts are active for outgoing payments and all related settings have been
made. This includes setting up the payment procedure and liquidity check, and releasing the required currencies.
Process Flow
The following section explains the precautionary and processing steps that need to be performed to use the manual
payment process and to process the relevant open items manually.
The process flow describes the individual steps that are specific to a manual outgoing payment by bank transfer. The
process flow is the same for outgoing payments using other payment forms and payment methods.
Creating the Invoice
1. Your company's purchasing department has requested services or ordered goods from a supplier, for example,
with a purchase order from the Purchase Requests and Orders work center.
2. The supplier from which your company procures the ordered goods or requested services issues a supplier invoice
and sends it to your company.
The supplier invoice contains a reference to preceding documents, for example, to an underlying
purchase order and an underlying goods receipt and external services document. In addition, the system
provides functions for the payment of supplier invoices without preceding documents. In this case, you
can enter additional invoices or credit memos for each supplier account in the supplier account monitor.
To do this, choose New Invoice/Credit Memo in the supplier account.
3. In your role as accounts payable accountant, you want to clear the open items of the supplier invoice.
For more information, see:
● Purchase Request Processing
● Purchase Order Processing
● Processing Goods and Services Receipts
● Supplier Invoice Types
● Processing Supplier Invoices Without Reference
● Processing Supplier Invoices with Reference
Manually Triggering the Payment Process
1. Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Suppliers Supplier Accounts to display your company's
suppliers' accounts to which payables exist.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 27
2. Select the supplier account you want to use to pay the invoice and choose View Account.
On the Supplier Account Monitor screen, the system displays general data on the selected supplier account and,
on the Trade Payables tab page, payables that your company has at this supplier.
The system automatically displays the Trade Payables tab by default.
3. To trigger the payment of an invoice manually, select it and choose Actions Pay Manually By .
Use the input help to select the payment method that you want to use to clear the invoice manually. You can choose
from the following payment methods: ● Outgoing check
● Outgoing bank transfer
● Outgoing wire transfer
If you have made a payment agreement with your suppliers, the system provides you with only the
payment methods defined in this payment agreement. If you have not made a payment agreement, the
input help is restricted to Incoming Check and Other Payment Methods.
You can also trigger payments directly in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view. To do this, choose Pay Manually By, specify the creditor you want to pay, and select the
open items to be paid.
The system opens the corresponding follow-on screen depending on the payment method selected:
For more information, see: ● Open Items Payables [73]
● Determination of Payment Method / Reservation [14]
● Supplier Account Monitor [74]
4. On the New Outgoing Bank Transfer screen, enter the data needed to pay the invoice.
Note that the name of the screen changes depending on the payment method you have selected.
If required, you can define an additional cash discount or deduction for the edited payment.
Depending on your configuration settings, the system automatically adds a payment proposal for
payment optimization using the data you entered (for example, best payment method or bank details).
For this, choose Complete Bank Data. You no longer need to enter the missing data manually. For the
payment proposal, you can preassign the payment amount and payment method as selection criteria.
The system provides you with additional criteria if you select View All.
Note that the actual payment amount according to configuration can differ from the original invoice
amount, for example, due to a cash discount or another type of deduction.
At this point, the system displays both the invoice that you want to pay and all the other open items from
the corresponding supplier. If required, you can select at this stage any additional open items to be paid.
You can influence how your outgoing payment is used and then view it on the screen.
If the Reference to Items radio button is selected, the open items that are to be cleared with the payment
are explicitly selected for payment in the system.
If the Direct Posting to G/L Account radio button is selected, the payment does not refer to a selection
of open items. Instead, the posting is made directly to the corresponding G/L account. This means that
you can specify the accounts to which the postings are made.
28 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
The Direct Posting to G/L Account radio button is also provided in the Payment Management and Liquidity
Management work centers. Both work centers incorporate the radio button, which you can use for specific
payments, such as donations or cash discounts.
5. Once you have entered the data, choose Release.
The system issues an appropriate message with which you can see the status change of the payment.
The message also shows you whether the payment was triggered directly or whether according to
configuration, approval is required by a manager of the organizational unit. For the approval check, you
can preassign a maximum limit for the payment amount as criterion.
Further processing of the payment is not possible until the responsible manager has approved the
payment of this invoice.
Manual Creation and Release of the Payment Medium
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and navigate to the Payment Monitor view.
2. Select the payment for which you want to create the payment medium.
To speed up the search process, we recommend that you use the enhanced search function. To do this,
choose Advanced and enter your search criteria (for example, payment method, document ID, or name
of the payee).
Depending on the payment method for the payment you have selected, you can perform different actions:
The system provides the following Actions for Bank Transactions, for example: Create Payment File,
Set As Manually Created, and Set to Not Transferred.
3. Create the actual payment medium for the payment to be processed using bank transfer. To do this, choose
Actions for Bank Transactions Create Payment File .
4. Depending on the payment method that is intended for the payment of the invoice, the system offers different
options to edit the data further and to provide your bank with the data for the actual cash transfer.
The system generates the following tasks within the payment media creation run for the standard payment methods
bank transfer and check: ● If you have selected the standard payment method bank transfer, the system generates a file for a German
domestic bank transfer, for example, in DTAUSDE0 format. You can transfer this file to your bank using specific
bank software.
● If you have selected the standard payment method check, the system generates a print file. You can print this
print file of the check and send it to your suppliers to clear your payables.
5. Download the file from the system and save a local copy.
You need the local copy to transfer the outbound file to your bank. The file is transferred using specific
bank software that you should have received from your bank.
6. Transmit the local outbound file online to your bank using the required bank software.
Editing the Bank Statement
1. Within the Liquidity Management work center, navigate to the Bank Statements view.
2. Enter your bank statement data in the system.
To ensure a timely update of your bank balances, we recommend saving the bank statement as a local
bank statement file on the day after the online transfer.
Depending on the standard processes in your company, you have the following options to enter bank statement
data in your system:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 29
● Manual Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted on PaperEnter the bank statement items from the local copy manually in your system, taking account of references to
preceding documents (for example, invoices).
● Electronic Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted OnlineOnce you have uploaded the locally-saved bank statement file, the system transfers the file data automatically.
3. If the bank statement was released, the relevant payment is indicated as confirmed.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
See Also
Outgoing Payments [11]
Incoming Payments [31]
2.1.6 Creating User-Defined Payment File Formats
Overview
SAP Business ByDesign supports the most popular file formats for electronic bank transfer for the countries for which
a fully localized solution is available. However, it may be that your bank uses its own custom payment formats or a
variant of one of the popular formats. It is now possible to create user-defined payment file formats, which are as per
your bank specification, using the Outgoing Bank Transfers fine tune activity.
To create a payment file format, you should first create a payment file structure in Payment File Structures. You then
assign this payment file structure to a payment medium format.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the Outgoing Bank
Transfers activity from the activity list.
You can create user-defined payment file formats that are flat files using this activity; it is not possible to create
XML-based formats.
Prerequisites
A suitable payment medium format exists. If one does not exist, you should create a payment medium format. For more
information, see Edit Payment Medium Formats under Outgoing Bank Transfers
Process Flow
1. In Outgoing Bank Transfers Payment File Structures , create a payment file structure according to the bank
specification for the format.
1. Enter general data such as the payment file structure ID.
2. Define the records to be used within the structure.
3. Define the fields used within each of these records.
For more information, see Create a Payment File Structure
2. You must then assign this payment file structure to a payment medium format.
30 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
In Assign a Payment File Structure to a Payment Medium Format, map the payment file structure to an existing
payment medium format. For more information, see Assign a Payment File Structure to a Payment Medium Format
3. You should then select the new payment file format in My Bank.
If, in the previous step, you assigned the payment file structure to a file format already in use within My
Banks, you can skip this step.
1. Go to Liquidity Management My Banks .
2. Select the relevant bank and click Edit .
3. Under Payment Formats , add the payment file format, which you have created.
4. You can then create outgoing bank transfers using this payment file format.
1. Go to Payment Management Payment Monitor , create a new payment by clicking New Payment by
Outgoing Bank Transfer.
2. Enter the required details for the bank transfer such as payee, payee's bank account number, and payment
amount. For more information, see Create an Outgoing Bank Transfer task in the Payment Monitor Quick
Guide [194]Payment Monitor Quick Guide [287].
After you release an outgoing bank transfer, the payment using your payment file format now appears under
Payment Monitor.
5. You can then create a payment file using this payment file format.
1. In the Payment Monitor, choose the outgoing bank transfer, which you released in the previous step. It should
have the status Ready for Transfer.
2. Click Actions for Bank Transactions and choose Create Payment File.
3. To download the payment file locally, you should do the following:
Go to the Outbound Files subview under File Management view, select the new payment file, and click
Edit .
From Outgoing File, go to the Attachments and select the payment file. To download the file from the browser
window to your computer, click Download .
If the bank rejects the payment file, a potential reason is errors in the layout or content of file. If this is so, you
should recheck the correctness of the payment file structure against the bank specification, and also make
use of any feedback from the bank.
2.2 Incoming Payments
2.2.1 Incoming Payments
Overview
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
Examples of incoming payments:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 31
● Payment of trade receivables by customers
● Sales of physical products and services
● Interest and repayment from loans (as lender)
● Tax refunds
● Private capital contribution
● Cash sale
The system differentiates between automatic incoming payments and manual incoming payments. The same
payment methods are available for both types of incoming payments:
● Check
Incoming checks are displayed in the Payment Management work center in the Payment Monitor view.
● Direct debits
● Credit cards
● Bank transfers
● Petty cash transactions
Incoming cash payments are displayed in the Payment Management work center in the Petty Cash view. Only
manual payments are relevant.
● Bills of exchange
The bill of exchange payment method is not used in Germany.
Prerequisites
Configuration
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration:
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
In the Business Configuration work center in the task list included in the Fine-Tune phase, you have made the following
settings relevant for cash flow management:
● Electronic Bank Statements:
The import format used for electronic bank statements corresponds to the format of the file that is sent by the bank.
The import format contains business transaction codes that determine the transaction type involved. The business
transaction codes have to be assigned to internal system codes so that the transaction types can be displayed
correctly in the form of the corresponding incoming and outgoing payments. SWIFT MT940 is the common import
format in Germany.
● Customers - payment terms:
You define the payment terms that exist in your company, namely the payment targets and discount amounts. You
can also add additional terms.
● Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity:
For incoming payments grouped by payment methods and for particular users, you can specify the payment amount
from which an approval process is triggered. The approval request is then sent to the person responsible for making
approvals.
● Clearing Strategies:
32 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
You specify up to which amount the system tolerates differences between the invoice amount and the actual
payment amount by the customer and automatically clears the receivables with the received payments. If the
difference amount is exceeded, the system issues a message (if you have made this setting in configuration).
Furthermore, you define how a payment amount should be distributed when multiple open items need to be cleared
(by due date, for example). If you create multiple clearing strategies, you need to define the strategy that you want
to use as standard. You can also define strategies for specific companies, customers, or suppliers.
● Dunning Strategy:
You define the dunning strategy that you use. This specifies which business transactions (for example, invoice) are
dunned in which cycles and as of which dunning amount a dunning notice or reminder is created. The system
creates a dunning proposal list according to your settings at the end of the respective time limit. If you create multiple
dunning strategies, you need to define the strategy that you want to use as standard. You can also define strategies
for specific companies or customers.
Master Data
● Bank Data:
You create your own bank data in the Liquidity Management work center under Master Data -> My Banks.
● Definition of Customer Data and Payment Methods:
To do this, go to the Receivables work center, choose Customers -> Customers. Choose New to create a new
customer or select one of the existing customers and choose Edit -> Financial Data to change the data of an
existing customer.
Process Flow
An invoice is usually issued before there is an incoming payment. This outstanding receivable (open items) to customers
should be cleared by an incoming payment. Depending on the payment method agreed with the customer, the data is
entered manually (check), executed automatically (direct debit, credit card) by a payment run, or transferred to the
system by importing the bank data. A cash payment can also be made.
If the customer has decided on payment check, you enter the data manually in the Payment Management work center
in the Payment Monitor view or in the Receivables work center in the Customer Account Monitor view. If a direct debit
or payment by credit card is planned for the customer, the payment can be executed automatically using a payment
run. If a credit memo was made by bank transfer to the bank account, it is an externally initiated incoming payment that
is automatically transferred to the system by importing the bank statements or by manually entering them. You can
differentiate between externally and internally initiated payments for both automatic and manual incoming payments.
Automatic Incoming Payments
Checks, bank transfers, and bill of exchange payable are externally initiated automatic incoming payments. Payments
by direct debit with mandate and credit card are internally initiated automatic incoming payments. The incoming payment
process is described below using the example of the direct debit with mandate.
1. Starting the Payment Run
To start the payment run, navigate to the Receivables work center and choose Periodic Tasks -> Payment Runs.
Start a payment run or access a standardized payment run that has already been configured.
2. Executing Payments
You can check the due customer invoices that have the selected payment method and which the payment run has
included with the invoices and execute the payments. You do this in the Receivables work center -> My Work or
under Automatic Payments.
3. Approving the Payment
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 33
Depending on your settings in configuration, approval is required by the employee responsible in your company.
Then you see the incoming payments to be collected in the Payment Management work center -> Payment
Monitor, regardless of whether they need to go through the approval process.
4. Transferring the Data to the Bank
To be able to transfer the data to the bank, the payments must be in the Payment Monitor view with the status
Ready for Transfer. To transfer bank direct debits and automatic debits, select the appropriate payment (payment
method incoming direct debit) and choose the actions for Bank transactions -> Create Payment File. Alternatively,
you can automate this process by creating the payment media in the periodic tasks.
Go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose File Management ->Outbound Files. Here you find the
payment file that you can send to the bank or transfer using bank software. Select the file and click Edit . The
Outbound File: <ID> window appears. In the Attachment screen area, download the outgoing payment file to your
computer and send in a separate e-mail to your bank. Alternatively, you can transfer the file to your bank software.
The system does not automatically transfer data to the bank.
5. Incoming Payment on the Bank Account
The incoming payments on the bank account are transferred to the system by the bank statement. This can be
done electronically in the Liquidity Management work center by choosing File Management -> Inbound Files.
However, you can also enter the bank statement manually in the Liquidity Management work center in the Bank
Statements view.
6. Payment Allocation
When it creates the bank statement, the system automatically allocates the cash receipt to a payment transaction
if the references are unique.
If there are no differences between the payment transaction and the cash receipt, the system can make the
allocation automatically. If the references are not unique, for example, because the amount on the bank statement
(for example, by fees) does not match the transaction amount, the system creates a task so that you can check it
manually. Make the necessary clarification by navigating in the Payment Management work center to the Payment
Allocation view and manually allocating the cash receipt.
For more information, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Manual Incoming Payments
Checks and bills of exchange payable belong to externally initiated manual incoming payments that you can trigger in
the Payment Management work center. You can create new checks in the Payment Monitor view and new check deposits
using Deposits -> Check Deposits.
You can navigate to a specific customer in the Receivables work center to create a payment directly in the customer
account monitor. This can also be a direct debit or credit card payment.
For more information, see Manual Incoming Payments [40].
See Also
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Open Items Receivables [132]
Customer Remittance Advices [62]
Bank Statements [253]
Automatic Incoming Payments [35]
Contracts in Receivables
34 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
2.2.2 Automatic Incoming Payments
Overview
In your role as an accounts receivable accountant, you require functions to process national and international incoming
payment transactions made with customers and other debtors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management, Receivables, and Liquidity Management work centers. When you create a payment, you can
specify the payment method and other details, such as the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the bank processing
date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all payment
transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payer.
You create and edit internally initiated automatic incoming payments in the Receivables work center. You edit the
automatic creation of payment media in the Payment Management and Liquidity Management work centers.
You use selection criteria first to define the preparatory selection run (payment run) for creating a payment proposal list.
You can then edit the payment proposals and release them for payment creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually.
You can execute the payment run manually as often as you want.
When the payment proposals are paid, the system automatically performs payment clearing.
The system supports the following standard payment methods for internally initiated incoming payments:
● Direct debit
● Credit card
● Bill of exchange receivables with or without acceptance
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your incoming payment
processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following activities in the Business Configuration work center under Activity List Fine-
Tuning Cash Flow Management :
● Deduction Categories – Germany (optional)
● Deduction Categories – US (optional)
● Tax Adjustments for Payment Differences (mandatory)
● Business Task Management for Processing of Payments and Clearings (optional)
● Business Task Management for Processing of Payments and Clearings (optional)
● Business Task Management for Bank Statement Processing (optional)
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 35
● Business Task Management for Credit Card Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity Payment Approvals (optional)
● Bank Groups (mandatory)
● Liquidity Forecast Profiles (optional)
● Global Settings for Management of Payments (optional)
● Global Settings for Liquidity Management (mandatory)
● Payment Authorization Threshold (optional)
● Payment Block Reasons (optional)
● Import Formats for Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Release Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Credit Card Types (optional)
● Direct Debits (mandatory)
● Credit Card Authorization Profiles (optional)
● Clearing Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Advice Deletion Period (optional)
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Allocation (optional)
Master Data
● You have defined a country in which your company is registered.
● You have made a payment agreement with your customers and debtors and have made other related settings, for
example, defined the account for automatic debit authorization from which money can be deducted, or defined at
least one credit card for making credit card payments.
● You have defined the supported payment formats for your bank.
● You have made sure that your bank accounts are active for incoming payments and all related settings have been
made. This includes setting up the payment procedure and releasing the required currencies.
Process Flow
The following section explains the steps that need to be performed to use the automatic payment process and to process
the relevant open items.
The process flow describes the individual steps that are specific to an internally initiated automated incomingpayment made by direct debit.
Creating the Invoice
1. A customer has requested services or ordered goods from a sales employee of your company using a sales order
from the Sales Orders, Service Orders, and Product and Service Portfolio work centers.
2. In the Customer Invoicing work center, your company's sales employee invoices the customer who has procured
the requested services or ordered goods from your company and sends the invoice to the customer.
36 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
The customer invoice contains a reference to preceding documents, for example, to an underlying quote
and an underlying customer or service order. In addition, the system provides functions for the payment
of customer invoices without preceding documents. Choose the Manual Invoice function in the Customer
Invoicing work center.
3. In your role as accounts receivable accountant, you want to clear the open items of the invoice.
4. Depending on whether you or your customer initiate the incoming payment to clear open items from the invoice,
you perform the process steps listed.
Triggering the Automated Payment Process
1. Navigate to the Receivables work center and choose Periodic Tasks Payment Runs .
2. Choose New then Payment Run. Define for which customer(s) and with which criteria you want to schedule a
payment run to clear open items. You create a new payment run based on these criteria.
Possible selection criteria for your payment run are: ● Posting date
● Bank processing date
● Include on account payments
● Company
● Customer from / to ID
You can define a value range and thus select multiple customers for one payment run.
If you do not select a customer, the system selects all the customers entered in the system for the
payment run.
● Currency
● Next payment run date
3. Activate the payment run and choose Schedule .
4. The Schedule Job screen appears. Choose when the payment run should be executed. You have the following
options: ● Start Immediately
The system starts the payment run directly after you have saved your entries.
● Single Run
The system starts the payment run on the date and at the time you have specified.
● Run After Job
The system starts the payment run depending on another payment run. That is, the payment run starts directly
after completion of the payment run that you selected from the selection list.
The system starts the payment run and generates a payment proposal list using the values defined in configuration.
Note that the time it takes for the payment run to execute varies depending on the number of items to
be paid.
5. In the Receivables work center in the Automatic Payments view, display the payment proposals that have been
created with the customers and your company's other debtors for which receivables exist.
6. To make changes to a payment proposal, select the appropriate payment proposal and click Edit .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 37
7. The screen for the selected payment proposal appears.
You can change the payment method, enter other bank details, or enter or change a cash discount amount. You
can also change the payment date of the payment, for example.
You can also cancel a payment proposal here. This does not affect the open items since there has been no posting
in the system.
8. To make a payment, select it and choose Execute Payment.
For more information, see:
● Open Items Receivables [132]
Automated Creation of the Payment Medium
You can view the status of the payment in the payment monitor. Go to the Payment Management work center and
navigate to the Payment Monitor view.
To speed up the search process, we recommend that you use the enhanced search function. To do this,
choose Advanced and enter your search criteria (for example, payment method, document ID, or posting
date).
To automate the next step, proceed as follows:
1. Within the Payment Management work center, go to the Periodic Tasks view and choose Payment Media Runs.
2. Define for which payments and with which criteria, you want to schedule a payment media run. Possible selection
criteria are: ● Payment Method
You define the payment method and account from which can be collected in the Business Partner Data work
center under Payment Agreement Business Partner Payment Data .
● Payment Media
● Payment Format
● Customer or Supplier
You can define a value range and then select multiple business partners or a payment processing
date for one payment media run.
If you do not select a business partner or payment processing date, the system selects all business
partners entered in the system regardless of possible payment processing dates for the payment
media run.
● Company
● Currency
● Payment Execution Date
● Payment Method (for example, direct debit with or without automatic debit authorization)
You define the payment method and account from which can be collected in the Business Partner Data work
center under Business Partner Payment Agreement Payment Data .
● Payment Order
3. Start the predefined payment media run manually if required, or schedule the run periodically. To do this, go to the
Job Scheduler screen and choose Activate and Schedule .
38 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
You can activate a payment media run directly on the Job Scheduler screen or from the payment media
run overview in the Periodic Tasks view.
You can use the payment media run for all standard payment methods that the system supports.
4. Download the file from the system and save a local copy.
You need the local copy to transfer the outbound file to your bank. The file is transferred using specific
bank software that you should have received from your bank.
5. Transmit the local outbound file online to your bank using the required bank software.
For more information, see:
● Credit Card Chargebacks [190]
● Quick Guide for Credit Card Settlement Runs [240]
Alternative Process: Manual Creation of the Payment Medium
If you do not want to create the payment medium automatically, as described above under Automatic Creation of thePayment Medium, proceed as follows:
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and navigate to the Payment Monitor view.
2. Check your worklist to view which payments were already triggered and whether appropriate payment media were
generated.
To speed up the search process, we recommend that you use the enhanced search function. To do this,
choose Advanced and enter your search criteria (for example, payment method, document ID, or
status).
3. Select the outbound file for the payment by direct debit and choose Actions for Bank Transactions Create
Payment File to generate an outbound file for download. The status of the payment document changes to In
Transfer.
4. Download the file from the system and save a local copy.
You need the local copy to transfer the outbound file to your bank. The file is transferred using specific
bank software that you should have received from your bank.
5. Transmit the local outbound file online to your bank using the required bank software.
Editing the Bank Statement
1. Within the Liquidity Management work center, navigate to the Bank Statements view.
2. Enter your bank statement data in the system.
To ensure a timely update of your bank balances, we recommend saving the bank statement as a local
bank statement file on the day after the online transfer.
Depending on the standard processes in your company, you have the following options to enter bank statement
data in your system: ● Manual Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted on Paper
Enter the bank statement items from the local copy manually in your system, taking account of references to
preceding documents (for example, invoices).
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 39
● Electronic Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted Online
To transfer a locally saved bank statement file to the system, choose Bank Reporting Inbound Files
New Inbound File Bank Statement File Type . Check the bank statement data and release the bank
statement. The system automatically transfers the data from the locally saved bank statement file to your
system. Indicate the bank statement file as Confirmed.
3. If the bank statement was released, the relevant payment is indicated as confirmed.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
See Also
Contracts in Receivables
2.2.3 Manual Incoming Payments
Overview
In your role as an accounts receivable accountant, you require functions to process national and international incoming
payment transactions made with customers and other debtors. The system makes these functions available in the
Receivables, Payment Management, and Liquidity Management work centers. All special features can be defined, such
as settings for the payment methods and payment procedures, payment formats or data media. The system also enables
you to monitor payment transactions with a complete record of the processing status of all relevant payment processes.
You can initiate payments yourself (internally initiated incoming payments) or edit payments that your customers
and other debtors have initiated (externally initiated incoming payments).
You create incoming payments depending on the payment method in the Receivables work center (for example, for
direct debits), Payment Management work center (for example, for incoming checks) or Liquidity Management work
center (for example, for bank statements). You perform further processes, such as editing check deposits in the Payment
Management work center. You can then manually clear the edited incoming payments in the Receivables work center,
if required.
The system supports the following standard payment methods:
● Payment Methods for Internally Initiated Incoming Payments ○ Direct debit
○ Credit card payment
● Payment Methods for Externally Initiated Incoming Payments ○ Checks, including payment advices, check deposits, and lockbox providers, if required
○ Bank transfer
○ Bill of exchange payables, including appropriate bill of exchange deposits, if required
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Scoping
40 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Manual Incoming Payments is activated in your solution configuration. To find this business option, go to the Business
Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Payment and Liquidity Management is selected within
Cash Flow Management.
In the Questions step, expand the Cash Flow Management scoping element, select Payment and Liquidity
Management and answer the questions related to Manual Incoming Payments.
Fine-Tuning
Manual Incoming Payments is activated in your solution configuration. To find this activity, go to the Business
Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the following activities from the activity list:
● Deduction Categories – Germany (mandatory)
● Deduction Categories – US (mandatory)
● Business Task Management for Outgoing Check Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Processing of Payments and Clearings (optional)
● Business Task Management for Credit Card Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Bank Statement Processing (optional)
● Business Task Management for Payment Processing (optional)
● Bank Groups (mandatory)
● Liquidity Forecast Profiles (optional)
● Global Settings for Management of Payments (optional)
● Global Settings for Liquidity Management (mandatory)
● Payment Authorization Threshold (optional)
● Payment Block Reasons (optional)
● Import Formats for Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Release Bank Statements (mandatory)
● Credit Card Types (optional)
● Direct Debits (mandatory)
● Credit Card Authorization Profiles (optional)
● Clearing Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Advice Deletion Period (optional)
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
● Payment Instruction (optional)
Master Data
● You have defined a country in which your company is registered.
● You have made a payment agreement with your customers and debtors and have made other related settings. For
incoming payments, you only need to specify payment agreements for direct debits and credit cards. You do notneed to define a payment agreement to enter checks.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 41
● You have defined the supported payment formats for your bank.
● You have made sure that your bank accounts are active for incoming payments and all related settings have been
made. This includes setting up the payment procedure and liquidity check, and releasing the required currencies.
You do not need to make any predefined settings in configuration for incoming checks. But before you can
enter a check, you have created a check storage in the master data.
Process Flow
The following section explains the precautionary and processing steps that need to be performed to use the manual
payment process and to process the relevant open items.
The process flow describes the individual steps that are specific to a externally initiated incoming payment bycheck.
Creating an Invoice
1. A customer has requested services or ordered goods from a sales employee of your company using a sales order
from the Sales Orders, Service Orders, and Product and Service Portfolio work centers.
2. Within the Customer Invoicing work center, a sales employee of your company invoices the customer who has
procured the ordered goods or requested services from your company.
The invoice contains a reference to preceding documents, for example, to an underlying quote and an
underlying customer or service order. In addition, the system provides functions for the payment of
invoices without preceding documents.
3. In your role as accounts receivable accountant, you want to clear the open items of the invoice once you have
received the payment.
Editing a Check
1. The customer sends your company a check with which he or she wants to clear the outstanding items from the
invoice that you have sent to him or her.
2. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose Incoming Payments Checks .
3. Choose New to transfer the check data to your system.
Depending on the processes in your company and the number of checks that you want to enter, the following
functions are available: ● Single Check
You can enter exactly one check and prepare for further processing.
● Multiple Checks
You can enter multiple checks at the same time in table format and prepare for further processing.
4. Transfer the check data to your system on the following New Single Check screen or New Multiple Check screen.
This includes the following data: ● Company
● Check number
● Total amount
● Issuer bank account
42 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
If you do not enter a deposit date, the system automatically adds the current date as the earliest deposit
date.
5. Enter other information on the check received that the system can use for later payment clearing. This includes
data on the following tab pages: ● Reference
References that you enter here are used to uniquely assign the incoming payment by check within later
payment clearing.
We recommend that you enter at least the internal invoice number as a reference. The clearing logic
of the system directly reads this number for payment clearing. In this way, you do not need to
manually trigger payment clearing and your payment processes are more efficient.
● Note to Payee
The free text that you enter here is used for the internal documentation of the payment in your system.
The clearing logic of the system does not read the note to payee for payment clearing.
6. Once you have entered the data, choose Release.
The system transfers the status change of the check asynchronously to the Receivables work center. This changes
the status of the relevant item; the status of the item changes to Cleared in the customer account monitor.
If the system cannot automatically clear the relevant item, it creates a task for manual clearing.
7. To assign a check deposit that already exists to the check, proceed as described under Assigning the CheckDeposit.
Creating a New Check Deposit
1. Within the Payment Management work center, go to the Incoming Payments view, Check Deposits and Lockbox
Batches.
You can assign the check that you want to clear to a previously created check deposit with the status In
Preparation if the company and bank account ID and the document date match.
2. Choose New → Check Deposit to create a new check deposit to which you can assign the check that you want
to clear.
If check deposits already exist in your system, the system displays them in a list. You can filter the list according
to the status of the check deposit. To do this, choose Display in the input help.
The system sequentially numbers the check deposits that you create.
We recommend that you check the check deposit assignment of your check. To do this, go to the editing
of the check deposit. On the Check Deposit: <Check Deposit Number> screen on the Assigned
Checks tab page, you can remove the checks assigned to the check deposit or other check deposits.
You cannot assign any other checks to the check deposit that you have opened for processing. (See the section
Assigning the Check Deposit).
3. Once you have completed the check deposit assignment of the check that you want to deposit, choose Release
and Print Deposit Slip.
You can release a check deposit exactly once. The system automatically creates a print file once the check deposit
has been released. To create other print files, the Print Deposit Slip function is available if required.
Assigning the Check Deposit
You can also select the check that you want to deposit directly in your worklist on the Checks screen. To do this, perform
the following process steps:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 43
1. Select the check that you want to deposit and choose Actions Assign to Deposit . The Input Parameters for
Assign to Deposit dialog box appears.
To deposit a check, it must have the status Released.
2. Assign the check that you are editing to a check deposit in the Check Deposit ID field. You have the following
options here: ● Select an existing check deposit and assign the check to be deposited to it.
● Do not select a check deposit and do not enter anything else. If a suitable check deposit does not exist, the
system creates a check deposit and assigns the check to this check deposit.
3. Once you have completed the check deposit assignment of the check that you want to deposit, choose Release
and Print Deposit Slip.
You can release a check deposit exactly once. The system automatically creates a print file once the check deposit
has been released. To create other print files, the Print Deposit Slip function is available if required.
Entering the Bank Statement Item
1. In your role as cash manager or accounts payable accountant, you receive a bank statement from your company's
bank. One bank statement item refers to the check deposit.
2. You want to enter this bank statement item in your system.
3. Navigate to the Liquidity Management work center and choose Bank Reporting Bank Statements .
Here you can view all of your company's bank statements that were manually entered or automatically generated
by the system.
4. Choose New → Bank Statement to create a bank statement that represents the incoming payment from the check
deposit as an item.
On the following Create Bank Statement screen, enter the general data for the bank statement. Enter the general
data as it appears on the bank statement. ● Statement ID
The system assigns sequential bank statement IDs if nothing else is planned in configuration.
● Opening Balance
The system derives the opening balance on your company's bank account from the balance of the previous
bank statement.
● Bank
● Closing Balance
5. Once you have entered the data, go to item selection by choosing Next.
The system displays an overview of all internally initiated transactions that were already entered for the selected
bank statement.
a. The system displays the check deposit that you can select.
b. If the check deposit is not displayed here, you can enter the data manually:
Choose Next to go to item entry to enter the incoming payment by check as a new transaction. You want to
manage this payment as an item of the newly created bank statement. Make sure that you enter all required
values. This includes data on the following tab pages: ● Transaction Data
You use the specified transaction data to manage the transaction type, original currency amount, business
partner (customer), document ID, value date, and account owner, for example.
● References / Note to Payee (optional)
44 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
You have already entered both of these fields when you entered the check. Leave the fields empty when
confirming the check deposit.
6. Once you have entered the data, you can check your bank statement with the check deposit as bank statement
item. You can then finish processing and release the bank statement. To do this, choose the actions Save,
Release, and Close.
The status of the check deposit changes to Confirmed.
Clearing the Payment Received by Check
1. Go to the Receivables work center to trigger payment clearing for the items of the edited bank statement.
If you have specified references when you entered your check, the system automatically performs payment clearing.
Manual processing is therefore not required. ● If the invoice amount of the check differs from the check amount and automatic clearing is not possible, the
system creates a task for manual payment clearing.
● If you have set up in configuration that postprocessing is required for underpayment or overpayment, the
system creates a task for manual payment clearing.
Therefore, we recommend that you specify references directly when you enter your check. The
higher degree of automation increases the efficiency of your accounting processes and reduces the
costs that arise from the processing effort.
2. If manual triggering of payment clearing is required, the system offers you the following functions depending on the
processes in your company and your configuration settings: ● Manual Payment Clearing
This process of payment clearing refers to a selected payment. You use this process in the following cases: ○ No references were entered in the system.
○ There is an overpayment.
○ A different payer was entered.
● Customer Account MaintenanceThis process of payment clearing refers to all payments that exist in the system for a selected customer.
3. Depending on the selected process of payment clearing, choose one of the alternatives described in the following
sections. Perform the process steps listed.
Manual Payment Clearing
1. Navigate within the Receivables work center to the Payment Clearing view and display the items that were entered
in your system and that are available for payment clearing.
2. Select the item of the incoming payment by check that you want to clear. To do this, choose Edit .
Items that you want to clear must have the status Open or Partially Cleared.
On the following Manual Payment Clearing: <Payment Clearing Number> screen, the system displays the details
on the selected item. This includes the payment amount, not assigned payment amount, taken cash discount, other
deductions, or payment type.
3. Choose Edit Clearing Proposal. The Proposed Items screen appears where you can search for one or more invoices
that are to be used to clear the items from the incoming payment by check.
In the Open Items list, select the invoice(s) that you want to clear with the incoming payment by check. The system
displays your selection in the Display Clearing Document list.
You can clear an invoice completely or partially with an incoming payment: ● Partial Clearing of an Invoice
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 45
The invoice amount is greater than the amount that was actually paid by check. You then manually adjust the
amount that is assigned to the invoice.
If you clear the invoice with the payment, there is a residual item.
● Clearing Multiple InvoicesThe individual invoice amounts are smaller than the amount that was actually paid by check.
If you clear multiple invoices with the payment, the system combines as many invoices until the invoice
amounts are similar to the actual payment amount.
4. Once you have completed processing the clearing proposal, choose Accept Proposal. Thus, the prerequisites for
payment clearing have been met and you can trigger the process of payment clearing for the selected invoice(s)
using Actions Clear .
The system only starts payment clearing if none of the selected items is already involved in another
clearing process. If this is the case, the system blocks the selected item for revised payment clearing.
Customer Account Maintenance
1. Navigate within the Receivables work center to the Customers view and choose the Customer Accounts screen.
2. In the displayed worklist, select the customer account from which the incoming payment by check was paid. To do
this, choose View .
On the following Customer Account Monitor: <Customer Name and Number> screen, the system displays the
detailed view of the selected customer account.
3. Within the Customer Account Monitor: <Customer Name and Number> screen, go to the Trade Receivables tab
page and start account maintenance.
4. Select the invoice(s) that you want to clear with the incoming payment by check and choose Manual Clearing.
You can clear an invoice completely or partially with an incoming payment: ● Partial Clearing of an Invoice
The invoice amount is greater than the amount that was actually paid by check. You then manually adjust the
amount that is assigned to the invoice. If you clear the invoice with the payment, there is a residual item.
● Clearing Multiple InvoicesThe individual invoice amounts are smaller than the amount that was actually paid by check. If you clear
multiple invoices with the payment, the system combines as many invoices until the invoice amounts are similar
to the actual payment amount.
You can view the items of the selected invoice using Item Details on the separate Item Details: <Document
Number> screen. The system displays all items regardless of their status. You can select a cleared item and go
directly to the related payment clearing process using View Clearing Document. This could be necessary, for
example, to view the items or to cancel payment clearing.
5. The Manual Clearing screen appears. Select the incoming payment by check with which you want to clear previously
selected invoice(s).
6. Once you have made the selection, choose Transfer. The system automatically closes payment clearing using the
selected items.
See Also
Contracts in Receivables
46 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
2.2.4 Incoming Payments by SEPA Direct Debit
Overview
The single European payments area (SEPA) enables you to make direct debits within the participating European
countries. This type of direct debit can be used within a country or across national boundaries.
To make SEPA direct debits, you need to obtain a statutory debit authorization in the form of a mandate. If you have
created a valid mandate of your customer in the system, it is selected in the payment run or during the manual direct
debit and the relevant data is then sent to the bank.
For SEPA transactions, the international bank code BIC (SWIFT) must be entered, which replaces the conventional
national bank code. The international account number IBAN also needs to be entered, which appears instead of the
national account number. New XML payment formats are also used.
If in your role as accounts receivable accountant, you want to directly debit your customers (that is, within the SEPA
participating countries), the system makes the required functions available in the Receivables, Payment Management,
and Liquidity Management work centers.
This document deals with both the precautionary measures that need to be made to use SEPA direct debits and making
manual or automatic direct debits.
The system does not support any outgoing SEPA direct debits that are initiated by a supplier, for example.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration
Scoping
Under Questions → Cash Flow Management, you have made the basic settings for your incoming payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
In the fine-tuning activity Global Settings for Payment, you have prioritized your payment methods to include SEPA
direct debit for each concerned country by selecting “Direct Debit” and moving the entry to the desired position by clicking
Move Up .
Master Data
● You have selected the bank in the Liquidity Management work center under Master Data My Banks using
Edit → General and have selected Payment Formats . There you have select the payment medium format SEPADirect Debit. On the Bank Accounts tab, you have also selected the entry SEPA Direct Debit on the lower screen
area on the Payment Method tab.
● You have received a unique creditor identifier from your country‘s national bank and have entered your company
in the master data in the Organizational Management work center.
● In the Receivables or Business Partner Data work center, you have selected the Customers view and by selecting
Edit → Financial Data → Bank Data you have entered the international account number IBAN. In this view under
Payment Data you have also defined the payment method Direct Debit.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 47
● You have obtained and activated debit authorization in the form of a SEPA mandate from your customer. You have
also entered it in the Receivables or Business Partner Data work center.
For more information on the creditor identifier and SEPA mandate, see the section Preliminary Steps.
Preliminary Steps
Request and Enter Creditor Identifier
The unique creditor identifier (UCI) enables the collector in a direct debit to be identified. In connection with the mandate
number it enables the mandate to be checked by the payer or paying bank.
The payee requests this number from a central issuer, for example, the national bank. Only one number can be
requested. If any data changes such as the company or legal form of the applicant, a new number must be requested
and the old number submitted for deletion.
You define the creditor identifier in the system in the Organizational Management work center. For more information,
see External Business Identifiers.
Create and Edit SEPA Mandate
The SEPA mandate can be compared to the conventional debit authorization and is used as the payer’s (debtor) approval
to the payee (creditor) to initiate an automatic debit in which the debtor’s bank is allowed to meet this request and debit
the account.
As the payee, you create the SEPA mandate in the system, enter the data, and print it. You send this form by post to
your customer, that is, the payer. The customer signs the mandate and returns it, thus giving you permission to debit
their account. You add the missing information in the system and activate the mandate. You need to keep this form and
send the required entries to the bank for each direct debit within the payment file.
You need to inform the bank of the following changes by means of updated data within the payment file:
● Mandate ID
● Payer Name
● Payer IBAN or BIC
● Company Name
For mandates, you are legally required to differentiate between core direct debits for private customers and business-
to-business direct debits. The type of mandate determines in which time frames the banks must make SEPA direct
debits.
The mandate information is always defined in the system in the payer’s master data.
For more information, see Create a SEPA Direct Debit Mandate [148].
If you want to keep track of the mandates for all of your customers or for certain periods of time, for example, you can
do so using the SEPA Mandate List [185] which provides an overview of all SEPA mandates.
Process Flow
Creating the Sales or Service Order and the Manual Invoice
48 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
1. A customer has requested services or ordered goods from your company's sales employee using a sales order
from the Sales Orders or Service Orders work centers. In the sales or service order, the sales employee enters the
payment method Direct Debit. The payment method is then automatically transferred with the note in the invoice
that the amount was debited (for example, “The invoice amount due will be collected in accordance with the payment
terms via direct debit”).
2. Optional: If there are no preceding documents, such as a sales or service order, you can create an invoice
manually. You do this in the Customer Invoicing work center where your company’s sales employee has issued
the customer the relevant manual invoice. When entering the invoice, the sales employee enters the payment
method Direct Debit. So the invoice automatically contains the note that the amount was debited by direct debit.
The sales employee sends the invoice to the customer.
In the next step, in your role as the accounts receivable accountant, you would like to clear the open items of the
invoice.
Initiating the Automatic Direct Debit
Create and Perform the Payment Run
1. Go to the Receivables work center and choose Periodic Tasks Payment Runs .
2. Choose New . On the New Payment Run screen, you enter the customer whose payables you want to clear with
SEPA direct debit.
Only enter a date in the Next Payment Run Date field if you want to perform the payment run once only.
If you schedule the payment run to be performed periodically, the date of the next payment run is
determined by the system. Depending on the payment strategy, the system determines for each open
item whether it is paid during this or the next payment run.
3. Save and activate the run. Choose Schedule to enter the time when the run should be performed. You can also
schedule recurring runs on a regular basis. The system starts the payment run at the time you specified and
generates a payment proposal.
For more information, for example, on scheduling payment runs, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Checking the Payment Proposal and Executing the Payment
1. Navigate to the Automatic Payments view and open the previously generated payment proposal by selecting the
proposal and choosing Edit .
2. Check the payment proposal and make any necessary changes. You can, for example, on the General Data tab,
select another mandate ID using the input help if the system has not proposed the correct mandate
3. To trigger the payment, choose Execute Payment .
For more information, for example, on scheduling payment runs, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Initiating the Manual Direct Debit
1. Go to the Receivables work center and choose Customers Customer Accounts . Select the customer whose
payable should be cleared by SEPA direct debit. Choose View .
2. Select the open item(s) to be cleared and choose Pay Manually By → Direct Debit .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 49
3. Check on the New Incoming Direct Debit screen whether the prefilled entries are correct and change them if
necessary. You can, for example, select another mandate ID using the input help if the system has not proposed
the correct mandate.
4. Choose Release . On the basis of your configuration settings, the payment runs through an approval process. As
soon as it is completed, the payment is cleared.
If you want to track the status of your payment, switch to the Payment Management work center and choose the
Payment Monitor view.
Creating and Downloading the Payment Medium
1. To create a payment medium automatically, switch to the Payment Management work center and select under
Periodic Tasks the Payment Media Runs subview.
2. Choose New → Payment Media Run. On the New Payment Media Run screen enter your company and the
customer for whom you want to perform the SEPA direct debit.
Set the Including Bank Transactions indicator and in the Format field, select the SEPA Direct Debit entry. Save
your entries.
3. Activate the payment media run. Choose Schedule to enter the time when the run should be performed. You can
also schedule recurring runs on a regular basis. The system starts the payment media run at the time you specified
and generates a payment file that you can send to the bank.
For more information, see Quick Guide for Payment Media Runs [236].
4. Download the payment file and save a local copy by navigating to the Liquidity Management work center and
choosing File Management and then Outbound Files. On the Outgoing File: <number> screen, select the
appropriate file and click Download . The file is transferred using specific bank software that you should have
received from your bank.
5. Transmit the local outbound file electronically to your bank using the bank software.
Your bank statement shows you that the payment has been received.
Optional: Manually Creating the Payment Medium
1. To create the payment medium manually, switch to the Payment Monitor view. This view is available in both the
Payment Management and Liquidity Management work center.
2. In the list, select the required SEPA direct debit that was initiated in the Receivables work center and that has the
status Ready for Transfer.
To speed up the search process, you can use the extended search function. For this, choose
Advanced and enter your search criteria. For example, in the Payment Method Details field, select the
SEPA Direct Debit entry. Click Go . Only payments are displayed that correspond to the selected
search criteria.
3. Choose Actions for Bank Transactions and then Create Payment File .
The system generates a payment file that you can send to the bank. The status of the payment changes to InTransfer.
4. Download the payment file and save a local copy by navigating to the Liquidity Management work center and
choosing File Management and then Outbound Files. On the Outgoing File: <number> screen, select the
appropriate file and click Download . The file is transferred using specific bank software that you should have
received from your bank.
5. Transmit the local outbound file electronically to your bank using the bank software.
Your bank statement shows you that the payment has been received.
50 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Editing the Bank Statement
1. To enter the bank statement that contains the incoming payment of your SEPA direct debit item, switch to the
Liquidity Management work center and choose the Bank Statements view.
2. Depending on the standard processes in your company, you have the following options to enter bank statement
data in your system: ● Manual Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted in Paper Form
In the guided activity for the bank statement, select the SEPA direct debit payments manually and then release
the bank statement.
● Electronic Entry for Bank Statement Data Submitted ElectronicallyTo transfer a locally saved bank statement file to the system, choose the File Management view and choose
Inbound Files. You can upload the file to the system from this view.
Check the bank statement data in the Bank Statements view and release the bank statement. The system
automatically transfers the data from the locally saved bank statement file to your system.
If the bank statement was released, the relevant payment is indicated as confirmed.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
Additional Information on Bank Processing Times
Banks have to adhere by law to certain periods of time when they process SEPA direct debit payments. These periods
differ depending on whether your customer is a private customer using a core mandate, or a corporate customer using
a business-to-business mandate. The default dates for the bank processing date are calculated by the system on the
basis of the document date, which corresponds to the date of the respective payment. However, these date fields can
be overwritten.
The following default dates are calculated by the system according to the legal requirements:
● New core mandateFor core mandates that are used for the first time, the bank processing date set by default by the system is five
bank business days after the document date.
● Changed core mandateFor core mandates that are in use but have been changed with an amendment, the bank processing date set by
default by the system for the first usage after the change is five bank business days after the document date.
● Recurring core mandateFor core mandates that are used repeatedly and have already been used once, the bank processing date set by
default by the system is two bank business days after the document date.
● Business-to-business mandateFor business-to-business mandates, the bank processing date set by default by the system is always one bank
business day after the document date.
Note that the system calculation assumes that you send the payment file to the bank on the same day that you generate
it. This enables the bank to process your payments within these periods of time.
You can also track the status of each payment in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view. The SEPA mandates used for a direct debit are displayed in the payment monitor.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 51
2.3 Special Business Transactions
2.3.1 Canceling a Supplier Invoice
Overview
You can cancel incoming invoices that you have paid manually or in a payment run, or for which you have requested
payment. The procedure for the cancellation depends on the status of the invoice and the payment.
It is preferable that you do not cancel an invoice that has already been paid or cleared. If, however, you need
to cancel an invoice that has already been paid, first go to the Payables work center to reverse the clearing
and then cancel the invoice in the Supplier Invoicing work center.
If you first cancel the supplier invoice in the Supplier Invoicing work center, the original clearing still exists and
the system generates a new open item (reversal document).
Process Flow
Canceling the Payment
First check whether it is possible to reverse the payment. For example, it is not possible to reverse a payment if a check
has already been sent to the supplier or funds have been transferred electronically to the bank.
Case a): Reversal of payment is not possible
In this case, reverse the payment clearing in the supplier account monitor.
1. Go to the Payables work center and select Supplier Supplier Accounts . In this view choose the Account
ID you wish to see and click View . Select the invoice and click Clearing Document . Click View All and then
Reset Clearing .
Result: The status changes from Cleared to Open.
Case b): Reversal of payment is possible
After payment has been made by either bank transfer or check, the Payables work center shows the status Cleared.
The Payment Management work center displays the status Ready For Transfer if a check has not been printed. If a
check has already been printed, the status In Transfer is displayed. (The payment execution status in the Payables
work center is set to the same status values.) In this case, you need to perform the following step (step 1) to reset the
status to Ready For Transfer. If this status is already displayed, you can start directly with step 2.
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the appropriate payment in the Payment Monitor view.
For a check, for example, choose Actions for Checks Set to Not Transferred .
Result: The status displayed in the payment monitor is Ready For Transfer.
2. Go to the Payables work center and select Supplier Supplier Accounts . In this view choose the Account
ID you wish to see and click View . Select the payment and click the value in the Document ID column. Click
View All , then click the Actions button and choose Reverse from the list.
Result: The payment and clearing are reversed. The status displayed in both the supplier account monitor and the
payment monitor is Canceled.
Canceling the Invoice
52 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
1. To cancel the invoice, go to the Supplier Invoicing work center.
2. Under Invoices and Credit Memos, select the invoice you want to cancel (with the status Posted) and choose
Cancel Document .
Result: The system generates a cancellation invoice. Simultaneously, in the Payables work center in the supplier
account monitor, the status of the invoice changes from Open to Canceled.
Invoices and their payment amounts can only be canceled in full.
See Also
Supplier Account Monitor [74]
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Special Cases for Reversals
2.3.2 Canceling a Customer Invoice
Overview
You can cancel outgoing invoices if they have already been paid by direct debit or credit card. The procedure for the
cancellation depends on the status of the invoice and the payment.
It is preferable that you do not cancel an invoice that has already been paid or cleared. If, however, you need
to cancel an invoice that has already been paid, first go to the Receivables work center to reverse the clearing
and then cancel the invoice in the Customer Invoicing work center.
If you first cancel the customer invoice in the Customer Invoicing work center, the original clearing still exists
and the system generates a new open item (reversal document).
Process Flow
Canceling the Payment
First check whether it is possible to cancel the payment. For example, it is not possible to reverse a payment if a direct
debit has already been sent in a payment file to the bank.
Case a): Reversal of payment is not possible
In this case, you have have already received the payment from your customer and you reverse the payment clearing in
the customer account monitor:
1. Go to the Receivables work center and call up the appropriate customer account monitor under Customer Accounts →
View . Select the invoice and click Clearing Document . Click View All and then Reset Clearing .
Result: The status changes from Cleared to Open.
Case b): Reversal of payment is possible
It is only possible to reverse the payment if it is a direct debit or credit card payment made by your customer and the
payment has not yet been processed by your bank. If this is the case, the Receivables work center displays the status
Cleared. The Payment Management work center displays the status Ready For Transfer if a payment file has not yet
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 53
been created. (The payment execution status in the Receivables work center is set to the same status values). In this
case, you can start directly with step 2, which is described subsequently, to cancel the payment.
If a payment file has already been generated, the status In Transfer is displayed. If you have not yet sent the file to the
bank, you proceed according to the following description to first reset the status to Ready For Transfer and then cancel
the payment.
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the appropriate payment in the Payment Monitor. For an
incoming direct debit, for example, choose Actions for Bank Transactions → Set to Not Transferred.
Result: The status displayed in the payment monitor is Ready For Transfer.
2. Go to the Receivables work center and call up the appropriate customer account monitor under Customer Accounts →
View . Select the payment and choose the number in the Document ID column. Click View All and then Actions →
Reverse .
Result: The payment and clearing are reversed. The status displayed in both the customer account monitor and
the payment monitor is Canceled.
Canceling the Invoice
This document contains text that is relevant for Mexico only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text, select
Personalize � My Settings. Select the Onscreen Help and choose Mexico in the Country drop-down menu. Save your
settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
1. To cancel the invoice, go to the Customer Invoicing work center.
2. Under Invoices and Credit Memos, select the invoice you want to cancel and choose Cancel . On the New
Cancellation - Invoice screen, choose Save and Release .
Result: The system generates a cancellation invoice. Simultaneously, in the Receivables work center in the
customer account monitor, the status of the invoice changes from Open to Canceled.
Invoices and their payment amounts can only be canceled in full.
See Also
Customer Account Monitor [133]
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Special Cases for Reversals
2.3.3 Customer Payments by Credit Card
Overview
The system enables you to process customer payments made by credit card, including incoming payments from your
customers and credit memos to your customers. To be able to use the credit card process, you need to complete a few
preliminary steps and, most importantly, sign a contract with a service provider (who has to be an SAP Partner). This
document deals with both the preliminary steps that must be taken in order to use credit cards and with the credit card
payment process itself.
54 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user in the Business Configuration work center. If you
do not have the required authorization, contact your key user.
Scoping (required)
You have activated Customer Payments by Credit Card in your solution configuration. To find this business option, go
to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Payment and Liquidity
Management is selected within Cash Flow Management.
In the Questions step, expand the Cash Flow Management scoping element, then expand Payment and Liquidity
Management. Select Payment Methods and activate the option for customer payments using credit cards by selecting
the Yes radio button in the Incoming Payments section. Make sure to select the correct service provider in the Credit
Card Service Providers section.
For more information on the service provider and how to set up the credit card functionality, see About Credit Card
Service Provider Computop or About Credit Card Service Provider Paymetric.
Integrate and Extend (required)
● Master Data for Your Credit Card Service Provider
You have created a supplier master data entry for your chosen credit card service provider and subsequently
established the communication arrangement. To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and
choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select
the Integrate and Extend phase, then select Credit Card Service Provider — Paymetric or Credit Card Service
Provider — Computop from the activity list and enter the relevant details.
Be sure to include the Dun & Bradstreet (D-U-N-S) number (to be found using the Additional Identifiers link).
Alternatively, you can navigate to the Payables or Supplier Base work center and enter the supplier master data
using the Suppliers view.
For more information, see Computop Supplier Master Data Entry or Paymetric Supplier Master Data Entry.
● New Clearing House and New Clearing House Account
You have created a clearing house record and a clearing house account. To find this activity, go to the Business
Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and
click Open Activity List . Select the Integrate and Extend phase, then select Credit Cards — Customer Payment
from the activity list. On the activity details screen, choose the Create new clearing house link text, and enter the
relevant details. When you are finished, return to the activity details screen, choose the Create new clearing house
account link text, and enter the relevant details. Do not forget to enter the merchant ID you received from your credit
card service provider!
This activity can also be completed in the Liquidity Management work center. To find this activity, choose
Master Data Clearing Houses and Master Data Clearing House Accounts .
For more information, see Clearing Houses and Clearing House Accounts [260].
Fine-Tuning (first is required; second is optional)
You have established a communication arrangement with a service provider; you have specified how credit card
authorizations are performed by the system; you have specified in which form the settlement of individual credit card
payments will be processed by the system. To find these two prerequisite Fine-Tune activities, go to the Business
Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then perform the following activities in the activity list:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 55
● Computop – Communication Arrangement or the Paymetric– Communication Arrangement — choose the
appropriate activity from the activity list in order to establish the communication arrangement with your credit card
service provider.
For more information, see Computop - Communication Arrangement or Paymetric - Communication Arrangement.
● Credit Card Authorization and Settlement
Choose this optional activity to review and adapt the predefined profiles that control the credit card authorization
horizon and to assign a settlement profile to your company.
The standard settings delivered with the system allow you to use the credit card process and may already
meet your business needs. If you decide to adapt these settings, be sure to align all user-defined settings
with your service provider.
1. Determine for which period of time the payment amount is reserved on the customer's credit card account. On
the activity details screen, click the link below Credit Card Authorization Profiles.
2. After having specified the authorization details, ensure that you assign this profile to your company. Click the
second link below Credit Card Authorization Profiles. For more information, see Configuration: Credit Card
Authorization Profiles
3. Assign one of the predefined profiles (single payment settlement or batch settlement) to your company. On the
activity details screen, click on the Assign settlement profiles to your company link text.
Additional Prerequisite (required)
You have entered credit card data for your customer in the system and have chosen credit card as the payment method
to be used for automatic payments. In addition, you have defined credit card as payment method. To meet these
prerequisites, complete the following:
● Customer Account with Credit Card Data
You have created a customer account including credit card data. The credit card data for your customer must exist
in the system before you can settle customer invoices using the payment method Credit Card. To do this, complete
the following steps:
1. Go to the Account Management, Business Partner Data, or Receivables work center and choose the
Accounts view (in the Receivables work center choose the Customers view).
2. Select the customer whose credit card data you want to enter. On the Corporate Account Overview screen, click
Edit then Financial Data .
Optional: If the customer does not yet exist in the system, create a new customer record in this view.
For more information, see Create and Edit an Account in the Tasks section of the Accounts Quick Guide.
3. On the Financial Data tab, click Bank Data . In the Credit Card section, click
Register with <Service Provider Name> . You are forwarded to your service provider’s system
4. Enter the credit card information provided to you by your customer. Confirm your entry to send your data to the
service provider and generate the credit card token. After the service provider has confirmed your entries, close
the service provider's screen. Note that the credit card number is saved only in the service provider’s system
and not in the SAP Business ByDesign system. The credit card token and the masked credit card number are
saved within the SAP Business ByDesign system.
5. The credit card, including the masked number that was generated by the service provider, is added to the table.
The Default indicator is active as standard. This means that the system proposes this credit card by default
when credit card is selected as payment method on sales orders, service orders, and invoices. In case you need
to block the credit card for payments at any point in time, select an appropriate reason from the dropdown list
in the Blocking Reason column. If you leave this field empty, the credit card is not blocked. Remember to save
your customer account master data!
56 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
6. Optional: If the credit card data already exists in the system and you wish to use it for your customer (for example,
if you need to re-enter customer master data that has been deleted), click Assign . In the Assign Credit Card
dialog box, select the relevant credit card using the value help. Click OK .
7. Optional: Credit Card Payment as Default Payment Method: If your customer has agreed to pay all invoices
with the same credit card, you can enter this credit card as the default payment method in the Payment Data
on the Corporate Account - Financial Data screen. The system will automatically bill this credit card even you
have not entered it on the sales order or on the customer invoice. Note that the system only prints a note
informing the customer that the invoice amount will be collected if the payment method Credit Card is also
specified on the customer invoice.
To choose credit card payment as the default payment method, return to the Financial Data tab, and this time
click Payment Data . In the Payment Methods section, click Add Row and select Credit Card from the dropdown
list. In the Credit Card section, you can select a credit card from the ones that were assigned to the customer
in the corresponding bank data and define a validity period for this payment method.
Credit card data must exist in the system even if your customer only wants to pay once using this payment
method. If this is the case, you can remove or block the credit card data after the transaction has been
completed so that it cannot be accidentally used or proposed as payment method by the system afterwards.
Process Flow
The credit card process involves four parties: Your company, your customer, the credit card service provider and
the acquirer, hereinafter referred to as the clearing house. The service provider is responsible for the encryption,
tokenization, and authorization of the credit card data in order to ensure Payment Card Industry (PCI) compliance at all
times. Furthermore, the service provider acts as the connection between your company and the clearing house
responsible for making the actual payments.
You Create the Sales or Service Order and the Manual Invoice
1. A customer has requested services or ordered goods from you in your role as the company's sales employee using
a sales order from the Sales Orders or Service Orders work centers. In the sales order or service order, you click
View All , and then select the payment method Credit Card and the corresponding credit card. If necessary, you
can also enter the data for a new credit card.
2. Before releasing the sales order or service order, initiate the authorization of the credit card data and the payment
amount in question by clicking Check Authorization . The data is sent to the service provider, who performs the
necessary checks and authorizes the amount. This reduces the credit limit of the customer’s credit card account
by the authorized amount. This amount is blocked for the number of days specified in the clearing house account
data (for 14 days, for example). Note that at this point the credit card is not yet debited. You can review the
authorization details by clicking the link next to the Check Authorization button.
Authorizations will only be cancelled automatically by the system as a result of the following scenarios:
A document that contained authorizations is deleted or cancelled, the credit card used to make the
payment is changed, the customer placing the order is changed, or the payment method is changed from
“credit card” to any other method (only alternative currently available is direct debit).
If an authorization is cancelled, it will be deleted from the system and a request to release the reserved
funds will be automatically sent to the service provider. If the automatic cancellation fails, you will not be
notified.
3. After delivery of the services or goods the invoicing process takes place. The payment method and authorization
information is automatically transferred to the invoice with a note stating that the given credit card will be charged
with the amount.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 57
4. Optional Manual Invoice: If there are no preceding documents, such as a sales order or service order, you can
create an invoice manually. You do this in the Customer Invoicing work center where your company’s sales
employee issues the relevant manual invoice for the customer. When entering the invoice, the sales employee
selects the payment method Credit Card. The invoice then automatically contains a note stating that the credit card
will be charged with the amount. Before releasing the invoice, be sure to click Check Authorization to request the
authorization. The sales employee then sends the invoice to the customer.
To automatically ensure that the invoice contains a valid authorization, you can create and schedule credit
card authorization runs in the Customer Invoicing work center. For more information, see Quick Guide for
Credit Card Authorization Runs.
You Initiate the Automatic Credit Card Payment
In your role as accounts receivable accountant, and after an invoice has been created, you can clear the open items of
the invoice by initiating either the automatic credit card payment or creating the manual credit card payment.
1. Create and Perform the Payment Run
a. Go to the Receivables work center and choose Periodic Tasks Payment Runs .
b. Click New . On the New Payment Run screen, you enter your company and if necessary, restrict the run to
specific customers, for example.
c. Save and activate the run. Click Schedule to enter the time when the run should be performed. You can also
schedule recurring runs on a regular basis. The system starts the payment run at the time you specified and
generates a payment proposal.
For more information, for example on scheduling payment runs, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
2. Check the Payment Proposal and Execute the Payment
a. Navigate to the Automatic Payments view and open the previously generated payment proposal by selecting
the proposal and clicking Edit .
b. Check and correct the payment proposal, if necessary.
If no payment method was chosen in the preceding documents, the system defaults the payment method
specified in the Payment Data section of the customer data (see above) for internally-initiated payments in the
payment proposal. If more than one payment method was specified in the payment data, the system proposes
the most common payment method of the respective country. It is possible to overwrite the payment method
given in the payment proposal. If your customer asks you, for example, to use another payment method instead
of their credit card, you can change this in the payment proposal.
If there is an issue with the customer account and the status of the payment proposal is Postpone
as a result, correct the account settings and ensure that you choose Actions Reset
Postpone before executing the payment.
c. Initiate the automatic credit card payment by clicking Execute Payment .
On the basis of your configuration settings, the payment runs through an approval process. After the payment
has been executed, an authorization of the full payment amount and the credit card data is performed. If the
authorization has already taken place on the sales or service order or on the manual invoice, it will only be
repeated if the authorization has expired in the meantime.
For more information, see Configuration: Credit Card Authorization Profiles (only relevant for sales orders and
service orders).
In the Payment Management work center in the Payment Monitor view, the status of the payment is now
displayed as Ready for Transfer. Note that the Payment Monitor view is also available in the Liquidity
Management work center.
58 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
You can cancel a credit card payment only while it has the status Ready for Transfer. To do so, go
to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Monitor view. Select the payment
you want to cancel and click Reverse . Once the payment status is In Transfer, you cannot cancel
the payment, but must initiate a credit memo to your customer’s credit card instead.
For more information, for example on payment proposals, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
You Create the Manual Credit Card Payment
1. Go to the Receivables work center and choose the Customers view, then select the customer whose payable should
be cleared by credit card.
2. Click View and select the open item(s) to be cleared, then choose Pay Manually By and select Credit Card from
the list.
a. If you select an open item for which the payment method credit card was already chosen, this information will
be used to create the payment. You can review the payment and, if necessary, change the credit card
information. When you are finished, click Post .
b. If you select one or more open items on which no agreed payment method is chosen, the default credit card
of the customer will be selected. You can review the payment and, if necessary, change the credit card
information. When you are finished, click Post .
3. On the basis of your configuration settings, the payment will run through an approval process. As soon as the
approval is completed, the open item is cleared with the payment. If you want to track the status of your payment,
switch to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Monitor view.
Cancellation of PaymentsIf you have authorized a payment directly from a sales order, service order, or manual invoice and later
cancel the payment, these authorizations will not be cancelled and the service provider will not be notified.
The authorizations will be re-used as soon as the open item is paid.
If you have requested the authorizations directly from the New Credit Card Payment screen (not directly
from the sales order, service order, or manual invoice) and later cancel the payment, the authorizations
will be cancelled and the service provider will be notified.
Payment Amount IncreaseIf the amount to be paid is greater than the amount authorized, you can request an additional authorization
for the difference by clicking on the Check Authorization button.
Alternative: Pay Manually By Other Payment MethodsFrom the open item list select the item(s) to be cleared, then choose Pay Manually By and select Other Payment
Methods. On the New Payment screen, select Credit Card as payment method if it is not already the default. Review
the payment, and then click Execute Payment . The approval process and payment status tracking are described
in step three above.
You Create and Perform the Credit Card Settlement Run
After you have initiated the credit card payment automatically or manually, you want to inform your provider that the
payment should be made now.
To create and edit credit card settlement runs, go to the Payment Management work center. In the Periodic Tasks view,
choose the Credit Card Settlements subview. You can schedule your runs according to your business needs, for example
to be performed every day or week or once only. If you, for example, specified batch settlement in business configuration,
all payments from a run will be bundled in one message that is sent to the provider. For more information, see Quick
Guide for Credit Card Settlement Runs [240].
When the settlement run is done, the status of the settled credit card payments changes to In Transfer and the payment
message is sent to the provider (in a batch or individually, according to the settings you have made in business
configuration). The service provider will then forward the message to the clearing house. The clearing house will check
the request and send a reply via the provider as to whether it will credit (or debit) the amount of the credit card payments
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 59
bundled in the message to your account. This reply is automatically updated to the system in the form of the appropriate
settlement status. The bank statement will then show you that the payment has been received. Note that the bank
statement will show only one item representing the total amount of all the credit card payments that were settled together.
But if you have arranged for the clearing house to send you a statement listing all individual credit card payment items,
you can check whether the total amount corresponds to these items.
You can track the settlement processing status by navigating to the Payment Monitor view and then to the Details section
of the screen. The status is displayed under Current Settlement Data.
The following settlement statuses exist:
● Pending
This status means that the message has been sent to the service provider and the system is waiting for a
confirmation of the settlement. If no problems occur, the settlement status normally changes to Accepted within a
few minutes.
If the status does not change within the next 24 hours, you should check whether there has been an error transferring
the message.
● Accepted
This status means that the message has been successfully sent to the service provider and from the service provider
to the clearing house. The clearing house in turn has confirmed that it will settle the payment and sends this
information to the system via the service provider.
● Rejected
This status means that the clearing house rejects the settlement of the payment. The payment status in the Payment
Monitor changes back from In Transfer to Ready for Transfer. In this case, contact the service provider or the
clearing house to find out the reason for rejection, indicating either the provider ID or the clearing house ID.
Optional: You Settle the Payment Manually
1. To initiate the settlement of a credit card payment manually, switch to the Payment Management work center and
choose the Payment Monitor view.
2. In the list, select the required credit card payment with the status Ready for Transfer that was initiated in the
Receivables work center. You can select more than one payment if you want to settle several at the same time.
To speed up the search process, you can use the extended search function. For this, click Advanced
and enter your search criteria. For example, in the Payment Method field, select Incoming Payment Card
Payment and in the Show field, select Ready for Transfer. Click Go . Only payments that correspond
to the selected search criteria are displayed.
3. Click Actions for Credit Cards and then Settle.
The system generates a message that is sent to the service provider. The status of the payment changes to In
Transfer. Once the settlement data has been transferred to the service provider and from the service provider to
the clearing house, which agrees that the payment will be made, the settlement status changes to Accepted in the
Details section of the screen under Current Settlement Data.
Alternatively, in order to settle an individual credit card payment, you can also go to the Payment
Monitor view and open the corresponding payment. On the credit card payment screen, click
Start Settlement .
4. The clearing house will credit (or debit) the total amount of the credit card payments bundled in the message to
your bank account. The bank statement will then show you that the payment has been received.
Note that the bank statement will show only one item representing the total amount of all the credit card payments
that were settled together. If you have arranged for the clearing house to send you a statement listing all individual
credit card payment items, you can check whether the total amount agrees with these items.
You Enter a Bank Statement Containing Credit Card Payments
60 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
● Select New Bank Statement from the Common Tasks view of the Liquidity Management work center, if you want
to manually enter bank statement data that has been submitted in paper form.
1. In the Create and Edit Items step, click Add Row and select Incoming Credit Card Payment (or, if your credit
memos have resulted in an outgoing payment, select Outgoing Credit Card Payment from the Payment
Method drop-down list).
2. Enter the credit card payment amount (from the clearing house) that is printed on your bank statement, then
post the bank statement.
● Select the File Management view from the Liquidity Management work center, if you want to enter bank statement
data that has been submitted electronically.
1. Choose Inbound Files to upload a locally saved bank statement file to the system. For more information, see
File Management Quick Guide [282].
2. Check the bank statement data in the Bank Statements view of the Liquidity Management work center, and then
post the bank statement.
The system creates a payment allocation task for the credit card payments, because it cannot align the total
amount from the bank statement with the individual credit card payments. This task must be completed before
creating a liquidity forecast.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
For more information on how to confirm payments with your bank statement, see Confirm Payments with Your Bank
Statement
You Process the Credit Card Payment from Your Bank Statement in the Payment Allocation
If you want to edit the payment allocation immediately after posting the bank statement, click on the Post-process bank
statement link on the released bank statement. On the bank statement overview screen, click View All . In the
Transactions section of the screen, click on the Required link in the Postprocessing column for the relevant payment
from the clearing house. This takes you to the Payment Allocation screen.
1. The Payment Assignment tab displays the credit card payments with the status In Transfer and Pre-Confirmed by
default. Select all items contained in the payment (and shown on the clearing house statement) and copy them to
the lower screen area using the down arrow. You can identify them using the settlement number in the External
Reference column.
If your service provider is able to generate electronic clearing house statements, then you can also
complete this step more quickly by clicking on Actions and selecting Import Clearing House
Statement from the drop-down menu. For more information on how to upload clearing house statements,
see Upload a Clearing House Statement. If your service provider is not able to generate an electronic
clearing house statement, we recommend you ask for a printed statement containing the individual credit
card payment items. You can use this statement to find the items that exist in the system.
2. On the Other Allocation Tab, you need to enter the service provider’s charges and assign a G/L account. The Open
Amount should now be zero. When you are finished, click Post .
See Also
About Credit Card Service Provider Computop
About Credit Card Service Provider Paymetric
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 61
2.3.4 Customer Remittance Advices
Overview
A remittance advice is exchanged between the payer and payee. It contains detailed payment information for a specific
date relating to one or more invoices. Thus the remittance advice announces a payment transaction. Both the buyer
and seller can send the message. The payment advice informs when and how much of which invoice will be paid. It
contains detailed information about a payment that is required to allocate and clear open items.
The advice items contain the following entries:
For outgoing remittance advices:
● Amounts (payment amount and gross amount) and currency
● Invoice number for the open item
For incoming remittance advices:
● Amounts (payment amount and gross amount)
● Entries for the open item (such as the invoice number)
The aim of the message is to automate and speed up the clearing of open items.
Depending on the company policy, customers send a remittance advice for each payment or only for payments that
combine multiple invoices. In this way, you are notified about which open items the customer clears with the payment.
This makes it easier for you, the payee, to assign the payment to the open item.
If you have given customers authorization for direct debit with mandate, they can send a remittance advice to announce
the direct debit from the account and to explain which open items this payment clears.
You edit remittance advices in the Payment Management work center.
The following applies to the remittance advice business process:
● A remittance advice is a message about a payment transaction.
● A remittance advice can refer to one or more business transactions, but to only one payment.
● A remittance advice can contain a note to a payment method, for example, a bank transfer or check.
● An individual remittance advice can refer to both national and international payment processing.
● Each remittance advice refers to only one payment date.
● Depending on agreements, a remittance advice can be created by and for each business partner.
The system prints outgoing remittance advices when performing the payment media run, if the relevant field was selected
in the payment media run and if certain requirements have been met (see the Creating Customer RemittanceAdvices section).
Incoming remittance advices are assigned to payments in the system as standard and you do not need to make any
extra settings. Incoming remittance advices that are due in the future are included in the liquidity forecast without any
extra settings. To view the liquidity forecast, in the Liquidity Management work center, open the Liquidity Forecasts view.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
62 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Configuration
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
In the Business Configuration work center in the task list included in the Fine-Tune phase, you have made the following
settings relevant for cash flow management:
● For outgoing remittance advices: ○ You have configured the note to payee in case a remittance advice needs to be printed.
● For incoming remittance advices: ○ Remittance Advice Deletion Period (optional)
You specify how long the advice data should be saved in the system.
○ Clearing Strategies (mandatory)
The settings that you make here also apply to remittance advices. You specify the settings for the tolerance
limits and when manual clearing or manual allocation should take place.
Features
Entering Remittance Advices Received from Customers
You copy all the incoming remittance advices manually or electronically into the system. You enter received remittance
advices in the Payment Management work center in the Remittance Advices view.
Automatic Allocation of Received Remittance Advices to Incoming Payments
The system supports an automatic allocation of received remittance advices to open invoices and related incoming
payments. After you have transferred remittance advices to the system, the system performs an automatic allocation to
the related incoming payments using the advice number. Therefore, you no longer need to search for open items or
manually assign them to incoming payments. This does not result in any posting in the system. The system only changes
the status of the invoice to Ordered. Incoming payments are not cleared with open items until clearing.
If the system finds differences when allocating the advice to incoming payments that affect the invoice amount or invoice
date, it displays these differences. The system also shows remittance advices that cannot be assigned to any invoice.
To display a list of remittance advices, in the Payment Management work center, choose Payment Allocation.
Creating Customer Remittance Advices
If multiple invoices of a customer are debited by direct debit, the system automatically creates a remittance advice when
you use the payment media run. This happens if this was specified in the master data or the predefined space for the
note to payee of the payment method is not sufficient to represent the explanations on the individual invoices. The
system does not save remittance advices sent to customers. However, you can print advices as often as you want.
You can create remittance advices for each payment or only for selected payments:
● For each payment
You define whether remittance advices are to be created for payments in the master data of the customer. To
activate the creation of a remittance advice for each payment for which you have authorization to debit the invoice
amounts from the customer's account by direct debit with mandate, proceed as follows:
1. In the Receivables work center, open the Customers view and the Customers subview.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 63
2. Select the customer for whom you want to make this setting.
3. Choose Edit → Financial Data.
4. Under Advice Control, select the Remittance Advice Required checkbox.
You must make these settings for each customer individually.
● For payments where the predefined space for the note to payee is not sufficient:
The remittance advice is created with the payment medium.
● For selected payments:
If you only want to create a remittance advice for payments of individual invoices or payments for multiple invoices
without having defined this in the master data, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Management work center, open the Payment Monitor view.
2. Select the required payments.
3. Click Create Remittance Advice .
The system accesses the invoice data during creation. The new advice status of the payment Issued is displayed
in the detail area of this screen under Remittance Advice Data.
Submitting a Customer Remittance Advice
You can submit outgoing remittance advices electronically if you have made the appropriate settings in configuration
and for master data. For more information, see Electronic Submission of Outgoing Remittance Advices [65].
Generating a Customer Remittance Advice
To print customer remittance advices or send them electronically if the customer has given you authorization for direct
debits, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Management work center, open the Periodic Tasks view and the Payment Media Runs subview.
2. Choose New → Payment Media Run.
The New Payment Media Run screen appears.
3. Fill the relevant fields on the New Payment Media Run screen and select the Including Payment Advice checkbox.
Save your entries.
4. Choose Set to Active .
The remittance advices are generated automatically during the next payment media run. You can generate an
outgoing customer remittance advice more than once.
5. To schedule the printing or electronic sending of remittance advices and thus to do this at specific times on a
recurring basis, choose Schedule .
The Schedule Job screen appears.
Enter the data required for the scheduling and save your entries.
Viewing the Status of a Customer Remittance Advice
You can view the advice status for each outgoing payment in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view. The status is displayed in the details under Advice Data. In the Advice Required field, the system also
displays whether a remittance advice is required, if this was specified in the master data of the customer or the space
for the note to payee was not sufficient.
Viewing the Remittance Advice History
If you want to display a customer’s remittance advice history, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Management work center, open the Remittance Advices view.
64 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
2. To display the payment of a specific customer, choose the filter function and enter the customer in the Payer/Payee
ID field.
All advices of the selected customer are displayed.
You can sort the advices according to their status (for example, released, canceled, confirmed).
2.3.5 Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices
You can send outgoing payment advices to your customers or suppliers using an electronic interface as opposed to
printing them in paper form. It is possible to do this if both you and your suppliers or customers have made the required
system settings for this interface.
Your company wants to dispense in future with printed payment advices that were previously sent to a supplier in the
mail. Instead, you want to send the payment advice to the supplier in electronic form with information about the payments
you have requested. In this case, your company, in its role of the customer, is the sender, and your supplier is the
receiver of the payment advice.
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Scoping
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices is activated in your solution configuration. To find this business
option, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your
implementation project and click Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Payment and
Liquidity Managementis selected within Cash Flow Management.
In the Questions step, expand the Cash Flow Management scoping element, select Payment and Liquidity
Management and answer the questions related to Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices.
Master Data
Both the sending and the receiving company of the payment advice must have their own standard form of identification,
such as a unique company D-U-N-S number (Data Universal Numbering System), which is assigned to companies by
Dun & Bradstreet. This ID is entered by both parties in the master data and required in each case by the system to
uniquely assign the electronic exchange of data between two companies. The following IDs can be used as a standard
form of identification:
● German customs number
● D-U-N-S number
● Global location number
● Standard Carrier Alpha Code (for freight companies)
To enter a standard ID, go to the Organizational Management work center and choose Common Tasks Edit Org
Structures . On the General tab, you can enter your standard ID using the External Business Identifiers link.
Both the sender and receiver need to agree upon a standard ID to use and communicate this to each other to be able
to activate the electronic interface.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 65
The following procedure uses the D-U-N-S number as the standard ID.
1. Data Retrieval and Entry of the D-U-N-S Number for Payment Advice Sender: ● On the Sender Side:
Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Common Tasks Show Organizational Structures .
On the Organizational Structure: <Name of Company> screen, the General tab displays the D-U-N-S number.
You inform the receiver of this number.
● On the Receiver Side:Navigate to the Receivables work center and choose Customers. Select the appropriate customer and choose
Edit → General. On the Corporate Account: <Name of Company> screen, enter in the D-U-N-S-Number field
the D-U-N-S number that you received from the sender. Choose Save.
2. Data Retrieval and Entry of the D-U-N-S Number for Payment Advice Receiver: ● On the Receiver Side:
Navigate to the Receivables work center and choose Common Tasks Show Organizational Structures
. On the Organizational Structure: <Name of Company> screen, the General tab displays the D-U-N-S
number. You inform the sender about this number.
● On the Sender Side:Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Suppliers. Select the appropriate supplier and choose
Edit → General. On the Supplier: <Name of Company> screen, enter in the D-U-N-S-Number field the D-U-
N-S number that you received from the sender. Choose Save.
Process Flow
For your company to be able to send payment advices electronically, you need to ensure that both the XML output
channel is set and that the interface is set up, also on the supplier side, as described below.
Setting the Electronic Submission of Payment Advices
The function for submitting payment advices electronically needs to be activated on both the side of the sender and the
receiver. The following sections explain how you make these settings.
Setting the Communication Arrangement on the Receiver Side
1. Go to the Application and User Management work center and choose Input and Output
Management Communication Arrangements . Choose New .
2. On the New Communication Arrangement screen, enter the required data including your customer in the Business
Partner ID field. Enter Dun & Bradstreet Number under the Identification Type.
Under Selected Service, choose the following values: ● Business Document: Remittance Advice Inbound
● Collaboration Template: Remittance Advice (Inbound Using SAP ESD)
● Collaboration Template Type: XI Inbound
In the Security section in the Authentication field, choose the value SSL Client Certificate. Alternatively, choose
the User Name/Password value and edit the User Name field accordingly.
3. The system generates a URL of which you inform the sender. This is displayed under Technical Settings.
4. Choose Save.
The configured interface now enables you to receive payment advices in electronic form, in which you are notified
electronically about payment requests.
66 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Setting the Communication Arrangement on the Sender Side
1. Go to the Application and User Management work center and choose Input and Output
Management Communication Arrangements . Choose New .
2. On the New Communication Arrangement screen, enter the required data including your supplier in the Business
Partner ID field. In the Identification Type field, enter Dun & Bradstreet Number.Under Selected Service, choose the following values:
● Business Document: Remittance Advice Outbound
● Collaboration Template: Remittance Advice (Outbound Using SAP ESD)
● Collaboration Template Type: XI Outbound
Under Technical Settings, enter in the URL field the URL that the recipient of the payment advice provided you
with.
In the Security section in the Authentication field, choose the value SSL Client Certificate. In the User Name field,
choose ByDesign System Key, which then enables you to use the Download Certificate function displayed
alongside.
Alternatively, choose the User Name/Password value and edit the User Name field accordingly.
Choose Save.
3. Navigate to the Payables work center and choose Suppliers. Select your supplier and choose Edit →
Addresses. On the Communication tab, choose Collaboration.
4. In the Remittance Advice Outbound field, choose XML and then Save.
You can now initiate payment transactions using the corresponding supplier invoices, and send payment advices to
your suppliers electronically with notification of your payment requests.
If the recipient of the payment advice does not use SAP Business ByDesign but does use a web service, the
recipient can inform the sender of the URL provided by this web service. The payment advice can then be
submitted using this URL.
See Also
Supplier Payment Advices [67]
Enter a Remittance Advice [235]
2.3.6 Supplier Remittance Advices
Overview
A remittance advice is exchanged between the payer and payee. It contains detailed payment information for a specific
date relating to one or more invoices. In this way, the remittance advice announces a payment transaction. Both the
buyer and seller can send the message. The remittance advice informs when and how much of which invoice will be
paid. It contains detailed information about a payment that is required to allocate and clear open items.
The advice items contain the following entries:
For outgoing remittance advices:
● Amounts (payment amount and gross amount) and currency
● Invoice number for the open item
For incoming remittance advices:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 67
● Amounts (payment amount and gross amount) and currency
● Entries for the open item (such as the invoice number)
The aim of the message is to automate and speed up the clearing of open items.
Depending on company policy, suppliers receive a remittance advice for each payment or only for payments that
combine multiple invoices. You create a remittance advice to inform the payee which open items are cleared with a
payment. This makes it easier for the payee to assign the payment to the open item.
If you have given suppliers authorization for direct debit with mandate, they can send a remittance advice to announce
the direct debit from the account and to explain which open invoices this payment clears.
You edit remittance advices in the Payment Management work center.
The following applies to the remittance advice business process:
● A remittance advice is a message about a payment transaction.
● A remittance advice can refer to one or more business transactions, but to only one payment.
● A remittance advice can contain a note to a payment method, for example, a bank transfer or check.
● An individual remittance advice can refer to both national and international payment processing.
● Each remittance advice refers to only one payment date.
● Depending on the agreements made, a remittance advice can be created by and for each customer or supplier.
The system prints remittance advices when performing the payment run, if the relevant field was selected in the payment
media run and if certain requirements have been met (see the Creating Supplier Remittance Advices section).
Incoming remittance advices are assigned to payments in the system as standard and you do not need to make any
extra settings. Incoming remittance advices that are due in the future are included in the liquidity forecast without any
extra settings. To view the liquidity forecast, in the Liquidity Management work center, open the Cash Position and
Forecast view.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
In the Business Configuration work center in the task list included in the Fine-Tune phase, you have made the following
settings relevant for cash flow management:
● For outgoing remittance advices: ○ You have configured the note to payee in case a remittance advice needs to be printed.
● For incoming remittance advices: ○ Clearing Strategies
The settings that you make here also apply to remittance advices. You specify the settings for the tolerance
limits and when manual clearing or manual allocation should take place.
Features
Entering Remittance Advices Received from Suppliers
You copy all the incoming remittance advices manually or electronically into the system. You enter received remittance
advices in the Payment Management work center in the Remittance Advices view.
68 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
Creating Supplier Remittance Advices
If multiple invoices of a supplier are paid with an outgoing payment, the system automatically creates a remittance advice
when you use the payment media run. This happens if this was specified in the master data or the predefined space for
the note to payee of the payment method is not sufficient to represent the explanations on the individual invoices. The
system does not save remittance advices sent to suppliers. However, you can print advices as often as you want.
You can create remittance advices for each payment or only for selected payments:
● For each payment
You define whether remittance advices are to be created for payments in the master data of the supplier. To activate
the creation of a remittance advice for each payment, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payables work center, open the Suppliers view and the Suppliers subview.
2. Select the supplier for whom you want to make this setting.
3. Choose Edit → Financial Data.
4. Under Advice Control, select the Advice Required checkbox.
You must make these settings for each supplier individually.
● For payments where the predefined space for the note to payee is not sufficient:
The remittance advice is created with the payment medium.
● For selected payments
If you only want to create a remittance advice for payments of individual invoices or payments for multiple invoices
without having defined this in the master data, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Management work center, open the Payment Monitor view.
2. Select the required payments.
3. Click Create Remittance Advice .
The system accesses the invoice data during creation. The new advice status of the payment Issued is displayed
in the detail area of this screen under Remittance Advice Data.
Submitting a Supplier Remittance Advice
You can submit outgoing remittance advices electronically if you have made the appropriate settings in configuration
and for master data. For more information, see Electronic Submission of Outgoing Remittance Advices [65].
Generating a Supplier Remittance Advice
To print supplier remittance advices or send them electronically, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Management work center, open the Periodic Tasks view and the Payment Media Runs subview.
2. Choose New → Payment Media Run
The New Payment Media Run screen appears.
3. Fill the relevant fields on the New Payment Media Run screen and select the Including Advice checkbox. Save your
entries.
4. Choose Activate .
The remittance advices are generated automatically during the next payment media run. You can generate an
outgoing supplier remittance advice more than once.
5. To schedule the printing or electronic sending of remittance advices and thus to do this at specific times on a
recurring basis, choose Schedule .
The Schedule Job screen appears.
Enter the data required for the scheduling and save your entries.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 69
Viewing the Status of a Supplier Remittance Advice
You can view the advice status for each outgoing payment in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view. The status is displayed in the details under Advice Data. In the Advice Required field, the system also
displays whether a remittance advice is required, if this was specified in the master data of the supplier or the space for
the note to payee was not sufficient.
2.3.7 Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing
Overview
The Point-of-Sale Transactions view enables you to process sales transactions and cash transactions from an external
system. An external sale is typically a business transaction that is performed at the point of sale, and subsequently
entered in an external (remote) system before being transferred at a point later in time to the SAP Business ByDesign
system. A cash transaction is the transfer of cash from one point-of-sale device to another with the external system.
If a sales transaction or cash transaction is complete and consistent, it is automatically processed by the system and
forwarded to Financial Management. However, should the sales transaction or cash transaction be incomplete or
inconsistent, you can use the Sales Transactions subview and Cash Transactions view to receive, analyze, and process
the sales or cash transaction data. You can then display and correct the data before it is released to Financial
Management.
If required, you can use the Sales Summaries subview to check for missing sales transactions by viewing sales
summaries that are periodically sent by the external system. You can access the Sales Summaries subview from the
Customer Invoicing work center under Sale Summaries. For more information, see Check a Sales Summary.
Note that a customer can pay for a sales transaction (purchase) using cash, credit card, or invoice (the customer
receives an invoice that is created in the external system).
If a customer returns a sold item to the external sales partner, a new sales transaction will be sent containing
a sales item with associated return reason code, and negative amounts and quantities.
The procedure used to process the sales transaction is exactly the same as that for a sales transaction
containing positive amounts and quantities.
Point-of-Sale Transactions processing supports the sale and redemption of gift certificates.
A sales transaction can originate from one of the following distribution channels:
● Internet
● Box office
● Call center
● Direct sales
Prerequisites
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
70 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
● You have obtained a written agreement with SAP or a written agreement between the customer and an SAP
approved third party solution provider for this particular functionality, as it is not included in the SAP Business
ByDesign license.
Point of Sales Transactions are enabled in your solution configuration. To find this business option, go to the
Business Configuration and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that the Point-of-Sale is selected within Customer
Invoicing.
In the Questions step, expand the Sales scoping element and select Customer Invoicing. Select Point-of-Sale and
answer the questions related to Point-of-Sale integration.
● Verify that all the required master data has been created, for example: ○ Account data
Account data must be regularly synchronized between the external (remote) system, and the SAP
Business ByDesign system.
○ Petty cash
○ Clearing house
○ Clearing house account
○ G/L accounts for revenues
○ Projects and corresponding tasks for events that are mapped by the external system
○ Payment terms
○ Credit card data for customers (if needed)
○ Bank account data for the representation of accounts with online payment services (if needed)
Process Flow
Scenario 1: Sales Transactions
1. The customer makes a purchase from an external distribution channel.
The following standard purchase variants are available: ● Purchase using a cash payment
● Purchase by credit card
● Purchase by invoice
● Purchase by credit card without customer data and other payment cards
● Purchase using an online payment service
● Mixed purchase. For example, using a combination of credit card and cash payment
2. The external system starts a batch upload and sends the data to Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing.
3. Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing does one of the following: ● If the sales transaction data is inconsistent, the sales transaction is not automatically released, and manual
correction of the data is required before releasing to Financial Management.
For more information about manual correction, see Correct and Release a Point-of-Sale Transaction.
● If the sales transaction data is consistent, it is automatically released to Financial Management.
For more information, see Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing in Financial Management.
Scenario 2: Cash Transactions
1. The cashier makes a cash transfer from one petty cash to another, for example, from the cash register to the main
safe, and enters the transfer amount in the point-of-sale device.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Business Background PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 71
2. The external system starts a batch upload and sends the data to Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing.
3. Point-of-Sale Transaction Processing does one of the following: ● If the cash transaction data is inconsistent, the cash transaction is not automatically released, and manual
correction of the data is required before releasing to Financial Management.
For more information about manual correction, see Correct and Release a Cash Transaction.
● If the cash transaction data is consistent, it is automatically released to Financial Management.
See Also
Point-of-Sale Transactions Quick Guide
72 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Business Background
3 Payables
3.1 Business Background
3.1.1 Open Items Payables
Overview
You can display open item lists for supplier accounts. Open items are posted open invoices for goods and services or
credit memos that were not yet paid. With the lists of the open items of suppliers of your company, you can monitor the
dates of outgoing payments to avoid interest on arrears and use cash discounts. Open payments are also displayed in
the open item list. In addition, you get an overview for which supplier accounts you still need to edit open items.
Prerequisites
To display open items, you must have already entered and posted a supplier invoice in the system. If you have notassigned a company to a supplier when you create the master data, the system attempts to do this automatically with
the first posted invoice. You can also assign the company yourself. To do this, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payables work center, open the Suppliers view and the Suppliers subview.
2. Select the appropriate supplier and choose Edit → Financial Data.
A dialog box appears.
3. Choose the Payment Data area.
4. You can use Add Row to create a new supplier account and enter the company.
5. Set up the account determination groups.
For more information, see Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business Transaction.
View of the Lists of Open Items
To get an overview of your open items, select the Reports view in the Payables work center. You find the following
reports in this list that display information about the open items to your suppliers:
● Open Item List - Suppliers
The report displays the open items for each supplier for a specific key date.
● Item List - Suppliers
The reports displays all items - open, cleared, and partially cleared - for each supplier for a specific period. You
can also only display the open items of your supplier for a selected period.
● Aging List for Payables
This report displays the overdue open items of your suppliers, structured by how long they are overdue in days.
The items that are not due yet are also displayed in total.
● Forecast List for Payables
This report displays for each supplier your open payables for which the due date is after the specified key date and
lies in the future. In this way, you can get an overview of the outgoing payments to be made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 73
The reports take the data from the register for trade receivables and payables, replicate this data in a separate database,
and import the data according to your selected report profile. Once you have selected the report, you can save different
queries to standardize repetitive activities.
For example, to create the Open Item List - Suppliers report, you must enter the company, currency, key date, and
conversion date of the display currency. If you leave the Supplier entry field empty, the report selects all suppliers. The
reports Aging List for Payables and Forecast List for Payables require that you also enter the aging/forecast analysis
period. You also have the option of selecting a specific supplier if you only want to display the open items of a specific
supplier. In the Item List -Suppliers report, you can use the status to specify whether only the cleared, partially cleared,
or open items should be displayed.
If you have saved a query as a selection variant, it appears for selection on the same screen in the Available Variants
list. You can change and save a selected selection variant if you want to copy the changes for the existing selection
variant. If you want to save the query under a new name, choose Save As. This saves the new query as a selection
variant. The Payment Statistics - Suppliers report is also provided to display open items.
In addition to the option of displaying open items in a report, you can also display the open items of a specific supplier
using the Supplier Account Monitor. For more information, see Supplier Account Monitor [74].
See Also
Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business Transaction
Supplier Account Monitor [74]
3.1.2 Supplier Account Monitor
Overview
The supplier account monitor provides you with an overview of your payables to your suppliers, for example to check
which invoices have to be paid by your company in the next few days. You can also use it when dealing with supplier
inquiries or clearing open items in an account.
It also provides you with an overview of your payables to your employees. This enables you to check which expense
reports are to be paid, for example.
To call up the supplier account monitor, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payables work center, open the Suppliers view, then the Supplier Accounts subview.
2. Select the appropriate supplier and choose View . (To view an employee's account, use the filter to show
employees, select the employee, and choose View .)
The following tab pages are available in the supplier account monitor:
● General Data
Here you can view the supplier's address, open item totals in the transaction currency, and valuated balances in
the company currency. You can also view accounting data, such as the company currency or the default set of
books.
You can access the customer account if you have defined the roles of both customer and supplier in the master
data records.
● Trade Payables — Invoices/Payments
Here you can view all the transactions made on a particular supplier account. You can also create manual payments
and start the manual clearing of payments.
You can filter the invoices, credit memos, and payments according to their status as follows:
74 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
○ Open Items shows open items and partially cleared items.
○ Cleared Items shows cleared items and canceled items.
○ All Items shows all items.
You can choose whether to include statistical items, such as down payment requests and bill of exchange requests,
in the display.
The information about the items is presented in table format and includes: status, external reference, document
type, document date, net due date, posting date, open amount in transaction currency, and clearing ID. In the detail
area below the table, additional information is displayed about the item selected in the table. This includes the
amount in the transaction currency, the cash discount amount, the payment terms and due dates, the payment
method, and payment block details.
The (optional) columns Document Amount in Transaction Currency or Cleared Amounts may show a
sum that is not equal to zero. This means that the sum of the payments and credit memos does not equal
the sum of the invoices. This happens when an item is transferred to another account or a discount is
taken.
● Trade Payables — Postings
Here you can view all the transactions made on a particular supplier account within a specified period. The display
also includes opening and closing balances for the period in question. You can choose to include journal entries
that are not relevant for the general ledger in order to explain open item amounts.
It is also possible to sort according to open item reference ID in order to view associated debit and credit entries
together.
● Changes
Here you can view the change history for a particular supplier account.
● Reports
Here you can run reports on balances, as well as access reports on aging and forecasts for the selected supplier.
Features
Line Item Details
In the line item details, you can see the status, due date, amount, cash discount amount, clearing document ID, and
Created On date, as well as other information for each invoice, credit memo, or payment.
You can also view all the journal entries related to this item.
For items that have not yet been included in any clearing or payment processes and have the status Open, you can
make changes to cash discount terms or payment method/block information.
Split Items
If there is only a partial payment for an invoice that leads to a partial clearing of the invoice, the system creates split
items for this invoice with split item IDs. Each of these split items has its own status (Open or Cleared). An invoice that
is only partially cleared therefore has precisely one open split item.
New Charge/Credit
You can use this function to create a new open item for which an invoice does not currently exist, for example, to portray
fees or rental payments. You might enter an item for fees and then clear it once the fees have been paid, for example.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 75
Manual Clearing
The manual clearing function on the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Payables tab enables you to manually
clear supplier payments with outstanding invoices if the system was not able to perform clearing automatically. You can
also clear credit memos with invoices or outgoing payments from the supplier (for example, refund by bank transfer or
other refunds) with credit memos. When you perform clearing, the balance of the selected items may not result in zero.
Differences can be written off or kept as remaining open items, which can be cleared later with future payments.
To start manual clearing, proceed as follows:
1. Select the appropriate invoices and choose Clear Manually . The New Manual Clearing screen appears. You see
the Open Items table. The system checks whether the items are already in clearing (whether a payment proposal
has already been created for these items). The available items are displayed for editing.
2. Select the relevant open items and choose Match Items . You see the total balance of the selected items in the
upper area of the screen.
If you use the function for splitting open items, you can use the supplier account monitor to perform manual
clearing only (not automatic). The items have the same external reference and must therefore be cleared
manually and included in separate clearings.
Manual Payment
The manual payment function ( Pay Manually By ) on the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Payables tab enables
you to pay invoices or credit memos, for example by check, bank transfer, or direct debit. The payment methods available
are based on your definition in the supplier master data.
Underpayment
If a difference arises because the payments made are smaller than the invoice amount and lead to a miscellaneous
operating income, you can represent this as follows:
● You can distribute the difference amount to the selected items together:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
2. Choose Apply Discount or Credit .
3. Enter the amount and reason. The system distributes the complete amount of the difference to the items.
● You can distribute the difference amount to selected items individually:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
2. Select the appropriate item in the table.
3. Choose Additional Discounts and Credits.
4. Choose Add Row.
5. Enter the amount and reason.
The precise behavior is also dependent on the settings made for the clearing strategy in Fine-Tuning.
The system performs the tax consolidation associated with the underpayment automatically.
76 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Overpayment
If a difference arises from an outgoing payment that is greater than the invoice amount (for example, when you have
granted the collection procedure to a supplier who has collected too much), you can assign the total payment amount
to the supplier account and leave the amount on the supplier account as an on account payment.
If the system was able to allocate payments to the open invoices based on invoice references and clearing has taken
place, the system still creates a task for payment clearing in the event of overpayments. This is dependent on the settings
for the clearing strategy in Fine-Tuning. You have the following options for handling the difference:
● In the Payables work center in the Payment Clearing view, you can leave the remaining balance as an on account
payment.
● You can contact your supplier and agree a refund for the overpaid amount.
● You can clear the difference amount manually:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
2. Select the relevant items.
3. Choose Apply Discount or Credit and enter a reason for the difference and the amount.
The system does not make any tax adjustments with respect to the overpaid amount. To make a tax
adjustment for the overpaid amount, you use the Manual Tax Entries view of the Tax Management work
center.
Reset Clearing
You can reset clearing, for example, if an invoice has been allocated to the wrong payment and then cleared. To do
this, proceed as follows:
If you need to cancel a supplier invoice that has already been paid, first reverse the clearing in the
Payables work center then cancel the invoice in the Supplier Invoicing work center.
If you first cancel the supplier invoice in the Supplier Invoicing work center, the original clearing still exists and
the system generates a new open item (reversal document).
If you have already transferred the source invoice manually to another account, a reversal item is displayed
on the original account. Transfer the reversal item in the same way as the source invoice. Then you can clear
the source invoice with the reversal document.
For more information, see Canceling a Supplier Invoice [52].
1. In the Supplier Account Monitor, click Invoices/Payments and filter for cleared items.
2. Select the item for which you want to undo clearing and choose Clearing Document .
3. Choose View All . You see a list with the clearing documents for this item.
4. Choose Reset Clearing .
5. Enter a cancellation date and document description (if desired).
6. Choose OK .
The item is no longer cleared and is displayed with the status Open or Partially Cleared.
Clearing When Canceling an Invoice
If you create a partially or completely-cleared invoice, or an invoice with reference to a down payment, the system
automatically clears part of the invoice. Typically, the invoice remains partially open, and the down payment is cleared.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 77
However, both the invoice and down payment can be partially cleared, depending on your choice of amounts. If you
cancel this invoice, the system creates a cancellation invoice. Furthermore, a cancellation document is created in the
payables and receivables register. You now have the following options for clearing:
● Reverse clearing for the invoice in the supplier account monitor and then clear the invoice manually with the
cancellation invoice. The invoice and cancellation invoice then have the status Cleared and the down payment has
the status Open.
● If you would rather not involve the clearing document for the invoice, possibly because you have defined a cash
discount or other deductions for additional documents that also need to be cleared, you can use the cancellation
invoice to clear other open items (in the same way as for a credit memo).
● If these considerations are not applicable, and if there are no further items available for clearing, you can clear the
repayment once you have received the payment from the supplier.
For more information, see Down Payments Made in Financials [81] and Down Payment Request Processing for
Supplier Invoices.
Other Functions
You can also do the following in the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Payables tab:
● Make single or multiple repostings of payments or invoices
● Transfer all items to another supplier account
● Split open items
You can split a payment between different reconciliation accounts, for example, to portray a security deposit for a
house purchase.
● Export the details of a supplier account to Microsoft Excel
● Set or reset payment blocks
The payment block only applies to payments that are triggered by your company. Incoming payments are not
affected by this. The payment block does not result in a delivery block.
Integration
If you have a supplier who is also a customer, you can also see them in the customer account monitor in the
Receivables work center. You must create the master data of this business partner twice. For more information, see
Business Partners.
See Also
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
3.1.3 Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials
Overview
A cash discount can be applied to the payment of a supplier invoice. This can be done automatically or manually. The
system automatically posts the cash discount deduction.
78 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Fine-Tuning
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials is activated in your solution configuration. To find this activity, go to the
Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project
and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials from
the activity list.
● You need to define the payment terms. To do this, choose General Business Data Suppliers Edit Payment
Terms .
● There needs to be an account for Deducted Cash Discounts and it needs to have been entered in your financial
reporting structures and assigned in account determination for the business transaction Cash Discount for
Payment/Discount. Choose Financial and Management Accounting Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting
Structures, Account Determination .
● You need to have defined your payment strategy. To do this, choose Cash Flow Management Payment
Strategy .
Automatic Deduction of a Cash Discount
A cash discount can be automatically determined by the system and deducted when a supplier invoice is paid. The cash
discount is determined using the following data:
● Payment terms for each supplier: Payment terms have been assigned in the master data of the relevant supplier.
● Payment term for each invoice: Payment terms were assigned when the supplier invoice was entered. If payment
terms exist for a supplier invoice, the system always applies these terms and not the payment terms entered in the
master data for that supplier. If no payment terms were assigned during invoice entry, the system applies the
payment terms for the relevant supplier.
● Payment Strategy: The payment strategy specifies how the cash discount amount and the payment date are
determined from the payment terms. The payment strategy can apply to a single supplier or a company.
The amount of the cash discount and the payment date for a supplier invoice are defaulted in the payment proposal list.
You can overwrite the discount amount and the payment date. You find the payment proposal list in the Payables work
center under Automatic Payments. For more information on outgoing payments, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Manual Deduction of a Cash Discount
Clear Manually
You can enter a cash discount while manually editing an open item in the supplier account monitor. In the Payables
work center, choose Suppliers Supplier Accounts and proceed as follows:
1. Select a supplier and choose View .
2. Select the items you require and choose Clear Manually .
3. Enter the required amount in the Cash Discount field of the invoice.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 79
Payment Proposal List
The discount is defaulted in the payment proposal list. You can overwrite the proposal. You find the payment proposal
list in the Payables work center under Automatic Payments.
Posting a Deducted Cash Discount
When you pay a supplier invoice, the cash discount is posted using the gross procedure. The input tax is corrected
automatically for the payment date of the invoice. For more information, see Discounts: Cash Discounts and Bonuses
[339]. How cash discounts are posted depends on whether they are combined with a goods receipt:
● Invoice receipt with goods receipt: The cash discount is not posted until GR/IR clearing is performed. For more
information, see GR/IR Clearing Run - Cash Discount.
● Invoice receipt without goods receipt: The cash discount is posted to the original account in the journal entry
for the supplier invoice, that is, to the expense account or to the fixed asset.
Cash Discounts for Partial Payments
If an invoice is only partially cleared, the cash discount is calculated and posted to the payment amount.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a 3 % cash discount, a partial payment of EUR 97 is made. In addition
to this, the system posts the cash discount of EUR 3 proportionately. This results in a clearing amount of EUR 100. If
you are processing an externally initiated outgoing payment, and it has been defined in the system configuration that a
task will always be generated for underpayments, the item is not cleared and the system creates a corresponding task.
The amounts used in the example are proposed automatically for clearing.
Cash Discounts for Clearing Credit Memos
If the payment terms of the credit memo match those of the invoice (for an invoice-relevant credit memo, for example),
a cash discount is posted for both the invoice and the credit memo.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a 3 % cash discount, and a credit memo of EUR 100 with a 3% cash
discount, a cash discount of EUR 3 is calculated for the clearing amount of EUR 100. The cash discount is posted as
a negative amount for the invoice and simultaneously as a positive amount for the credit memo, meaning that no cash
discount is paid.
If the credit memo has no cash discount terms, such as a subsequent bonus credit memo, a cash discount is calculated
and posted to the credit memo during manual clearing.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a cash discount of 3 %, and a bonus credit memo of EUR 97 without
a cash discount, a cash discount of EUR 3 is posted additionally. This results in a clearing amount of EUR 100.
Cash Discounts for Down Payments
During the clearing of a supplier invoice (of EUR 1,000, for example) with a down payment (of EUR 100, for example),
the system does not post a cash discount. If the system creates the final payment during the automatic payment run,
for example, the system calculates the cash discount for the remaining payment. This is EUR 900 in the example.
If you want to apply the cash discount to the total amount of the invoice, then you can choose when processing the
payment proposal the supplier invoices for which you have received down payments and adjust the cash discount to
the total invoice amount. To view and process a payment proposal, choose Payables Automatic Clearing .
See Also
Supplier Account Monitor [74]
GR/IR Clearing
80 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Outgoing Payments [11]
Configuration: Payment Strategies
Suppliers — Configuration Guide
3.1.4 Down Payments Made in Financials
Overview
Before goods are produced or services provided, it is sometimes necessary to make a down payment on an invoice
amount. Securing a reservation is an example of a down payment. In such cases, the supplier sends a down payment
request, which is entered in the system.
The down payment request is displayed in the system in the payables balance as a statistical open item. It is part of the
balance confirmation request and can be paid. The amount from the down payment request is not initially posted to
accounting, nor is the tax amount initially entered in the tax entries. Instead, this occurs when the payment is made.
The down payment can be made manually, or automatically using a scheduled payment run. If the system creates the
payment, the tax amounts are posted and the down payment amounts are posted to the corresponding general ledger
accounts.
Once the final invoice for the total amount is received, the system automatically assigns the total invoice item to the
down payment item if the references match. A transfer posting is made from the Down Payments Made account to the
Payables account. The tax entry resulting from the down payment made is cancelled and a new tax entry is entered
using the amount from the total invoice.
For more information on postings for down payments, see Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method) [331].
Prerequisites
The accounts for down payments are provided in the Business Configuration work center in the Activity List view and
the Fine-Tune step. To navigate to this step, choose Financial and Management Accounting > Chart of Accounts,
Financial Reporting Structures, Account Determination -> Accounts Payable or Accounts Receivable. For more
information about account determination, see Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business
Transaction and Reconciliation Accounts.
Process Flow
1. Create Down Payment RequestYou create a new down payment request in the Supplier Invoicing work center. If a down payment is based on a
purchase order defined in the Purchase Requests and Orders work center, you need to enter a down payment
request with a purchase order reference (while quoting the relevant purchase order number). If you enter an invoice
at a later point in time, the system uses the purchase order number to identify automatically the referenced down
payment. For more information, see Editing Down Payment Requests for Supplier Invoices.
2. Display Supplier AccountIn the Payables work center, in the Suppliers view under Supplier Accounts you can display the down payment
request with the status Open.
3. Make a Down PaymentYou can pay the down payment request manually, or automatically using a payment run. To pay the down payment
request manually, go to the Payables work center to the Suppliers and Supplier Accounts views. Your down
payment request is displayed in the supplier account monitor with the status Open. You can pay the down payment
request manually using the action Pay Manually By <Payment Method> (Pay Manually By Outgoing Check, for
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 81
example). Once you have released the check, you can view the document flow by choosing Outgoing Check ->
View All. You see that the check was posted as a down payment made and that a provisional tax amount has been
entered.
To pay the down payment request using an automatic payment run, go to the Payables work center and the
Automatic Payments view. Once the automatic payment run has been performed, the system displays a payment
proposal, which contains your down payment request with the status Open. By scheduling a payment run, and
depending on your settings in configuration, your down payment request is paid on the due date. .
Partial clearing for down payment requests is not supported. Only the full amount can be cleared.
4. Enter Final InvoiceIn the supplier account monitor, you can see the down payment with the status Open. To enter the final invoice,
switch to the Supplier Invoicing work center.
For the creation of the final invoice, the system proposes clearing all existing down payments made to the supplier
on the Down Payments tab page. Here, you can change the amount of the down payment to be cleared. You can
clear any remaining amount with a future invoice from the supplier.
5. Pay Final Invoice
Reversing Down Payment Requests, Down Payments, and Total Invoices
You can make a down payment request invalid in the Supplier Invoicing work center prior to posting, as long as it has
not yet been paid. If you have already made the down payment, you must first reverse clearing in the supplier account
monitor. For more information on reversing clearing and on clearing when you cancel an invoice with reference to a
down payment, see Supplier Account Monitor [74] and refer to the section on clearing when canceling an invoice with
reference to an invoice.
Discount Applied to Supplier Invoices with Down Payments
During the clearing of a supplier invoice (of EUR 1,000, for example) with a down payment (of EUR 100, for example),
the system does not post a cash discount. If the system creates the final payment during the automatic payment run,
the system proposes the cash discount amount only for the remaining amount of the invoice. This is EUR 900 in the
example.
If you want to apply the cash discount to the total amount of the invoice, then you can choose when processing the
payment proposal the supplier invoices for which you have received down payments and adjust the cash discount to
the total invoice amount. To view and process a payment proposal, choose Payables -> Automatic Clearing. For more
information, see Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials [78].
See Also
Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method) [331]
Supplier Account Monitor [74]
Editing Down Payment Requests for Supplier Invoices
Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials [78]
3.1.5 Foreign Currency Remeasurement
Overview
If you start the procedure for foreign currency remeasurement, the system automatically makes the relevant postings
and subsequently withdraws postings.
You can perform foreign currency remeasurement for receivables and payables and for cash in foreign currency. Foreign
currency remeasurement is an important part of period-end closing.
82 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Payables and Receivables
Depending on the set of books, the system proceeds as follows for foreign currency remeasurement for payables and
receivables:
1. The system selects all open receivables / payables for which the transaction currency differs from the company
currency.
2. The system totals the receivables / payables either by business transaction or for all business transactions of a
customer.
3. The system determines the key date on the basis of the selection parameters “Period” and “Fiscal Year”. The last
day of the period or fiscal year is the key date.
4. The system valuates these receivables / payables using the exchange rate valid on the key date and compares
the amounts with the amounts that were originally posted.
5. The system generates correcting entries for receivables / payables that show an amount that differs from the amount
originally posted. With these correcting entries, the balance sheet reflects the gains and losses resulting from
exchange rate fluctuation.
The system performs a remeasurement depending on the foreign currency remeasurement method used. For more
information on the foreign currency remeasurement method, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method.
6. The differences are posted to the receivables / payables account. The offsetting entry is made to a separate
expense and revenue account for exchange rate differences.
7. The system reverses this entry on the first day of the new period because it is not required for daily business.
If you start this run again using the same parameters, the system determines the change to the previous run, and displays
and posts this change. This only affects items that changed between the previous run and the current run.
The run only includes open items. If you start the run again, under no circumstances should an item that was
previously open in the first run be cleared when the run is repeated. It is important to ensure that the
corresponding accounting period is closed for operation postings before starting the run.
The foreign currency remeasurement of receivables produces the following posting, for example:
Remeasurement
Debit Credit
Receivables 5000
Exchange Rate Differences from Remeasurement 5000
Reversal in the New Period
Debit Credit
Exchange Rate Differences from Remeasurement 5000
Receivables 5000
Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Cash
Depending on the set of books, the system proceeds as follows for foreign currency remeasurement for cash:
1. The system selects all open balances for which the transaction currency differs from the company currency.
2. The system totals the balances either by business transaction or for all business transactions of a business partner.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 83
3. The system determines the key date on the basis of the selection parameters “Period” and “Fiscal Year”. The last
day of the period or fiscal year is the key date.
4. The system valuates these balances using the exchange rate valid on the key date and compares the amounts
with the amounts that were originally posted.
5. The system generates correcting entries for the balances that show an amount that differs from the amount originally
posted. With these correcting entries, the balance sheet reflects the gains and losses resulting from exchange rate
fluctuation.
6. The differences are posted to the balance account. The offsetting entry is made to a separate expense and revenue
account for exchange rate differences.
7. The system reverses this entry on the first day of the new period because it is not required for daily business.
If you start this run again using the same parameters, the system determines the change to the previous run, and displays
and posts this change. This only affects items that changed between the previous run and the current run.
The run only includes open items. If you start the run again, under no circumstances should an item that was
previously open in the first run be cleared when the run is repeated. It is important to ensure that the
corresponding accounting period is closed for operation postings before starting the run.
The foreign currency remeasurement of receivables produces the following posting, for example:
Remeasurement
Debit Credit
Exchange Rate Differences from Remeasurement 70
Foreign Currency Remeasurement 70
Reversal in the New Period
Debit Credit
Foreign Currency Remeasurement 70
Exchange Rate Differences from Remeasurement 70
3.1.6 Reclassification
Overview
If you start the procedure for reclassification, the system automatically posts the corresponding receivables or payables,
depending on their remaining terms. To do so, the system automatically creates the relevant journal entries.
Reclassification is an important part of period-end closing.
Prerequisites
To enable the system to automatically create the relevant journal entries, you have to have set up the accountdetermination for the reclassification.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the Chart of Accounts,
Financial Reporting Structures, Account Determination activity from the activitiy list.
84 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Under Account Determination choose Accounts Payable for the payables accounts or Accounts Receivable for the
receivables accounts. You specify the respective reclassification accounts on the tab Reclassification .
As a standard, the account determination for the reclassification contains the default accounts for payables and
receivables. For all other accounts, such as accounts for retainages or the accounts you have manually added to your
own chart of accounts, you have to specify them separately. For more information on how to set up account
determination, see Define Account Determination for Each Subledger.
It is possible to leave the field for an account determination group empty. The account in this row then applies
to all values of this account determination group (default account). If you have set up account determination
for a specific value of this account determination group, this value always takes priority over the default
account.
In spite of this possibility, we recomment that you always specify the account determination group.
Reclassification for Payables and Receivables
Depending on the set of books, the system proceeds as follows for the reclassification of payables and receivables:
1. Accounts Receivable / PayableThe system determines for each debtor and creditor whether it is really dealing with accounts receivable and
payable or rather accounts receivable with a credit balance and accounts payable with a debit balance. To do this,
the system checks whether the closing balance of a debtor or creditor is on the credit or debit side: ● If the closing balance is a debit amount, it is characterized under accounts payable.
● If the closing balance is a credit amount, it is characterized under accounts receivable.
2. Remaining TermsDepending on whether the debtor or creditor relates to accounts receivable or payable, the system reclassifies the
receivable and payable items by the remaining term: ● For all accounts receivable/payable, the system selects all the receivables and payables for which the
remaining term is greater than one year. These receivables and payables are then reclassified on separate
G/L accounts. The system provides accounts for remaining terms greater than one year and also greater than
five years.
The offsetting posting is made directly to the previously used receivables / payables account.
● For accounts payable with a debit balance / accounts receivable with a credit balance, the system selects
all the available receivables and payables. These receivables and payables are then reclassified on separate
G/L accounts, such as debit postings.
The offsetting posting is made directly to the previously used receivables / payables account.
3. Reversal of ReclassificationDepending on the settings in your business configuration, the reversal of a reclassification run leads to either
negative postings or equivalent debit or credit postings.
The automatically created journal entries from the original reclassification run are reversed on the first day of the
new accounting period, since they are not required for daily business.
If you start this run again using the same parameters, the system determines the change to the previous run, and displays
and posts this change. This only affects items that changed between the previous run and the current run.
The run only includes open items. If you start the run again, under no circumstances should an item that was
previously open in the first run be cleared when the run is repeated. It is important to ensure that the
corresponding accounting period is closed for operation postings before starting the run.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 85
Example
Reclassifying payables and receivables can lead to the following postings:
1) Creditor
Creditor 2 has a credit balance of EUR 2,000. This credit balance can by structured by the following remaining terms:
● Less than one year: EUR 500
● Greater than one year: EUR 1500
Creditor 1: Reclassify Payables
Debit Credit
Payables 1500
Payables > 1 Year 1500
2) Debtor
Debtor 1 has a debit balance of EUR 1,000. This debit balance can by structured by the following remaining terms:
● Less than one year: EUR 400
● Greater than one year: EUR 600
The system makes the relevant transfer postings:
Debtor 1: Reclassify Receivables
Debit Credit
Receivables 600
Receivables > 1 Year 600
3) Accounts Payable with Debit Balance
Creditor 2 has a debit balance of EUR 200.
Creditor 2: Accounts Payable with Debit Balance: Reclassify Creditor's Debit Balance
Debit Credit
Payables 200
Accounts Payable with Debit Balance 200
3.2 Suppliers View
3.2.1 Quick Guide for Suppliers (in Payables)
The Suppliers view in the Payables work center provides a central point of access for all the supplier master data related
to your accounts payable. You can check transaction and account details for all of your suppliers, and check and release
86 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
as required the supplier balance confirmations that you created in the balance confirmation run. The Suppliers view
features three subviews that allow you to access the information and perform the tasks you need:
Supplier Accounts
In this subview, you can display the account balances of your suppliers as well as call up and edit (manually clear, for
example) individual payables items on the accounts.
Suppliers
In this subview, you can display, edit, and create supplier master data records. You can also check supplier details,
such as their location, main contact person, and contact information.
Balance Confirmation
This subview provides you with a list of proposed balance confirmations that you can check and release so they are
sent to your suppliers.
Business Background
Supplier Account Monitor
The supplier account monitor provides you with an overview of your payables to your suppliers, for example to check
which invoices have to be paid by your company in the next few days. You can also use it when dealing with supplier
inquiries or clearing open items in an account.
For more information, see Supplier Account Monitor [74].
Suppliers
A person or company from whom or which you purchase goods or services. The supplier is assigned as a role to a
person or company.
For more information, see Supplier.
Open Items Payables
You can display open item lists for supplier accounts. Open items are posted open invoices for goods and services or
credit memos that were not yet paid. With the lists of the open items of suppliers of your company, you can monitor the
dates of outgoing payments to avoid interest on arrears and use cash discounts. Open payments are also displayed in
the open item list. In addition, you get an overview for which supplier accounts you still need to edit open items.
For more information, see Open Items Payables [73]
Down Payments Made in Financials
Before goods are produced or services provided, it is sometimes necessary to make a down payment on an invoice
amount. Securing a reservation is an example of a down payment. In such cases, the supplier sends a down payment
request, which is entered in the system.
The down payment request is displayed in the system in the payables balance as a statistical open item. It is part of the
balance confirmation request and can be paid. The amount from the down payment request is not initially posted to
accounting, nor is the tax amount initially entered in the tax entries. Instead, this occurs when the payment is made.
For more information, see Down Payments Made in Financials [81].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 87
Tasks
Create and Edit a Supplier
1. In the Suppliers subview, choose New then Supplier.
2. Enter the name of the supplier, the address, communication data, and any other information.
Enter a note if required.
You can check whether a supplier is already entered in the system if you selected
this option during scoping in the business configuration. To do this, choose
Check for Duplicates . The system also displays any suppliers that might be
duplicated when you save the details of a new supplier. For more information, see
Business Partner Duplicate Check.
3. To enter additional supplier information, click View All .
4. To return to the Suppliers subview, click Save and Close .
Manual Clearing in the Supplier Account Monitor
For more information on this task, see Supplier Account Monitor [74].
Reverse Clearing in the Supplier Account Monitor
For more information on this task, see Supplier Account Monitor [74].
3.3 Automatic Payments View
3.3.1 Quick Guide for Automatic Payments (Payables)
You can access this view from the Payables work center under Automatic Payments. In this view, you can display all
the outgoing payments created using payment runs, as well as manual payments created in the supplier account monitor
using Pay Manually By then Other Payment Methods. With the payment run, you create payment proposals, which
contain all the due invoices and any cash discounts granted upon immediate payment. You can check the payment
proposals, and release, postpone, or cancel the proposed items as necessary. Once you have released an item, the
system makes the payment automatically.
In this way, you ensure that payments reach your suppliers on time, although not prematurely, enabling your company
to make use of any cash discounts.
Business Background
Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments
In your role as an accounts payable accountant, you require functions to process national and international outgoing
payment transactions made with suppliers and other creditors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management and Payables work centers. When you create a payment, you can specify the payment method
88 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
and other details, such as the house bank account from which to pay, the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the
bank processing date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all
payment transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payee.
As the accounts payable accountant for your company, you initiate the automatic creation and editing of outgoing
payments in the Payables work center. Here you create a payment run, which is used to generate a payment proposal
list based on the payment strategy configured and the selection criteria chosen. Possible selection criteria are:
● Company
● Date of the next payment run; if required, taking account of your configuration settings for the payment strategy
Specify this date if you want to perform the payment run once only. If you schedule the payment run to be performed
on a recurring basis, the system determines the appropriate date.
● Suppliers and other creditors
● Currency
● Bank processing date
Specify the requested payment date (for bank transfers and direct debits only). Depending on working days, the
bank may make the payment later. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run periodically.
● Posting date
The default posting date is the execution date of the run. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run
periodically.
In your role as accounts payable accountant, you can edit the payment proposals and then release them for payment
creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually
for the same or an overlapping selection of suppliers.
You can execute the payment run manually often as you want.
The system supports the following forms of payment:
● Outgoing check, with the option of including payment advices
● Outgoing wire transfer
● Outgoing bank transfer, with the option of including payment advices
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
For more information, see Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments [16].
Tasks
Approve An Automatic Payment Proposal
The Automatic Payments view in the Payables work center enables you to approve proposed
outgoing payments so that your suppliers are paid on time. The system creates a list of proposed
payments based on your payment strategy, which is then displayed in this view.
For more information on this task, see Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal [90].
Display Payment Proposals
1. In the Automatic Payments view, select a payment and click View Payment Proposals .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 89
2. In the Payment Proposal Overview: <ID> screen, you can view a list of all the payment
proposals created by the payment run execution that includes the selected payment.
3.3.2 Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal
Overview
The Automatic Payments view in the Payables work center enables you to approve proposed outgoing payments so
that your suppliers are paid on time. The system creates a list of proposed payments based on your payment strategy,
which is then displayed in this view.
Procedure
1. In the Automatic Payments view, select a payment proposal with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
The Payment: <ID> editor appears.
2. If you want to check the payment information and details on the payee and memo line, view the General tab.
3. Choose the Open Items tab and check the open items. To remove an open item from the proposed payment,
deselect it in the Matched column. For detailed information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open
Items Table [93].
4. If the proposed payment is appropriate, click Execute Payment . The payment is then sent for further approval, if
necessary. If you want to reject a payment proposal, choose Actions then Void Proposal. Then click Close to
close the editor and return to the worklist.
Result
If you click Execute Payment , the payment status changes to Completed.
3.4 Payment Clearing View
3.4.1 Quick Guide for Payment Clearing (Payables)
The Payment Clearing view in the Payables work center enables you to clarify a payable payment, such as a manual
outgoing payment for a supplier invoice, either by clearing or by reposting it. The system usually clarifies such payments
by clearing automatically. If the system does not find any open items that fit to the payment, or the open items that it
does find do not match the open items that are referenced (incorrect document date or invoice amount, for example),
it creates a Payment Clearing task.
To assist you in matching an outgoing payment with the appropriate open invoice, the system creates clearing proposals
that suggest the best match if it is unable to make the clearing itself, based on factors such as the payment amount,
due payment date, and payment references. You can simply accept these proposals or you can edit them for a better
match. There are several editing methods you can use, such as changing the discounts that should be applied to each
invoice, deducting the difference between the invoice and payment amounts, or editing which invoices should be paid
by the outgoing payment. The system provides you with a list of different discounts and deductions that you can apply,
and it records this information when you apply them. Once the difference between the payment amount and the invoice
amount has been eliminated, the outgoing payment can be cleared.
90 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
The Payment Clearing task is complete when the payment is clarified. A payment is considered to be clarified under the
following circumstances:
● It is applied to open items and cleared.
● It is reposted to a different customer account or supplier account.
● The remaining balance is accepted on account.
● A combination of the above.
If a partial payment is to clear an invoice completely, you can apply additional discount manually to the item in question,
or use the action Apply Discount or Credit, which distributes the discount according to the clearing strategy configured.
Note that it is not possible to apply such a discount to an overpayment. In the case of an overpayment, you have to
accept the overpayment on account and clear it later, for example against a supplier credit item.
Your manual payment clearing tasks can also be accessed from the Work view of the Payables work center.
Business Background
Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials
A cash discount can be applied to the payment of a supplier invoice. This can be done automatically or manually. The
system automatically posts the cash discount deduction.
For more information, see Cash Discounts for Payables in Financials [78].
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Tasks
Clear An Outgoing Payment Manually
In the Payment Clearing view of the Payables work center, you can clear outgoing payments
manually.
Depending on the configuration in your clearing strategy, you can also call up tasks
for manual payment clearing in the Work view of the Payables work center or in one
of the variants.
For more information on this task, see Clear an Outgoing Payment Manually [92].
View Clearing
1. If you want to view the details for payment clearing, select the clearing that you want to
display in the Payment Clearing view and click Show Clearing .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 91
2. In the Clearing Overview: <ID> editor, you can view the parameters set for clearing, such
as the remaining balance that needs to be cleared for the entire clearing process to be
completed, amounts assigned to other customers and suppliers, accounting data, open
items, and the payment amount. You can also clear the outgoing payment manually if
required. If you want to clear the outgoing payment manually, click View All and perform
the task Clear An Outgoing Payment Manually [92].
3.4.2 Clear An Outgoing Payment Manually
Overview
In the Payment Clearing view of the Payables work center, you can clear outgoing payments manually.
Depending on the configuration in your clearing strategy, you can also call up tasks for manual payment
clearing in the Work view of the Payables work center or in one of the variants.
Procedure
1. In the Payment Clearing view, select a payment clearing item with the status Paid on Account and click Edit .
The General tab in the editor displays the clearing balance that needs to be zeroed before clearing can be
completed.
The amounts under Clearing Overview and Payment Overview are influenced only by those open items
that are matched in the Open Items table.
2. In the Open Items table, you can display the items that are currently open and that can be added to the clearing
proposal to clear the payment amount. To include an item in the proposal, select the item that you want to use in the
Matched column. Similarly, items can be removed by deselecting them.
For detailed information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
3. Once you have eliminated the clearing difference, click Clear to clear the selected items. If you want to save a
'draft' version of your clearing proposal first, click Save . Be aware that any reposting-relevant changes are posted
to accounting though. Then click Close to return to the clearing worklist.
After you have checked a payment clearing task, you might find that the payment cannot be allocated to
an open item. In this case, select the clearing task concerned and choose Actions then Send to Payment
Allocation.
Result
Your outgoing payment is cleared either partially or entirely and updated in the list in the Payment Clearing view. All the
open items that are allocated to the payment are cleared, and all the amounts that were accepted on account or allocated
to other customers or suppliers are included on the relevant supplier or customer account.
92 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
3.4.3 Using the Open Items Table
Overview
The Open Items table displays the open items for the current payment in a hierarchical table. This table is structured by
account ID. Each first-level item reflects the part of the payment assigned to that account. Each second-level item reflects
an open item on that account that can be matched. The hierarchical structure enables you to see clearly when items
belonging to different accounts are paid by a single payer in a single payment.
You select items from the table to match them to the current payment. You can then apply net amounts, cash discounts,
or other discounts or credits (for example due to goods being damaged), in order to clarify the payment.
Accessing Multiple Accounts
To facilitate the search for items across multiple accounts, you can use the following functions:
Accounts
This function allows you to add individual accounts to and remove individual accounts from the Open Items list. When
an account is added, all its open items are also added. When an account is removed, all its open items including any
already-matched items and on account payments are also removed.
Search Open Items
This function searches for open items across multiple accounts of the current company. The search result includes all
items, including items that are locked by a clearing proposal or even already cleared. If you then select any of the items
found for matching to the current payment, the appropriate accounts are added to the Open Items table automatically.
You might use this function when a payment covers invoices from more than one account, for example.
If an item has the status Open and also has a clearing ID, you cannot select it because it is currently included
in a clearing proposal. If you want to match this item to the current payment, click on the clearing ID to go to
the details of the clearing where you can void the proposal. Then you can match the item to the current
payment.
Other Functions
You also have some or all of the following functions at your disposal in the Open Items table depending on which process
or payment method you are currently working on:
Assign Payment on Account
With this function, you can assign an on account payment to an account of your choice. By default, the system proposes
the balance between the total payment amount and all payments that have already been assigned to accounts.
You might use this function to repost part of a payment currently posted to account A to account B as an on account
payment, for example, or maybe to assign an overpayment as an on account payment.
Actions Apply Discount or Credit
You can use this function to apply cash discounts or other discounts/credits (for example due to damaged goods) to
individual or multiple open items. If you apply an amount to multiple items, the system will distribute it among the matched
items according to your company’s clearing strategy.
Actions Edit Bank Charges
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 93
As an alternative to posting bank charges as costs in accounting, you can use this function to post them directly to
customer/supplier accounts.
3.4.4 Finding Open Items for Externally-Initiated Payments
Overview
When an externally-initiated payment, such as an incoming check or an outgoing direct debit payment, is created, you
must ensure that the relevant open items are assigned to the payment for clearing. The system supports you in this
process by searching for open items based on various factors.
Search Based on Memo Line Content and Payer ID
The system scans the content of the memo line of the payment for invoice IDs and customer/supplier information, such
as the account ID. It then uses this data combined with the payer ID (if known) to search for suitable open items.
This process may have the following outcomes, depending on the result of the search:
● An allocation task is created, for example if the payer is not known.
● A clearing task is created, for example if the payer is known, and the payment amount and the account ID specified
in the memo line match an open item, but no invoice ID is specified in the memo line.
● Automatic clearing takes place, for example if the payer is known, and the invoice ID and account ID specified in
the memo line match an open item.
Handling of Typographical Errors (Fuzzy Search)
In everyday business, typographical errors may occur when users are entering data, such as check or bank statement
data. The system considers certain potential typographical errors in memo line content when it searches for open items.
The system assumes that a reference might contain a maximum of one error. This may mean that a character has been
deleted or inserted by mistake, or two characters have been swapped by mistake. The system applies the possible
modifications to the references and searches for open items that match the modified references.
If the system finds a single open item based on a fuzzy search, a clearing task will be created. If multiple open items
are found, no item will be proposed as a match and no clearing task will be created.
In an example scenario where the correct reference is ORDER 21, the system will search for open items using references
like ORDRE 21, ORDER 12, ORDERR 21, ORDER 215, ORDR 21, ORDER21, ORDRR 21, or ORDER X1 and still find an
open item containing the correct reference ORDER 21. Since, however, only one error is allowed, it would not use ORDRE
12, for example.
The fuzzy search only operates if the account is known and the reference has at least three characters. There
is no fuzzy search for accounts.
See Also
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
94 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
3.5 Periodic Tasks
3.5.1 Quick Guide for Payment Runs (Payables)
In the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of the Payables work center, you can perform automatic runs,
which generate payment proposals for internally initiated payments. The system displays recurring payment runs as
well as payment runs that you have scheduled for a future date. You can edit existing payment runs and reschedule
them. You can display existing payment runs and check the application logs of runs that have already been executed.
You do not use this view to generate bank transfers, direct debits, checks, or bills of exchange. Instead you use the
Payment Media Run in the Payment Management area.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments
In your role as an accounts payable accountant, you require functions to process national and international outgoing
payment transactions made with suppliers and other creditors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management and Payables work centers. When you create a payment, you can specify the payment method
and other details, such as the house bank account from which to pay, the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the
bank processing date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all
payment transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payee.
As the accounts payable accountant for your company, you initiate the automatic creation and editing of outgoing
payments in the Payables work center. Here you create a payment run, which is used to generate a payment proposal
list based on the payment strategy configured and the selection criteria chosen. Possible selection criteria are:
● Company
● Date of the next payment run; if required, taking account of your configuration settings for the payment strategy
Specify this date if you want to perform the payment run once only. If you schedule the payment run to be performed
on a recurring basis, the system determines the appropriate date.
● Suppliers and other creditors
● Currency
● Bank processing date
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 95
Specify the requested payment date (for bank transfers and direct debits only). Depending on working days, the
bank may make the payment later. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run periodically.
● Posting date
The default posting date is the execution date of the run. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run
periodically.
In your role as accounts payable accountant, you can edit the payment proposals and then release them for payment
creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually
for the same or an overlapping selection of suppliers.
You can execute the payment run manually often as you want.
The system supports the following forms of payment:
● Outgoing check, with the option of including payment advices
● Outgoing wire transfer
● Outgoing bank transfer, with the option of including payment advices
Processing bill of exchange payables is not released for Germany.
For more information, see Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments [16].
Tasks
Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Payables
For more information on this task, see Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Payables [96].
3.5.2 Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Payables
Overview
A payment proposal list contains all open items (for example, invoices or credit memos) that the system proposes for
payment within a single execution of a payment run. You can use the payment proposal lists to check internally initiated
payments before they are executed.
A payment proposal list is determined on the basis of the payment strategy that you have defined in configuration and
displays the due payments taking payment conditions into account. Depending on the setting, it allows an optimal usage
of granted cash discounts.
To display a payment proposal list created by the system for internally initiated outgoing payments, in the Payables work
center, choose Automatic Payments.
Alternatively, you can access payment proposals in the Work view filtered according to Payment Run
Tasks, or in the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view.
The system shows due supplier payments. You can decide when invoices should be paid so that you ensure that your
commitments to suppliers are cleared on time and correctly. This view contains all outgoing payments initiated by a
96 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
payment run (not outgoing payments initiated by suppliers, such as by direct debit with mandate) and payments to
customer credits (customers with a credit balance).
Once you have checked the payment details and terms of the proposed payments, you can release them. Depending
on the settings in configuration, you may need approval from a manager.
Once you have executed the payments (by choosing Execute Payment in the Automatic Payments view), the system
posts the payment and clears the open items to be paid.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following settings in Business Configuration under Activity List Fine-Tune Cash Flow
Management :
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
You can create one or multiple payment strategies, which the system accesses when creating the payment proposal
lists. These settings directly influence when the open items are included in a payment proposal list and whether
deductions should be made.
● Approval Process
In the payment processing settings, you specify a threshold value for each payment method. When this threshold
value is reached, an approval of the outgoing payment is required. The approval request is always sent to the
manager that you have specified in Application and User Management in the Work Distribution Rules At Employee
Level area.
● Prioritization of Bank Accounts
You can specify all bank information, the payment method for each bank account, and the threshold values for the
bank accounts. The system accesses the bank accounts during liquidity assignment for the payment of invoices
depending on the priority.
Procedure
1. Creating a Payment Proposal List
To create a new payment run, proceed as follows:
a. Go to the Payables work center and choose the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view. Choose
New then Payment Run.
The New Payment Run screen appears.
You can use the following selection criteria for your payment run: ● Posting Date
You can specify a posting date. The default posting date is the execution date of the run. Leave this field
empty if you want to schedule the run periodically.
● Bank Processing Date
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 97
You can specify the requested payment date (for bank transfers and direct debits only). Depending on
working days, the bank may make the payment later. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run
periodically.
● Include On Account Payments
Here you can specify whether you want the run to include outgoing on account payments. These are
payments that have been posted to an account but not yet cleared.
● Company
● Supplier from/to ID
You can define a value range enabling you to select multiple suppliers for one payment run. If you do notselect a supplier, the system selects all the suppliers entered in the system for the payment run.
● Currency
You can specify a currency. Only those invoices that match the selected currency are cleared.
● Next Payment Run Date
Here you enter the date up to which all open items should be considered in the payment proposal list. You
cannot edit this field later.
You only specify this date if the payment run is performed immediately and performed once only. If the
payment run is scheduled periodically, no date should be entered here. The payment run then takes into
account all items until the payment run is next performed.
Items with a payment block are not selected by the run. This applies to on accounts payment as well.
b. Activate and save your entries.
2. Scheduling a Payment Run
a. On the Payment Run: <ID> screen, click Schedule .
The Schedule Job screen appears.
If you want to start the payment run immediately and run it once only, choose Start Immediately. Alternatively,
you can specify a start date and time or arrange for it to run after a specific job.
If you want to schedule the payment run periodically, specify when the payment run should be repeated, for
example, daily or weekly.
b. Save your entries.
c. Close the Schedule Job screen.
You can view the technical details on the execution of a run in the log in the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic
Tasks view. To do this, select the relevant payment run under Payment Runs then click on the relevant ID in the
Application Log ID column of the lower table. For more information, see Messages in the Payment Run Application
Log [99].
3. Displaying a Payment Proposal
If the run was successful, you can display the payment proposals created by the system for internally initiated
outgoing payments. You do this in the Payables work center in the Automatic Payments view.
4. Editing and Releasing a Payment Proposal
To edit a payment proposal, proceed as follows:
a. In the Payables work center, open the Automatic Payments view. Alternatively, you can open the Work view
and filter according to Payment Run Tasks.
b. Select the appropriate payment proposal.
c. Choose Edit to display the details for the payment and to make changes. You can change the payment method
and related data (such as the bank account), change the payment amount, select other customer/supplier bank
98 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
details, enter or change a cash discount amount, or delete open items (which will exclude them from the
payment).
You can also reject a payment proposal. This does not affect the open items since there has been no posting
in the system.
d. To protect the company's liquidity, the system checks during payment creation (release) whether liquid assets
could be successfully allocated to the payment. It checks whether there is sufficient liquidity for the payment at
the bank and reserves the relevant amount for this payment. If the system could not allocate liquidity because
there were not sufficient liquid funds, it issues an error message. For important payments, you can override the
allocation of liquidity and specify that there should be no allocation of liquid funds. To do this, choose
Actions then Liquidity Allocation Not Required. In this case, the payment is made regardless of the availability
of liquid funds.
e. Once you have finished editing a payment proposal, choose Execute Payment to forward the payment to the
Payment Management work center or to the approver of the outgoing payment.
The approval is necessary if the threshold value defined in configuration for the approval of an outgoing payment
is reached. If no approval is necessary for the outgoing payment, posting takes place in the system with the
execution of the payment and the open items are cleared. If an approval is necessary, posting takes place after
approval.
5. Approving a Payment Proposal
Once you have edited and released a payment proposal that must be approved, it is automatically forwarded to the
approver in the Managing My Area work center in the Approvals view. The approver can approve the payment or
send it back for revision.
See Also
Internally Initiated Automatic Outgoing Payments [16]
Configuration: Payment Strategies
3.5.3 Messages in the Payment Run Application Log
Overview
On the Results tab of the payment run application log, you can view all the messages generated during an individual
execution of a payment run. To access this tab in the Payables or Receivables work center, choose Periodic
Tasks Payment Runs . Select the relevant payment run under Payment Runs then click on the relevant ID in the
Application Log ID column of the lower table. The messages and any action required are explained below:
Message Severity
What Happened? What Can I Do?
All proposals postponed; totalpayment proposed exceedsaccount balance
warning
The overall account balance (both payablesand receivables) has been checked andindicates that the overall proposed paymentamount is not required. This check considersall created payment proposals regardless ofcurrency and payment details. The mostcommon reasons for this message are:
● On account payments are not consideredby the payment run (unless you specifythat they should be when you create the
You can: ● Ignore the balance check warning
and execute the payment anywayby choosing Reset Postpone.
● Void the individual paymentproposal.
● Edit the proposal to add orremove items.
Ideally, however, you should maintainaccounts on a regular basis to keep the
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 99
run). These items are, however, still openand therefore visible in the balance.
● Items that are locked by a clearingprocess, such as when a clearing is stillin approval, are not selected by thepayment run. These items are, however,still open and therefore visible in thebalance.
● The payment run does not net payablesand receivables, but the balance checkdoes consider both. Therefore, if thebusiness partner is both customer andsupplier, payment proposals may bepostponed due to open items of the otheraccount type.
Note that down payments are not consideredby the balance check.
number of balance check warnings toa minimum.
All proposals postponed;exchange rate<Currency1> to<Currency2> missing
error The account balance check could not beprocessed successfully.
You can: ● Maintain the exchange rate and
execute the run again.
● Ignore the balance check warningand execute the payment anywayby choosing Reset Postpone.
<Payer/Payee/AccountID> blocked forpayments
information
A payment block has been set in the masterdata and is active on the current payment date.Note that the system checks both customer/supplier and payer/payee for payment blocks.
No action required.
Void not possible: payment<ProposalID> locked by<UserID>
error The payment run generally voids any existingproposals for items that it selects in order tooptimize the grouping of items for payment.In this case, the system was not able to void aproposal because it is locked by another user.
If you want to optimize the grouping,contact the user or execute the runagain later.
Proposal discarded; Paymentnot possible as items balanceto zero
warning
Proposals for items that balance to zero are notcreated because no payment is necessary.These items are, however, due.
● Check whether payment isrequired and pay manually ifnecessary.
● Clear the items balancing to zeromanually.
Proposal discarded; Incomingpayment data missing for<PayerID>
information
In general incoming payments are externallyinitiated. Therefore, proposals for incomingpayments are not created if the payment datafor initiating the payments is missing.
No action required if the payments areexternally initiated.If the payments are internally initiated,you must provide the missing paymentdata and execute the run again or paymanually.
Outgoing payment datamissing for <PayeeID>
warning
In general outgoing payments are internallyinitiated. Therefore, proposals for outgoingpayments are created even though therequired payment data is missing.
You must provide the missing paymentdata before you can execute thepayment.
<ItemType> <ItemID>(open amount <Amount>)
information
The proposal has been discarded. Thismessage shows which items would have beenpaid with the proposal.
No action required. You can use theinformation provided if you need tofollow up manually.
<ItemType> <ItemID>currently locked by user<UserID>
error This item is due, but is currently locked byanother user
If you want to pay this item, contact theuser and pay the item manually orexecute the run again later.
100 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
<ItemType> <ItemID>excluded; not due according topayment strategy
information
The item has been excluded from the paymentproposal based on the strategy defined duringbusiness configuration.
No action required.
<ItemType> <ItemID>excluded; locked by<Payment/Clearing><DocumentID>
warning
The item has been excluded from the paymentproposal because it is already included in aclearing process or payment process.
You can either complete the processthat is locking the item or discard itmanually. Either way, you shouldcheck that the item is fully cleared,because an additional payment maybe required for a remaining openamount.
<ItemType> <ItemID>excluded; error convertingcurrency <Currency1> to<Currency2>
error The item has been excluded from the paymentproposal because its currency could not beconverted.
Maintain the exchange rate andexecute the run again.
<ItemType> <ItemID>excluded; defined paymentmethod is externally initiated
information
The item has been excluded from the paymentproposal because the payment methoddefined individually for the item is externallyinitiated, such as check payment on acustomer invoice.
No action required.
<ItemType> <ItemID>blocked for payments
information
A payment block has been set for this item andis active on the current payment date.
No action required.
Down payment <ItemID>excluded
information
Down payments are excluded by paymentruns, because they are only interim items thatare followed eventually by invoices.They are also excluded by the account balancecheck.
No action required.
Payment contains items of<Customer/SupplierID>
information
A payment proposal covers at least one itembelonging to an account other than the payer/payee's account. This may occur when a payeralso makes payments on behalf of otheraccounts, for example.
No action required.
Proposal postponed; onaccount payment with foreigncurrency
warning
You have chosen to include on accountpayments in the payment run and at least oneon account payment is in a currency other thanthe currency of the corresponding account.The payment proposal is postponed.
Check the proposal in the paymentproposal list.
Payment not possible;incoming payment datamissing for <Customer ID>
information
A payment proposal has not been generatedbecause no internally initiated paymentmethod is maintained for this customer. Onlyexternally initiated payments are possible forthis customer.
No action required.
See Also
Application Log
Mass Data Runs
3.5.4 Quick Guide for Balance Confirmation Runs (Payables)
You use the balance confirmation run in the payables area to compile data for your supplier balance confirmations and
to create balance confirmation letters. These letters inform your suppliers about their account balances and request that
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 101
the balance information is confirmed. In this way, you can reconcile your system data records with the data records in
the supplier system.
Alternatively, you can request that your suppliers send you a balance confirmation return letter.
You access the balance confirmation run functionality for payables in the Balance Confirmation Runs subview of the
Periodic Tasks view of the Payables work center.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Balance Confirmation for Payables
Balance confirmation for payables is a means of checking that payables to business partners are correct. Discrepancies
may arise and need to be clarified with your business partner. During balance confirmation, you inform your business
partner of the individual amounts that need to be confirmed and request the confirmation.
Fore more information, see Balance Confirmation for Payables
Open Items Payables
You can display open item lists for supplier accounts. Open items are posted open invoices for goods and services or
credit memos that were not yet paid. With the lists of the open items of suppliers of your company, you can monitor the
dates of outgoing payments to avoid interest on arrears and use cash discounts. Open payments are also displayed in
the open item list. In addition, you get an overview for which supplier accounts you still need to edit open items.
For more information, see Open Items Payables [73]
Tasks
Create a Balance Confirmation Run
For more information on this task, see Create a Balance Confirmation Run [103]Create a Balance
Confirmation Run [165].
102 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
3.5.5 Create a Balance Confirmation Run
Overview
You can send balance confirmations to compare your data records with those of your suppliers/customers and
consequently identify any inconsistencies. You use balance confirmation runs to schedule balance confirmations on a
frequent and recurring basis. Alternatively, you can perform a manual run as a one-off request. You can create a balance
confirmation run in the Balance Confirmation Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of either the Payables or the
Receivables work center.
Procedure
1. To create a new balance confirmation run, click New then Balance Confirmation Run.
2. Select a Type
1. Enter a description for the balance confirmation run.
2. Choose an appropriate balance confirmation type: ● Without Return Letter
This selection enables you to check the accuracy of your accounts payable and receivable using balance
confirmations. You can detect and correct any discrepancies which might exist between your records and
those of your customers or suppliers and make any necessary value adjustments. However, the customer
or supplier does not send a return letter documenting the differences in this case. The balance confirmation
can only be confirmed or rejected. As long as the customer or supplier makes no objections prior to the
cut-off date, your balance is accepted.
● With Return Letter
This selection enables you to contact your customers or suppliers to discuss the details relating to your
open items. Your company issues a letter listing all your open item details. This letter requests that the
customer or supplier confirms whether the data entries agree with each other, or specifies how the accounts
differ using the return letter provided. In this way, you can determine whether your customer and supplier
accounts are up-to-date as well as identify any discrepancies using the information contained in the return
letter.
● Request
This selection enables you to contact your customers or suppliers to check the balance of your accounts
on the side of the customer or supplier. You can request the account balance alone or also detailed
information relating to the balance.
3. Choose Release Immediately if you want to release the confirmation straight away. The balance confirmation
letters are printed automatically once the run has been completed. Alternatively, you can manually check and
release each balance confirmation.
4. Choose whether you want automated or manual selection of customers/suppliers.
3. Enter Restrictions
You can enter the name of the company or the customer/supplier. You can also choose various selection parameters
that include or exclude particular customers or suppliers from the balance confirmation run, depending on the
restriction type that you selected in the previous step.
4. Complete and Confirm Selection
Click Finish to save the balance confirmation run.
When the run has been saved successfully, the Run ID field displays the ID of the new balance confirmation run.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 103
Choose Schedule Balance Confirmation Run.
The Schedule Job editor appears. Here you can schedule and save the run.
Result
The balance confirmation run has now been created and scheduled successfully. You can display the results of the run
in the Balance Confirmation subview of either the Suppliers view in the Payables work center or the Customers view in
the Receivables work center. From this location, you can check and release the balance confirmation.
You can use search criteria, such as the Status or Run ID to search for the balance confirmation that you
want to view.
3.5.6 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Payables)
You use foreign currency remeasurement to convert open payables from foreign currencies into the company currency
on a specific key date.
This closing activity is relevant for companies with suppliers for which the transactions are portrayed in a currency
differing from the company currency. At the time when the amounts of these open payables originate, you convert them
into the company currency using the exchange rate valid at that time. On the day when the balance sheet is created, a
different exchange rate applies, causing you to have to revaluate the open items. You can repeat the remeasurement
as often as required until the payables are cleared or written off.
Business Background
Multi-Currency
A currency is the legally recognized means of payment in a given country. A currency has to be specified for every
financial amount in the system. The currencies are specified using the ISO standard form, such as EUR for euros or
USD for US dollars.
For more information, see Currencies.
Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method
You use the foreign currency remeasurement method to set up the various methods for entering foreign currency
remeasurement in accordance with the legal requirements. For each foreign currency remeasurement method, you
define the accounting principles that should be used by the corresponding remeasurement method.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method.
Foreign Currency Remeasurement
If you start the procedure for foreign currency remeasurement, the system automatically makes the relevant postings
and subsequently withdraws postings.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement [82].
104 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Closing Activities — Year-End Closing
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
For more information, see Closing Activities — Year-End Closing.
Tasks
Check Prerequisites
Before foreign currency remeasurement can be performed, the following prerequisites must be
fulfilled:
● The current exchange rates need to have been entered in the system. For more information,
see Editing Exchange Rates.
● You need to have reclassified the payables. For more information, see Quick Guide for
Reclassification (Payables) [107].
● Using account determination, you need to have defined and set up in configuration the
accounts that you want to remeasure. For more information, see Business Configuration of
Account Determination for a Business Transaction.
● You need to have defined how the system is to valuate and post exchange rate differences.
For this, you need to have assigned the appropriate set of books to the foreign currency
remeasurement method. For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement
Method.
Perform Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Payables
1. To create a new foreign currency remeasurement run, click New and then Foreign
Currency Remeasurement Run.
2. You have the following options for performing foreign currency remeasurement runs: ● Foreign Currency Remeasurement with Reference
To re-use the data from a previous foreign currency remeasurement run, select the
foreign currency remeasurement run that you want to use and click Copy . The
system copies the data directly to the input screen for the new foreign currency
remeasurement run. You can then adjust the data copied from the previously-executed
foreign currency remeasurement run.
● Test RunTo perform the foreign currency remeasurement run as a test run, set the Test Run
indicator. The system previews the results of the test run but does not make any
postings. The postings are only simulated.
You can only delete foreign currency remeasurement runs that you either
scheduled or performed as a test run. To delete a test run, select the run that
you want to delete and click Delete .
● Set of BooksYou can perform the remeasurement for a single set of books or for all sets of books.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 105
If you use multiple sets of books with different fiscal year variants, you should ideally
perform the remeasurement separately for each set of books. The system determines
the key date on the basis of the fiscal year variant of the set of books.
● Business partner IDYou can limit foreign currency remeasurement to payables for individual suppliers.
● CurrencyYou can limit foreign currency remeasurement to payables in specific currencies.
● Closing StepYou select the closing step that you want the system to use when making the postings
on the key date to the corresponding accounting period. This accounting period must
be open for the closing step that you have selected. For more information, see Closing
Steps.
● Period / YearYou select the period and year for which you want to perform foreign currency
remeasurement.
3. Scheduling
You can either perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately or schedule it to occur
later: ● To perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately, click Start Immediately .
You have to wait until the foreground job finishes before you can continue
with your work. This may take several minutes depending upon the data
volume, which can cause the screen to time out. In such a case, you can go
to the main screen for the run and refresh the data. When the run status
changes to Finished, click View to view the logs. Alternatively, you can click
Log Result in the Details section of a finished run.
● To schedule foreign currency remeasurement for a subsequent point in time, click
Schedule and specify the time when the system will perform remeasurement. If you
leave the Date and Time fields empty, the run starts immediately.
You can continue with your work while the system executes the run as a
background job.
You can view scheduled foreign currency remeasurement runs and their respective
times in the subview Foreign Currency Remeasurement under Jobs .
Display and Check Log
1. Display LogIf you have performed foreign currency remeasurement immediately, the system issues a
status message. To display a list of the logs, click Display Log in the status message.
When you have scheduled foreign currency remeasurement, you can display the list of logs
in the Foreign Currency Remeasurement subview after foreign currency remeasurement
has been performed. To do this, choose the relevant foreign currency remeasurement.
2. Check the LogThe log contains the following information:
● General
Shows the result of the foreign currency remeasurement run, the execution date, any
messages that were issued, and the extent of profit or loss from the valuation.
106 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
● Data Selection
Shows the information that you entered at the start of the foreign currency
remeasurement run.
● Messages
Shows a list of all messages that were issued (such as warning messages).
● Postings
Shows all the account movements and journal entries that the system posted for the
key date valuation.
● Processed Successfully
Shows for each remeasuremed account all the documents with their source document
ID, historical value, and key date value, as well as gains and losses. You can also view
the term over which the valuation was performed.
● Not Remeasured Balances
Shows for each remeasuremed account the documents that were subject to errors
during processing, for example, no account determination.
To verify whether a run has been completed successfully, you can run the following checks: ● Log
You find a log for a run in the corresponding subview. Each run has a status
(Information, Error). To display the details of a log, select the relevant run and click
Display .
If errors occur during a run, you need to resolve them. You can find information on the
errors on the Messages tab page. Once you have resolved the errors, start the run
again. The system repeats the postings that could not be made in the first run.
● Job MonitorIf a run has not been completed successfully and you cannot find and resolve the cause,
you can display the technical details relating to your run in the Job Monitor. Select the
relevant run and click Display Jobs . If a job finds errors, contact your system
administrator.
3.5.7 Quick Guide for Reclassification (in Payables)
You use the reclassification of payables to display your payables correctly.
The reclassification of payables and receivables is an important closing step. Based on the closing balance for each
single debtor and creditor, and based on the remaining term, the system characterizes the amounts accordingly under
accounts payable for debit amounts, and under accounts receivable for credit amounts. In a second step the system
reclassifies the receivable and payable items by remaining terms (0 – 12 months, 12 – 60 months, > 60 months). A
reclassification can be reversed.
Overdue items are not restructured. They have a remaining term of less than one year.
The intervals for the reclassification are derived automatically on the basis of the accounting principle specified in the
business configuration.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 107
Business Background
Reclassification
If you start the procedure for reclassification, the system automatically makes the relevant postings and subsequently
withdraws postings.
If you start the procedure for reclassification, the system automatically posts the corresponding receivables or payables,
depending on their remaining terms. To do so, the system automatically creates the relevant journal entries.
For more information, see Reclassification [84].
Closing Activities — Year-End Closing
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
For more information, see Closing Activities — Year-End Closing.
Tasks
Perform Reclassification for Payables
1. To perform a new reclassification run, click New and then Reclassification of Payables.
2. You have the following options for performing reclassifications: ● Reclassification with Reference
To reuse the data from a previous reclassification, select the reclassification that you
want to use and click Copy . The system copies the data directly to the input screen
on the new reclassification. You can then adjust the data copied from the previously-
executed reclassificatio
● Test RunTo perform the reclassification as a test run, select Test Run. The system previews the
results of the test run but does not make any postings. The postings are only simulated.
You can only delete reclassifications that you either scheduled or performed
as a test run. To delete a test run, select the run that you want to delete and
click Delete .
● Set of BooksYou can perform reclassification for a single set of books or for all sets of books.
If you use multiple sets of \books with different fiscal year variants, you should ideally
perform the balance carryforward separately for each set of books. The system
determines the key date on the basis of the fiscal year variant of the set of books.
● Closing StepYou select the closing step that you want the system to use when making the postings
on the key date to the corresponding accounting period. This accounting period must
be open for the closing step that you have selected. For more information, see Closing
Steps.
108 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
3. SchedulingYou can perform reclassification immediately or schedule it to occur later:
● To perform reclassification immediately, click Start Immediately .
You have to wait until the foreground job finishes before you can continue
with your work. This may take several minutes depending upon the data
volume, which can cause the screen to time out. In such a case, you can go
to the main screen for the run and refresh the data. When the run status
changes to Finished, click View to view the logs. Alternatively, you can click
Log Result in the Details section of a finished run.
● To schedule reclassification for a subsequent point in time, click Schedule and
indicate when you want the system to perform reclassification. If you leave the Date
and Time fields empty, the run starts immediately.
You can continue with your work while the system executes the run as a
background job.
You can view scheduled reclassifications and their respective times in View Jobs .
● Review the results of the run in the Payables work center in the Work view under
Reclassification Run Payables Tasks. Edit the tasks accordingly, click Actions and
click Complete.
● The Reclassification run now appears in the list of finished reclassification runs.
Display and Check Log
1. Display LogIf you performed reclassification immediately, the system issues a status message. To
display details, click Display Log in the status message.
When you have scheduled reclassification, you can display the list of logs once the
reclassification has been performed. To do this, choose the relevant reclassification run.
2. Check the LogThe log contains the following information:
● General
Shows the result of the reclassification, the execution date, any messages that were
issued, and the extent of profit or loss from the valuation.
● Data Selection
Shows the information that you entered at the start of the reclassification.
● Messages
Shows a list of all messages that were issued (such as warning messages).
● Postings
Shows all the account movements and journal entries that the system posted for the
key date valuation and the valuation reversal.
You can display the postings for each reconciliation account or sorted by document.
● Processed Successfully
Shows for each reconciliation account all the journal entries with data on the supplier,
journal entry ID, remaining term groups, and the amount in company currency.
● Not Processed
Shows the documents that were subject to errors during processing, for example
because of missing account determination for each reconciliation account.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 109
To verify whether a run has been completed successfully, you can run the following checks: ● Log
You find a log for a run in the corresponding subview. Each run has a status
(Information, Error). To display the details of a log, select the relevant run and click
Display .
If errors occur during a run, you need to resolve them. You can find information on the
errors under Messages . Once you have resolved the errors, start the run again. The
system repeats the postings that could not be made in the first run.
● Job MonitorIf a run has not been completed successfully and you cannot find and resolve the cause,
you can display the technical details relating to your run in the Job Monitor. Select the
relevant run and click View Jobs . If a job finds errors, contact your system
administrator.
Perform Reversal of Reclassification for Payables
If you perform the reversal of a run performed in an accounting period after the periodis closed, the system allows you to execute the run. At the end of the run, instead of
postings, you will see an error message saying that reversal is not possible because
the closing step for the period has already been performed.
1. Select the run to be reversedSelect the reclassification you want to reverse. The run must be an Update run and must
have Finished as the execution status.
2. Schedule reversal run ● click Reverse , enter a Run Description and schedule it.
3. Review the results of the run in Reclassification Run Payables Tasks. Edit the tasks
accordingly, click Actions and click Complete.
4. The reversed run now appears in the list of finished reclassification runs.
5. ResultAs a result of reclassification the system posts negative postings or equivalent debit or credit
postings. This is determined by the business configuration. ● If the reversal run for the selected reclassification run is scheduled to a later time, it is
listed in the Payables work center under the Work view with a blank status. The status
switches to Finished when the run has been performed.
● All the reversed runs have the Reversed indicator set.
3.5.8 Central Bank Reporting
3.5.8.1 Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria, France, and Germany. To ensure that the system
displays the correct text, select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under
Country, choose the relevant country. Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
110 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
The Central Bank Reporting subview enables you to report your foreign trade transactions to the authorities. This
information is used in the calculation of the balance of payments for your country. Different regulations apply to central
bank reporting depending on the country.
You can use the Central Bank Reporting subview to manually maintain and prepare this data for central bank reporting
that has been collected from supplier and customer invoicing. In addition to the automated data collection process, it is
possible to manually enter data to the central bank reporting work list.
If there are no entries for your company in the Central Bank Reporting list, your company might not be activated
for central bank reporting. You should check the Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion activity in business
configuration if central bank reporting is deactivated for your company.
Business Background
Central Bank Reporting Exclusion
You can exclude any of your company entities from the system's processing for central bank reporting. When a company
is excluded, no customer or supplier invoicing information is transferred to the Central Bank Reporting worklist and no
central bank reporting tasks are created. For more information, see Central Bank Reporting Exclusion
Tasks
Perform Central Bank Reporting
In the Central Bank Reporting subview of Periodic Tasks, you can perform central bank reporting,
which involves the collection and management of foreign trade transactions. These transactions
are reported to the authorities to create the balance of payments for the respective country. For
more information, see Perform Central Bank Reporting [112].
Edit Central Bank Code Determination Rules
In the Central Bank Code Determination fine tune activity in Business Configuration, you can
assign central bank codes according to the official lists provided by the authorities. The rules can
also be created or edited in the Central Bank Reporting subview. These rules are used to
determine the default central bank code used for an invoice that has the relevant attributes.
Assigning a Business Partner to an International Organization –Austria
When a business partner belongs to or is considered to be an international development
organization, it is subject to central bank reporting. Trading with this customer or supplier is
subsequently reported to as part of your company’s regular central bank reporting. For more
information, see Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting –
Austria [117] .
This task is relevant for Austria only.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 111
3.5.8.2 Perform Central Bank Reporting
Overview
In the Central Bank Reporting subview of Periodic Tasks, you can perform central bank reporting, which involves the
collection and management of foreign trade transactions. These transactions are reported to the authorities to create
the balance of payments for the respective country.
Prerequisites
Ensure you have resolved any outstanding central bank reporting related tasks in the Work view. For example, that you
have manually assigned central bank codes where the system was unable to automatically determine the relevant code,
or created additional line items (for non-payables or non-receivables items) that need to be reported.
The same data is available in the Central Bank Reporting subviews of the Payables and Receivables work centers and
you can perform central bank reporting from either of these work centers.
Data from customer invoicing and supplier invoicing from business partners abroad appears in the Central
Bank Reporting worklist.
Procedure
1. Go to the relevant work center, such as Payables or Receivables. Choose the Periodic Tasks view and then choose
the Central Bank Reporting subview.
2. Specify the country to report.
3. Filter for the relevant document line items:
● To filter the document line items, click the Advanced search link and enter the search details. Useful filter
parameters include filtering by date range and by status.
● Click Go to filter for the relevant document line items.
The following statuses are available: ● The Not Relevant status indicates a line item which includes a central bank code but doesn't
need to be reported.
● The In Preparation status indicates a line item created manually or automatically for which data
entry is not yet completed, for example a missing central bank code. This status automatically
changes to Reporting in Process when data is complete, for example when you enter a central
bank code. It is not possible to manually change this status.
● The Reporting in Process status indicates a line item created manually or automatically for
which all data is complete but the line item has not yet been reported to the relevant authorities.
When you have reported this line item you change the status to Reported.
● The Reported status indicates a line item has been reported to the relevant authorities for the
appropriate reporting period. If you mistakenly change the status of a line item to Reported you
can change it back to Reporting in Process.
● The Cancellation Reporting in Process status indicates the corresponding invoice for the line
item has been cancelled but the cancellation has not been reported yet to the authorities. When
112 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
you have reported the cancellation you change the status of this line item to CancellationReported. If the corresponding invoice is cancelled in the same month before it was reported to
the authorities, the line item is deleted from the central bank reporting worklist.
● The Cancellation Reported status indicates the corresponding invoice for the line item has been
cancelled, and the cancellation was reported to the authorities for the respective reporting period.
If you mistakenly change the status of a line item to Cancellation Reported you can change it
back to Cancellation Reporting in Process.
4. Add any missing information that needs to be declared to the worklist, for example, salary for employees abroad.
1. Click New and choose New Central Bank Reporting to open the Central Bank Reporting quick activity.
2. Enter reporting information as required.
3. Click Save to add the item to the central bank reporting worklist.
5. Review the document line items.
● If you need to manually assign a central bank code to a document line item, click Edit to open the Central
Bank Reporting quick activity and then enter the required data.
However, to avoid receiving further tasks in your worklist relating to similar document line item types, you should
create a central bank code determination rule for this document line item type. You can then propose this central
bank code for document line items with the ” In Preparation” status.
If you have created a new line item for the central bank reporting worklist, you have the option to edit
all the details for this line item. However, if the line item comes from another document , such as an
invoice, you can only edit the central bank code. In some cases such as transit trades, you may need
to review and change the central bank code.
● If the business partner is located in the same country as your company or if the country of the business partner
is missing, you should mark the entry as “Not Relevant” . This item will then be excluded from reporting.
6. Format the report:
● Click on the Advanced link to display the Advanced filter options.
● Set the Status field to "Reporting In Process".
● Set additional filters as required, for example, document date and company ID.
● Click Go .
The system displays the filtered data in the table. You can now perform the Export function to create a Microsoft
Excel spreadsheet with the reporting data.
7. To transfer the details to the relevant authorities, you must export the reporting information to a Microsoft Excel
spreadsheet .
1. Choose Export To Microsoft Excel .
2. The system displays the message: Exported spreadsheet is ready; download to your local
machine? Choose Yes .
3. The system displays a message: Do you want to open or save this file? Choose Save .
4. The system displays the “Save As” dialog box for you to choose where to save this file on your local machine.
Choose a suitable location to save the file on your local machine and click Save .
5. The system displays the message: Download Complete.
Choose Open to open the file immediately. You can choose Close to close the dialog box if you want to open
the file later.
6. The system displays the message: Do you want to replace the contents of the destination
cells in Sheet1? Choose Yes .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 113
7. The Microsoft Excel worksheet is now open for you to use the data as required. Scroll to the bottom of the
worksheet to see the “Pivot table” with the summary of the Central Bank Reporting data for you to report. In this
pivot table you can sort by central bank code and check the total value of transactions for a particular code.
For Germany, if the total for a central bank code exceeds EUR 12,500 , then you must report this
transaction to the authorities.
8. Select each of the line items you have reported and click Actions , then choose “Reported”.
If the status is not set to “Reported”, then reported line items may be inadvertently included in future central
bank reports. If you mistakenly change the status of a line item to “Reported” you can change it back to
“Reporting in Process”.
Result
Using this Excel as a basis, you must fill out and submit the relevant forms manually to the relevant central bank.
See Also
Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting [110]Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting [173]
3.5.8.3 Related Information
3.5.8.3.1 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — Austria
When a user creates an invoicing document (invoice or credit memo) for a foreign business partner, certain information
in this document may need to be reported to Statistik Austria, who collect balance of payment information on behalf of
Oesterreichische Nationalbank (OeNB), the Austrian central bank. In the Central Bank Code Determination — Austria
configuration activity, you can create rules that map the relevant invoice line attributes to the official central bank code.
A rule consists of one or more attribute values, which is then assigned a central bank code. The system uses specific
attributes of each document line item to automatically determine the applicable central bank code.
This document contains details and instructions regarding configuration settings. Such settings are normally
performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization, contact your key user.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the activity from the activity list.
Prerequisites
You have selected central bank reporting in your system configuration. Central bank reporting is only available for
Austria, France and Germany. You must select one of these countries in the Country and Type of Business step in the
scoping phase.
To find this topic, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Edit Project Scope. In the Scoping step of the guided activity, select
Compliance , then Central bank Reporting topic.
114 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Tasks
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — CustomerInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — Austria activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Customer Invoicing - Austria.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Receivables work center . Select Austria from the countries available and then select
a customer invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central
Bank Code Determination for Austria.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a customer invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
customer invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
You are only required to report cross border services and transit trade goods to Statistik
Austria. You should therefore create a rule in central bank reporting to exclude other
goods that are not transit trade.
To automatically exclude non-transit-trade goods from central bank reporting, you
should do the following:
● If required, select the relevant company.
● Select Material as the product type.
● Choose Transit Trade equals to No.
● Do not enter any central bank code, that is, leave it empty.
Reported In is automatically changed to False. Any entries for non-transit-trade goods
are then hidden from the central bank reporting list.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 115
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — SupplierInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — Austria activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Supplier Invoicing - Austria.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Payables work center . Select Austria from the countries available and then select a
supplier invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central Bank
Code Determination for Austria.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a supplier invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
supplier invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
You are only required to report cross border services and transit trade goods to Statistik
Austria. You should therefore create a rule in central bank reporting to exclude other
goods that are not transit trade.
To automatically exclude non-transit-trade goods from central bank reporting, you
should do the following:
● If required, select the relevant company.
● Select Material as the product type.
● Choose Transit Trade equals to No.
● Do not enter any central bank code, that is, leave it empty.
Reported In is automatically changed to False. Any entries for non-transit-trade goods
are then hidden from the central bank reporting list.
116 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Follow-On Activities
Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting
If a customer or supplier is or belongs to an international development organization, any trading activities with this
organization are relevant for central bank reporting. You should then create central bank code determination rules for
this international organization in the Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting activity.
For information see, Configuration: Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting [117].
Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion
If a company in your organization is not relevant for central bank reporting, you should exclude its activities from central
bank reporting. For example, if the company only has local business partners. For more information, see Configuration:
Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion
3.5.8.3.2 Configuration: Determination of International Organizations for CentralBank Reporting – Austria
Overview
When your business partner belongs to or is considered to be an international development organization, it is subject
to central bank reporting. Trading with this customer or supplier is subsequently reported to as part of your company’s
regular central bank reporting.
International organizations have this status because of their international, multilateral, or diplomatic status. Examples
of international organizations include the United Nations, the World Health Organization, and the International
Committee of the Red Cross.
Business partners who are assigned to an international organization retain their country code, as this corresponds to
their invoicing address. These partners are also assigned a country for reporting code which uniquely identifies the
international organization to which they are assigned. For partners assigned to international organizations, the country
for reporting code is used to summarize central bank report data.
You can create central bank code determination rules for international organizations in the Determination of International
Organizations for Central Bank Reporting activity. They can also be created or edited in the Central Bank Reporting
view of the Payables or the Receivables work centers.
This document contains details and instructions regarding configuration settings. Such settings are normally
performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization, contact your key user.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the activity from the activity list.
Settings
The controls and possible settings in this fine-tuning activity are explained below.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 117
Settings Explanation
S. No This serial number is automatically created by the system and uniquely identifies each line in the rule list.The rules will be applied in this order.You cannot change this value.
Business Partner ID The business partner ID identifies the party who belongs to or is considered to be an internationalorganization.
Country of Company This is the country of your company address.
InternationalOrganization
A standard list of international organization codes is delivered with the solution and cannot be changed.This list is provided by Statistik Austria.All international development organizations, regardless of the country where the organization is based,are considered foreign business parties for central bank reporting purposes.
Assigning a Business Partner to an International Organization
1. In the fine-tune phase of business configuration, open the Determination of International Organizations for Central
Bank Reporting activity.
Alternatively, in the Payables or Receivables work center, open the Periodic Tasks view and select Central Bank
Reporting.
Choose Austria from the list of countries. Click Action Maintain International Organizations for Central Bank
Reporting .
2. To assign a business partner, click Add Row . ● Under Business Partner ID, select * (asterisk) and choose the relevant business partner. To do this, select the
operator “EQ - Equals To” and browse for the business partner using the Open Dialog Selection.
● Under Country, select your country from the list.
● Under International Organization, select the relevant organization.
3. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule is first and the most generic rule
is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules is important as code determination works from top to bottom. You should therefore
create the most specific rule at the top of the list and the most general rule should be last.
See Also
Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination - Austria [114]
3.5.8.3.3 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — France
When a user creates an invoicing document (invoice or credit memo) for a foreign business partner, certain information
in this document may need to be reported to the Banque de France, the French central bank. In the Central Bank Code
Determination — France configuration activity, you can create rules that map the relevant invoice line attributes to the
official central bank code. A rule consists of one or more attribute values, which are then assigned a central bank code.
The system uses specific attributes of each document line item to automatically determine the applicable central bank
code.
118 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
This document contains details and instructions regarding configuration settings. Such settings are normally
performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization, contact your key user.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the activity from the activity list.
Prerequisites
You have selected central bank reporting in your system configuration. Central bank reporting is only available for
Austria, France and Germany. You must select one of these countries in the Country and Type of Business step in the
scoping phase.
To find this topic, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Edit Project Scope. In the Scoping step of the guided activity, select
Compliance , then Central bank Reporting topic.
Tasks
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — CustomerInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — France activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Customer Invoicing - France.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Receivables work center . Select France from the countries available and then select
a customer invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central
Bank Code Determination for France.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a customer invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
customer invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 119
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — SupplierInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — France activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Supplier Invoicing - France.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Payables work center . Select France from the countries available and then select a
supplier invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central Bank
Code Determination for France.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a supplier invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
supplier invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
Follow-On Activities
Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion
If a company in your organization is not relevant for central bank reporting, you should exclude its activities from central
bank reporting. For example, if the company only has local business partners. For more information, see Central Bank
Reporting — Exclusion
3.5.8.3.4 Configuration Guide for Central Bank Code Determination — Germany
When a user creates an invoicing document (invoice or credit memo) for a foreign business partner, certain information
in this document may need to be reported to the Deutsche Bundesbank, the German central bank. In the Central Bank
Code Determination — Germany configuration activity, you can create rules that map the relevant invoice line attributes
to the official central bank code or chapter number. The system uses specific attributes of each document line item to
automatically determine the applicable chapter number or central bank code.
120 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
This document contains details and instructions regarding configuration settings. Such settings are normally
performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization, contact your key user.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the activity from the activity list.
Prerequisites
You have selected central bank reporting in your system configuration. Central bank reporting is only available for
Austria, France and Germany. You must select one of these countries in the Country and Type of Business step in the
scoping phase.
To find this topic, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Edit Project Scope. In the Scoping step of the guided activity, select
Compliance , then Central bank Reporting topic.
Tasks
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — CustomerInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — Germany activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Customer Invoicing - Germany.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Receivables work center . Select Germany from the countries available and then select
a customer invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central
Bank Code Determination for Germany.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a customer invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
customer invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 121
Create a Rule for Central Bank Code Determination — SupplierInvoicing
In the Central Bank Code Determination — Germany activity, click Central Bank Code
Determination for Supplier Invoicing - Germany.
After the implementation project is complete, you can also access this fine-tune activity
from the Central Bank Reporting view, which is under Periodic Tasks in the
Payables work center . Select Germany from the countries available and then select
a supplier invoice line item from the list. Finally, click Actions and choose Central
Bank Code Determination for Germany.
Supplier and customer invoice items are both displayed in the Payables and
Receivables central bank reporting work lists. You must therefore ensure that you
select a supplier invoice in order to edit the central bank code determination list for
supplier invoicing.
1. Select the company that is performing the central bank reporting.
2. If relevant for this rule, select a product type. To do this, under Product Type, select *
(asterisk) and choose the operator EQ - Equals To; browse for the product type using the
Open Selection Dialog.
3. If relevant for this rule, select a product ID.
4. If relevant for this rule, select a product category.
5. Select a code that corresponds to the combination of selections you made for the different
attributes. If necessary, use the arrow buttons to reorder the rules so the most specific rule
is first and the most generic rule is last. Click Save and Activate .
The sequence of rules in the list is important as the code determination works from top
to bottom. Create the most specific rule at the top of the list, and the most general or
default rule at the very end. Insert new rules where necessary to maintain the integrity
of the code determination sequence.
Follow-On Activities
Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion
If a company in your organization is not relevant for central bank reporting, you should exclude its activities from central
bank reporting. For example, if the company only has local business partners. For more information, see Central Bank
Reporting — Exclusion
3.6 Reports
3.6.1 Aging List for Payables
Overview
This report displays for each supplier your overdue payables according to a specific key date and aging period.
122 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
considers only items with a transaction date before the key date.
● Period 1 through Period 4
You can specify four aging periods to group your overdue payables. These periods are calculated from the specified
key date. In the default display, the period structure is as follows: 30 days (period 1), 60 days (period 2), 90 days
(period 3), 120 days (period 4). This means, for example, that period 2 displays the overdue payables with a due
date between 31 and 60 days in the past, regardless of whether they are cleared on the current date. These values
can be changed.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
In addition to the overdue payables, the report also displays for each period the payables that are not yet due and the
total amount of payables (the total overdue items and items not yet due).
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Supplier invoices are displayed as negative amounts.
● Supplier credit memos are displayed as positive amounts.
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The net due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From the open items displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 123
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.2 Forecast List for Payables
Overview
This report displays for each supplier your open payables for which the due date is after the specified key date and lies
in the future. The report also lists open items that your suppliers need to pay you.
Canceled items are not included.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Forecast List for Payables - (Standard)Displays the following for each supplier: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the net due date (payment target).
● Normal Cash DiscountDisplays the following for each supplier: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the due date of the normal cash discount,
as shown in the example below: Cash discount terms 2.
● Maximum Cash DiscountDisplays the following for each supplier: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the due date of the maximum cash
discount, as shown in the example below: Cash discount terms 1.
You receive an invoice dated 07/01/09 with the following payment terms:
● 1) Payment within 8 days: 3 % cash discount
● 2) Payment within 14 days: 2% cash discount
● 3) Payment within 30 days: Net
This means that there are three possible due dates for this invoice:
● Cash discount term 1) (maximum cash discount): Can be paid up to 09.07.09
● Cash discount term 2) (normal cash discount): Can be paid up to 15.07.09
● Net (payment target: term 3): Can be paid up to 31.07.09
The system displays different net amount and aging periods for the invoice, depending on the view you select.
Depending on the view used, the invoices are grouped by net due date, due date with normal cash discount, or due
date with maximum cash discount.
124 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
considers only items with a transaction date before the key date.
● Period 1 through Period 4
You can specify four aging periods to group your payables due at a future date. These periods are calculated from
the specified key date. In the default display, the period structure is as follows: 30 days (period 1), 60 days (period
2), 90 days (period 3), 120 days (period 4). This means, for example, that period 2 displays the payables due from
day 31 through 60 after the specified key date. These values can be changed.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
In addition to the items due for each period in the future, the report displays the payables overdue on the key date and
the total amount of all open items (total overdue and not yet due items).
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Supplier invoices are displayed as negative amounts.
● Supplier credit memos are displayed as positive amounts.
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From the open items, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value and open
the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 125
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.3 Details to Items of Suppliers
Overview
This report lists all items for a supplier for a particular period.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Entry Date
The system takes the previous two weeks as the default value for the documents entered.
● Item Status
You can restrict the display to a specific item status, such as open, cleared, or unassigned. For this, use the input
help.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays for each item the full document amount as well as any cash discount available or taken, and amounts
outstanding. The dunning level is also displayed for any overdue items. The data in this report is displayed in table
format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From each supplier displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
126 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.4 Details to Open Items of Suppliers
Overview
This report lists the open items for each supplier for a specific key date.
Canceled items are not included.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Open Item List – Suppliers (Standard)This view displays for each supplier all the open items for a specific key date as well as information about any cash
discount available or taken.
● Open Item List – All Items By SuppliersDisplays a list of all the open items by document number in ascending order.
● Open Item List – Summary By SuppliersShows the total number of open items for all or a selection of customers.
● Open Item List – ReconciliationDisplays the open items for each supplier and transaction currency.
You use this view for technical reconciliation on the basis of the Accounts Payable Reconciliation report. For
more information, see Accounts Payable Reconciliation.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). When doing so, note
the following:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
displays only items with a transaction date before the key date.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 127
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Supplier invoices are displayed as negative amounts.
● Supplier credit memos are displayed as positive amounts.
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The net due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can call up the corresponding detailed information for the open items displayed. To do this, select the
appropriate value and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.5 Payment Statistics - Suppliers
Overview
The report provides an overview of your company's payment behavior towards its suppliers for a specific period.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data that you want to see by making value selections for variables. You
must make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk
(*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variable:
● Proposed Posting Date
The system takes the previous two weeks as the default value for the documents entered.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
128 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
Analyzing the Report
This report displays the following: the number of days from the invoice receipt until payment (payables), payment
amount, average number of days until the net due date, number of overdue days in the specified period in percent, and
the permitted, claimed, and forfeited cash discount.
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From each supplier displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.6 Payment Statistics – Cash Discount
Overview
The report displays an overview of all the cash discounts that your company has taken or lost while making payments
over a given period of time. All the cash discounts that your company is still allowed to use are also shown.
Canceled items are not included.
Views
● Payment Statistics – Cash DiscountsDisplays all the cash discounts, including all those taken or not used, over a given period of time, as well as all the
cash discounts that are currently available. The default value for this period is 365 days.
● Payment Statistics – Top Lost Cash DiscountsDisplays the ten highest discount amounts that were not used over the last 365 days.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data that you want to see by making value selections for variables. You
must make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk
(*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
● Clearing Date
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 129
You can restrict the display to payments that were cleared within the specified period of time, such as the current
month or the last 14 days. The default value for this variable is the last 365 days.
● Display CurrencyThis report is displayed in the company currency as standard. However, you can also run the report in a different
currency.
● Display Currency – Conversion DateIf you want to run this report in a currency that differs from the company currency, you can specify the conversion
date. The current date is taken as the standard conversion date.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report displays the amount of the cash discounts that your company has taken or lost or is still allowed to use for
each supplier.
Additional information is available for the following key figures:
● Cash Discount AllowedShows the cash discount that you are allowed or were allowed to use for a particular payment.
● Cash Discount TakenShows the cash discount that you were allowed to use according to your supplier and that you have taken.
● Additional Cash Discount TakenShows the cash discount that you have taken in addition to the amount that you were allowed to use according to
your supplier. This means that it is the difference between the total cash discount amount taken and the allowed
cash discount amount.
● Cash Discount LostShows the cash discount that you would have been allowed to use but that you did not take.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, click on the filter symbol and select the required values.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can use the individual suppliers displayed to navigate directly to an overview of their master data. To do this,
select the appropriate value and open the corresponding menu.
● If you want to display more lost discount amounts than displayed in the standard view, proceed as follows:
Under Columns, choose the Key Figures dropdown list and then Manage Conditions. In the dialog box displayed,
choose Edit. On the Edit Conditions screen in the From Value column, overwrite the displayed value and enter the
required number of rows. You can save your changes and set the modified view to be your standard. For more
information, see Conditions.
From this report, you can navigate to:
● Business Partner Overview
● Details for All Items – Suppliers
● Payment Statistics – Suppliers [128]
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
130 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payables
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
3.6.7 Supplier List
Overview
The supplier list shows a list of all the suppliers that are in the system.
You can view various data for suppliers, such as:
● Business partner ID and name
● Address data
● Status
● Creation date
● User who created the record
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 131
4 Receivables
4.1 Business Background
4.1.1 Open Items Receivables
Overview
You can display open item lists for customer accounts. Open items are posted open invoices from goods and services
or credit memos that were not yet paid. The lists of open items of all customers help you to recognize your customers'
outstanding payments and to collect them in a timely fashion with optimized dunning. You also get an overview for which
customer accounts you still need to edit open items.
Prerequisites
To display open items, you must have already entered and posted a customer invoice in the system. If you have not
assigned a company to a customer when you create the master data, the system attempts to do this automatically when
the first invoice is posted. The company is derived using the sales company that created the invoice and using
Organizational Management. You can also assign the company yourself. To do this, proceed as follows:
1. In the Receivables work center, open the Customers view and subview.
2. Select the appropriate customer and choose Edit → Financial Data.
A dialog box appears.
3. Choose the Payment Data area. You can use Add Row to create a new customer account and enter the company.
4. Set up the account determination groups.
Once you have finished saving, the system creates a new customer account in the subledger. For more information,
see Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business Transaction.
View of the Lists of Open Items
To get an overview of your open items, select the Reports view in the Receivables work center. You find the following
reports in this list that display information about your customers' open items:
● Open Item List - Customers
The report displays the open items for each customer for a specific key date.
● Item List - Customers
The reports displays all items - open, cleared, and partially cleared - for each customer for a specific period. You
can also only display the open items of your customers for a selected period.
● Aging List for Receivables
This report displays the overdue open items of your customers, structured by how long they are overdue in days.
● Forecast List for Receivables
This report displays for each customer your open receivables for which the due date is after the specified key date
and lies in the future. In this way, you can get an overview of the incoming payments to be expected.
132 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
The reports take the data from the register for trade receivables and payables, replicate this data in a separate database,
and import the data according to your selected report profile. Once you have selected a report, you can save different
queries to standardize repetitive activities.
For example, to create the Open Item List - Customers report, you must enter the company, currency, key date, and
conversion date of the display currency. If you leave the Customer entry field empty, the report selects all customers.
For the reports Aging List for Receivables and Forecast List for Receivables, you also need to enter the aging/forecast
analysis period. You also have the option of selecting a specific customer if you only want to display the open items for
that particular customer. In the Item List - Customers report, you can use the status to specify whether only the cleared,
partially cleared, or open items should be displayed.
If you have saved a query as a selection variant, it appears for selection on the same screen in the Available Variants
list. You can change and save a selected selection variant if you want to copy the changes for the existing selection
variant. If you want to save the query under a new name, choose Save As. This saves the new query as a selection
variant.
The following reports are also available to display open items and customer behavior:
● Dunning History - Customers
● Dunning History - Documents
● Dunning Statistics
● Payment Statistics - Customers
● Payment List - Customers
In addition to the option of displaying open items in a report, you can also display the open items of a specific customer
using the Customer Account Monitor. For more information, see Customer Account Monitor [133].
See Also
Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business Transaction
Customer Account Monitor [133]
4.1.2 Customer Account Monitor
Overview
The customer account monitor provides you with an overview of your customer due items (invoices, payments, credit
memos), for example so you can check which payments are expected in the next few days. Based on this, you can
decide which follow-up activities you need to perform (for example, initiating a dunning procedure), and you can plan
your liquidity.
You can also use the customer account monitor when dealing with customer inquiries or when clearing open items in
an account.
To call up the customer account monitor, proceed as follows:
1. In the Receivables work center, open the Customers view, then the Customer Accounts subview.
2. Select the appropriate customer and choose View .
The following tab pages are available in the customer account monitor:
● General Data
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 133
Here you can view the customer’s address, open item totals in the transaction currency, and valuated balances in
the company currency. You can also see dunning information, the credit limit, and accounting data, such as the
company currency or the default set of books.
You can also access the supplier account if you have defined the roles of both supplier and customer in the master
data records.
● Trade Receivables — Invoices/Payments
Here you can view all the transactions made on a particular customer account. You can also create manual
payments and start the manual clearing of payments.
You can filter the invoices, credit memos, and payments according to their status as follows: ○ Open Items shows open items and partially cleared items.
○ Cleared Items shows cleared items and canceled items.
○ All Items shows all items.
You can choose whether to include statistical items, such as down payment requests and bill of exchange requests,
in the display.
The information about the items is presented in table format and includes: status, external reference, document
type, document date, net due date, posting date, open amount in transaction currency, and clearing ID. In the detail
area below the table, additional information is displayed about the item selected in the table. This includes the
amount in the transaction currency, the cash discount amount, the payment terms and due dates, dunning details,
the payment method, and payment block details.
You can set or reset dunning blocks under Actions .
The (optional) columns Document Amount in Transaction Currency or Cleared Amounts may show a
sum that is not equal to zero. This means that the sum of the payments and credit memos does not equal
the sum of the invoices. This happens when an item is transferred to another account or a discount is
taken.
● Trade Receivables — Postings
Here you can view all the transactions made on a particular customer account within a specified period. The display
also includes opening and closing balances for the period in question. You can choose to include journal entries
that are not relevant for the general ledger in order to explain open item amounts.
It is also possible to sort according to open item reference ID in order to view associated debit and credit entries
together.
● Changes
Here you can view the change history for a particular customer account.
● Reports
Here you can run reports on balances, as well as access reports on aging, forecasts, and dunning for the selected
customer.
Features
Line Item Details
In the line item details, you can see the status, due date, amount, cash discount amount, clearing document ID, and
Created On date, as well as other information for each invoice, credit memo, or payment.
You can also view all the journal entries related to this item.
For items that have not yet been included in any clearing or payment processes and have the status Open, you can
make changes to cash discount terms, dunning, or payment method/block information.
134 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Split Items
If there is only a partial payment for an invoice that leads to a partial clearing of the invoice, the system creates split
items for this invoice with split item IDs. Each of these split items has its own status (Open or Cleared). An invoice that
is only partially cleared therefore has precisely one open split item.
New Charge/Credit
You can use this function to create a new open item for which an invoice does not currently exist, for example, to portray
fees or rental payments. You might enter an item for dunning fees and then clear it once the fees have been paid, for
example. However, this function is not to be used to replace an invoice. When you manually enter open items in this
way, you cannot assign any payment terms.
Manual Clearing
The manual clearing function on the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Receivables tab enables you to manually
clear customer payments with outstanding invoices if the system was not able to perform clearing automatically. You
can also clear credit memos with invoices or outgoing payments from the customer (for example, refund by bank transfer
or other refunds) with credit memos. When you perform clearing, the balance of the selected items may not result in
zero. Differences can be written off or kept as remaining open items, which can be cleared later with future payments.
To start manual clearing, proceed as follows:
1. Select the appropriate invoices and choose Clear Manually . The New Manual Clearing screen appears. You see
the Open Items table. The system checks whether the items are already in clearing (whether a payment proposal
has already been created for these items). The available items are displayed for editing.
2. Select the relevant open items and choose Match Items . You see the total balance of the selected items in the
upper area of the screen.
If you use the function for splitting open items, you can use the customer account monitor to perform manual
clearing only (not automatic). The items have the same external reference and must therefore be cleared
manually and included in separate clearings.
Manual Payment
The manual payment function ( Pay Manually By ) on the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Receivables tab
enables you to pay invoices or credit memos, for example by check, bank transfer, or direct debit. The payment methods
available are based on your definition in the customer master data. It is always possible to create an incoming check.
Underpayment
If a difference arises because the payments received are smaller than the invoice amount and lead to a miscellaneous
operating cost, you can represent this as follows:
● You can distribute the difference amount to the selected items together:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
2. Choose Apply Discount or Credit .
3. Enter the amount and reason. The system distributes the complete amount of the difference to the items.
● You can distribute the difference amount to selected items individually:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 135
2. Select the appropriate item in the table.
3. Choose Additional Discounts and Credits .
4. Choose Add Row .
5. Enter the amount and reason.
The precise behavior is also dependent on the settings made for the clearing strategy in Fine-Tuning.
The system performs the tax consolidation associated with the underpayment automatically.
Loss on Receivable in the Event of Insolvency
You can also write off an open item for which no payment has been received and for which you no longer expect an
incoming payment. This may be due to a customer’s insolvency (bad debts), for example. To write off a bad debt, proceed
as follows:
1. In the customer account monitor, filter for open items. The system displays open and partially cleared items.
2. Select the open invoice(s).
3. Choose Clear Manually .
4. Under Other Discounts/Credits, enter the full amount and choose the reason S01 - Insolvency.
5. Choose Clear .
The receivable is written off or depreciated in financial accounting on the Write Down of Current Assets account. The
account is determined using account determination. The VAT that has already been paid is automatically recalculated
and corrected accordingly on the tax account. In the General Ledger work center under Journal Entries, you reclassify
the receivable to doubtful debts, set up the reserves for bad debts, and clear the provisions from doubtful debts. For
more information, see Reserves for Bad Debt.
Overpayment
If a difference arises from an incoming payment that is greater than the invoice amount, you can assign the total payment
amount to the customer account and leave the amount on the customer account as an on account payment.
If the system was able to allocate payments to the open invoices based on invoice references and clearing has taken
place, the system still creates a task for payment clearing in the event of overpayments. This is dependent on the settings
for the clearing strategy in Fine-Tuning. You have the following options for handling the difference:
● In the Receivables work center in the Payment Clearing view, you can leave the remaining balance as an on account
payment.
● You can contact your customer and refund the overpaid amount.
● You can clear the difference amount manually:
1. Choose Clear Manually .
2. Select the relevant items.
3. Choose Apply Discount or Credit and enter a reason for the difference and the amount.
The system does not make any tax adjustments with respect to the overpaid amount. To make a tax
adjustment for the overpaid amount, you use the Manual Tax Entries view of the Tax Management work
center.
136 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Reset Clearing
You can reset clearing, for example, if an invoice has been allocated to the wrong payment and then cleared. To do
this, proceed as follows:
If you need to cancel a customer invoice that has already been paid, first reverse the clearing in the
Receivables work center then cancel the invoice in the Customer Invoicing work center.
If you first cancel the customer invoice in the Customer Invoicing work center, the original clearing still exists
and the system generates a new open item (reversal document).
If you have already transferred the source invoice manually to another account, a reversal item is displayed
on the original account. Transfer the reversal item in the same way as the source invoice. Then you can clear
the source invoice with the reversal document.
For more information, see Canceling a Customer Invoice [53].
1. In the customer account monitor, go to the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Receivables tab, and filter for
cleared items.
2. Select the item for which you want to undo clearing and choose Clearing Document .
3. Choose View All . You see a list with the clearing documents for this item.
4. Choose Reset Clearing .
5. Enter a cancellation date and document description (if desired).
6. Choose OK .
The item is no longer cleared and is displayed with the status Open or Partially Cleared.
Clearing When Canceling an Invoice
If you create a partially or completely-cleared invoice, or an invoice with reference to a down payment, the system
automatically clears part of the invoice. Typically, the invoice remains partially open, and the down payment is cleared.
However, both the invoice and down payment can be partially cleared, depending on your choice of amounts. If you
cancel this invoice, the system creates a cancellation invoice. Furthermore, a cancellation document is created in the
payables and receivables register. You now have the following options for clearing:
● Reverse clearing for the invoice in the customer account monitor and then clear the invoice manually with the
cancellation invoice. The invoice and cancellation invoice then have the status Cleared and the down payment has
the status Open.
● If you would rather not involve the clearing document for the invoice, possibly because you have defined a cash
discount or other deductions for additional documents that also need to be cleared, you can use the cancellation
invoice to clear other open items (in the same way as for a credit memo).
● If these considerations are not applicable, and if there are no further items available for clearing, you can use the
manual payment function ( Pay Manually By ) in the customer account monitor to create a payment for the
cancellation invoice. A customer invoice is then paid in the same way as a credit memo.
For more information, see Down Payments Received in Financials [140] and Customer Down Payments.
Other Functions
You can also do the following in the Invoices/Payments subtab of the Trade Receivables tab:
● Make single or multiple repostings of payments or invoices
● Transfer all items to another customer account
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 137
● Split open items
You can split a payment between different reconciliation accounts, for example, to portray a security deposit for a
house purchase. You may also want to split an open item over a number of due dates to cater for installment
payments.
● Export the details of a customer account to Microsoft Excel
● Set or reset payment blocks or dunning blocks
The payment block only applies to payments that are triggered by your company. Incoming payments are not
affected by this. The payment block does not result in a delivery block.
Integration
If you have a customer who is also a supplier, you can also see them in the supplier account monitor in the Payables
work center. You must create the master data of this business partner twice. For more information, see Business
Partners.
See Also
Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Contracts in Receivables
4.1.3 Automatic Dunning
Overview
From time to time your company may have outstanding receivables against customers. To remind customers about
amounts due, you can use dunning notices or payment reminders. The usual case is that a customer has not paid an
invoice.
The dunning run enables you to schedule the system to determine on a regular basis all the invoices, down payment
requests, or bills of exchange receivable for which payment is overdue or due shortly. A dunning proposal list is then
issued. You can check and edit this list before the dunning notices or payment reminders are created. You review the
dunning proposal list to check whether any reasons exist for not sending a dunning notice. The dunning run determines
the receivables proposed for dunning based on the entries in the dunning strategy, which are entered in configuration.
After you have checked and made any changes to the dunning proposal list, it can be released. Once you have released
the dunning proposals, the dunning notices or payment reminders are sent to your customers by fax or e-mail, or printed
in the form of dunning letters.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Scoping
You have entered the country-specific dunning procedures.
Fine-Tuning
You have defined the dunning strategy in the Business Configuration work center under Activity List Fine-
Tune Cash Flow Management .
138 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
You can specify the dunning strategies that the system should use when creating a dunning proposal list. These settings
directly influence when the overdue items are included in the dunning proposal.
Master Data
In the Application and User Management work center, you can set the dunning form that you want to use and specify
how it should be sent.
Process Flow
Create and Schedule a Dunning Proposal List
You create and schedule the dunning proposal list using the dunning run. In the Receivables work center, choose
Periodic Tasks Dunning Runs . For more information, see Quick Guide for Dunning Runs (Receivables) [156].
Select Items for the Dunning Proposal List
Based on the criteria that you entered when performing the dunning run, the system determines all the items for your
company and the corresponding customers. Depending on your settings in the dunning strategy, the system only
determines the items overdue for a minimum period.
The dunning process generally includes receivables. If a receivable is not listed in the dunning proposal, this could be
due to one of the following reasons:
● You have not defined a dunning level for the document type (invoice, down payment request, bill of exchange
receivable).
● The receivable has already been dunned and the next dunning level not yet reached.
● The highest dunning level has already been reached.
● You have agreed with your customer or supplier that payments will be made by direct debit.
You specify the payment agreements under Receivables Customers Financial Data .
● You have locked the receivable for dunning.
● You have locked the customer for dunning.
List Receivables with Highest Dunning Level
Overdue payment items can be dunned in accordance with the configured steps. If all the steps have been performed,
the affected items will not be selected in an additional dunning run. We advise against using these items in an additional
dunning document to prevent the previous correspondence becoming invalid. A company would then usually take legal
action.
If you want to list the items that have already reached the highest dunning level, proceed as follows:
1. In the Receivables work center, choose Reports.
2. Choose the report Dunning History – By Document.
3. Choose the date up to which you want to search for data.
4. Copy the Dunning Level free characteristic into your column selection and sort the characteristic in descending
order so that the highest value is at the top of the list.
You can also filter by the highest dunning level.
Edit Dunning Proposals
You edit dunning proposals in the Dunning view. Choose Receivables and then the Dunning view. For more information,
see Quick Guide for Dunning (Receivables) [155].
You can use the following reports to perform dunning evaluations. The reports can be found under
Receivables Reports .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 139
See Also
Dunning History - Documents [178]
Dunning Statistics [179]
4.1.4 Down Payments Received in Financials
Overview
Before goods are produced or services provided, it is sometimes necessary to receive a down payment on an invoice
amount from the customer. You company then sends a down payment request to the customer.
The down payment request is displayed in the system in the receivables balance as a statistical open item that is part
of the balance confirmation request, and that can be dunned and paid. The amount from the down payment request is
not initially posted to accounting, nor is the tax amount initially entered in the tax entries. This first occurs when your
company receives the payment.
Once your company has received the payment, which clears the payment request, the tax amounts are updated and
used for the tax return. Entries are also made in the corresponding G/L accounts.
If your company issues a final invoice, the received down payment is assigned automatically to the invoice if the
references match. A transfer posting is made from the Down Payments Received account to the Receivables account.
The tax entry resulting from the down payment received is cancelled and a new tax entry is entered using the amount
from the total invoice. The remaining amount can now be cleared with the total payment.
For more information on postings for down payments, see Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method) [331].
Prerequisites
The accounts for down payments are provided in the Business Configuration work center in the Activity List view and
the Fine-Tune step. To navigate to this step, choose Financial and Management Accounting Chart of Accounts,
Financial Reporting Structures, Account Determination Accounts Payable or → Accounts Receivable . For more
information about account determination, see Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business
Transaction and Reconciliation Accounts.
Process Flow
1. Create Down Payment RequestYou create a new down payment request in the Customer Invoicing work center. For more information, see Down
Payments from Customers.
2. Display Customer AccountTo display the down payment request with the status Open, in the Receivables work center, choose the views
Customers Customer Accounts .
The customer account monitor is displayed.
3. Create Payment for Down Payment RequestTo create a payment for the down payment request, go to the Trade Receivables tab in the Customer Account
Monitor and choose, for example, the action Pay Manually By → Incoming Check.
140 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
You can include other payments for this incoming check. If the customer has transferred an amount
smaller than that displayed in the down payment request, you can specify the difference amount as a
deduction. The system does not currently support partial payments.
Once you release the check, the down payment request is paid. After clearing, the status of the down payment
request changes from Open to Cleared. The system generates a new item, namely a down payment, with the status
Open.
Once you have released the check, you can view the document flow by choosing View All Incoming
Check . You see that the check was posted as a down payment received and that a provisional tax amount has
been entered.
Partial clearing for down payment requests is not supported. Only the full amount can be cleared.
4. Enter Final InvoiceYou can create final invoices in the Customer Invoicing work center. Using the Down Payments tab, the system
proposes the down payments that exist for the customer account.
For more information on invoice entry, see Customer Invoice Processing.
If the amount of the down payment received matches the attributable amount displayed in the invoice for this down
payment, the invoice is cleared automatically.
The tax amount is posted automatically during automatic clearing. The tax entry resulting from the down payment
received is cancelled and a new tax entry is entered using the total tax amount from the invoice.
In the following cases, the system creates a task for manual clearing, which the processor accepts, if the amounts
match or differ only slightly, or enters manually, if a down payment already exists: ● The system does not find a down payment for the final invoice.
● The system finds a down payment that is used elsewhere.
● The amounts in the down payment and the item in the final invoice do not match.
5. Enter Total Payment
Reversing Down Payment Requests, Down Payments, and Total Invoices
You can make a down payment request invalid in the Customer Invoicing work center prior to posting, as long as it has
not yet been paid. If you have already received the down payment and entered it in the system, you must first reverse
clearing in the customer account monitor. For more information on reversing clearing, see Customer Account Monitor
[133] in the section Clearing When Canceling An Invoice With Reference to a Down Payment.
Discount Applied to Customer Invoices with Down Payments
During the automatic clearing of a customer invoice (of EUR 1,000, for example) with a down payment (of EUR 100, for
example), the system does not post a cash discount. If the system processes the final payment, that is, during the
automatic clearing of the final payment, the system calculates the cash discount for the remaining payment. This is EUR
900 in the example. If your customer has applied a greater cash discount, the system creates a task for the user for the
payment clearing.
If you want to apply the cash discount to the total invoice amount, you can do this when you process the clearing task.
To view a task for clearing, choose Receivables Tasks .
For more information, see Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials [142].
See Also
Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method) [331]
Customer Account Monitor [133]
Down Payments from Customers
Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials [142]
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 141
4.1.5 Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials
Overview
A customer can deduct a cash discount when paying an invoice. When the corresponding open item is cleared, the cash
discount amount is entered either automatically or manually. The system automatically posts the cash discount granted.
Prerequisites
Configuration Settings
Fine-Tuning
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials is activated in your solution configuration. To find this activity, go to the
Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project
and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the following activities from the activity list:
● You need to define the payment terms. To do this, choose General Business Data Accounts Maintain
Payment Terms .
● There needs to be an account for Granted Cash Discounts and it needs to have been entered in your financial
reporting structures and assigned in account determination for the business transaction Cash Discount for
Payment/Discount. Choose Financial and Management Accounting Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting
Structures, Account Determination .
● You need to have defined your clearing strategy. To do this, choose Cash Flow Management Clearing
Strategies .
Automatically Determining Granted Cash Discounts
When the open item was created, the system already calculated any cash discount amounts. For this, the system uses
the following data:
● Payment terms for each customer: Payment terms have been assigned in the master data of the relevant
customer.
● Payment term for each invoice: Payment terms were assigned during customer invoicing. If payment terms exist
for a customer invoice, the system always applies these terms and not the payment terms entered in the master
data for that customer. If no payment terms have been assigned during customer invoicing, the system applies the
payment terms for the relevant customer.
Cash Discount Deductions for Automatic Incoming Payments
Cash discounts that have been deducted by the customer are taken into account for automatic incoming payments,
such as incoming bank transfers on a bank statement. The system compares the cash discount amount that it has
calculated for the payment execution date against the cash discount amount actually deducted by the customer. The
system uses the clearing strategy to compare the amounts. You can also define grace days for deducting cash discounts
142 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
or set up a rule that always generates a task for underpayment. If the cash discount amount deducted by the customer
exceeds the tolerance limits and you have defined a task for underpayment, the item is not cleared, and a task is created.
For more information, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Cash Discount Deductions for Manual Incoming Payments
When a manual incoming payment (such as an incoming check) is entered, the system proposes the cash discount
amount that has already been determined by the system for the transaction date. You can overwrite the cash discount
amount that the system proposes. For more information, see Manual Incoming Payments [40].
Deducting Cash Discounts During Manual Clearing
You can enter a cash discount while manually clearing an open item in the customer account monitor. In the
Receivables work center, choose Customers Customer Accounts and proceed as follows:
1. Select the appropriate customer and choose View .
2. Select the items you require and choose Clear Manually .
3. Enter the required amount in the Cash Discount field of the invoice.
Posting a Granted Cash Discount
When a customer invoice is paid, the deducted cash discount is posted using the gross procedure. The VAT is corrected
automatically for the payment date of the invoice. Cash discounts are always posted to a separate account for granted
cash discounts. For more information, see Discounts: Cash Discounts and Bonuses [339].
Cash Discounts for Partial Payments
If an invoice is only partially cleared, the cash discount is calculated and posted to the payment amount.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a 3 % cash discount, a partial payment of EUR 97 is made. In addition
to this, the system posts the cash discount of EUR 3 proportionately. This results in a clearing amount of EUR 100. If
you are processing an automatic incoming payment, and it has been defined in the system configuration that a task will
always be generated for underpayments, the item is not cleared and the system creates a corresponding task. The
amounts used in the example are proposed automatically for clearing.
Cash Discounts for Clearing Credit Memos
If the payment terms of the credit memo match those of the invoice (for an invoice-relevant credit memo, for example),
a cash discount is posted for both the invoice and the credit memo.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a 3 % cash discount, and a credit memo of EUR 100 with a 3% cash
discount, a cash discount of EUR 3 is calculated for the clearing amount of EUR 100. The cash discount is posted as
a negative amount for the invoice and simultaneously as a positive amount for the credit memo, meaning that no cash
discount is paid.
If the credit memo has no cash discount terms, such as a subsequent bonus credit memo, a cash discount is calculated
and posted to the credit memo during manual clearing.
For example: For an invoice of EUR 1,000 with a cash discount of 3 %, and a bonus credit memo of EUR 97 without
a cash discount, a cash discount of EUR 3 is posted additionally. This results in a clearing amount of EUR 100.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 143
Cash Discounts for Down Payments
During the automatic clearing of a customer invoice (of EUR 1,000, for example) with a down payment (of EUR 100, for
example), the system does not post a cash discount. If the system processes the final payment, that is, during the
automatic clearing of the final payment, the system calculates the cash discount for the remaining payment. This is EUR
900 in the example. If your customer has applied a greater cash discount, the system creates a task for the user for the
payment clearing.
If you want to apply the cash discount to the total invoice amount, you can do this when you process the clearing task.
To view a task for clearing, in the Receivables work center select the Account ID you wish to see. Then click New
and choose Task.
Cash Discount Amounts for Point-of-Sale Transactions
Cash discount amounts can be specified explicitly for individual due items from point-of-sale transactions. These cash
discounts override the payment terms.
See Also
Customer Account Monitor [133]
Automatic Incoming Payments [35]
Manual Incoming Payments [40]
Configuration: Clearing Strategies
4.1.6 Refund of Payments Received
Overview
The refund of payments received is necessary if payments cannot be allocated because they were not intended for your
company (incorrect payment by the customers), if the customer has returned goods, or made an overpayment or double
payment.
A refund by bank transfer is possible in the system in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Allocation view.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration:
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following settings in the Business Configuration work center under Activity List Fine-
Tuning Cash Flow Management :
144 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● Setting the tolerances in the clearing strategy:
You specify which difference between the invoice amount and actual payment by the customer the system accepts
and automatically clears the receivables with the received payments.
● Configuration of the import format for your bank statement:
It enables the system to interpret the business transaction codes of the bank and to represent them correctly as
disbursement or collection.
Process Flow
After receiving the incoming payments, the system automatically allocates open items (receivables). Due to missing
information or incorrect bank transfers by the business partner, there is no automatic allocation and therefore the system
cannot perform automatic clearing. This means that manual allocation and clearing is necessary. Depending on the
business transaction, the following scenarios are possible:
● Automatic allocation and amount difference ○ Manual allocation of the total amount to the debtor and clearing of the total amount
○ Partial allocation of the total amount to the debtor ○ Clearing of the partial amount
○ Refund by bank transfer of a partial amount
○ No allocation and refund of the total amount
● Allocation not possible and manual clearing of the total amount ○ Allocation of amounts
○ Posting of the total amount to the debtor account
Received Incoming Payments that Can Be Allocated
The incoming payment can be allocated to a debtor, however for specific reasons, the system cannot perform automatic
clearing. For example, the amount cannot be uniquely allocated or the customer has made deductions that cannot be
tracked in the system. In this case, you find the incoming payment in the Receivables Work Center in the Payment
Clearing view. Note that an incoming payment is represented with a minus sign in this view because it decreases the
receivable.
● Manual allocation of the total amount
1. In the Receivables work center, choose Payment Clearing.
2. Display all open items, select the relevant incoming payment, and choose Edit .
The Manual Payment Clearing screen appears.
3. To post the amount to the debtor account, choose Assign Payment On Account .
4. Choose Save .
● Manual allocation of a partial amount:
It is not possible to only accept a part of the amount and to directly refund the amount that is not allocated.
● Refund by bank transfer of a partial amount or total amount:
You can reject the total payment in the Receivables work center in the Payment Clearing view under Actions .
Then you see this payment by selecting the rejected payments. This transaction does not refund the amount by
bank transfer.
To make a refund by bank transfer, go to the Payment Management work center and create a manual outgoing
payment for the amount to be refunded. For more information, see the Manual Outgoing Payments section in
Outgoing Payments [11].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 145
Once the outgoing payment is approved, you see the outgoing payment as an open approved payment in the
Receivables work center in the Customers view, Customer Accounts subview. You need to clear these payments
with manual clearing with the amount that you wanted to refund.
You prepare the outgoing payment to the bank in the Payment Management work center in the Outgoing
Payments view.
Received Incoming Payments that Cannot Be Allocated
In the Payment Management work center in the Payment Allocation view, you can view all payments that the system
could not allocate automatically. They have the status In Preparation. Note that an incoming payment is represented
with a plus sign in this view because it is an inflow of cash.
1. Select the relevant payment and choose Edit .
The Edit Payment Allocation screen appears.
Here you can choose Mark as Return for a payment.
Enter the following information for the refund: ● Allocated amount
● Currency
● Return reason (for example, cash payment, account closed, invalid bank details)
2. Save your entries.
The status of the payment allocation changes to Released. The system posts the returned amount depending on
what is entered as the return reason. The repayment must be initiated manually.
To reverse a payment, on the Edit Payment Allocation screen, choose the Reverse button.
4.2 Customers View
4.2.1 Quick Guide for Customers (in Receivables)
The Customers view in the Receivables work center provides a central point of access for all the customer master data
related to your receivables. You can check transaction and account details for all of your customers, and check and
release as required the customer balance confirmations that you created in the balance confirmation run. The
Customers view features three subviews that allow you to access the information and perform the tasks you need:
Customer Accounts
In this subview, you can view the account balances of your customers and call up individual receivables items on the
accounts. You can also create manual payments and start the manual clearing procedure.
Customers
In this subview, you can display, edit, and create customer master data records. You can also check customer details
such as their location, main contact person, and contact information.
Balance Confirmation
This subview provides you with a list of proposed balance confirmations that you can check and release so that they
are sent to your customers.
146 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Business Background
Customer Account Monitor
The customer account monitor provides you with an overview of your customer due items (invoices, payments, credit
memos), for example so you can check which payments are expected in the next few days. Based on this, you can
decide which follow-up activities you need to perform (for example, initiating a dunning procedure), and you can plan
your liquidity.
You can also use the customer account monitor when dealing with customer inquiries or when clearing open items in
an account.
For more information, see Customer Account Monitor [133].
Customer
A person or company with whom a business relationship exists and who purchases or receives a product. The term
“customer” covers both corporate and private customers.
For more information, see Customer.
Open Items Receivables
You can display open item lists for customer accounts. Open items are posted open invoices from goods and services
or credit memos that were not yet paid. The lists of open items of all customers help you to recognize your customers'
outstanding payments and to collect them in a timely fashion with optimized dunning. You also get an overview for which
customer accounts you still need to edit open items.
For more information, see Open Items Receivables [132]
Down Payments Received in Financials
Before goods are produced or services provided, it is sometimes necessary to receive a down payment on an invoice
amount from the customer. You company then sends a down payment request to the customer.
The down payment request is displayed in the system in the receivables balance as a statistical open item that is part
of the balance confirmation request, and that can be dunned and paid. The amount from the down payment request is
not initially posted to accounting, nor is the tax amount initially entered in the tax entries. This first occurs when your
company receives the payment.
For more information, see Down Payments Received in Financials [140].
Tasks
Create and Edit a Customer
1. In the Customers subview, choose New then Corporate Customer or Private Customer.
2. Enter the name of the customer, the address, communication data, and any other
information. Enter a note if required.
You can check whether a customer is already entered in the system if you selected
this option during scoping in the business configuration. To do this, choose
Check for Duplicates . The system also displays any customers that might be
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 147
duplicated when you save the details of a new customer. For more information,
see Business Partner Duplicate Check.
3. To enter additional customer information, click View All .
4. To return to the Customers view, click Save and Close .
Create a SEPA Direct Debit Mandate
For more information on this task, see Create a SEPA Direct Debit Mandate [148].
Manual Clearing in the Customer Account Monitor
For more information on this task, see Customer Account Monitor [133].
Reverse Clearing in the Customer Account Monitor
For more information on this task, see Customer Account Monitor [133].
4.2.2 Create a SEPA Direct Debit Mandate
Overview
If you want to make payments using the SEPA direct debit procedure, you need to obtain automatic debit authorization
in the form of a mandate for each of your customers. You first create and print out the mandate and then send it to your
customers for them to sign. The customer then completes the necessary data before returning the signed copy of the
mandate. You update the data in the system and send the entries stored in the mandate with each direct debit to the
bank. This enables the bank to then directly debit your customer's account.
Prerequisites
You have a unique creditor identifier (UCI), which you requested and obtained from the national bank. You have entered
the UCI in your company master data in the Organizational Management work center.
Procedure
1. Create a Preliminary SEPA Mandate
a. In the Receivables work center, navigate to the Customers view. In the Customers subview, select the
appropriate corporate or private customer and click Edit and then Financial Data .
b. Under SEPA Mandates, click New .
c. In the Direct Debit Mandate window, enter the required data for your customer, including: ● Mandate ID
If you want the system to generate a sequential number, then leave this field empty. If you want to create a
mandate that already exists in the system, enter its number in the field.
● Single-Use
If you want to use the mandate for one direct debit only, set this indicator. If you want to reuse the mandate,
leave the checkbox empty.
148 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● Payer Data
Check the data displayed for your customer and use the input help to select their bank.
● Mandate Type
To view the Mandate Type column, go to Personalize My Settings This Screen . Select Sepa
Mandates from the Sections list and select the Mandate Type checkbox from the Fields list. Check that the
preselected mandate type is correct, displaying either SEPA Business–to–Business or SEPA Core.
The system deducts this value according to customer account information, depending on whether you are
dealing with a corporate or private customer.
● Optional: Alternative Payer
If the payables are not settled by the customer but instead by an unknown payer in the system, then you
need to set this indicator. Enter the required payer data. In this case, the alternative payer must agree to the
direct debit and sign the mandate.
d. Once you have entered all the required data, click Save . Then print the mandate by choosing Actions > Print
Mandate so that you can send it to your customer for signing.
When you print the form, the mandate status changes from In Preparation to Waiting forConfirmation. This status means that the customer has not yet sent the signed mandate back to you
or that you have not yet entered it in the system.
2. Finalize a SEPA Mandate
a. After your customer has sent back a signed version of the SEPA direct debit mandate, reselect your customer
and choose Edit > Financial Data.
b. Under SEPA Mandates, click Edit .
On the Direct Debit Mandate screen, enter the data that the customer added to the form and enter the place of
signature and the signature date in the Signature Details area.
Click Save .
The mandate obtains the status Active and can now be used for SEPA direct debit transactions.
Upon first use of the mandate with a direct debit procedure, the system enters the mandate data in the
payment file and submits it to the bank. Whenever the mandate is used again, only the mandate ID is sent
to the bank since the other information is already stored. Only in the case of the mandate being amended
is the bank information updated by the payment file.
3. Enter an Existing Mandate in the System
This step only applies if a mandate exists that was signed by a customer but that has not been entered in
the system.
a. In the Receivables work center, navigate to the Customers view. In the Customers subview, select the
appropriate corporate or private customer and click Edit and then Financial Data .
b. Under SEPA Mandates, click New .
c. Enter the data for the SEPA client as described under Create a Preliminary SEPA Mandate but with the
following difference: Enter the existing mandate ID in the Mandate ID field as well as the date and signature.
Click Save .
The mandate status changes to Active and can now be used for direct debits. You can print the mandate as
often as you want.
4. Amend an Existing Mandate in the System
a. If you need to make changes to a SEPA direct debit mandate with the status Active, reselect your customer.
Choose Edit > Financial Data.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 149
b. You can edit the following fields of which the bank must then be informed: ● Mandate ID
● Creditor IDThis entry has to be changed in the Organizational Management work center.
● Company NameThis entry has to be changed in the Organizational Management work center.
● Payer IBAN or BICThese entries have to be changed on the Bank Data subtab of the Financial Data tab for the respective
customer.
Note that changes made in other views or work centers will be automatically updated on the SEPA Mandate
screen.
You can set the Blocked indicator without generating a change that needs to be reported. In this way, the
mandate is blocked from being used with direct debits. You can remove the block at any time. If you change a
mandate, the mandate data is sent by payment file to the bank when the next direct debit is made.
Result
Once a mandate has the status Active, you can use it for SEPA direct debit payments. Note, however, that if a mandate
is not used for more than 36 months, it can then no longer be applied.
You cannot delete any mandates. If the validity of a mandate expires, the system prevents a payment with
this mandate. If you no longer want to use a mandate or it is no longer valid, you can set its status manually
from Mark as Obsolete to Obsolete. In this way, you can filter the list in the SEPA mandates area by active,
that is, valid mandates.
See Also
SEPA Mandate List [185]
4.3 Automatic Payments View
4.3.1 Quick Guide for Automatic Payments (Receivables)
You can access this view from the Receivables work center under Automatic Payments. You use this view to check
automatic incoming payments prior to their execution to ensure that they will be received correctly and on time. You can
perform the following tasks:
● View all internally-initiated incoming payments, such as direct debits or credit card payments, before they are
completed.
● Review proposed payments to be received and release them for payment.
● Create and track recurring payments.
You can approve automatic payment proposals. To do this, you check the details of a proposal then release it. The
system makes the payment automatically once you have saved the changes.
150 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Business Background
Automatic Incoming Payments
In your role as an accounts receivable accountant, you require functions to process national and international incoming
payment transactions made with customers and other debtors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management, Receivables, and Liquidity Management work centers. When you create a payment, you can
specify the payment method and other details, such as the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the bank processing
date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all payment
transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payer.
You create and edit internally initiated automatic incoming payments in the Receivables work center. You edit the
automatic creation of payment media in the Payment Management and Liquidity Management work centers.
You use selection criteria first to define the preparatory selection run (payment run) for creating a payment proposal list.
You can then edit the payment proposals and release them for payment creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually.
You can execute the payment run manually as often as you want.
When the payment proposals are paid, the system automatically performs payment clearing.
The system supports the following standard payment methods for internally initiated incoming payments:
● Direct debit
● Credit card
● Bill of exchange receivables with or without acceptance
For more information, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Tasks
Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal
The Automatic Payments view in the Receivables work center enables you to approve proposed
incoming payments so that your company receives the correct payment from your customers on
time. The system creates a list of proposed payments based on your customer invoices and
payment information, which is then displayed in this view.
For more information on this task, see Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal [152].
Display Payment Proposals
1. In the Automatic Payments view, select a payment and click View Payment Proposals .
2. In the Payment Proposal Overview: <ID> screen, you can view a list of all the payment
proposals created by the payment run execution that includes the selected payment.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 151
4.3.2 Approve an Automatic Payment Proposal
Overview
The Automatic Payments view in the Receivables work center enables you to approve proposed incoming payments
so that your company receives the correct payment from your customers on time. The system creates a list of proposed
payments based on your customer invoices and payment information, which is then displayed in this view.
Procedure
1. In the Automatic Payments view, select a payment proposal with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
The Payment: <ID> editor appears.
2. If you want to check the payment information and details on the payer and memo line, view the General tab.
3. Choose the Open Items tab and check the open items. To remove an open item from the proposed payment,
deselect it in the Matched column. For detailed information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open
Items Table [93].
4. If the proposed payment is appropriate, click Execute Payment . The payment is then sent for further approval, if
necessary. If you want to reject a payment proposal, choose Actions then Void Proposal. Then click Close to
close the editor and return to the worklist.
Result
If you click Execute Payment , the payment status changes to Completed.
4.4 Payment Clearing View
4.4.1 Quick Guide for Payment Clearing (Receivables)
The Payment Clearing view in the Receivables work center enables you to clarify a receivable payment, such as an
incoming payment for a customer invoice, either by clearing or by reposting it. The system usually clarifies such
payments by clearing automatically. If the system does not find any open items that fit to the payment, or the open items
that it does find do not match the open items that are referenced (incorrect document date or invoice amount, for
example), it creates a Payment Clearing task.
To assist you in matching an incoming payment with the appropriate open invoice, the system creates clearing proposals
that suggest the best match if it is unable to make the clearing itself, based on factors such as the payment amount,
due payment date, and payment references. You can simply accept these proposals or you can edit them for a better
match. There are several editing methods you can use, such as changing the discounts that should be applied to each
invoice, deducting the difference between the invoice and payment amounts, or editing which invoices should be paid
by the incoming payment. The system provides you with a list of different discounts and deductions that you can apply,
and it records this information when you apply them. Once the difference between the payment amount and the invoice
amount has been eliminated, the incoming payment can be cleared.
The Payment Clearing task is complete when the payment is clarified. A payment is considered to be clarified under the
following circumstances:
152 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● It is applied to open items and cleared.
● It is reposted to a different customer account or supplier account.
● The remaining balance is accepted on account.
● A combination of the above.
If a partial payment is to clear an invoice completely, you can apply additional discount manually to the item in question,
or use the action Apply Discount or Credit, which distributes the discount according to the clearing strategy configured.
Note that it is not possible to apply such a discount to an overpayment. In the case of an overpayment, you have to
accept the overpayment on account and clear it later, for example against a customer charge item.
Your manual payment clearing tasks can also be accessed from the Work view of the Receivables work center.
Business Background
Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials
A customer can deduct a cash discount when paying an invoice. When the corresponding open item is cleared, the cash
discount amount is entered either automatically or manually. The system automatically posts the cash discount granted.
For more information, see Cash Discounts for Receivables in Financials [142].
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Tasks
Clear an Incoming Payment Manually
In the Payment Clearing view of the Receivables work center, you can clear incoming payments
manually.
You can also call up tasks for manual payment clearing in the Work view of the
Receivables work center.
For more information on this task, see Clear an Incoming Payment Manually [154].
View Clearing
1. If you want to view the details for payment clearing, select the clearing that you want to
display in the Payment Clearing view and click Show Clearing .
2. In the Clearing Overview: <ID> editor, you can view the parameters set for clearing, such
as the remaining balance that needs to be cleared for the entire clearing process to be
completed, amounts assigned to other customers and suppliers, accounting data, open
items, and the payment amount. You can also clear the incoming payment manually if
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 153
required. If you want to clear the incoming payment manually, click View All and perform
the task Clear An Incoming Payment Manually [154].
4.4.2 Clear an Incoming Payment Manually
Overview
In the Payment Clearing view of the Receivables work center, you can clear incoming payments manually.
You can also call up tasks for manual payment clearing in the Work view of the Receivables work center.
Procedure
1. In the Payment Clearing view, select a payment clearing item with the status Paid on Account and click Edit .
The General tab in the editor displays the clearing balance that needs to be zeroed before clearing can be
completed.
The amounts under Clearing Overview and Payment Overview are influenced only by those open items
that are matched in the Open Items table.
2. In the Open Items table, you can display the items that are currently open and that can be added to the clearing
proposal to clear the payment amount. To include an item in the proposal, select the item that you want to use in the
Matched column. Similarly, items can be removed by deselecting them.
For detailed information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
3. Once you have eliminated the clearing difference, click Clear to clear the selected items. If you want to save a
'draft' version of your clearing proposal first, click Save . Be aware that any reposting-relevant changes are posted
to accounting though. Then click Close to return to the clearing worklist.
After you have checked a payment clearing task, you might find that the payment cannot be allocated to
an open item. In this case, select the clearing task concerned and choose Actions then Send to Payment
Allocation.
In the payment clearing task, it is not possible in the case of an overpayment to clear the overpaid amount
with deductions. If you have an overpayment, click Clear . The system asks you whether to accept the
balance on account. Confirm this. You can clear the balance later in the account monitor.
Result
Your incoming payment is cleared either partially or entirely and updated in the list in the Payment Clearing view. All
the open items that are allocated to the payment are cleared, and all the amounts that were accepted on account or
allocated to other customers or suppliers are included on the relevant supplier or customer account.
154 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
4.5 Dunning View
4.5.1 Quick Guide for Dunning
In the Dunning view of the Receivables work center, you can use automatically-created dunning proposals to issue
dunning notices to your customers who have overdue payment items, and in this way, request payment of the
outstanding amounts owed to your company. The system assists you with this task by creating with a dunning run a list
of dunning proposals that you can edit, block, or use to send dunning notices to your business partners, as appropriate.
To create dunning proposals, use the dunning run provided under Receivables Periodic Tasks Dunning
Runs .
Business Background
Automatic Dunning
From time to time your company may have outstanding receivables against customers. To remind customers about
amounts due, you can use dunning notices or payment reminders. The usual case is that a customer has not paid an
invoice.
For more information, see Automatic Dunning [138].
Tasks
Edit and Execute Dunning
For more information on this task, see Edit and Execute Dunning [155].
Preview a Dunning Letter
1. If you want to preview a dunning letter, go to the Dunning view, select a dunning proposal
for which you want to display the dunning letter, and click Edit .
The Dunning Proposal: <ID> editor appears.
2. Choose Preview then Dunning Letter, and on the Preview screen, select the dunning
letter you want to view and click Open .
Alternatively, you can preview a dunning letter from the Dunning view by selecting a dunning
proposal for which you want to display the dunning letter and then choosing Preview then
Dunning Letter.
4.5.2 Edit and Execute Dunning
Overview
In the Dunning view of the Receivables work center, you can use automatically-created dunning proposals to issue
dunning notices to your customers who have overdue payment items, and in this way, request payment of the
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 155
outstanding amounts owed to your company. The system assists you with this task by creating with a dunning run a list
of dunning proposals that you can edit, block, or use to send dunning notices to your business partners, as appropriate.
Procedure
1. In the Dunning view, select a dunning proposal with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
The Dunning Proposal: <ID> editor appears.
2. If you want to check the dunning information and the overview of dunning items, select the General tab.
3. Choose the Dunning Items tab, and check the individual dunning items. These are overdue payment items that are
included in the dunning notice when it is sent to your customer, unless you change their status.
1. If you prefer not to include an individual dunning item in a dunning notice, select the item from the list, and
choose Actions then Postpone or Actions then Block .
2. If you choose Block, you will need to enter a dunning block reason. Click the Block Reason arrow, and choose
the relevant reason.
4. Click Execute Dunning .
The proposal status is updated in the worklist to Issued.
If you do not want to execute dunning immediately but first want to save a draft, click Save and then Close to
close the editor. You then return to the worklist.
If you do not want to issue the dunning notice, click Close to close the editor and to return to the worklist.
Choose Actions then Postpone. The entire dunning proposal is postponed, irrespective of the status of
the individual dunning items contained in the proposal.
Result
If you click Execute Dunning and approve the dunning proposal, a dunning notice is automatically sent to your customer
using your chosen dunning medium. If you postpone a dunning proposal, the task is deleted from the Work view, but
remains in the dunning worklist with the status Rejected.
4.6 Periodic Tasks
4.6.1 Quick Guide for Dunning Runs
In the Dunning Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of the Receivables work center, you can perform automatic
runs, which generate dunning proposals. The system automatically generates a dunning proposal list containing
invoices, for example, for which payment is overdue or due shortly. The system displays recurring dunning runs as well
as dunning runs that you have scheduled for a future date. You can edit existing dunning runs and reschedule them.
You can display existing dunning runs and check the application logs of runs that have already been executed.
156 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Automatic Dunning
From time to time your company may have outstanding receivables against customers. To remind customers about
amounts due, you can use dunning notices or payment reminders. The usual case is that a customer has not paid an
invoice.
For more information, see Automatic Dunning [138].
Tasks
Create a Dunning Run
For more information on this task, see Create a Dunning Run [159].
Activate a Dunning Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Dunning Runs subview, select a dunning run with the status
In Preparation or In Revision and click Edit .
2. In the Dunning Run: <ID> editor, you can check the available data and make any necessary
changes. If you make any data changes, make sure you then Save .
3. Choose Activate .
Alternatively, you can activate a dunning run by going to the Periodic Tasks view and Dunning
Runs subview. Here you select a dunning run with the status In Preparation or In Revision and
choose Actions then Set to Active.
.
You can also perform this step when you create a dunning run. It is then not necessary
to perform a separate activation step. Note that you cannot change an existing run if
it has the status Active.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 157
Schedule a Dunning Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Dunning Runs subview, select a dunning run with the status
Active and click Schedule .
The Schedule Job editor appears.
2. If you want to start a dunning run immediately and do not intend to repeat the run, select
Start Immediately. Alternatively, you can specify a start date and time or arrange for it to run
after a specific job. If you want to schedule the dunning run periodically, specify in addition
to the execution date when the dunning run should be repeated, for example, daily or weekly.
3. Then choose Save and Close .
You can also perform this step when you create a dunning run, once you have saved
and activated it. It is then not necessary to perform a separate scheduling step. You
can reschedule an active run at any time or change its scheduling parameters.
Edit a Dunning Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Dunning Runs subview, select a dunning run with the status
In Preparation and click Edit .
The Dunning Run: <ID> editor appears.
2. Make your changes.
3. Then click Save .
Display Scheduled Runs
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Dunning Runs subview, select the dunning run you want
to view and click View Jobs .
The Job Monitor window appears.
2. You can check which runs are scheduled and change or cancel runs if required. If you want
to change the execution date of a job, select the appropriate job and click Reschedule . If
you want to cancel a job that has already been scheduled, click Cancel Job .
You can display the technical details for jobs that have already been executed as follows:
1. In the Job Monitor window, use the Show field to view the executed jobs.
2. Click View Job Log .
Display Application Log
1. If you want to view the details of runs that have already been executed, first go to the Periodic
Tasks view and the Dunning Runs subview. Here you select the relevant dunning run and
you can see the details in the lower table.
2. To then display the application log, click on the relevant ID in the Application Log ID column
of the lower table.
158 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
4.6.2 Create a Dunning Run
Overview
In the Dunning Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of the Receivables work center, you can create dunning
proposals automatically for all or selected customers with overdue open items.
You can also generate reminders for open items not yet due.
Procedure
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Dunning Runs subview, choose New then Dunning Run.
2. In the New Dunning Run editor, specify the criteria that you want to use to perform the dunning run. Make entries in
the following fields:
● Company
● Customer from / to ID
You can define a value range, which enables you to select multiple customers for one dunning run. If you do
not make a selection here, the system includes all the customers for the selected company in the dunning run.
● Dunning Strategy
Select a dunning strategy. If you do not make a selection from the list, the system uses the dunning strategy
defined as standard in the business configuration.
The dunning run ID is automatically assigned by the system.
3. Choose Save .
Result
You have created a dunning run that can now be activated and performed immediately or scheduled for a later date. If
you have only saved a dunning run and not yet activated it, you can still make changes to it.
4.6.3 Quick Guide for Payment Runs (Receivables)
In the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of the Receivables work center, you can create automatic
runs, which generate payment proposals for internally initiated payments. The system displays recurring payment runs
as well as manually scheduled payment runs. You can edit existing payment runs and reschedule them. You can display
existing payment runs and check the application logs of runs that have already been executed.
You do not use this view to generate bank transfers, direct debits, checks, or bills of exchange. Instead you use the
Payment Media Run in the Payment Management area.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 159
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Automatic Incoming Payments
In your role as an accounts receivable accountant, you require functions to process national and international incoming
payment transactions made with customers and other debtors. The system makes these functions available in the
Payment Management, Receivables, and Liquidity Management work centers. When you create a payment, you can
specify the payment method and other details, such as the bank data of the supplier/customer, or the bank processing
date. You can also use the Payment Monitor in the Payment Management work center to monitor all payment
transactions regardless of status, payment medium, or payer.
You create and edit internally initiated automatic incoming payments in the Receivables work center. You edit the
automatic creation of payment media in the Payment Management and Liquidity Management work centers.
You use selection criteria first to define the preparatory selection run (payment run) for creating a payment proposal list.
You can then edit the payment proposals and release them for payment creation.
Note that the system replaces all existing payment proposal lists each time you generate a new list manually.
You can execute the payment run manually as often as you want.
When the payment proposals are paid, the system automatically performs payment clearing.
The system supports the following standard payment methods for internally initiated incoming payments:
● Direct debit
● Credit card
● Bill of exchange receivables with or without acceptance
For more information, see Automatic Incoming Payments [35].
Tasks
Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Receivables
For more information on this task, see Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Receivables
[161].
160 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
4.6.4 Create and Edit Payment Proposals for Receivables
Overview
A payment proposal list contains all open items (for example, invoices or credit memos) that the system proposes for
payment within a single execution of a payment run. You can use the payment proposal lists to check internally initiated
payments before they are executed.
A payment proposal list is determined on the basis of the payment strategy that you have defined in configuration and
displays the due payments taking payment conditions into account. Depending on the setting, it allows an optimal usage
of granted cash discounts.
To display a payment proposal list created by the system for internally initiated incoming payments, in the
Receivables work center, choose Automatic Payments.
Alternatively, you can access payment proposals in the Work view filtered according to Payment Run
Tasks, or in the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view.
Due payment runs for direct debits (receivables clearing) in foreign currencies are not supported by the
system.
The system shows due customer payments to be collected from the customer's bank account by direct debit or credit
card. The system creates the proposal list on the basis of the outgoing invoices and payment information that you have
created for the customers.
Once you have checked the payment details and terms of the proposed payments, you can release them. Depending
on the settings in configuration, you may need approval from a manager.
Once you have executed the payments (by choosing Execute Payment in the Automatic Payments view), the system
posts the payments and clears the open items to be paid.
You perform any subsequent processing, for example, creating payment files or payment media in the Payment
Management work center.
Prerequisites
You have made the following predefined settings in configuration and for master data:
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
Scoping
Under Questions Cash Flow Management , you have made the basic settings for your payment processes.
Fine-Tuning
You have selected the following settings in Business Configuration under Activity List Fine-Tune Cash Flow
Management :
● Payment Strategy (mandatory)
You can create one or multiple payment strategies, which the system accesses when creating the payment proposal
lists. These settings directly influence when the open items are included in a payment proposal list and whether
deductions should be made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 161
● Approval Process
In the payment processing settings, you specify a threshold value for each payment method. When this threshold
value is reached, an approval of the incoming payment is required. For customer credits, for example payment of
credit memos, the approval threshold for outgoing payments is used instead. The approval request is sent to the
next manager in the organization chart that you have defined in configuration for Corporate Organizational
Management.
● Prioritization of Bank Accounts
You can specify all bank information, the payment method for each bank account, and the threshold values for the
bank accounts. The system accesses the bank accounts during liquidity assignment for the payment of invoices
depending on the priority.
Procedure
1. Creating a Payment Proposal List
To create a new payment run, proceed as follows:
a. Go to the Receivables work center and choose the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view. Choose
New then Payment Run.
The New Payment Run screen appears.
You can use the following selection criteria for your payment run: ● Posting Date
You can specify a posting date. The default posting date is the execution date of the run. Leave this field
empty if you want to schedule the run periodically.
● Bank Processing Date
You can specify the requested payment date (for bank transfers and direct debits only). Depending on
working days, the bank may make the payment later. Leave this field empty if you want to schedule the run
periodically.
● Include On Account Payments
Here you can specify whether you want the run to include incoming on account payments. These are
payments that have been posted to an account but not yet cleared.
● Company
● Customer from/to ID
You can define a value range enabling you to select multiple customers for one payment run. If you do
not select a customer, the system selects all the customers entered in the system for the payment run.
● Currency
You can specify a currency. Only those invoices that match the selected currency are cleared.
● Next Payment Run Date
Here you enter the date up to which all open items should be considered in the payment proposal list. You
cannot edit this field later.
This date should only be specified if the payment run is performed immediately and performed once only. If
the payment run is scheduled periodically, no date should be entered here. The payment run then takes into
account all items until the payment run is next performed.
Items with a payment block are not selected by the run. This applies to on account payments as well.
b. Save your entries.
2. Scheduling a Payment Run
a. On the Payment Run: <ID> screen, click Schedule .
162 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
The Schedule Job screen appears.
If you want to start the payment run immediately and run it once only, choose Start Immediately. Alternatively,
you can specify a start date and time or arrange for it to run after a specific job.
If you want to schedule the payment run periodically, specify when the payment run should be repeated, for
example, daily or weekly.
b. Save your entries.
c. Close the Schedule Job screen.
The payment run number is displayed in the title of the screen. You can find the payment run with this payment
run number in the Payment Runs subview. You can check the status of the payment run in the Payment
Runs subview, in the Status column.
You can view the technical details on the execution of a run in the log in the Payment Runs subview of the Periodic
Tasks view. To do this, select the relevant payment run under Payment Runs then click on the relevant ID in the
Application Log ID column of the lower table. For more information, see Messages in the Payment Run Application
Log [99].
3. Displaying a Payment Proposal
If the run was successful, you can display the payment proposals created by the system for internally initiated
incoming payments (for example direct debit from customer's account). You do this in the Receivables work center
in the Automatic Payments view.
4. Editing and Releasing a Payment Proposal
To edit a payment proposal, proceed as follows:
a. In the Receivables work center, open the Automatic Payments view. Alternatively, you can open the Work view
and filter according to Payment Run Tasks.
b. Select the appropriate payment proposal.
c. Choose Edit to display the details for the payment and to make changes. You can change the payment method
and related data (such as the bank account), change the payment amount, select other customer/supplier bank
details, enter or change a cash discount amount, or delete open items (which will exclude them from the
payment).
You can also reject a payment proposal. This does not affect the open items since there has been no posting
in the system.
d. Once you have finished editing a payment proposal, choose Execute Payment to forward the payment to the
Payment Management work center or to the approver of the incoming payment.
The approval is necessary if the threshold value defined in configuration for the approval of an incoming payment
is reached. If no approval is necessary for the incoming payment, posting takes place in the system with the
execution of the payment and the open items are cleared. If an approval is necessary, posting takes place after
approval.
5. Approving a Payment Proposal
Once you have edited and released a payment proposal that must be approved, it is automatically forwarded to the
approver in the Managing My Area work center in the Approvals view. The approver can approve the payment or
send it back for revision.
See Also
Configuration: Payment Strategies
Contracts in Receivables
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 163
4.6.5 Quick Guide for Balance Confirmation Runs (Receivables)
You use the balance confirmation run in the receivables area to compile data for your customer balance confirmations
and to create balance confirmation letters. These letters inform your customers about their account balances and request
that the balance information is confirmed. In this way, you can reconcile your system data records with the data records
in the customer system.
Alternatively, you can request that your customers send you a balance confirmation return letter.
You access the balance confirmation run functionality for receivables in the Balance Confirmation Runs subview of the
Periodic Tasks view of the Receivables work center.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Balance Confirmation for Receivables
You can use balance confirmations to check that the receivables from your business partners are correct.
If discrepancies are found, they need to be clarified with the business partner or reserves for bad debt need to be made.
During balance confirmation, you inform your business partner of the individual amounts that need to be confirmed and
request the confirmation.
For more information, see Balance Confirmation for Receivables
Open Items Receivables
You can display open item lists for customer accounts. Open items are posted open invoices from goods and services
or credit memos that were not yet paid. The lists of open items of all customers help you to recognize your customers'
outstanding payments and to collect them in a timely fashion with optimized dunning. You also get an overview for which
customer accounts you still need to edit open items.
For more information, see Open Items Receivables [132]
Reserves for Bad Debt
For year-end closing, you have to check the recoverability of your receivables and valuate them accordingly. By valuating
the receivables individually, the individual credit risk of a customer can be taken into account.
For more information, see Reserves for Bad Debt.
164 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Tasks
Create a Balance Confirmation Run
For more information on this task, see Create a Balance Confirmation Run [103]Create a Balance
Confirmation Run [165].
4.6.6 Create a Balance Confirmation Run
Overview
You can send balance confirmations to compare your data records with those of your suppliers/customers and
consequently identify any inconsistencies. You use balance confirmation runs to schedule balance confirmations on a
frequent and recurring basis. Alternatively, you can perform a manual run as a one-off request. You can create a balance
confirmation run in the Balance Confirmation Runs subview of the Periodic Tasks view of either the Payables or the
Receivables work center.
Procedure
1. To create a new balance confirmation run, click New then Balance Confirmation Run.
2. Select a Type
1. Enter a description for the balance confirmation run.
2. Choose an appropriate balance confirmation type: ● Without Return Letter
This selection enables you to check the accuracy of your accounts payable and receivable using balance
confirmations. You can detect and correct any discrepancies which might exist between your records and
those of your customers or suppliers and make any necessary value adjustments. However, the customer
or supplier does not send a return letter documenting the differences in this case. The balance confirmation
can only be confirmed or rejected. As long as the customer or supplier makes no objections prior to the
cut-off date, your balance is accepted.
● With Return Letter
This selection enables you to contact your customers or suppliers to discuss the details relating to your
open items. Your company issues a letter listing all your open item details. This letter requests that the
customer or supplier confirms whether the data entries agree with each other, or specifies how the accounts
differ using the return letter provided. In this way, you can determine whether your customer and supplier
accounts are up-to-date as well as identify any discrepancies using the information contained in the return
letter.
● Request
This selection enables you to contact your customers or suppliers to check the balance of your accounts
on the side of the customer or supplier. You can request the account balance alone or also detailed
information relating to the balance.
3. Choose Release Immediately if you want to release the confirmation straight away. The balance confirmation
letters are printed automatically once the run has been completed. Alternatively, you can manually check and
release each balance confirmation.
4. Choose whether you want automated or manual selection of customers/suppliers.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 165
3. Enter Restrictions
You can enter the name of the company or the customer/supplier. You can also choose various selection parameters
that include or exclude particular customers or suppliers from the balance confirmation run, depending on the
restriction type that you selected in the previous step.
4. Complete and Confirm Selection
Click Finish to save the balance confirmation run.
When the run has been saved successfully, the Run ID field displays the ID of the new balance confirmation run.
Choose Schedule Balance Confirmation Run.
The Schedule Job editor appears. Here you can schedule and save the run.
Result
The balance confirmation run has now been created and scheduled successfully. You can display the results of the run
in the Balance Confirmation subview of either the Suppliers view in the Payables work center or the Customers view in
the Receivables work center. From this location, you can check and release the balance confirmation.
You can use search criteria, such as the Status or Run ID to search for the balance confirmation that you
want to view.
4.6.7 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Receivables)
You use foreign currency remeasurement to convert open receivables from foreign currencies into the company currency
on a specific key date.
This closing activity is relevant for companies with customers for which the transactions are portrayed in a currency
differing from the company currency. At the time when the amounts of these open receivables originate, you convert
them into the company currency using the exchange rate valid at that time. On the day when the balance sheet is
created, a different exchange rate applies, causing you to have to revaluate the open items. You can repeat the
remeasurement as often as required until the receivables are cleared or written off.
Business Background
Multi-Currency
A currency is the legally recognized means of payment in a given country. A currency has to be specified for every
financial amount in the system. The currencies are specified using the ISO standard form, such as EUR for euros or
USD for US dollars.
For more information, see Currencies.
Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method
You use the foreign currency remeasurement method to set up the various methods for entering foreign currency
remeasurement in accordance with the legal requirements. For each foreign currency remeasurement method, you
define the accounting principles that should be used by the corresponding remeasurement method.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method.
166 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Foreign Currency Remeasurement
If you start the procedure for foreign currency remeasurement, the system automatically makes the relevant postings
and subsequently withdraws postings.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement [82].
Closing Activities — Year-End Closing
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
For more information, see Closing Activities — Year-End Closing.
Important tasks
Check Prerequisites
Before foreign currency remeasurement can be performed, the following prerequisites must be
fulfilled:
● The current exchange rates need to have been entered in the system. For more information,
see Editing Exchange Rates.
● You need to have reclassified the receivables. For more information, see Quick Guide for
Reclassification (Receivables) [169].
● Using account determination, you need to have defined and set up in configuration the
accounts that you want to remeasure. For more information, see Business Configuration of
Account Determination for a Business Transaction.
● You need to have defined how the system is to valuate and post exchange rate differences.
For this, you need to have assigned the appropriate set of books to the foreign currency
remeasurement method. For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement
Method.
Perform Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Receivables
1. To create a new foreign currency remeasurement run, click New and then Foreign
Currency Remeasurement Run.
2. You have the following options for performing foreign currency remeasurement runs: ● Foreign Currency Remeasurement with Reference
To re-use the data from a previous foreign currency remeasurement run, select the
foreign currency remeasurement run that you want to use and click Copy . The
system copies the data directly to the input screen for the new foreign currency
remeasurement run. You can then adjust the data copied from the previously-executed
foreign currency remeasurement run.
● Test RunTo perform the foreign currency remeasurement run as a test run, set the Test Run
indicator. The system previews the results of the test run but does not make any
postings. The postings are only simulated.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 167
You can only delete foreign currency remeasurement runs that you either
scheduled or performed as a test run. To delete a test run, select the run that
you want to delete and click Delete .
● Set of BooksYou can perform the remeasurement for a single set of books or for all sets of books.
If you use multiple sets of books with different fiscal year variants, you should ideally
perform the remeasurement separately for each set of books. The system determines
the key date on the basis of the fiscal year variant of the set of books.
● Business partner IDYou can limit foreign currency remeasurement to receivables for individual customers.
● CurrencyYou can limit foreign currency remeasurement to receivables in specific currencies.
● Closing StepYou select the closing step that you want the system to use when making the postings
on the key date to the corresponding accounting period. This accounting period must
be open for the closing step that you have selected. For more information, see Closing
Steps.
● Period / YearYou select the period and year for which you want to perform foreign currency
remeasurement.
3. Scheduling
You can either perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately or schedule it to occur
later: ● To perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately, click Start Immediately .
You have to wait until the foreground job finishes before you can continue
with your work. This may take several minutes depending upon the data
volume, which can cause the screen to time out. In such a case, you can go
to the main screen for the run and refresh the data. When the run status
changes to Finished, click View to view the logs. Alternatively, you can click
Log Result in the Details section of a finished run.
● To schedule foreign currency remeasurement for a subsequent point in time, click
Schedule and specify the time when the system will perform remeasurement. If you
leave the Date and Time fields empty, the run starts immediately.
You can continue with your work while the system executes the run as a
background job.
You can view scheduled foreign currency remeasurement runs and their respective
times in the subview Foreign Currency Remeasurement under Jobs .
Display and Check Log
1. Display LogIf you have performed foreign currency remeasurement immediately, the system issues a
status message. To display a list of the logs, click Display Log in the status message.
When you have scheduled foreign currency remeasurement, you can display the list of logs
in the Foreign Currency Remeasurement subview after foreign currency remeasurement
has been performed. To do this, choose the relevant foreign currency remeasurement.
168 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
2. Check the LogThe log contains the following information:
● General
Shows the result of the foreign currency remeasurement run, the execution date, any
messages that were issued, and the extent of profit or loss from the valuation.
● Data Selection
Shows the information that you entered at the start of the foreign currency
remeasurement run.
● Messages
Shows a list of all messages that were issued (such as warning messages).
● Postings
Shows all the account movements and journal entries that the system posted for the
key date valuation.
● Processed Successfully
Shows for each remeasured account all the documents with their source document ID,
historical value, and key date value, as well as gains and losses. You can also view the
term over which the valuation was performed.
● Not Remeasured Balances
Shows for each remeasured account the documents that were subject to errors during
processing, for example, no account determination.
To verify whether a run has been completed successfully, you can run the following checks: ● Log
You find a log for a run in the corresponding subview. Each run has a status
(Information, Error). To display the details of a log, select the relevant run and click
Display .
If errors occur during a run, you need to resolve them. You can find information on the
errors on the Messages tab page. Once you have resolved the errors, start the run
again. The system repeats the postings that could not be made in the first run.
● Job MonitorIf a run has not been completed successfully and you cannot find and resolve the cause,
you can display the technical details relating to your run in the Job Monitor. Select the
relevant run and click Display Jobs . If a job finds errors, contact your system
administrator.
4.6.8 Quick Guide for Reclassification (In Receivables)
You use the reclassification of receivables to display your receivables correctly:
The reclassification of payables and receivables is an important closing step. Based on the closing balance for each
single debtor and creditor, and based on the remaining term, the system characterizes the amounts accordingly under
accounts payable for debit amounts, and under accounts receivable for credit amounts. In a second step the system
reclassifies the receivable and payable items by remaining terms (0 – 12 months, 12 – 60 months, > 60 months). A
reclassification can be reversed.
Overdue items are not restructured. They have a remaining term of less than one year.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 169
The intervals for the reclassification are derived automatically on the basis of the accounting principle specified in the
business configuration.
Before you perform the reclassification step, you need to have performed the reserves for bad debt as well as the
allowance for doubtful accounts. The intervals for the reclassification are derived automatically on the basis of the
accounting principle specified in the business configuration.
Business Background
Reclassification
If you start the procedure for reclassification, the system automatically posts the corresponding receivables or payables,
depending on their remaining terms. To do so, the system automatically creates the relevant journal entries.
For more information, see Reclassification [84].
Closing Activities — Year-End Closing
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
For more information, see Closing Activities — Year-End Closing.
Reserves for Bad Debt
For year-end closing, you have to check the recoverability of your receivables and valuate them accordingly.
For more information, see Reserves for Bad Debt.
Allowance for Doubtful Accounts
For year-end closing, you valuate your receivables with regard their general credit risk. On the basis of your business
experience, you determine a percentage for losses on receivables. You apply this percentage to your receivables and
post the general credit risk to a separate account.
For more information, see Allowance for Doubtful Accounts.
Tasks
Perform Reclassification for Receivables
1. To perform a new reclassification, click New and then Reclassification of Receivables.
2. You have the following options for performing reclassifications: ● Reclassification with Reference
To reuse the data from a previous reclassification, select the reclassification that you
want to use and click Copy . The system copies the data directly to the input screen
for the new reclassification. You can then adjust the data copied from the previously-
executed reclassification.
● Test RunTo perform the reclassification as a test run, select Test Run. The system previews the
results of the test run but does not make any postings. The postings are only simulated.
170 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
You can only delete reclassifications that you either scheduled or performed
as a test run. To delete a test run, select the run that you want to delete and
click Delete .
● Set of BooksYou can perform reclassification for a single set of books or for all sets of books.
If you use multiple sets of books with different fiscal year variants, you should ideally
perform the balance carryforward separately for each set of books. The system
determines the key date on the basis of the fiscal year variant of the set of books.
● Closing StepYou select the closing step that you want the system to use when making the postings
on the key date to the corresponding accounting period. This accounting period must
be open for the closing step that you have selected. For more information, see Closing
Steps.
3. SchedulingYou can perform reclassification immediately or schedule it to occur later:
● To perform reclassification immediately, click Start Immediately .
You have to wait until the foreground job finishes before you can continue
with your work. This may take several minutes depending upon the data
volume, which can cause the screen to time out. In such a case, you can go
to the main screen for the run and refresh the data. When the run status
changes to Finished, click View to view the logs. Alternatively, you can click
Log Result in the Details section of a finished run.
● To schedule reclassification for a subsequent point in time, choos Schedule and
indicate when you want the system to perform reclassification. If you leave the Date
and Time fields empty, the run will start immediately.
You can continue with your work while the system executes the run as a
background job.
You can view scheduled reclassifications and their respective times in View Jobs .
● Review the results of the run in the Receivables work center in the Work view under
Reclassification Run Receivables Tasks. Edit the tasks accordingly, click Actions and
click Complete.
● The Reclassification run now appears in the list of finished reclassification runs.
Display and Check Log
1. Display LogIf you have performed reclassification immediately. the system issues a status message.
To display details, click Show Log in the status message.
When you have scheduled reclassification, you can display the list of logs after
reclassification has been performed. To do this, choose the relevant reclassification.
2. Check the LogThe log contains the following information:
● General
Shows the result of the reclassification, the execution date, any messages that were
issued, and the extent of profit or loss from the valuation.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 171
● Data Selection
Shows the information that you entered at the start of the reclassification.
● Messages
Shows a list of all messages that were issued (such as warning messages).
● Postings
Shows all the account movements and journal entries that the system posted for the
key date valuation and the valuation reversal.
You can display the postings for each reconciliation account or sorted by document.
● Processed Successfully
Shows for each reconciliation account all the journal entries with data on the supplier,
journal entry ID, remaining term groups, and the amount in company currency.
● Not Processed
Shows the documents that were subject to errors during processing, for example
because of missing account determination for each reconciliation account.
To verify whether a run has been completed successfully, you can run the following checks: ● Log
You find a log for a run in the corresponding subview. Each run has a status
(Information, Error). To display the details of a log, select the relevant run and click
Display .
If errors occur during a run, you need to resolve them. You can find information on the
errors on the Messages tab page. Once you have resolved the errors, start the run
again. The system repeats the postings that could not be made in the first run.
● Job MonitorIf a run has not been completed successfully and you cannot find and resolve the cause,
you can display the technical details relating to your run in the Job Monitor. Select the
relevant run and click Display Jobs . If a job finds errors, contact your system
administrator.
Perform Reversal of Reclassification for Receivables
If you perform the reversal of a run in an accounting period after the period isclosed, the system allows you to execute the run. At the end of the run, instead of
postings, you will see an error message saying that reversal is not possible because
the closing step for the period has already been performed.
1. Select the run to be reversedSelect the reclassification you want to reverse. The run must be an Update run and must
have Finished as the execution status.
2. Schedule reversal run ● click Reverse . enter a Run Description and schedule it.
3. Review the results of the run in Reclassification Run Receivables Tasks. Edit the tasks
accordingly, click Actions and click Complete.
4. The reversed run now appears in the list of finished reclassification runs.
5. ResultAs a result of reclassification the system posts negative postings or equivalent debit or credit
postings. This is determined by the business configuration.
172 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● If the reversal run for the selected reclassification run is scheduled to a later time, it is
listed in the Receivables work center under the Work view with a blank status. The
status switches to Finished when the run has been performed.
● All the reversed runs have the Reversed indicator set.
● References to the reclassified postings are removed from the line items of the journal
entry of the reversed reclassification.
4.6.9 Quick Guide for Central Bank Reporting
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria, France, and Germany. To ensure that the system
displays the correct text, select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under
Country, choose the relevant country. Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
The Central Bank Reporting subview enables you to report your foreign trade transactions to the authorities. This
information is used in the calculation of the balance of payments for your country. Different regulations apply to central
bank reporting depending on the country.
You can use the Central Bank Reporting subview to manually maintain and prepare this data for central bank reporting
that has been collected from supplier and customer invoicing. In addition to the automated data collection process, it is
possible to manually enter data to the central bank reporting work list.
If there are no entries for your company in the Central Bank Reporting list, your company might not be activated
for central bank reporting. You should check the Central Bank Reporting — Exclusion activity in business
configuration if central bank reporting is deactivated for your company.
Business Background
Central Bank Reporting Exclusion
You can exclude any of your company entities from the system's processing for central bank reporting. When a company
is excluded, no customer or supplier invoicing information is transferred to the Central Bank Reporting worklist and no
central bank reporting tasks are created. For more information, see Central Bank Reporting Exclusion
Tasks
Perform Central Bank Reporting
In the Central Bank Reporting subview of Periodic Tasks, you can perform central bank reporting,
which involves the collection and management of foreign trade transactions. These transactions
are reported to the authorities to create the balance of payments for the respective country. For
more information, see Perform Central Bank Reporting [112].
Edit Central Bank Code Determination Rules
In the Central Bank Code Determination fine tune activity in Business Configuration, you can
assign central bank codes according to the official lists provided by the authorities. The rules can
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 173
also be created or edited in the Central Bank Reporting subview. These rules are used to
determine the default central bank code used for an invoice that has the relevant attributes.
Assigning a Business Partner to an International Organization –Austria
When a business partner belongs to or is considered to be an international development
organization, it is subject to central bank reporting. Trading with this customer or supplier is
subsequently reported to as part of your company’s regular central bank reporting. For more
information, see Determination of International Organizations for Central Bank Reporting –
Austria [117] .
This task is relevant for Austria only.
4.7 Reports
4.7.1 Aging List for Receivables
Overview
This report displays for each customer your overdue receivables according to a specific key date and aging period.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
considers only items with a transaction date before the key date.
● Period 1 through Period 4
You can specify four aging periods to group your overdue receivables. These periods are calculated from the
specified key date. In the default display, the period structure is as follows: 30 days (period 1), 60 days (period 2),
90 days (period 3), 120 days (period 4). This means, for example, that period 2 displays the overdue receivables
with a due date between 31 and 60 days in the past, regardless of whether they are cleared on the current date.
These values can be changed.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
In addition to the overdue receivables, the report also displays for each period the receivables that are not yet due and
the total amount of receivables (the total overdue items and items not yet due).
174 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Customer invoices are displayed as positive amounts.
● Customer credit memos are displayed as negative amounts.
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The net due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can call up the corresponding detailed information for the open items displayed. To do this, select the
appropriate value and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.2 Forecast List for Receivables
Overview
This report displays for each customer your open receivables for which the due date is after the specified key date and
lies in the future. The report also lists open items that your customers need to pay you.
Canceled items are not included.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Forecast List for Receivables - (Standard)Displays the following for each customer: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the net due date (payment target).
● Normal Cash Discount
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 175
Displays the following for each customer: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the due date of the normal cash discount,
as shown in the example below: Cash discount terms 2.
● Maximum Cash DiscountDisplays the following for each customer: the amount already overdue on the key date, future aging periods, total
future due amount, open total amount. The due date calculation refers to the due date of the maximum cash
discount, as shown in the example below: Cash discount terms 1.
You receive an invoice dated 01.07.09 with the following payment terms:
● 1) Payment within eight days: 3 % cash discount
● 2) Payment within 14 days: 2% cash discount
● 3) Payment within 30 days: Net
This means that there are three possible due dates for this invoice:
● Cash discount term 1) (maximum cash discount): Can be paid up to 09.07.09
● Cash discount term 2) (normal cash discount): Can be paid up to 15.07.09
● Net (payment target: term 3): Can be paid up to 31.07.09
The system displays different net amount and aging periods for the invoice, depending on the view you select.
Depending on the view used, the invoices are grouped by net due date, due date with normal cash discount, or due
date with maximum cash discount.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
considers only items with a transaction date before the key date.
● Period 1 through Period 4
You can specify four aging periods to group your receivables due at a future date. These periods are calculated
from the specified key date. In the default display, the period structure is as follows: 30 days (period 1), 60 days
(period 2), 90 days (period 3), 120 days (period 4). This means, for example, that period 2 displays the receivables
due from day 31 through 60 after the specified key date. These values can be changed.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
In addition to the items due for each period in the future, the report displays the receivables overdue on the key date
and the total amount of all open items (total overdue and not yet due items).
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Customer invoices are displayed as positive amounts.
● Customer credit memos are displayed as negative amounts.
176 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From the open items, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value and open
the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.3 Dunning History - Customers
Overview
This report shows for each customer a detailed dunning history of all overdue payment items.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
For each customer, the report shows the number of overdue payment items, the dunning date, dunning status, highest
dunning level, dunning amount, and the accrued dunning fees. The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 177
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can call up the corresponding detailed information for the items displayed. To do this, select the appropriate
value and open the corresponding menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.4 Dunning History - Documents
Overview
This report shows each customer's detailed dunning history using individual documents.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). When doing so, note
the following:
● Key Date
The current date is specified in the default display. The system deals only with dunning notices that were created
up to the selected date.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Overdue payment items can be dunned in accordance with the configured steps. If all the steps have been
performed, the affected items will not be selected in an additional dunning run. We advise against using these
items in an additional dunning document to prevent the previous correspondence from becoming invalid. A
company would then usually take legal action.
You can use this report to determine any overdue payment items. On the variable screen, specify the dunning
date up to which you want to perform the search. Use the free characteristics to copy the Dunning Level field
to the lines displayed and sort this field in descending order starting with the greatest value displayed at the
top of the list.
Analyzing the Report
For each customer, the report shows the document numbers, due date, the period of time in days that items are overdue
at the time the dunning notice is sent, and the dunning amount. The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
178 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can call up the corresponding detailed information for the items displayed. To do this, select the appropriate
value and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.5 Dunning Statistics
Overview
This report shows your company's dunning activities for each customer . In this way, you can track all your customers'
overdue payment items in detail.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Business Partner
You can restrict the display to one customer, which you can choose using the input help.
● Entry Date
The system takes the previous two weeks as the default value for the documents entered.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report provides you with details on your dunning activities, including the total receivables amount for each customer,
overdue receivables from this amount, the dunning level, and dunning amount. Furthermore, the report shows the
number of dunning items as well as items and amounts sent to the legal department. The following statistical information
is also provided:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 179
● Dunning amount statistics: The value displayed is calculated from the dunning amount divided by the receivables
amount.
● Statistics from the legal department: The value displayed is calculated from the portion of the dunning amount that
was sent to the legal department, then divided by the total dunning amount.
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● You can call up the corresponding detailed information for the items displayed. To do this, select the appropriate
value and open the corresponding menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.6 Details to Items of Customers
Overview
This report lists all items for a customer for a particular period.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). Some variables are
explained below:
● Entry Date
The system takes the previous two weeks as the default value for the documents entered.
● Item Status
You can restrict the display to a specific item status, such as open, cleared, or unassigned. For this, use the input
help.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays for each item the full document amount as well as any cash discount available or taken, and amounts
outstanding. The dunning level is also displayed for any overdue items. The data in this report is displayed in table
format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
180 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From each customer displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.7 Details to Open Items of Customers
Overview
This report lists the open items of a customer for a specific key date.
Canceled items are not included.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Open Item List – Customers (Standard)Displays for each customer all the open items for a specific key date as well as information about any cash discount
available or taken.
● Open Item List – All Items By CustomersDisplays a list of all the open items by document number in ascending order.
● Open Item List – Summary By CustomersShows the total number of open items for all or a selection of customers.
● Open Item List – ReconciliationDisplays the open items for each customer and transaction currency.
You use this view for technical reconciliation on the basis of the Accounts Payable Reconciliation report. For
more information, see Accounts Payable Reconciliation.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 181
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data that you want to display by selecting variables. You must specify a value
for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*). When doing so, note
the following:
● Key Date
The key date always corresponds to the transaction date of the open items and not to the posting date. The system
displays only items with a transaction date before the key date.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
Note the following for the individual document types:
● Customer invoices are displayed as negative amounts.
● Customer credit memos are displayed as positive amounts.
● Payments do not have a specific due date. The net due date displayed therefore corresponds to the
transaction date.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From each customer displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
To be able to navigate to the source document, add the following characteristics to the report:
● Source Document Type
● Document Number and/or External Reference
You must insert Source Document Type to the left of Document Number and External Reference.
You can then navigate to the source document from Document Number or External Reference.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
182 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
4.7.8 Customer List
Overview
The customer list shows a list of all the customers that are in the system.
You can view various data for customers, such as:
● Business partner ID and name
● Address data
● Status
● Creation date
● User who created the record
4.7.9 Account Financial Data
Overview
Provides an overview of financial data for accounts that can be used by sales managers and representatives for a
synopsis of their account master data. It provides financial data, such as payment data, bank data, and credit card data,
along with information about the related accounts.
Prerequisites
You have selected the report in your solution configuration. To find this business option, go to the Business
Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click
Edit Project Scope . In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Business Partners is selected within General Business
Data.
In the Questions step, expand the General Business Data scoping element and select Business Partners. Select
Reporting and Analytics for Business Partners and answer the question related to the reports for accounts.
Views
The following views are available with this report:
● Account Payment Data
Displays payment data, such as the company ID, the account determination group, and the payment block reason.
This view is also the pre-delivered default view of the report.
● Account Bank Data
Displays bank data, such as the bank and the bank account data.
● Account Credit Card Data
Displays credit card data, such as the type, the holder, and the expiration date of the credit card.
● Account Tax Data
Displays tax data, such as the tax type, the tax number, and the tax number type.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 183
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables.
The following variables are available for this report:
● Company
● Account
● City
● Country
● Status
Analyzing the Report
The report displays the following data:
● Payment data for an account, including the following: ○ Company ID
○ Account determination group
○ Payment block reason
○ Payment block expiry date
○ Dunning block reason
○ Dunning block expiry date
○ Credit limit amount
● Bank data for an account, including the following: ○ Bank country
○ Bank name
○ National bank code
○ IBAN
○ Bank account number
○ Bank account holder
○ Bank account validity period
● Credit card data for an account, including the following: ○ Credit card type
○ Credit card token
○ Credit card holder
○ Credit card expiration date
○ Credit card blocking reason
○ Indication of whether a credit card is the default credit card for the account
● Tax data for an account, including the following: ○ Tax type
184 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
○ Tax number
○ Tax number type
○ Tax exemption reason
○ Country of the tax number
○ Country of the tax exemption
● Basic data of the related account, including the following: ○ Account name and ID
○ Address data
To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
See Also
Overview of Reports in General Business Data
Overview of Data Sources in General Business Data
Reports View
4.7.10 SEPA Mandate List
Overview
The report displays an overview of the SEPA mandates that have been created within your company to enable you to
collect payments from your customers under the SEPA direct debit scheme.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. Additional
information is available for the following selected variables:
● Mandate ID
You can restrict the display to specific mandates. You can use the input help to select one or more mandate IDs.
● Mandate Type
You can make a selection using the input help to restrict the display to a specific mandate type. If you want to see
information on mandates from private individuals only, choose “SEPA Core” from the value help. If you want to
evaluate mandate information for corporate accounts, choose “SEPA B2B”.
● Status
You can restrict the display to mandates with a specific status. This status indicates, for example, whether a
mandate can currently be used.
Statuses include: ○ In Preparation
○ Waiting for Confirmation
○ Active
○ Canceled
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 185
○ Obsolete
Analyzing the Report
This report displays all SEPA mandates for your company together with their respective data, such as the date on which
they were last used or whether they are currently blocked for payments.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, click on the filter symbol and select the required values.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From this report, you can navigate to any mandate document by clicking on its mandate ID.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
4.7.11 Accounts Receivable – Pledging of Open Items
Overview
You can use this report to show all items that are pledged as collateral. These can be particular open items or if a
customer account is pledged, all open items of this customer are marked.
This report is relevant for Austria only.
Views
The following view is available with this report:
Receivables – Pledging of Open Items
Shows all items for each G/L account and customer. By default, all open and partially cleared items are displayed. If an
item is pledged, the related pledging ID and pledging description are given.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
● StatusYou can specify the status of the line items. By default, open and partially cleared line items are displayed, but you
can also display items that have already been cleared.
● Pledging ID
186 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Receivables
If a customer account or open item has been pledged as collateral, the related pledging ID is shown. If the item is
not pledged, then a hash symbol (#) is displayed.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management. You can save
the entries you make on the selection screen as a variant . You can then reuse that variant the next time you run this
report.
Analyzing the Report
The report is displayed in table format. You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● From each line item displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu. In this way, you can display the relevant entry in the journal for a line item as
well as the corresponding documents.
See Also
Accounts Receivable - Open Items
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Receivables PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 187
5 Payment Management
5.1 Business Background
5.1.1 Payment Allocation and Clearing
Overview
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
You perform manual payment allocations from the Payment Management work center, in the Payment Allocation view.
You perform manual payment clearing from the Payment Clearing view of either the Payables or the Receivables work
centers, for customer and supplier payments respectively. These tasks can also be accessed from the Work view of the
relevant work center.
Payment allocation typically involves the assignment of a payment to a particular payment area, such as accounts
payable, accounts receivable, or tax. The payment is then assigned to a particular business partner, such as a supplier,
customer, or tax authority, within that area.
Payment clearing then takes place, where the payment is matched with an open item and both are cleared. The system
uses business partner and payment reference information, such as an invoice number, payment amount, and bank
account to first select the correct business partner and then the correct open item. In some cases, due payment date
and payment method are also used in this process. If all the relevant information is available and correct, then the
payment allocation and the payment clearing will be performed automatically by the system.
Manual Payment Allocation Scenarios
In some cases, the automatic process described above is not possible. The different scenarios where this might occur
are outlined here:
● Missing business partner information
● Incorrect electronic bank statement configuration
● Transaction charges on foreign payments
● Bank charges or interest in bank statement
Missing Customer and Supplier Information
Payments can be received with missing customer or supplier information due to several reasons: a payment could be
received from a third party payer, who has paid an open invoice on behalf of a customer. This might be a parent or
subsidiary company of that customer, for example. If this payer party is not recorded in the customer master data record,
then manual allocation of the payment to the customer will be required. Similarly, the customer or supplier information
might be lost or corrupted at some point prior to the payment being received. Payment advices can also be affected by
these problems.
188 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
If a bank statement exists with an unknown bank account ID, the system performs a search based on invoice numbers
in the note to payee. If a suitable invoice number is found, the payment is posted to the corresponding customer or
supplier.
Incorrect Electronic Bank Statement Configuration
Payment notification can be received in the form of bank statement line items, informing you that a payment has been
made to one of your bank accounts. If electronic bank statement files are used for this purpose, the import format used
for the file must be configured so that the bank transaction code used by your bank for a particular payment method,
for example a bank transfer, corresponds to the bank transaction code your company uses for that payment method. If
these codes are not recorded correctly in your system, then the payments that have incorrect codes must be manually
allocated to the relevant business partner. You define your transaction codes in the Business Configuration work center,
in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management -> Import Formats for Bank Statements.
For more information, see Import Formats for Bank Statements.
Transaction Charges on Foreign Payments
In cases where payments involve business partners in other countries, your bank may charge handling or processing
fees, depending on the payment method involved and your arrangements with the bank. If these payments are received
or confirmed by bank statement, then these transaction charges can be included in the bank statement line item for
each payment. In this situation, a manual payment allocation task will be created. The charges are posted to the relevant
general ledger account using this task, and the balance of the payment is allocated to the relevant business partner.
Bank Charges or Interest in Bank Statement
If a bank statement contains bank charge or interest line items, then manual payment allocation of these items is
required. However, in this situation, the payment allocation does not involve a business partner, but instead the charges
or interest are posted directly on the relevant general ledger account. A manual payment allocation task will be created
so this posting can be performed. Rent payments made by direct debit are also handled in this way.
Manual Payment Clearing Scenarios
Once payment allocation (manual or automatic) has been performed, a manual payment clearing task may be required,
in the following circumstances:
● Missing payment reference
● Payment difference
● Payment made before invoice is received
Missing Payment Reference
It is possible for a payment to be received without reference to the open item(s) that should be paid by that payment.
Similarly, business partners may process externally initiated outgoing payments from your company without including
payment reference information. Payment references can also be incorrect or include transposed digits. Payment advices
can also be affected by these problems. Should these situations arise, the system will create a manual payment clearing
task, so the payments or advices can be matched with the correct open items, and both can be cleared.
Payment Difference
Payment and invoice amounts do not always match: incorrect discounts may be applied to payments, or other deductions
might be made from payment amounts, for example due to a dispute or a credit memo. Sometimes simply the wrong
payment amount might be processed. In cases such as this a manual payment clearing task might be created, depending
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 189
on the settings of your clearing strategy, if the payment tolerance is exceeded by the payment difference. You define a
payment tolerance as part of your clearing strategy in the Business Configuration work center, in the Activity List view.
In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management -> Clearing Strategy. For more information, see Configuration:
Clearing Strategies.
Payment Made Before Invoice is Received
Under certain circumstances, a payment can appear in the system before the corresponding invoice does. This can
occur when a supplier processes an outgoing payment by direct debit, and then issues the invoice for the payment.
Similarly, a customer may purchase a product online and pay immediately, but only receive an invoice with the shipped
item. In these situations a manual payment clearing task will be created, as the system will not be able to find a matching
invoice for the payments involved.
Influence of Payment Type on Manual Allocation and Clearing
The table below outlines the relationship between the type of payment involved (internally or externally initiated, incoming
or outgoing) and the most likely reasons for a manual payment allocation or clearing task. Manual tasks for incoming
internally initiated payments are so exceptional that it is not possible to predict a reason these tasks might occur.
Reasons for Manual Tasks by Payment Type
Payment Type Manual Payment Allocation Scenario Manual Payment Clearing Scenario
Incoming internally initiated (credit card ordirect debit)
Unable to predict Unable to predict
Incoming externally initiated (check orbank transfer)
Missing business partner information orincorrect electronic bank statementconfiguration
All scenarios possible
Outgoing internally initiated (check orbank transfer)
Incorrect electronic bank statementconfiguration
Payment difference
Outgoing externally initiated (credit cardor direct debit)
Missing business partner information Payment difference
5.1.2 Credit Card Chargebacks
As accounts receivable accountant it is your task to process your company's national and international payment
transactions made with customers and other accounts receivable. This includes incoming payments as well as
processing credit memos or customer-initiated chargebacks to their credit cards. The following sections explain these
two scenarios.
Prerequisites
In the customer master data, you have specified payment by credit card as the payment method.
You have entered a customer order invoice and specified payment by credit card as the payment method. In this step,
you have checked the authorization of the credit card payment.
The chargeback can be made if the customer payment has already been received, or the customer can initiate the
termination of the transaction by the credit card company before the payment has been transferred.
190 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
In the fine-tuning phase, the approval of company-initiated payments is defined in two tables to differentiate
clearly between incoming or outgoing credit card payments.
For more information, see Refund of Payments Received [144].
Process Flow
The following sections explain the procedure for charging back credit card payments. We can differentiate between two
scenarios:
● A credit memo you have initiated to the customer's credit card account
● A chargeback requested directly from the credit card company by the customer
Scenario 1
A customer lodges a complaint about goods received and returns them to your company. You make an agreement with
the customer to post a credit memo to the credit card account. You inform the customer's credit card company that the
amount needs to be posted back to the customer account.
Credit Memo Posting to the Credit Card Account
The customer has made a payment and this payment has been received. You want to create a credit memo for the
customer and post the amount to the credit card account.
1. Navigate to the Customer Invoicing work center and choose the Invoices and Credit Memos view.
2. Select your released invoice and choose Follow-Up Manual Credit Memo . Click Release.
3. Navigate to the Receivables work center and choose Customers Customer Accounts . Select your customer
account and click View Account. The Customer Account Monitor: <Name - Customer ID> screen is displayed.
4. Select the credit memo and choose Pay Manually By Other Payment Methods . On the New Manual
Payment screen, click Close.
You can specify that this process runs automatically by selecting the Receivables work center and
choosing Periodic Tasks Payment Runs . The payment is then initiated in the payment run.
5. If the payment needs to be approved, navigate in your role as manager to the Managing My Area work center and
choose the Approvals view. Select the payment and click Edit. Click Approve.
6. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Monitor view. Select the outgoing credit
card payment and choose Actions for Credit Card Settle .
You can specify that this process runs automatically by selecting the Payment Management work center
and choosing Periodic Tasks Credit Card Settlement Runs . The credit card payment is then
initiated during this run.
7. Create the bank statement for the outgoing payment in the Liquidity Management work center in the Bank
Statements view. Choose New Bank Statement .
8. On the Bank Statement: <Number> screen in the step Enter General Data, enter in the Closing Balance field the
difference between the opening balance and the outgoing amount and then click Next twice.
Alternatively, the bank statement can be imported automatically using a file.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 191
9. In the Create and Edit Items step, click Add Row. In the Payment Method column, choose Outgoing Bank
Transfer and enter the outgoing amount in the Debit Amount column. Click Release.
10.Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Allocation view. Select the Bank
Statement with In Preparation status in the payment allocation and click Edit.
11.On the Payment Allocation: <Number> screen, choose the Payment Assignment tab and select the payment. Copy
this payment to the lower screen area using the down arrow. Click Release.
12.In the Payment Management work center in the Payment Monitor view, you can now view the payment with
Confirmed status.
Scenario 2
A customer initiates the chargeback of a payment directly with the credit card company. You are informed about this
chargeback in the bank statement or the credit card settlement from the credit card company.
Customer-Initiated Chargeback With the Credit Card Company
The customer may request that a payment is charged back to a credit card after you have already received the payment.
The credit card company initiates the chargeback from your account. You can view the cash withdrawal on the bank
statement. We can differentiate between two situations: In the first case, the incoming payment has already been
confirmed by the bank on the bank statement. The next statement received from the bank contains the outgoing payment.
In the second case, both the incoming and outgoing payments are included on the same bank account statement.
However, the credit card company can cancel the payment even if no payments have been made to your account at a
particular time. In this case, you will be informed online using a payment advice or credit card settlement.
The following section explains the procedure to be followed if you receive a credit card payment for an existing bank
statement and this payment needs to be posted back.
1. You create a bank statement using the outgoing payment. Navigate to the Liquidity Management work center and
choose the Bank Statements view. Choose New Bank Statement .
2. On the Bank Statement: <Number> screen in the step Enter General Data, enter in the Closing Balance field the
difference between the opening balance and the outgoing amount and then click Next twice.
3. In the Create and Edit Items step, click Add Row. In the Payment Method column, choose Outgoing Bank
Transfer and enter the outgoing amount in the Debit Amount column. Click Release.
4. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Allocation view. Select the bank statement
and click Edit. On the Payment Allocation: <Number> screen, choose the Payment Assignment tab.
5. Select the confirmed payment using the dropdown list options Display All Payments Confirmed By Bank .
You can then copy this payment to the lower screen area using the down arrow. The indicator in the Payment
Returned column is set automatically. Click Release.
6. The outgoing payment is now displayed in the Payment Management work center in the Payment Monitor view
with a negative amount and Returned status.
The following section explains the procedure used if the incoming payment and the outgoing payment that was posted
back are both listed on the same statement issued by the bank.
1. You create a bank statement using your incoming and outgoing payments. Navigate to the Liquidity
Management work center and choose the Bank Statements view. Choose New Bank Statement .
2. Enter the closing balance of your bank statement on the Bank Statement: <Number> screen in the Enter General
Data step. For the following example, this balance corresponds to the opening balance plus the incoming payment
amount. Click Next twice.
192 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
3. In the Create and Edit Items step, click Add Row. In the Payment Method column, choose Outgoing Bank
Transfer and enter the outgoing amount in the Debit Amount column. This amount is derived from all the incoming
credit card payments and the outgoing payment (chargeback) that are included on the bank statement. Click
Release.
4. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Allocation view. Select the bank statement
and click Edit.
5. On the Payment Allocation: <Number> screen, choose the Payment Assignment tab and select all the incoming
credit card payments that belong to the total amount entered on the bank statement. Copy this payment to the lower
screen area using the down arrow. For the payment that was charged back, set the indicator in the Payment
Returned column. Click Release.
6. You can now view your incoming and outgoing payments in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view. The status of the incoming payments is Confirmed and for the outgoing or charged back payment
Returned.
The following section explains the procedure used if your credit card company sends you a payment advice informing
you that the transaction has been cancelled and therefore the transfer cannot be executed.
1. The status of the payment is In Transfer and can be checked in the Payment Management work center in the
Payment Monitor view.
2. Go to the Liquidity Management work center. In the Bank Payment Advices view, choose New Bank Payment
Advice . Enter the following data and then click Release: ● Advice Type: Bank Credit Advice
● Payment Method: Credit Card
● Payment Amount: 0,00
● Payment Confirmed: Set the indicator.
● Account: Choose the account for the incoming payment.
3. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose the Payment Allocation view. Select the payment
allocation for the payment advice and click Edit.
4. On the Payment Allocation: <Number> screen, choose the Payment Assignment tab. Select the incoming credit
card payment that was returned and copy this to the lower screen area using the down arrow. Set the indicator in
the Payment Returned column. Click Release.
5. The payment that was cancelled is now displayed in the Payment Management work center in the Payment
Monitor view with the status Returned.
See Also
Automatic Incoming Payments [35]
Manual Incoming Payments [40]
Quick Guide for Returns
5.1.3 Cash Outpayments - Switzerland
This document contains text that is relevant for Switzerland. To ensure that the system displays the correct
text, select Personalize —>My Settings. Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose Switzerland.
Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 193
5.2 Payment Monitor View
5.2.1 Payment Monitor Quick Guide
In the Payment Monitor view, you can track and maintain all your company's incoming and outgoing payments. You can
filter the payments by date, by payee, or by status, for example, to show obsolete payments which have been canceled,
returned, or rejected payments. You can create new payments, or enter payments that are created manually or outside
of the system. You can also view payment details for each item. These details vary depending on the payment method
and status of the payment, for example, deposit data for incoming checks, or the reason why a check was voided.
You can access the Payment Monitor view from the Payment Management work center or from the Liquidity
Management work center under Payment Monitor.
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31].
Outgoing Payments
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Bank Transfers
You can use bank transfers to make both automatic and manual outgoing payments. There are two types of bank
transfer: bank transfers, which are used to make payments from a company account to third-party accounts; and bank-
to-bank transfers, which are used to transfer funds between company bank accounts. These are used mainly for
transfers relating to liquidity management.
For more information, see Bank Transfers [255].
Liquidity Check
A liquidity check is performed each time an outgoing payment is created to verify that there are sufficient funds available
to facilitate the payment.
194 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
The liquidity check is performed for all outgoing payments created in the Payables, Receivables, Liquidity
Management, and Payment Management work centers. This includes the following payment methods:
● Outgoing Wire Transfer
● Outgoing Bank Transfer
● Outgoing Check
● Bill of Exchange Payable
No liquidity check is performed for tax payments and cash transfers.
For more information, see Liquidity Check [268].
Electronic Payment Formats
You use the Electronic Payment Format feature to select the relevant file formats for the automated process of
transmitting electronic payments to your bank(s).
For more information, see Electronic Payment Formats [274].
Manual Payment Formats
When you create an outgoing payment the system needs to communicate this information to the bank. In most cases,
this is communicated directly to the bank using electronic data exchange, (for direct debits and wire transfers) or an
electronic payment file (for bank transfers). The system uses payment formats as a medium to communicate the payment
information to the bank.
For more information about the electronic payment formats used by the system see Electronic Payment Formats
[274]
However, the system can also create outgoing payments without using the payment formats defined in the system.
These payments are created using manual payment formats.
The manual payment format can be used for outgoing payments that use the following payment methods:
● Bank Transfer
● Wire Transfer
● Direct Debits
For more information, see Manual Payment Formats [275].
Cash and Liquidity Management
The Cash and Liquidity Management business scenario enables financial professionals at midsize companies to
quickly and efficiently meet cash flow deadlines and achieve better transparency in managing the company's liquidity
position. It comprises cash flow information from payables and receivables and tax, as well as payment and liquidity
management, and streamlines your daily cash management cycle by automatically collecting and aggregating this
information. This scenario covers the cash flow management cycle from the actual liquidity snapshot to forecasting, and
analyzes steps through to optimized cash flow from money transfers or other cash flow impacting strategies.
For more information, see Cash and Liquidity Management.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 195
Tasks
Create a New Payment
1. Click New Payment By , then choose the appropriate payment method. You can create the
following types of payments: ● Incoming Check
● Outgoing Check
● Outgoing Bank Transfer
● Outgoing Wire Transfer
● Multiple Checks
2. Enter the relevant details for the payment method you selected. These details vary
depending on the payment method selected. Mandatory fields are indicated by an asterisk
(*).
3. Payments can be created with reference to an open item, customer, or supplier account, or
they can be posted directly to a general ledger account.
For selected incoming and outgoing payment types you can optionally define in the
configuration settings whether approval tasks should be generated for this work center
for specific payment methods and when you exceed a defined threshold amount. You
find these settings in fine-tuning under Business Task Management for Payment and
Liquidity.
Monitor Payment Allocation Processing
For more information on this activity, see here [259].
Create a New Outgoing Bank Transfer
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
You can also perform this task in the Payables work center, Supplier Account
Monitor view.
2. Click New Payment By , then Outgoing Bank Transfer.
3. Enter the relevant details for the bank transfer. The following fields are mandatory, as
indicated by an asterisk (*): Company ID, Payment Amount, Payee, Payee Bank, and select
a bank account ID to make the payment from.
If you do not wish to perform a liquidity check on the bank account before the
transfer is posted , select the Liquidity Allocation Not Required checkbox. For
information about liquidity checks, see Liquidity Check [268].
4. Click Complete Bank Data . The system automatically fills the other fields, where possible.
For example, if you have not selected a bank account in the Bank Account ID field, the
system automatically chooses the optimum bank account . To enter further details such as
196 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
payment instructions, or to change the type of bank transfer, for example to international
bank transfer, click View All to display all available fields.
Payment instructions are additional services provided by your bank that may
increase the security of the transaction, for example, calling the recipient bank
with notification of a payment. These services are only available for international
bank transfers. Your bank will inform you of the payment instructions it offers and
any additional fees they charge for using them.
If the bank transfer has already been completed outside the system, you do not need to
create a payment file. If you do not wish to create a payment file for this bank transfer, select
the Create Payment Manually check box. You can also choose the bearer of the bank
charges arising from the transfer.
If you do not want to execute the bank transfer immediately, you can enter the date that you
want the bank to execute the transaction in the Bank Processing Date field. If you click
Complete Bank Data after you enter this date, the system automatically fills the Expected
Bank Value Date and Posting Date fields.
5. Select whether you wish to allocate the transfer to open items or post it directly to the general
ledger account without allocating the payment. ● To allocate the bank transfer to open items, choose Reference to Items. The system
displays open items for the supplier or customer account. You can then match the bank
transfer to these open items. You can also add discounts to these items.
If you want to pay items on behalf of another customer or supplier, click Accounts then
Add Account. Now you can also choose from the open items belonging to the account
you selected in addition.
For more information on how to edit your open items, see Using the Open Items Table
[93].
● To use this bank transfer to make a payment that is not matched to any open items,
choose Direct Posting to G/L Account. Select a country and choose the entry type
Gross or Net. Click Add Row to manually assign the payment to the relevant general
ledger account. You can also enter a memo line in the bank transfer.
6. Click Post . The bank transfer is displayed in the Payment Monitor work center view with
the status Ready for Transfer.
7. A payment file must be created in the appropriate file format to be made available to the
bank or banking software for processing. This can be done automatically using a payment
file media run. For information on how to create a payment media run, see Create Payment
Media Run [238].
To create the file manually for transmission to the bank, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Monitor view, select the relevant bank transfer, and click
Actions for Bank Transactions , then Create Payment File.
2. Go to the File Management work center view, Outbound Files subview, select the new
payment file, and click Edit .
3. From the Outgoing File screen, go to the Attachment tab and select the payment file.
To download the file from the browser window to your computer, click Download .
This document contains text that is relevant for Austira only. To ensure that the system displays
the correct text, select Personalize> My Settings. Select the Onscreen Help and choose Austria
in the Country drop-down menu. Save your settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 197
Create an Outgoing Check
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
You can also perform this task in the Payables work center, Supplier Account
Monitor view.
2. Click New Payment By , then Outgoing Check to open the New Outgoing Check screen.
3. Enter the appropriate data for the fields Company ID, Payment Amount, and Payee.
4. Click Complete Bank Data . The system fills the Bank Account ID and Bank Name fields
automatically.
5. Ensure the Reference to Items radio button is selected, so you can match the check with
the appropriate open item. All open items on the customer or supplier account should appear
in the Open Items table, if you have previously entered the Payee. Select one or more open
items to be paid by the check using the Matched indicator.
Discounts or credits can be applied to the open items, if necessary, to ensure the payment
amount matches the open item amount by clicking Actions , then
Apply Discount or Credit .
For more information on how to edit your open items, see Using the Open Items Table
[93].
If the check you are issuing is not related to a customer or supplier account, select
the Direct posting to G/L Account radio button, then select an appropriate general
ledger account to which the check should be posted. You would do this if your
company wished to make a charitable donation, for example.
6. To save your check, click Post .
7. To manually print a check to send to the recipient, click Actions for Checks , then Print
Check Form.
Outgoing checks are printed automatically by the system on a regular basis. If you
create a check outside of the system, you can stop printing for the check (based
on the check information you enter into the system) by selecting the Set as
Manually Created indicator.
To void a check, for example if the check form is damaged in the printer and you need
to print a new one, click Actions for Checks , then Void. This option is possible while
the check has the status In Transfer. Note that voiding a check does not cancel the
payment; it simply invalidates the old check and generates a new check number. To
cancel a check, click Reverse . Note that you can only cancel a check while it has the
status Ready for Transfer.
For more information, see Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checkes [257].
Enter an Incoming Check
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
2. Click New Payment By , then Incoming Check to open the New Incoming Check screen.
198 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
To enter more than one new check, click New Payment By , then Multiple
Checks to open the New Multiple Checks screen. Note that with this action you
are not able to clear open items.
3. Enter the relevant payment details, including the data for the fields Payer, Check Number,
Payment Amount , and select the correct currency from the dropdown list next to the amount.
Enter other information as required.
4. Under Payment Application Method, select whether you wish to allocate the check amount
to open items or post it directly to the general ledger account without allocating the payment. ● To allocate the check to open items, choose Reference to Items. The system displays
open items for the supplier or customer account. You can then match the check to these
open items. You can also add discounts to these items.
● To use this check to make a payment that is not matched to any open items, choose
Direct Posting to G/L Account. Select a country and choose the Entry Type. Click Add
Row to manually assign the payment to the relevant General Ledger account.
5. Click Post to save and post the new check. If you want to create more than one check you
can also use the Post and New button. The new check is saved in the system and added
to the payments listed in the Payment Monitor view.
Work with an Existing Payment
Depending on the payment method used for each payment, several editing options are available,
which influence the status of the payment or the payment itself.
1. Select the relevant payment and click Edit . The relevant screen for the selected payment
type opens.
2. To prevent the payment from being completed, click Reverse .
3. To create a remittance advice for the selected payment, provided the payment method
supports remittance advice, click Create Remittance Advice .
Depending on the status of each payment, it may not be possible to edit or reverse
the payment, or to issue a remittance advice.
4. In addition to the general functions listed above, each payment method has additional
possible actions: ● Actions for Checks
○ Set To in Transfer: Indicates that a paper check has already been created for the
payment.
○ Void: Cancels the specific check that has been issued, and leaves the open payment
in the system so that a new check can be issued.
○ Assign to Deposit: Adds the check to an appropriate check deposit, so it can be sent
to the bank.
○ Print Check Form: Instructs the system to print a check letter for the check.
○ Renumber: Allows a new check number to be assigned to a check, for example, due
to a mismatch between the check number in the system and the number printed on
the check.
○ Toggle: Switches the check numbers of two selected checks.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 199
○ Set to Not Transferred: Indicates that a check has not yet been sent to a bank or
customer or supplier, so that it can be reissued. This may be necessary if a check
was incorrectly printed, for example.
● Actions for Bank Transactions ○ Create Payment File: Sends the payment file that will be sent to the bank to the
Liquidity Management work center. The payment file will be created in the next
scheduled payment media run if this action is not used.
○ Set to in Transfer: Indicates that the transfer has already taken place, using online
banking or a money transfer service, for example.
○ Set to Not Transferred: Indicates that a transfer has not yet been sent to a bank or
business partner, so that it can be reissued. This may be necessary if the payment
file was incorrectly transferred or was corrupted.
● Actions for Credit Cards ○ Settle: Settles a credit card payment that has not already been transferred.
5.3 Payment Allocation View
5.3.1 Quick Guide for Payment Allocation
In the Payment Allocation view, you can track payments and remittance advices that require manual payment allocation.
This situation applies when the system cannot allocate payments to a customer or supplier using the available data, for
example. You can use this view to manually allocate payments or payment advices to particular customers, suppliers,
or business transactions. The process of manual payment allocation incorporates additional allocations, such as posting
bank charges or entering a line item directly on a G/L account. It is essential that your payments are allocated correctly
so that the status of all your payment items is kept up-to-date.
Payment allocation takes place before the clearing process whereby payments are matched to open items, which
consequently clears open payable or receivables.
You can access this view from the Payment Management work center.
Business Background
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
200 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31]
Outgoing Payments
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Tasks
Allocate a Payment Manually
For more information on this task, see here [202].
Reverse a Payment
1. If you want to reverse a payment that was debited incorrectly from your account or if a credit
memo was posted by mistake, for example, select the appropriate allocation (the preceding
document is the bank statement) and click Edit .
2. In the Edit Payment Allocation editor under Allocation Details, select an appropriate Return
Reason from the dropdown list.
3. Choose Actions Mark as Return . The system creates a reimbursement item, which
is displayed in the payment monitor. It is easier to display the item by going to the Payment
Monitor view to the Advanced area, where you can choose the payment method OutgoingRefund of Incoming Payment or Outgoing Refund of Outgoing Payment.Inform your bank that you want to reverse the debit or credit memo postings on your account,
since the system cannot trigger this activity automatically.
4. Once the bank has credited or debited the appropriate amount on your account and
confirmed this on your bank statement, you can allocate the reimbursement item in the
Payment Allocation view. You can find this item in the Edit Payment Allocation: <ID> editor
on the Payment Assignment tab. From the dropdown list, choose Show Returned
Payments . Release the allocation when you have finished processing.
Add a Memo Line Analysis Rule
For more information on this task, see here [203].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 201
5.3.2 Allocate a Payment Manually
Overview
If the system is not able to allocate a payment automatically, it cannot release it. This can be because information is
missing that the system requires to allocate a payment, such as a customer or supplier, open item, or account. For this
reason, you have to make the allocation manually and then release. The process of manual payment allocation
incorporates additional allocations, such as posting bank charges or entering a line item directly on a G/L account.
Prerequisites
An externally initiated payment was entered that the system cannot allocate automatically. The payment can be both
an incoming and outgoing payment.
Procedure
1. In the Payment Management work center, under Payment Allocation, select the allocation that you want to edit and
click Edit . Alternatively, you can call up the required allocation task using the Work view. In both cases, the same
entry screen appears.
The details of the original payment, note to payee, and other known details about the respective preceding document
(for example, check, bank statement, payment advice) are displayed on the Edit Payment Allocation editor on the
Original Payment tab at the top of the screen. Information is displayed about related payment media, bank statement
or payment advice line items. You can use these details to determine the reason for the payment allocation task and
the relevant business partner.
The References tab can give you references to invoices or open items that should be cleared with the payment.
2. Once you have found the missing data that has triggered the manual allocation task, you can allocate the payment
completely or partially using the following tabs:
a. Customer/Supplier
If customer or supplier data is required, you can enter the customer or supplier on this tab. In the Open Items
table, the open items for this customer or supplier are displayed.
If you need to allocate the transaction amount to several customers or suppliers, go to the Open Items table
and click Accounts , then Add Account. For more information, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
If you select a tax authority instead of a customer or a supplier, you define the amount as a payment
for VAT / sales tax, withholding tax, or service tax (India). For all other tax types, you have to enter
the relevant amounts under Other Allocation.
If you receive or make recurring payments from or to customers or suppliers, you can reuse this assignment of
the customer or supplier to the bank data specified in the bank statement item you edit in this tab. To make use
of this function, set the Remember Assignment for Future Payment Allocations indicator. The next time a
payment allocation occurs, the system can automatically assign the payment to the given customer or supplier
based on the bank data given in the bank statement item, hence saving you manual effort.
b. Payment Allocation
The payment items that are in transfer and for which this payment allocation is possible are displayed on this
tab. You can remove items from this list or add them again using the arrow symbols. This can be necessary,
for example, if the details of a bank statement line item do not match the appropriate payment or check deposit
that should confirm the bank statement.
202 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
c. Fees and Interest
If the payment is a fee or interest, you can make the appropriate allocation on this tab. You can also separate
fees from payments or bank statement line items that contain fees for special transactions. You can specify the
fee amount contained in the payment and post it separately to an appropriate account.
d. Other Assignment
You can use this tab to make postings directly to certain general ledger accounts if payments were made that
do not relate to open items. This can be, for example, lease and rent revenues or revenues from an insurance
payout that your company receives.
The amounts that you allocate on the respective tab are displayed in the Allocated Amounts area. However, in the
header of the editor, the total of the already allocated amounts are displayed as the allocated amount and the part
of the transaction amount that you have not yet allocated is displayed as the open amount.
If a payment should be reimbursed, for example, because your account was debited incorrectly, arrange
a posting to a prior period with the bank and reverse the payment in the system. You enter a return reason
and choose Actions Mark as Return . Once the bank has credited the appropriate amount to your
account and confirmed this on your bank statement, you can allocate the reimbursement item in the
Payment Allocation view. For more information, see Quick Guide for Payment Allocation [200].
3. Optional: If you want to reverse the changes that you have made to the system's allocation proposal, choose
Actions Create Proposal . In this way, all of the entries you have made are overwritten and the proposal is
reset to the status when you first opened it. Alternatively, you can perform this action when, after you have opened
and checked the task in the system, you add data, for example, bank data for a customer or supplier. The allocation
is started again and the system can find the previously missing data.
4. Choose Post . If you want to save the allocation initially as a draft without releasing it, click Save .
Result
The allocation that you have manually performed and completed, makes sure that the system can continue the payment
process and can begin with automatic payment clearing.
Example
An employee receives notification that business partner information is missing for an incoming payment. The employee
opens the Payment Allocation view and finds the relevant payment allocation. He or she checks the payment and
allocates it to the correct business partner by comparing the payment information to any open invoices. He or she can
use information such as the payment method, amount, currency, and payment date, to help select the correct business
partner for payment allocation.
5.3.3 Memo Line Analysis Rules
Overview
After you release a payment transaction, the system tries during payment allocation to assign it to the correct customer,
supplier, open item, or account, for example. If this automatic allocation fails, the system generates a manual allocation
task. In order to achieve as many automatic allocations as possible, you can create your own rules based on memo line
content. These rules influence how your payment transactions (for example, bank statements or incoming checks) are
assigned based on the information contained in the memo line. They are designed to find structured information, which
can be used for allocating payments automatically.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 203
When you create a rule, you define on the one hand what information you expect to be contained in the memo line (for
example, an invoice number or an amount), and on the other hand where the payment is to be allocated to.
You can create memo line analysis rules in the following screens:
● Payment Management work center, Payment Allocation view:
Select a payment allocation from the worklist and click Edit . In the Payment Allocation view, click the Edit Rules
for Analyzing Memo Lines link.
● Business Configuration work center, Implementation Projects view:
Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine Tune phase, then select the Global
Settings for Payment activity from the activity list. On the activity details screen, click the Edit Rules for Analyzing
Memo Lines link in the Rules for Analyzing Memo Lines section.
To be able to access this functionality, the Business Configuration work center must be assigned to you.
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the Business Configuration
work center assigned to you, contact your key user.
Process Flow
When you use your own memo line analysis rules, the system proceeds as follows during the payment allocation step:
It analyzes the relevant memo line using the rule and then uses the resulting information to find the correct allocation
target, that is, the element to which the payment transaction is to be assigned, for example:
● If the system identifies an invoice number according in the memo line based on the rule definition, it attempts to
find the corresponding invoice and to clear it automatically.
● If the system identifies bank charges within the memo line based on the rule definition, it automatically posts the
specified amount as bank charges.
You can create memo line analysis rules in different definition modes, depending on the content to be identified in the
memo line. The following modes are available and described below:
1. Search Term ModeUse this mode if you want to search the memo line for a specific term, for example an invoice number or customer
number. You can define the search result using several parameters.
To create a rule in the search term mode, click Add Row . Enter a rule name and a description for your new rule.
From the Rule Type dropdown list, select the search item you want to create the rule for. From the Rule Definition
Mode dropdown list, select Search Term.
Enter the relevant values in the two sections described below: ● Search Term
In the Text Before Search Result field, you can enter texts that are likely to precede the search result in the
memo line. You can create any number of preceding texts to cover as many variations as possible by adding
new lines and entering the corresponding texts. If you are creating a rule for searching for invoice numbers,
for example, you could enter “Invoice:”, “Inv.:”, “CI:” and so on.
● Rule DescriptionIn this section, you can specify the individual parts of the search result using the following parameters: ○ Search Result Prefix
Enter the characters that will precede each search result of this rule.
○ Search Result SuffixEnter the characters that will follow each search result of this rule.
○ Minimum Length
204 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Enter the minimum number of characters within the variable part of the search result.
○ Maximum LengthEnter the maximum number of characters within the variable part of the search result.
○ AlphanumericSelect this checkbox if you want to allow numbers as well as letters within the variable part of the search
result. In this case, the following example search result will be found: “CI-595AB9”. If you do not select this
checkbox, only results containing numbers such as “CI-595659” will be found.
2. Text and Placeholder ModeUse this mode if you want to search the memo line for a combination of a text and one or more placeholders, for
example for amounts or dates. You can define the rule in a way that only one placeholder amount will be posted
automatically, for example to an account or as fees/interest.
To create a rule in the text and placeholder mode, click Add Row . Enter a rule name and a description for your
new rule. From the Rule Type dropdown list, select the search item you want to create the rule for. From the Rule
Definition Mode dropdown list, select Text and Placeholder.
Enter the relevant values in the two sections described below: ● Text and Placeholder
In this section, you can specify the structure of text and placeholders: ○ Search Text Incl. Placeholders
Enter the text to be searched for and enter placeholder variables where you expect in the memo line. Enter
placeholder variables in the format “&1”, “&2”, “&3”” to “&9”.
○ Result SelectionSelect whether a specific placeholder or the complete amount of the transaction (mostly corresponding to
the bank statement item) will be used for the result processing.
Note that if you select a specific placeholder as the result the currency is derived from the bank statement
(or check).
○ Credit/DebitSelect whether the amount is to be interpreted as a positive or negative amount by the system.
Note that if you create and define a rule with the rule definition mode Search Term or Text and Placeholder
without saving it, and then select a different rule definition mode, all rule definition details below the Rule
Overview table are lost.
● Placeholder Definition ○ Placeholder Type
Select the format in which the system is to interpret each placeholder. The available values are amount
formats, date formats, or a general placeholder with no specific format.
○ Minimum LengthIf you select the general placeholder as placeholder type, you can enter a minimum length.
○ Maximum LengthIf you select the general placeholder as placeholder type, you can enter a maximum length.
Note that if you create and define a rule with the rule definition mode Search Term or Text and Placeholder without
saving it, and then select a different rule definition mode, all rule definition details below the Rule Overview table
are lost.
3. Expert ModeIf you need a more complex rule than the two modes described above, you can create your own rule pattern
according to your requirements in the form of a POSIX-based regular expression. By creating a regular expression
of this type, you can define a rule tailored exactly to your expected search result.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 205
To create a rule in the expert mode, click Add Row . Enter a rule name and a description for your new rule. From
the Rule Type dropdown list, select the search term you want to create the rule for. From the Rule Definition
Mode dropdown list, select Expert.
Below you find two examples for regular expressions with corresponding explanations used as memo line analysis
rules:
1. \b(?:Customer:\s+)(\d{ 5, 10})\b ● The” \b”operators match the beginning as well as the end of a word.
● A pair of parentheses like “(…)” represents a subexpression, also called subgroup. In the first expression
there are two sub-expressions: “(?:Customer:\s+)” and “(\d{ 5, 10})”. The first subexpression starts with
“(?:”meaning that the part of a text matching this subexpression is not returned as a result while the match
for the second subexpression is returned as a result.
● The “d{5,10}” statement describes a sequence of 5 to 10 digits.
2. \b(MCFLY\d{ 1, 2})\bIn this example, a search is triggered for words beginning with “MCFLY” followed by a number containing one
to two digits.
Note that when you enter regular expressions it is expected that they contain exactly one subexpression which is
defined as result to be returned (that is a pair of parentheses without “?:” at the beginning).
Memo Line analysis rules may be defined in a very specific or a more generic way. When you create generic
rules, one result (bank charges, for example) might be found by two overlapping rules. In this case, the system
is not able to assign the complete transaction uniquely and thus triggers a manual allocation task.
Simulation
To enable you to check how the rules you create will work, a simulation function is available. After you have created
and saved a rule, you can click Simulate and enter a sample memo line, for example a memo line text you already
have received in a customer payment. The simulation finds and displays all the rules that have results in the sample
memo line together with the corresponding fragments extracted from the memo line.
See Also
Assign a G/L Account to a Memo Line Analysis Rule [209]
Search Memo Lines for Invoice Numbers [206]
Creation of Memo Line Analysis Rules for Common Use Cases [211]
Rule Types For Analyzing Memo Lines [216]
Finding Open Items for Externally-Initiated Payments [94]
5.3.4 Search Memo Lines for Invoice Numbers
Overview
When you use memo line analysis rules, you can, amongst other things, create search rules for finding invoice numbers.
This can be useful if you want to automate the payment allocation process in the system and hence reduce your manual
efforts. Rules of this type can be useful when your customers or suppliers tend to state the invoice numbers in memo
lines when making payments. Using these rules, the system can extract the relevant invoice numbers from the memo
lines. If the system finds invoice numbers, it will assign the corresponding payments to the appropriate invoice items.
206 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
You can create memo line analysis rules in the following screens:
● Payment Management work center, Payment Allocation view:
Select a payment allocation from the worklist and click Edit . In the Payment Allocation view, click the Edit Rules
for Analyzing Memo Lines link.
● Business Configuration work center, Implementation Projects view:
Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine Tune phase, then select the Global
Settings for Payment activity from the activity list. On the activity details screen, click the Edit Rules for Analyzing
Memo Lines link in the Rules for Analyzing Memo Lines section.
To be able to access this functionality, the Business Configuration work center must be assigned to you.
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the Business Configuration
work center assigned to you, contact your key user.
Example
To illustrate how you can create rules for searching memo lines for invoice numbers, the following example is used:
In your company you receive payments for customer invoices. Your invoice numbers follow the pattern MCCI-<number>.
The memo lines for the payments usually contain the corresponding invoice numbers in their memo lines following the
same pattern.
The memo lines for the payments look like the following examples:
Payment for Invoice Number: MCCI-9875468 of 05-06-2010
Your Invoice: MCCI-78544, 04-06-2010, CUSTOMER 656548
Paym. Inv.: MCCI-00445557, 04-06-2010, Order 3547656548
Our order 434, Invoice.: 555008, 04-11-2011 Cust.:5584441
From these examples the following memo line structures can be derived:
● Invoice Number: MCCI-<7-digit number>
● Invoice: MCCI-<5-digit number>
● Inv.:MCCI-<8-digit number>
● Invoice: <6-digit number>
Because payments with memo line references with combinations of these types occur often, you want to create rules
covering these patterns in order to automate the payment allocation process.
The rules you create will have to consist of several parts, like a prefix, a number, and a suffix. For this particular example,
two different rules will be needed because in the last example the prefix of the invoice number is missing.
Procedure
1. Create a rule for complete invoice numbers
The first three example patterns can be covered by one rule because they have the same structure, consisting of a
preceding text, the invoice prefix, and the actual invoice number.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 207
a. In the Rule Overview table, click Add Row .
b. Enter a rule name and a description for your new rule. Because you want to search for customer invoices, select
Open Receivable Document ID from the Rule Type dropdown list. From the Rule Definition Mode dropdown list,
select Search Term.
c. In the Text Before Search Result table, enter the following three entries using Add Row : ● Invoice Number:
Make sure that the Spaces Allowed indicator is selected because a blank space separates the preceding
text from the invoice number.
● Invoice:
Make sure that the Spaces Allowed indicator is selected because a blank space separates the preceding
text from the invoice number.
● Inv.:
Deselect the Spaces Allowed indicator because there is no blank space separating the preceding text from
the invoice number.
d. In the Result Description section, enter the following values in the corresponding fields: ● Search Result Prefix: MCCI-
● Minimum Length: 5
● Maximum Length:8
● Alphanumerical indicator: deselected
e. Save the rule.
With this rule, the following fragments of the corresponding memo line will be found: ● Invoice Number: MCCI-9875468
● Invoice: MCCI-78544
● Inv.:MCCI-00445557
2. Create a rule for incomplete invoice numbers
In the example pattern “Invoice: <6-digit number>”, the prefix of the invoice number as it exists in the system is
missing. Customers may leave the prefix out in the memo line deliberately thinking that it does not belong to the
actual invoice number, for example. With the rule explained below you can cover this case as the rule can be defined
to search for an incomplete reference. You can specify within the rule which prefix or suffix is to be added and to be
used for the further processing of the search result.
a. In the Rule Overview table, click Add Row .
b. Enter a rule name and a description for your new rule. Because you want to search for customer invoices, select
Open Receivable Document ID from the Rule Type dropdown list. From the Rule Definition Mode dropdown list,
select Search Term.
c. In the Text Before Search Result table, enter Invoice and make sure that the Spaces Allowed indicator is
selected.
d. In the Result Description section, leave the Search Result Prefix field empty. Enter the appropriate minimum
and maximum length values according to how long you expect the invoice numbers to be.
e. In the Rule Overview table, go to the Prefix Added to Result column and enter the value to be inserted before
the incomplete invoice number: MCCI-.
f. Save the rule.
With this rule, the following fragment of the corresponding memo line will be found: ● Invoice: 555008
208 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Simulate Your Rules
1. To test your new rules, click Simulate .
2. Enter an appropriate memo line text to check which results the rule will find (for example Invoice Number:
MCCI-9875468).
3. Click Simulate . The results that will be found using your rules are displayed in the Rules Found section. If your
customer’s payment is displayed in this section, the rules and their assignment will work as intended.
4. Repeat the second and the third step for each of your new rules.
See Also
Memo Line Analysis Rules [203]
5.3.5 Assign an Account to a Rule for Analyzing Memo Lines
Overview
When you use memo line analysis rules, you can create assignments so that your rules post a search result to specific
G/L accounts. This can be useful if you want to automate the posting of recurring revenues or expenses. You can also
specify that the amount that is to be posted to a G/L account is to be assigned to a cost center or a project as well.
This document shows how you can set up your system to post a transaction amount or a part of it to a G/L account
based on a concrete example.
You can create memo line analysis rules in the following screens:
● Payment Management work center, Payment Allocation view:
Select a payment allocation from the worklist and click Edit . In the Payment Allocation view, click the Edit Rules
for Analyzing Memo Lines link.
● Business Configuration work center, Implementation Projects view:
Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine Tune phase, then select the Global
Settings for Payment activity from the activity list. On the activity details screen, click the Edit Rules for Analyzing
Memo Lines link in the Rules for Analyzing Memo Lines section.
To be able to access this functionality, the Business Configuration work center must be assigned to you.
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the Business Configuration
work center assigned to you, contact your key user.
Example
To illustrate how you can create automatic postings to G/L accounts using memo line analysis rules, see the following
example:
Every month you pay the lease payments for two leased cars using direct debit as the payment method. This means
that the car leasing company is allowed to collect the monthly payments from your bank account. The memo line contains
the costs for each car. You want to post these costs to different cost centers.
The monthly invoice amount is EUR 800.00 which is split into the two payment amounts 250 EUR and 550 EUR.
Akron Cars Cust.No. 0499643
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 209
Car F-DAA56 250.00 EUR
Car F-DAA57 550.00 EUR
Because this memo line pattern is the same every month, you want to automate the posting of the leasing costs by
creating corresponding memo line analysis rules. To cover these transactions, you need to create two rules, one rule
for each lease payment amount given in the memo line. In an additional step, you have to assign the rules to the
corresponding G/L account posting with the specific cost center for each car.
Procedure
1. Create a Set of Rules
● Create a Rule for Car F-DAA 56
a. In the Rule Overview table, click Add Row .
b. Enter a rule name and a description for your new rule. From the Rule Type dropdown list, select Account
Assignment. From the Rule Definition Mode dropdown list, select Text and Placeholder.
c. In the Search Text Incl. Placeholders field, enter the following text: Akron Cars Cust.No. 0499643 Car
F-DAA56 &1 EUR Car F-DAA57 &2 EUR. Press Enter to update the Placeholder Definition table with
the placeholder variables you have entered.
d. Assign the following placeholder types to the variables: ● Placeholder number 1: Amount in format 12,345.67
● Placeholder number 2: Amount in format 12,345.67
Press Enter.
e. From the Result Amount dropdown list, select &1 (for the first lease payment amount). Then select Debit
from the dropdown list next to the selected variable.
f. Save the rule.
● Create a Rule for the Car F-DAA 57
a. Select the rule you created in step 1.
b. Copy the rule by selecting it in the Rule Overview table and clicking Copy . Enter a rule name and a
description for your new rule.
c. From the Result Amount dropdown list, select &2 (for the second lease payment amount).
2. Assign a G/L Account to Your Rules
After having created the rules, you have to specify the G/L account and cost centers to which each part of the total
lease payments will be posted.
● Assign a G/L Account and Cost Center to the Rules
a. In the Rule Overview table, click Assign Account to Rule .
b. On the Assign Account to Rule for Analyzing Memo Lines screen, click Add Row .
c. Select the rule you created to identify the leasing rate for the first car F-DAA56. If needed, you can enter
your company ID.
d. From the General Ledger Account dropdown list, select the appropriate G/L account, for example, 7370 –
Rent or Lease.
e. Select the cost center you want to post the car’s leasing rate to.
f. Repeat steps b. to f. for the second car F-DAA57 using a different cost center.
g. Save your assignment.
3. Simulate Your Rules
210 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
a. To test your newly created rules, click Simulate .
b. Enter the memo line text contained in the payments of your customer: Akron Cars Cust.No. 0499643
Car F-DAA56 250.00 EUR Car F-DAA57 550.00 EUR.
c. Click Simulate . The search results are displayed in the Rules Found section. If your payment to the leasing
company is displayed in this section, the rules and their assignment will work as intended.
The simulation is for test purposes only. No real postings will be made using this function.
See Also
Memo Line Analysis Rules [203]
5.3.6 Creation of Memo Line Analysis Rules for Common Use Cases
Overview
You can create memo line analysis rules to streamline and automate the payment allocation process. With these rules,
the system analyzes the memo lines of incoming or outgoing payments for information on invoice numbers, open items,
and customers or suppliers, for example, in order to find the corresponding payment in the system.
This document describes how you can define memo line analysis rules for common use cases and is intended to offer
you guidance for creating your own rules designed for different scenarios.
You can create memo line analysis rules in the following screens:
● Payment Management work center, Payment Allocation view:
Select a payment allocation from the worklist and click Edit . In the Payment Allocation view, click the Edit Rules
for Analyzing Memo Lines link.
● Business Configuration work center, Implementation Projects view:
Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine Tune phase, then select the Global
Settings for Payment activity from the activity list. On the activity details screen, click the Edit Rules for Analyzing
Memo Lines link in the Rules for Analyzing Memo Lines section.
To be able to access this functionality, the Business Configuration work center must be assigned to you.
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the Business Configuration
work center assigned to you, contact your key user.
For more information on memo line analysis rules and their creation in general, see Memo Line Analysis Rules [203].
Rule Definition Details for Various Use Cases
To create a memo line analysis rule, navigate to the Rules for Analyzing Memo Lines screen. In the Rule Overview
table, click Add Row . Define your rule according to the details given below and save your rule.
The following sections provide you with the options you have to select and the values you have to enter in various rule
definition scenarios using example memo lines for illustration purposes.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 211
Find Invoice Numbers in the Memo Line
Example Memo Line:
Invoice CI-654851 of 04-08-2011
Explanation:
The memo line contains the invoice number preceded by the text “Invoice”. The invoice number consists of the fixed
prefix “CI-“ (for “Customer Invoice”) and a variable part with a length between 6 and 8 characters.
You want to extract the invoice number including the prefix from the memo line.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Search Term
Rule Type Open Receivable Document ID
Text Before Search Result Invoice
Search Result Prefix CI-
Minimum Length 6
Maximum Length 8
Alphanumerical [Deselect]
Find Customer Numbers in the Memo Line
Example Memo Line 1:
Subscription of Customer CU-054218
Example Memo Line 2:
Monthly Payment, Cust. CU-4218
Explanation:
The memo line texts “Customer” and “Cust.” that precede the invoice numbers are indicators for the alphanumeric string
to refer to a customer number. To ensure that the number is correct, you can describe the expected result by determining
that the fixed prefix of the customer number has to be “CU-“. The numerical variable may consist of of 4 to 10 characters.
With the rule you create, you can extract the customer number from the memo line.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Search Term
Rule Type Customer
Text Before Search Result Customer, Cust. (use an individual line for each value using Add Row )
Search Result Prefix CU-
Minimum Length 4
212 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Maximum Length 10
Alphanumerical [Deselect]
Find Bank Charge or Interest Information in the Memo Line
Example Memo Line:
Paym. 2021100 05-11-2011, Bank Charges: 2.82 EUR
Explanation:
The memo line refers to bank charges. You want to identify these bank charges and post them to an appropriate account.
For bank charges, the bank always uses the same text with only the relevant amounts differing for different transactions.
Therefore you first create a rule in order to extract the amount part and identify it as bank charges. These charges will
then be posted to the G/L account dedicated to charges, which is defined in account determination.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Text and Placeholder
Rule Type Bank Charges
Search Text Incl. Placeholders Bank Charges: &1 EUR
Placeholder Type (of the Placeholder 1) Amount in format 12,345.67
Result Amount &1
Variant: The whole transaction amount consists of bank charges:
Bank Charges, Ref. Paym. 2021100 05-11-2011
This memo line does not specify an amount because the whole transaction amount consists of bank charges. In this
case, use the rule definition mode Text and Placeholder as well. As search text, you can use “Bank Charges, Ref. Paym.
&2”. The Placeholder &2 is needed to identify the variable part of the text. As the result amount, use Complete
Amount.
Post Charges to a G/L account with Cost Center
Example Memo Line:
AKRON Company, Charges, June 2011
Explanation:
The memo line indicates that the whole transaction amount is charges. These charges are to be posted on a G/L account
and assigned to a cost center. In a first step, you create a rule to identify the text “AKRON Company, Charges” and in
a second step you specify and assign a G/L account and a cost center.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 213
Rule Definition Mode Text and Placeholder
Rule Type Account Assignment
Search Text Incl. Placeholders AKRON Company, Charges
Result Amount Complete Amount
Click Assign Account to Rule .
Add a row and from the Rule column dropdown list, select the rule for the created rule and make the following selections:
Column Name Selection
General Ledger Account [Select the appropriate G/L account.]
Cost Center ID [Select the appropriate cost center.]
Variant: Only a part of the transaction amount consists of charges:
AKRON Company, 10.00 USD Charges, June 2011
Explanation:
The structure of the memo line is similar to the one above, the difference being the search text and the variable part
(amount).
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Type Account Assignment
Search Text Incl. Placeholders AKRON Company, &1 USD Charges
Placeholder Type Amount in format 12,345.67
Result Amount &1
Click Assign Account to Rule and proceed as indicated above.
Find File References Contained in Memo Line Instead of Dedicated BankStatement Field
Example Memo Line:
Confirm Paym. Ref. 5484512151
Explanation:
The memo line contains a reference to a payment confirmation (such as a confirmation of an outgoing bank transfer, a
check deposit, or an outgoing check), which is usually entered by the bank in a dedicated field of the bank statement
file.
With the rule you create, you can find references based on the memo line. Using these references, the system tries to
find the corresponding payment or payment message in order to confirm the bank statement.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
214 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Search Term
Rule Type DME Reference
Text before Search Result Confirm Paym. Ref.
Minimum Length 3
Maximum Length 32
Variant: Using rule type “Text and Placeholder” to extract the file reference from the memo line.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Text and Placeholder
Rule Type DME Reference
Search Text Incl. Placeholders Confirm Paym. Ref. &1
Placeholder Type General Placeholder
Minimum Length 3
Maximum Length 32
Result Selection &1
Find Incomplete Invoice or Customer Numbers (For Example Due to MissingPrefix)
Example Memo Line:
Payment for Customer Invoice: 849845
Explanation:
The customer wants to pay the invoice “CI-849845”. The prefix “CI-“ is missing from the memo line, for example because
the customer paying for the invoice does not realize that this prefix is an actual part of the invoice number. First you
have to create a rule to find the incomplete invoice number, and then, within the same rule, define that the missing prefix
(or suffix) should be added so that the system then can process the payment allocation with the complete invoice number.
Create the rule with the following parameters:
Column or Field Name Selection or User Entry
Rule Definition Mode Search Term
Rule Type Open Receivable Reference Item
Text Before Search Result Payment for Customer Invoice:
Search Result Prefix [Leave empty]
Search Result Suffix [Leave empty]
Minimum Length 6
Maximum Length 8
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 215
Prefix Added to Result CI-
See Also
Memo Line Analysis Rules [203]
Assign a G/L Account to a Memo Line Analysis Rule [209]
Search Memo Lines for Invoice Numbers [206]
Rule Types For Analyzing Memo Lines [216]
5.3.7 Rule Types For Analyzing Memo Lines
Overview
When you create a rule for analyzing memo lines, you have to select a rule type. This type specifies what kind of
information you want to find in the respective memo line.
The following list shows the available rule types and explains for which business transactions they can be used and how
the corresponding rule will work.
Rule Type BusinessTransaction
Description
Open PayableExternalReference
Outgoing directdebit
The rule searches for an open payable on the basis of the external reference. If the relevantpayable item exists, the system assigns the payment to it in the payment allocation process.A common example for a payable external reference is the external document ID on asupplier invoice.
OpenReceivableDocument ID
Incoming banktransfer, lockbox
The rule searches for an open receivable on the basis of the document ID. If the relevantpayable item exists, the system assigns the payment to it in the payment allocation process.A common example for a document ID reference is the ID on a customer invoice.
Open Due ItemExternalReference
Incoming banktransfer,outgoing directdebit, lockbox
The rule searches for an open payable or open receivable on the basis of the externalreference. If the relevant item exists, the system assigns the payment to it in the paymentallocation process.Common examples for due item external references are the external document ID of asupplier invoice and the external reference on a customer invoice.
Customer Incoming banktransfer,outgoing directdebit, lockbox
The rule searches for a customer ID. If the relevant customer ID is found in the memo line,it will be used to search for the open items of this customer.
Supplier Incoming banktransfer,outgoing directdebit, lockbox
The rule searches for a supplier ID. If the relevant supplier ID is found in the memo line, itwill be used to search for the open items of this supplier.
BusinessPartner
Incoming banktransfer,outgoing directdebit, lockbox
The rule searches for a customer or supplier ID. If the relevant customer or supplier ID isfound in the memo line, it will be used to search for the open items of this customer orsupplier.
AccountAssignment
All banktransactions,lockbox
The rule searches for a specific pattern (optionally containing an amount). This transactioncan then be assigned to a specified account.
BankTransaction Fee
All banktransactions
The rule searches for a bank charge transaction amount and posts it separately as definedin the rule.
216 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
DME Reference Outgoing banktransfer,incoming directdebit, checkdeposit,outgoing check,outgoing returnof an incomingpayment,incoming returnof an outgoingpayment
The rule searches for a DME reference (data medium exchange). The DME reference is anidentifier that is transferred when an internally initiated payment is created in the system.Once the payment is confirmed with the corresponding bank statement item including theDME reference, the payment allocation process uses this reference to confirm the internallyinitiated payment. Although the DME references are usually contained in a dedicated field,they might also be used in the memo line.
Bank Charges Outgoing directdebit, bankcharges
The rule searches for a bank charge and posts it separately as defined in the rule.
Bank Interest Incoming banktransfer, bankinterests
The rule searches for a bank interest amount and posts it separately as defined in the rule.
OpenReceivableExternalReference
The rule searches for an open receivable on the basis of the external reference. If the relevantreceivable exists, the system assigns the payment to it in the payment allocation process.A common example for a receivable external reference is the external reference on acustomer invoice.
OpenReceivablePaymentReference
The rule searches for an open receivable on the basis of the payment reference (which isspecified on the open due item, for example with the Swiss payment method inpayment slipwith reference number (ISR)). If the relevant receivable item exists, the system assigns thepayment to it in the payment allocation process.An example for a receivable payment reference is the ISR reference number on a customerinvoice.
See Also
Memo Line Analysis Rules [203]
5.4 Petty Cash View
5.4.1 Quick Guide for Petty Cash
In the Petty Cash view, you can create and monitor petty cash for your company and also record incoming and outgoing
cash payments made to and from your petty cash. Cash can be transferred between petty cash locations, or from and
to bank accounts. You can create any number of petty cash funds for your company and view in the cash journal, in
which the incoming and outgoing cash payments are recorded, the entire transaction history for a specific petty cash
fund.
The payments that can be entered in this view include the payment of occasional purchases and transactions in which
customers or suppliers are involved.
You can access this view from the Payment Management and from the Liquidity Management work centers.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 217
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31]
Outgoing Payments
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Editing Point of Sale Transactions
The Point-of-Sale Transactions view enables you to process sales transactions and cash transactions from an external
system. An external sale is typically a business transaction that is performed at the point of sale, and subsequently
entered in an external (remote) system before being transferred at a point later in time to the SAP Business ByDesign
system. A cash transaction is the transfer of cash from one point-of-sale device to another with the external system.
If a sales transaction or cash transaction is complete and consistent, it is automatically processed by the system and
forwarded to Financial Management. However, should the sales transaction or cash transaction be incomplete or
inconsistent, you can use the Sales Transactions subview and Cash Transactions view to receive, analyze, and process
the sales or cash transaction data. You can then display and correct the data before it is released to Financial
Management.
For more information, see Editing Point of Sale Transactions [70].
Tasks
Create Petty Cash
1. Click New , then Petty Cash.
On the New Petty Cash screen, enter the basic data for your new petty cash fund. In addition
to the petty cash ID, you specify the currency, for example. A petty cash fund can be created
in only one currency. You also need to enter the account determination group.
2. Click Save .
If you want to process your cash payments in different currencies, you need to create
additional petty cash funds.
218 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
You can create new petty cash funds in this view as well as in the Liquidity
Management work center in the Master Data view.
Create An Outgoing Cash Payment
For more information on this activity, see here [221].
Enter an Incoming Cash Payment
For more information on this activity, see here [219].
Transfer Cash
For more information on this activity, see here [222].
Monitor Petty Cash Transactions in the Cash Journal
1. If you want to view the cash journal containing a list of all the transactions performed for a
specific petty cash fund, select the petty cash that you want to display and click View .
On the Petty Cash Journal: <Petty Cash Name> sceen, go to the Show dropdown list and
choose All. All the incoming and outgoing payments are displayed together with details on
the postings, such as the document ID and the posting date.
2. If you want to use the petty cash journal to reverse payments, select the relevant payment
and click Reverse .
Close Petty Cash
1. If you want to close a petty cash fund that you no longer require, select the petty cash from
the Petty Cash ID column.
2. On the Petty Cash: <Petty Cash Name> screen, click Actions , then Close Petty Cash.
To be able to close a petty cash fund, your entries must balance to zero. This means
that you need to ensure that any cash balances are transferred to another petty cash
fund or to a bank account.
5.4.2 Enter an Incoming Cash Payment
Overview
In your day-to-day business operations, you might receive payments from your customers or other occasional payments
in the form of cash. These transactions are recorded by the system in the cash journal, and monitored and cleared like
any other payment. Incoming cash payments are posted directly to a G/L account or to a customer or supplier account
in which the incoming payment can be assigned to an open item or entered without assignment as an on account
payment.
You can create outgoing cash payments in the Payment Management work center under Petty Cash.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 219
Prerequisites
You have at least one active petty cash fund containing sufficient cash for the payment.
Procedure
1. Go to the Petty Cash view and select the petty cash fund that you require. Click New , then Incoming Cash
Payment. You can use the same navigation path if you are using the cash journal.
2. On the New Incoming Cash Payment screen, enter the relevant payment details. Enter a short description specifying
the reason for the cash payment, as well as the receipt date of the payment, a receipt number, and the cash payer.
The posting date is defaulted to the current date. However, you can change this date, if necessary.
3. To post the incoming cash payment to a customer or supplier account, select the Reference to Items radio button.
Enter the relevant customer or supplier in the Payer field. The open items are then displayed in the Open Items table.
You can now choose which open items in the list are to be paid by setting the Matched indicator next to the required
items.
If you want to enter deductions, such as cash discounts or reductions due to damaged goods, click Accounts ,
then Apply Discount or Credit.
For more information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
To post the incoming cash payment directly to a G/L account, click the Direct Posting to G/L Account radio
button. In the Entry Type field, specify whether the payment is to be displayed as a gross or net amount.
Enter the payment amount in the Gross Amount or Net Amount field, based on your selection in the Account
Assignment table, and choose the appropriate G/L account. If you choose a tax code, the system
automatically calculates the tax amount. If necessary, the Tax Totals table displays all the tax-relevant
postings created by your entries.
If the payer wants to pay open items from another customer or supplier as opposed to paying his or her own open
items, click Actions , then Add Account. A dialog box appears in which you can choose another customer or
supplier. The available payers are retained, but the Open Items table now displays the open items of the customer
or supplier account that you have just selected.
For more information on how to use the Open Items table, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
4. When all the details are correctly entered, click Post to save the incoming cash payment and to post it. Click
Close to close the editor and return to the Petty Cash view or cash journal.
5. Optional: If you need to cancel an incoming cash payment, open the cash journal by selecting the relevant petty cash
fund and clicking View .
On the Petty Cash Journal: <Name of Petty Cash Journal> screen, select the relevant payment and click
Reverse .
Result
The posting is made to the relevant G/L account or customer/supplier account, depending on your selections, and the
new payment is displayed with its corresponding document number in the cash journal. The cash journal shows the
current balance, which has been increased by the incoming cash payment.
220 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
5.4.3 Create An Outgoing Cash Payment
Overview
In your day-to-day business operations, it is sometimes necessary to pay for goods or services in the form of cash, in
addition to your regular invoicing and payment processes. You can pay for such items using petty cash kept at your
company. The system then records these transactions in the cash journal.
You can create outgoing cash payments in the Payment Management work center under Petty Cash.
Prerequisites
You have at least one active petty cash fund containing sufficient cash for the payment.
The steps described here refer to occasional operating costs, such as postage, in which an employee is given
a sum of money to cover the cost of the item, or pays for the item him or herself and is subsequently
reimbursed. Costs such as these are posted to the appropriate G/L account, rather than to a customer or
supplier account.
Procedure
1. Go to the Petty Cash view and select the petty cash fund that you require. Click New , then Outgoing Cash
Payment. You can use the same navigation path if you are using the cash journal.
2. On the New Outgoing Cash Payment screen, enter the relevant payment details. Enter a short description specifying
the reason for the cash payment, as well as the receipt date of the payment, a receipt number, and the cash recipient,
if required. The posting date is defaulted to the current date. However, you can change this date, if necessary.
3. Select whether you wish to allocate the cash payment to open items or post it directly to the general ledger account
without allocating the payment.
● To post the outgoing cash payment directly to an appropriate G/L account, choose the Direct Posting to G/L
Account option. In the Entry Type field, specify whether the payment is to be displayed as a gross or net amount.
In the account assignment table, choose the appropriate G/L account and tax code, and enter the net or gross
amount of the payment, depending on the entry type you selected previously. You can also enter the relevant
cost center or project task IDs. Furthermore, you can add lines if you enter items separately, split the posting
between different G/L accounts, or want to use different tax codes. You can also delete lines if necessary.
● If you want to pay customer or supplier invoices, choose the Reference to Items option. Select open items from
the list displayed and settle them with the payment transaction, or make on account payments without having
to select an open item from the list. These payments are posted on the respective customer or supplier account.
If you want to pay items on behalf of another customer or supplier, click Accounts , then Add Account. Now
you can also choose from the open items belonging to the account you selected in addition.
For more information on how you can edit your open items, see Using the Open Items Table [93].
4. Once you have entered all the details correctly, click Post to save and post the outgoing cash payment. Click
Close to close the editor and return to the Petty Cash view or cash journal.
5. Optional: If you need to cancel an outgoing cash payment, open the cash journal by selecting the relevant petty cash
fund and clicking View . On the Petty Cash Journal: <Name of Petty Cash Journal> screen, select the relevant
payment and click Reverse .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 221
Result
If you have chosen the Direct Posting to G/L Account option, for example, the outgoing cash payment is posted to the
selected G/L account and the new payment is displayed with its corresponding document number in the cash journal.
The cash journal shows the current balance, which has decreased due to the outgoing cash payment.
Example
A company employee requires a small amount of cash to mail a business document. The employee pays the postage
and receives a receipt in return. The employee then takes the receipt to the person responsible for petty cash, who in
turn reimburses the employee. On the New Outgoing Cash Payment screen, you enter the payment details such as the
amount, short text, and cash recipient, and select the appropriate G/L account. The cash payment is then released. The
payment is entered in the petty cash journal and the cash balance is automatically updated.
5.4.4 Transfer Cash
Overview
If your company manages one or more petty cash funds to make certain payments in cash, you need to make sure that
sufficient cash is stored in the petty cash fund, but at the same time prevent excessive amounts of cash accumulating.
Therefore, it is possible to make cash transfers between two petty cash funds, from petty cash to a bank account and
vice versa. In this way, you can control liquidity and minimize security risks.
You can create cash transfers in the Payment Management work center under Petty Cash.
Prerequisites
You have at least one active petty cash fund.
Procedure
1. To transfer cash from one petty cash fund to another, or from petty cash to a bank account, choose New -> Outgoing
Cash Transfer. The New Outgoing Cash Transfer window appears. Enter the transaction amount, posting date, and
document date for the petty cash location from which the transfer will be made. Use the appropriate radio button to
specify whether the cash should be transferred to a petty cash fund or a bank account. Depending on your selection,
make entries for the petty cash ID or bank account ID.
2. Choose Post .
To transfer cash from a bank account to petty cash, choose New -> Incoming Cash Transfer. The Incoming
Cash Transfer window appears. Enter the transaction amount and the account ID of the bank account
from which the cash will be drawn, and then click Post .
Result
You have regulated the liquidity of your petty cash in the following ways; by transferring cash out of your petty cash fund
to a bank account or other petty cash fund, or by transferring cash into your petty cash fund from another petty cash
location or bank account.
222 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
5.5 Deposits View
5.5.1 Quick Guide for Check Deposits
In the Check Deposits subview of the Payment Management work center, you can create deposits for incoming checks
received from your customers or suppliers, which you can then group and deposit at your bank. The deposit slip is a
document that contains all the information required for cashing the check. This includes the total amount, currency,
references to the checks, and the account. You need to use a separate check deposit for each account and each
currency. Once you have assigned all the required checks to the check deposit, such as all the checks received in one
day, you release it and print it out. You then send the deposit slip together with the paper checks to the bank where they
are processed and credited to the respective account. Your bank statement shows you that the payment has been
received.
Any checks that you assign to a check deposit need to have been entered beforehand in the Payment Monitor view.
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31]
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Tasks
Check Prerequisites
To be able to use a check deposit, you first need to create a check storage. To do this, go to
the Liquidity Management work center.
For more information on this task, see Quick Guide for Master Data (Liquidity Management)
[276].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 223
Create a Check Deposit
1. Choose New Check Deposit.
2. On the New Check Deposit screen, enter the data required for your check deposit, that is,
in addition to your company, enter the account to which the checks should be credited. You
can overwrite the default values for the following fields, if required: ● Posting Date
Date on which you want to enter the deposit in financial accounting.
● Deposit Date
Date on which you want to cash the deposit at the bank.
● Value Date
Date on which the bank expects to settle the value on your account. The default value
is three days after the deposit date.
3. Choose Save .
Assign Check to Check Deposit
1. Go to the Payment Monitor view, select the required incoming check, and choose Actions
for Checks Assign to Deposit. A window appears in which you enter the deposit ID. You
can also select the ID from the input help.
If you do not specify or select a check deposit in the window displayed but confirm
the empty field, the system automatically creates a new check deposit in the
background. We recommend that you then navigate to the Check Deposits view
and if necessary, overwrite the bank data selected by the system.
2. Optional: Select the required check, click Edit , then Assign to Deposit .
A window appears in which you enter the deposit ID. You can also select the ID from the
input help.
Unassign Check or Change Assignment to Check Deposit
1. If you want to unassign a check or change a check assignment (if you have assigned a check
incorrectly to a deposit or if you are not ready to cash the check, for example), then select
the deposit in the Check Deposit subview. Click Edit .
2. Choose the Assigned Checks tab and select the check. Then click
Unassign from Check Deposit . If you want to make another assignment, click
Change Assignment to Deposit and enter the check deposit ID in the window displayed, either
independently or using the input help.
Release Deposit and Print Deposit Slip
1. When you create a check deposit, it has the status In Preparation. Before you are able to
print a check deposit slip, you need to release the check deposit. Once the deposit has been
released, you can no longer assign checks to the check deposit. Select the required check
deposit and choose Actions Release and Print Deposit Slip. You can now send the
printed check deposit slip together with your paper checks to the bank.
2. Optional: If you want to release a check deposit for payment but do not want to print the
deposit slip, (if the bank provides the slip in paper format, for example), choose
224 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Actions Release and Set to In Transfer. In this way, the deposit obtains the required
status meaning that the payment can then be confirmed in the system with the bank
statement.
If you initially choose to release only the deposit and not create a printout, select the
appropriate deposit and click Edit . On the Check Deposit: <ID> screen, click
Release . If you want to print the check deposit slip at a later date, select the
appropriate deposit from the list and click Print Deposit Slip .
Delete Check Deposit
You can only delete check deposits if they have the status In Preparation and no
checks assigned to them. It is not possible to delete released check deposits.
1. Select the appropriate check deposit and click Delete .
5.5.2 Quick Guide for Lockbox Batches
You can use the Lockbox Batches subview to track incoming checks that are processed by your lockbox providers and
imported into the system as files. This is a service provided to you by your bank or another service agent. You obtain
an address for your company that your customers and suppliers can use to send you checks. The checks are processed
by the service provider in that the provider deposits the checks at your bank to be credited to your account. This subview
informs you about the processing stages in which the provider send you files that you can upload to your system for
checking. Your bank statement shows you that the payment has been received. The bank statement contains the
corresponding check deposit that you can confirm in the system. In this way, your company can outsource manual tasks
that arise from processing checks.
Lockbox services are currently only used in the US.
You can access this subview from the Payment Management work center under Deposits.
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31]
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 225
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Tasks
Check Prerequisites
To be able to use the lockbox service, you first need to create a check storage for your lockbox
provider. To do this, go to the Liquidity Management work center.
For more information on this task, see Quick Guide for Master Data (Liquidity Management)
[276].
Upload a Lockbox Batch
1. To be able to display and check lockbox batches, you first need to upload the lockbox files
to the system. To do this, go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose File
ManagementInbound Files.
2. Select your company from the company file register and choose New Inbound File .
On the New Inbound File screen in the File Type field, choose Lockbox. In the Sender Bank
ID field, enter the service provider that sends you the lockbox files.
3. Select the file that you want to upload and click Start File Upload .
If the file has already been uploaded, you can display and check the details. If the uploaded
file is complete and free from errors, choose Actions Mark As Confirmed . If the files
contain errors, choose Actions Mark As With Errors .
For more information, see File Management Quick Guide [282].
Check a Lockbox Batch
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose Deposits Lockbox
Batches . Select the lockbox batch that you want to use and click Edit .
2. In the Lockbox Batch: <ID> editor, you can view the checks that belong to the batch. In the
External Check ID column, you can use the check number to display the respective check.
Checks that are processed using the lockbox procedure are always assigned to a
check deposit. The deposits are always added to one lockbox batch.
Reverse a Lockbox Batch
1. If you want to prevent a check deposit from being paid, perhaps if the deposit includes an
incorrect check, for example, then the lockbox batch can be reversed. To do this, go to the
Payment Management work center and choose Deposits Lockbox Batches . Select
the lockbox batch that you want to cancel and click Reverse .
Note that it is not possible to reverse individual checks in the lockbox batch. You
have to reverse the complete batch and the lockbox provider needs to send you
226 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
an updated version of the lockbox file. You can then import the new file into the
system.
5.5.3 Quick Guide for Bill of Exchange Deposits
In the Bill of Exchange Deposits subview, you can assign incoming bill of exchange receivables to a bill of exchange
deposit so that your company can receive bill of exchange payments from customers. Each bill of exchange received
from a customer must be assigned to a deposit. If you have assigned the appropriate bill of exchange to the deposit, it
can be released and issued. You then send the bill of exchange deposits in file format to the bank for the amount to be
credited. Your bank statement shows you that the payment has been received.
Commercial transfers are not affected by bill of exchange deposits.
There are two bill of exchange types that your company can use and assign to deposits - bills for collection and
discounted bills. Both bill of exchange types or corresponding bill of exchange deposits are sent to the bank prior to the
due date of the bills of exchange that they contain. If you use a bill for collection, payment is received on the due date
of the bills of exchange. If you use a discounted bill, payment is received prior to the due date of the bills of exchange,
since the bank purchases the bill of exchange and consequently allows a discount credit. If your company requires early
payment for liquidity purposes, then we recommend using a discounted bill. However, you need to pay the bank for the
early payment since you receive payment for the bill of exchange only, without interest or expenses.
You can access this subview from the Payment Management work center under Deposits.
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31]
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 227
Tasks
Check Prerequisites
1. To be able to create bills of exchange receivables or to use bill of exchange deposits, you
first need to create a bill of exchange storage. To do this, go to the Liquidity
Management work center and choose Master Data Bill of Exchange Storage.
2. Choose New Bill of Exchange Storage.
In the window displayed, enter the required data including data for the following fields: ● Bill of Exchange Storage ID
Enter a name for your bill of exchange storage. Alphanumeric values are permitted
(such as AKRON 01).
● Bank Account ID
Specify the number of the account to which the bills of exchange are to be credited.
3. Click Save , then Activate.
If possible, create only one bill of exchange storage for each company.
Create a Bill of Exchange Deposit
1. Choose New Bill of Exchange Deposit.
2. In the New Bill of Exchange Deposit editor, enter the data required for your bill of exchange
deposit, that is, in addition to your company, enter the bank account to which the bills of
exchange should be credited and the currency (EUR) in which they should be paid. In the
Deposit Type field, specify whether you want to assign a bill for collection or a discounted
bill to the deposit. You can overwrite the default values for the following fields, if required: ● Posting Date
Date on which you want to enter the deposit in financial accounting.
● Deposit Date
Date on which you want to cash the deposit at the bank.
● Value Date
This field is activated if you have selected Discounting for the deposit type. Here you
can enter the date on which the bank is to credit the amount to your account and
consequently permit the discount credit.
3. Click Save and Close .
Assign Bills of Exchange to a Bill of Exchange Deposit
1. Go to the Payment Monitor view, select the bill of exchange receivable that you want to use,
which has the status Ready for Deposit, and choose Actions for BoE Assign to
Deposit.
2. In the displayed window, enter the number of the check deposit or select it using the input
help, and specify whether you want to use a bill for collection or a discounted bill. Confirm
your selection. The status of the bills of exchange then changes to Ready for Transfer.
228 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Unassign a Bill of Exchange or Change an Assignment to a Bill ofExchange Deposit
1. If you want to unassign a bill of exchange or change a bill of exchange assignment (if you
have assigned a bill of exchange incorrectly to a deposit, for example), then select the
deposit in the Bill of Exchange Deposit subview. Click Edit .
2. Choose the Assigned Bills of Exchange tab in the editor and select the bill of exchange.
Then click Remove . If you want to make another assignment, click
Change Assignment to Deposit , enter the bill of exchange deposit ID in the window displayed,
and confirm your selection.
Release a Bill of Exchange Deposit
1. When you create a bill of exchange deposit, it has the status In Preparation. To be able to
issue the bill of exchange deposit, that is, send the deposit to the bank, you first need to
release it. Once the bill of exchange deposit has been released, you can no longer assign
bills of exchange to that deposit. Select the appropriate bill of exchange deposit and choose
Actions Release.
Once you have released a bill of exchange deposit, you cannot delete it. You can only
delete a bill of exchange deposit with the status In Preparation by selecting the deposit
and clicking Delete .
Issue a Bill of Exchange Deposit
To be able to send the bill of exchange deposit to the bank, it first needs to be issued.
This generates a file, which you can then upload and send in subsequent steps.
1. Select the appropriate bill of exchange deposit and choose Actions Issue. The status
changes to In Transfer.
2. Optional: If you want to reverse the In Transfer status because you do not yet want to send
the file to the bank, for example, select the required deposit and choose Actions Set
to Not Issued. The status is then reset to Released.
Send a Bill of Exchange Deposit as a File to the Bank
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose File Management Outbound
Files.
2. Optional: If you want to check your bill of exchange deposit file prior to sending it, select your
deposit with the status In Transfer. This status shows that the file was not yet downloaded
and sent. Click Edit .
On the Outgoing File: <ID> screen, select the Attachment tab and open the file from the
document title. If the file contains errors, you can exclude it from being sent by choosing
Actions Discard.
3. Select the bill of exchange deposit and click Edit .
On the Outgoing File: <ID> screen on the Attachment tab, select the outgoing file and save
it to your computer. You can now send the file to the bank.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 229
4. To indicate in the system that you have sent the file for the bill of exchange deposit to the
bank, select the bill of exchange deposit and choose Actions Release.
The status changes from In Release to Released for Transfer. This activity is only performed
so that you can map the files that have already been sent in the system.
5. Once the payment deposit has been confirmed on the bank statement, select the bill of
exchange deposit and choose Actions Confirm.
The status changes from Released for Transfer to Confirmed. This activity is also only
intended to provide an overview of the files that have been paid and their status.
For more information, see File Management Quick Guide [282].
Reverse a Bill of Exchange Deposit
You can only delete bill of exchange deposits with the status Released.
1. Select the appropriate bill of exchange deposit and click Reverse .
2. A window is displayed in which you select the date on which the reversal journal entry is to
be created for the bill of exchange deposit. The default value displayed here is the deposit
date, which corresponds with the date on which a journal entry was created for the bill of
exchange deposit in financial accounting. If the reversal is made on a date for which the
accounting period is already closed, then you can overwrite this date.
5.5.4 Quick Guide for Bill of Exchange Cashings
In the Bill of Exchange Cashings subview, you can enter bill of exchange cashings that you receive from your bank.
Your company receives a cashing notification from the bank in either electronic or paper form, which informs you about
the approaching due date for bill of exchange payables. The payment will be made unless you tell the bank otherwise.
If you enter a new cashing in the system, choose the bills of exchange that were included in the cashing you received
from the bank. You can then approve or reject each bill of exchange.
In this way, you can process bills of exchange with or without acceptance, as well as sole bills. Commercial transfers
are not affected by bill of exchange cashings.
You can access this subview from the Payment Management work center under Deposits.
Business Background
Payment Allocation and Clearing
Payment allocation and clearing are two distinct but related steps involved in payment processing. Payment allocation
and payment clearing are necessary processes for both incoming and outgoing payments. The system usually performs
both steps automatically. In some cases the system cannot perform these processes and will create manual payment
allocation tasks or manual payment clearing tasks that require user involvement. The different situations that can result
in these manual tasks are explained here, as is the relationship between payment allocation and payment clearing.
For more information, see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188]
Outgoing Payments
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
230 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Tasks
Upload Electronic Information for a Bill of Exchange Cashing
This section is only relevant if your bank sends you a cashing notification in electronic
form. If you receive notification in paper form, refer to the section Create a Bill ofExchange Cashing.
1. To be able to display and edit bill of exchange cashings, you first need to upload the cashing
files to the system. To do this, go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose
File Management Inbound Files.
2. Select your company from the company file register and choose New Inbound File.
On the New Inbound File screen in the File Type field, choose Bill of Exchange Cashing
Advice. In the Sender Bank ID field, enter the financial institution that sends the data to you
for the bill of exchange cashings.
3. Select the file that you want to upload and click Start File Upload .
If the file has already been uploaded, you can display and check the details. If the uploaded
file is complete and free from errors, choose Actions Mark As Confirmed. If the files
contain errors, choose Actions Mark As With Errors.
For more information, see File Management Quick Guide [282].
Create and Approve a Bill of Exchange Cashing Received in PaperForm
This section is only relevant if you receive a cashing notification from your bank in
paper form and you need to create a bill of exchange cashing manually. If you receive
notification in electronic form, refer to the section Approve or Reject a Bill ofExchange Cashing.
1. Choose New Bill of Exchange Cashing.
In the guided activity for the New Bill of Exchange Cashing Advice, enter the data required
for the bill of exchange cashing. This data can be found in the notification that you received
from your bank. In addition to your company and the cashing advice number, enter the
account from which the bill of exchange amounts are to be debited. Enter also the response
due date proposed by the bank. If you do not respond by this date, the bank accepts the bill
of exchange and debits the amounts. Click Next .
2. In the Select Bills of Exchange step, first select the bill of exchange that you want to accept,
which is displayed according to company, bank account, and bill of exchange status. Then
use the arrow symbol to copy the selected bill of exchange from the screen area All
Unconfirmed Bills of Exchange to the area Accepted Bills of Exchange. Once you have
checked all bills of exchange and accepted the ones you require, click Finish .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 231
This activity is only required to map in the system the bill of exchange cashings that you
accept. The actual acceptance of the bill of exchange cashing is made in paper form when
you return the cashing form back to your bank.
Accept or Reject a Bill of Exchange Cashing Received in ElectronicForm
1. Select a bill of exchange cashing with the status In Verification and click Edit .
2. On the Bill of Exchange Cashing: <ID> screen, select the bill of exchange for which you want
to accept cashing and click Accept Cashing .
If you do not want to accept bills of exchange, make the appropriate selections and click
Reject Cashing . If you reject a bill of exchange cashing, specify a rejection reason.
3. Click Release . If you want to save the cashing initially as a draft without releasing it, click
Save .
If the status is Released, you can reverse the acceptance for editing. To do this, select
the relevant bill of exchange cashing and click Void . The status is then reset to In
Verification. From this status, you can also reverse the cashing. (See section Reversea Bill of Exchange Cashing).
Issue a Bill of Exchange Cashing Received in Electronic Form
To be able to send a bill of exchange cashing received in electronic form to the bank,
it first needs to be issued. This generates a bill of exchange acceptance file, which you
can then upload and send in subsequent steps. You can also perform this step directly
after releasing the bill of exchange cashing. (See section Accept or Reject a Bill ofExchange Cashing Received in Electronic Form).
1. Select the appropriate bill of exchange cashing and click Issue.
2. Optional: If you want to reverse the In Transfer status because you do not yet want to send
the file to the bank, for example, select the required cashing and choose Actions
Set to Not Issued. The status then changes from Issued back to Released.
Send a Bill of Exchange Cashing Acceptance as a File to theBank
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose File Management Outbound
Files.
2. Optional: If you want to check your acceptance file prior to sending it, select the bill of
exchange cashing acceptance with the status In Transfer. This status shows that the file
was not yet downloaded and sent. Click Edit .
On the Outgoing File: <ID> screen, select the Attachment tab and open the file from the
document title. If the file contains errors, you can exclude it from being sent by choosing
Actions Discard.
3. Select the bill of exchange casing acceptance and click Edit .
On the Outgoing File: <ID> screen on the Attachment tab, select the outgoing file and save
it to your computer. You can now send the file to the bank.
232 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
4. To indicate in the system that you have sent the bill of exchange deposit file to the bank,
select the bill of exchange deposit and choose Actions Release.
The status changes from In Release to Released for Transfer. This activity is only performed
so that you can map the files that have already been sent in the system.
5. Once the payment deposit has been confirmed on the bank statement, select the bill of
exchange cashing acceptance and choose Actions Confirm.
The status changes from Released for Transfer to Confirmed. This activity is also only
intended to provide an overview of the files that have been paid and their status.
If you return to the Payment Management work center to the Bill of Exchange Cashings view,
you can see that the status of the bill of exchange cashing is now Cashed.
For more information, see File Management Quick Guide [282].
Reverse a Bill of Exchange Cashing
If a bill of exchange cashing contains an error, it can be reversed. The process flow
for this depends on whether the bill of exchange cashing was received in electronic
form or created manually.
1. Reverse a Bill of Exchange Cashing Received in Paper Form
a. Select the appropriate bill of exchange cashing with the status Released.
b. Choose Actions Void. The status changes to Void and the bill of exchange
cashing can no longer be edited.
2. Reverse a Bill of Exchange Cashing Received in Electronic Form
a. Select the appropriate bill of exchange cashing with the status Released.
b. Choose Actions Void. The status then changes to In Verification.
c. Choose Actions Reverse. The status changes to Void and the bill of exchange
cashing can no longer be edited.
5.6 Remittance Advices View
5.6.1 Quick Guide for Remittance Advices
In the Remittance Advices view, you can enter all the incoming remittance advices that you received for payments
initiated by your customers or suppliers. These payments can include outgoing payments by direct debit or incoming
check payments and transfers that a customer or supplier informs you about prior to payment processing. Once you
have entered the remittance advices in the system, they are used to support the automatic clearing process after the
payments have been made. In some cases, no payment advices are created for payments initiated by a customer or
supplier since they can usually be processed quickly. You might also not receive payment advices for payments if their
usage has not been specified for particular customers or suppliers.
Outgoing payment advices used to inform your customers or suppliers about payments you have initiated are
created in the system as required but not saved. These outgoing payment advices can be generated directly
from the system.
You can access this view from the Payment Management work center.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 233
Business Background
Supplier Payment Advices
A remittance advice is exchanged between the payer and payee. It contains detailed payment information for a specific
date relating to one or more invoices. In this way, the remittance advice announces a payment transaction. Both the
buyer and seller can send the message. The remittance advice informs when and how much of which invoice will be
paid. It contains detailed information about a payment that is required to allocate and clear open items.
For more information, see Supplier Payment Advices [67]
Customer Payment Advices
A remittance advice is exchanged between the payer and payee. It contains detailed payment information for a specific
date relating to one or more invoices. Thus the remittance advice announces a payment transaction. Both the buyer
and seller can send the message. The payment advice informs when and how much of which invoice will be paid. It
contains detailed information about a payment that is required to allocate and clear open items.
For more information, see Customer Payment Advices [62]
Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices
You can send outgoing payment advices to your customers or suppliers using an electronic interface as opposed to
printing them in paper form. It is possible to do this if both you and your suppliers or customers have made the required
system settings for this interface.
For more information, see Electronic Submission of Outgoing Payment Advices [65].
Tasks
Enter a Remittance Advice
For more information on this task, see here [235].
Reverse a Remittance Advice
1. Select the remittance advice that you want to reverse.
2. Click Edit .
Check the data to ensure that the advice you have selected is really the one you want to
reverse.
3. Click Reverse .
You can also reverse a remittance advice without rechecking the data. In this case,
select the appropriate payment advice from the list and click Reverse . Confirmed
remittance advices cannot be reversed.
234 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
5.6.2 Enter a Remittance Advice
Overview
You can enter remittance advices that you receive from your customers in the system. For each payment initiated by a
customer, you can receive a remittance advice from the respective customer or supplier. However, it is more usual that
the customer sends you the remittance advice, especially for payments made by incoming check or bank transfer.
You can create remittance advices in the Payment Management work center under Remittance Advices.
Prerequisites
You have received a remittance advice from your customer. This can be in written form or made by a telephone call.
Procedure
1. Go to the Remittance Advices view and choose New Remittance Advice.
On the New Remittance Advice screen, enter the relevant data in the mandatory fields Company, Payer/Payee ID,
Payment Amount, and Advice Date. Enter further information as required. If the remittance advice refers to an
outgoing payment that a customer or supplier initiates on behalf of your company, such as a direct debit, select the
Debit Advice checkbox.
Under Payer Data in the Payer/Payee ID field, enter the name of the payer or payee and all the available bank details.
If you know the account to which the payment is to be made, enter the appropriate details.
Usually the payer is the customer who pays your company. It is also possible for payments to be made
by a third party on behalf of the customer.
2. Under Open Items, select all open items relevant for payment by setting the Matched indicator. If an explanation is
provided or needs to be provided for a particular item, you can add this by clicking View All and entering the
corresponding text in the Memo Line field.
If the entries are correct, click Release .
Once a remittance advice has been released, it can not be deleted but only reversed. To do this, click
Reverse .
Result
The new remittance advice is saved in the system. In the Payment Clearing view of the Receivables or Payables work
center, you can see a new entry with the status Advised. The open items selected in the remittance advice now have a
new clearing ID. Once the payment is made or confirmed on the bank statement, the remittance advice is included in
the automatic payment clearing process. This means that the payment is used to clear the open invoice automatically
using the information contained in the remittance advice, thereby eliminating any manual work. Once a remittance advice
has been confirmed on a bank statement, it is no longer possible for it to be reversed.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 235
Example
Mr Weaver receives a remittance advice from a customer, which informs the company Akron about a payment that will
be made by bank transfer to a bank account held by the company. He enters the payment and bank details from the
remittance advice, selects the open invoices to be paid, and then releases the advice in the system. Once the payment
has been made and its receipt confirmed by Akron when the amount is displayed on its bank statement, the remittance
advice information and the bank statement are used to clear the open invoices paid in the bank transfer.
5.7 Periodic Tasks View
5.7.1 Quick Guide for Payment Media Runs
In the Payment Media Runs subview, you can perform automatic runs, which generate payment media for bank transfers,
direct debits, checks, and bills of exchange. You can view recurring payment media runs as well as payment media runs
that were scheduled for a particular date. You can edit existing payment media runs and reschedule them. You can also
display available runs and check the application logs of runs that have already been performed.
You can access this view from the Payment Management work center under Periodic Tasks.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Tasks
Create a Payment Media Run
For more information on this task, see here [238].
Activate the Payment Media Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Media Runs subview, select a payment media
run with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
236 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
2. In the Payment Media Run: <ID> editor, you can check the available data and make any
necessary changes. If you make any data changes, make sure you then Save .
3. Click Activate .
You can also perform this step when you create a payment media run. It is then not
necessary to perform a separate activation step. Note that you cannot make any
changes to an existing run after it has been activated.
Schedule a Payment Media Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Media Runs subview, select a payment media
run with the status Active and click Schedule .
The Schedule Job editor appears.
2. If you want to start a payment media run immediately and do not intend to repeat the run,
click Start Immediately . Alternatively, you can specify a start date and time or arrange for it
to run after a specific job. If you want to schedule the payment media run periodically, specify
in addition to the execution date when the payment media run should be repeated, for
example, daily or weekly.
3. Click Save .
You can also perform this step when you create a payment media run, once you have
saved and activated it. It is then not necessary to perform a separate scheduling step.
You can reschedule an active run at any time or change its scheduling parameters.
Display Scheduled Runs
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Media Runs subview, select the payment media
run you require and click View Jobs .
The Job Monitor window appears.
2. You can check which runs are scheduled and change or cancel runs if required. If you want
to change the execution date of a job, select the appropriate job and click Reschedule . If
you want to cancel a job that has already been scheduled, click Cancel Job .
Display Execution Details
1. If you want to view the details of runs that have already been executed, first go to the Periodic
Tasks view and Payment Media Runs subview. Here you can select the appropriate payment
media run and check the details in the Execution Details section.
You can display when the run was executed and the user who created it. The execution
status is also displayed, such as Finished.
2. If you want to view the log, you can display it from the Application Log ID column. Here you
can check the results of the run, such as whether payment media were created and if so,
which media were created.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 237
5.7.2 Create a Payment Media Run
Overview
In the Payment Media Runs subview, you can create payment media on paper or as files for data media exchange.
You can access this subview from the Payment Management work center under Periodic Tasks.
Prerequisites
In the Payables or Receivables work centers, you have finished processing the payment proposal and have performed
the payment run.
Procedure
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Media Runs subview, choose New Payment Media Run.
2. In the New Payment Media Run editor, specify the payments you want to make and the criteria you want to apply
when you perform the payment media run. Make entries in the following mandatory fields:
● Company ID
● Payment Media Types
For each run, you can select only one payment medium type (such as Including Outgoing Check).
● Format
Select the format that corresponds with the selected payment medium (for example, check).
Additional selection criteria that you might want to include, are:
● Customer / Supplier from / to
You can define a value range, which enables you to select multiple customers or suppliers for a payment media
run. If you do not make a selection here, the system includes in the run all the customers or suppliers entered
in the system.
● Payment Execution Date from / to
You can define a value range, which enables you to specify a payment processing period for a payment media
run. If you do not specify anything here, the run is performed independently of the date.
● Including Payment Advice
You can set this indicator if you want to generate payment advices during the run.
3. Click Save .
Result
You have created a payment media run that can now be activated and performed immediately or scheduled for a later
date. If you have only saved a payment media run and not yet activated it, you can still make changes to it.
238 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
5.7.3 Quick Guide for Payment Deposit Runs
In the Payment Deposit Runs subview, you can perform automatic runs, which generate payment deposits for bills of
exchange. You can view recurring payment deposit runs as well as payment deposit runs that were scheduled for a
future date. You can edit existing payment deposit runs and reschedule them. You can also display available runs and
check the application logs of runs that have already been performed.
During a payment deposit run, the system looks for due bills of exchange so that the deposit can be created and sent
to the respective bank.
You can access this view from the Payment Management work center under Periodic Tasks.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Tasks
Create a Payment Deposit Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Deposit Runs subview, choose New
Payment Deposit Run.
2. In the New Payment Deposit editor, enter your company ID. If you want to use a specific bill
of exchange storage in the run, enter the appropriate ID. You can also make additional field
entries for the Currency or Bank Account ID.
3. Click Save .
If you close the payment deposit run without activating it, you can still display it again and
edit it at any time.
Activate the Payment Deposit Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Deposits Runs subview, select a payment deposit
run with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
2. In the Payment Deposit: <ID> editor, you can check the available data and make any
necessary changes. If you make any data changes, make sure you then click Save .
3. Click Activate .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 239
Schedule a Payment Deposit Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Deposits Runs subview, select a payment deposit
run with the status Active and click Schedule . The Schedule Job editor appears.
2. If you want to start a payment deposit run immediately and do not intend to repeat the run,
click Start Immediately. Alternatively, you can specify a start date and time or arrange for it
to run after a specific job. If you want to schedule the payment deposit run periodically,
specify in addition to the execution date when the payment deposit run should be repeated,
for example, daily or weekly.
3. Click Save .
Display Scheduled Runs
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Payment Deposit Runs subview, select the payment deposit
run you require and click View Jobs .
The Job Monitor window appears.
2. You can check which runs are scheduled and change or cancel runs if required. If you want
to change the execution date of a job, select the appropriate job and click Reschedule . If
you want to cancel a job that has already been scheduled, click Cancel Job .
Display Execution Details
1. If you want to view the details of runs that have already been executed, first go to the Periodic
Tasks view and Payment Deposit Runs subview. Here you can select the appropriate
payment deposit run and check the details in the Execution Details section.
You can display when the run was executed and the user who created it. The execution
status is also displayed, such as Finished.
2. To view the log, click Display Log . Here you can check the results of the run, such as
whether payment deposits were created and if so, which deposits were created.
5.7.4 Quick Guide for Credit Card Settlement Runs
You can create automatic credit card settlement runs in the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview. In this way, credit
card payments can be grouped together in one settlement and in a file. This payment order file can then be sent to the
clearing house (also referred to as acquirer). You can view recurring credit card settlement runs as well as runs that
were scheduled for a particular date. You can edit existing credit card settlement runs and reschedule them. You can
also display available runs and check the application logs of runs that have already been performed.
You can access the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview from the Payment Management work center under in the
Periodic Tasks.
Business Background
Mass Data Runs
A Mass Data Run (MDR) is the automatic mass processing of a task or a business transaction. MDRs enable mass
processing of business data and are used in business processes, for example, invoice runs, payment authorization runs,
240 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
or balance confirmation runs. When a user schedules an MDR the system represents it as a background job. During
scoping, it is possible to provide default variants of the MDRs.
MDRs are created and maintained in the work centers. Using the Job Scheduler, users schedule the run to execute
once or regularly at specified times.
In the Background Jobs view of theApplication and User Management work center, key users can monitor and
reschedule MDR jobs that are created by users in other work centers.
For more information, see Mass Data Runs.
Tasks
Create a Credit Card Settlement Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview, choose New
Credit Card Settlement Run.
2. On the New Credit Card Settlement Run screen, enter your company ID. If you only want to
include one particular type of credit card in the run, for example, select this from the
dropdown list. Additional selection criteria that you might want to include, are: ● Customer From / To
You can define a value range, which enables you to select multiple customers or
suppliers for a credit card settlement run. If you do not make a selection here, the system
includes in the run all the customers or suppliers entered in the system.
● Payment Execution Date
You can specify a particular payment execution date for the credit card settlement run.
If you do not specify anything here, the run is performed independently of the date.
3. Click Save .
If you close the credit card settlement run without activating it, you can still display it again
and edit it at any time.
Activate a Credit Card Settlement Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview, select a credit card
settlement run with the status In Preparation and click Edit .
2. On the Credit Card Settlement Run: <ID> screen, you can check the available data and
make any necessary changes. If you make any data changes, make sure you then click
Save .
3. Click Activate .
Schedule a Credit Card Settlement Run
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview, select a credit card
settlement run with the status Active and click Schedule . The Schedule Job screen
appears.
2. If you want to start a credit card settlement run immediately and do not intend to repeat the
run, select Start Immediately . Alternatively, you can specify a start date and time or arrange
for it to run after a specific job. If you want to schedule the credit card settlement run
periodically, specify in addition to the execution date when the credit card settlement run
should be repeated, for example, daily or weekly.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 241
3. Click Save .
Display Scheduled Runs
1. In the Periodic Tasks view in the Credit Card Settlement Runs subview, select the credit
card settlement run that you want to view and click View Jobs .
The Job Monitor window appears.
2. You can check which runs are scheduled and change or cancel runs if required. If you want
to change the execution date of a job, select the appropriate job and click Reschedule . If
you want to cancel a job that has already been scheduled, click Cancel Job .
Display Execution Details
1. If you want to view the details of runs that have already been executed, first go to the Periodic
Tasks view and Credit Card Settlement Runs subview. Here you can select the appropriate
credit card settlement run and check the details in the Execution Details section.
You can display when the run was executed and the user who created it. The execution
status is also displayed, such as Finished.
2. If you want to view the log, you can display it from the Application Log ID column. Here you
can check the results of the run, such as whether clearing house payment orders were
created and if so, which orders were created.
5.7.5 Quick Guide for Foreign Currency Remeasurement (Cash)
You use foreign currency remeasurement to convert the balances of cash ledger accounts from foreign currencies into
the company currency on a specific key date.
This closing activity is relevant for companies for which gains and losses, resulting from exchange rate fluctuation, are
displayed on the cash ledger accounts in foreign currencies. At the time when the amounts of these balances originated,
they were converted into the company currency using the exchange rate valid at that time. On the day when the balance
sheet is created, a different exchange rate usually applies, and the balances therefore have to be revaluated. The
remeasurement can be repeated as often as required until the receivable has been cleared or written off.
You can access the Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Cash subview from the Payment Management work center
under Periodic Tasks.
Business Background
Multi-Currency
A currency is the legally recognized means of payment in a given country. A currency has to be specified for every
financial amount in the system. The currencies are specified using the ISO standard form, such as EUR for euros or
USD for US dollars.
For more information, see Currencies.
242 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method
You use the foreign currency remeasurement method to set up the various methods for entering foreign currency
remeasurement in accordance with the legal requirements. For each foreign currency remeasurement method, you
define the accounting principles that should be used by the corresponding remeasurement method.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement Method.
Foreign Currency Remeasurement
If you start the procedure for foreign currency remeasurement, the system automatically makes the relevant postings
and subsequently withdraws postings.
For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement [82].
Closing Activities — Year-End Closing
Before you can create your closing reports, you first need to perform some preparatory tasks. The system supports you
in this process.
For more information, see Closing Activities - Year-End Closing.
Tasks
Check Prerequisites
Before foreign currency remeasurement can be performed, the following prerequisites must be
fulfilled:
● The current exchange rates need to have been entered in the system. For more information,
see Exchange Rates.
● Using account determination, you need to have defined and set up in configuration the
accounts that you want to remeasure. For more information, see Business Configuration of
Account Determination for a Business Transaction.
● You need to have defined how the system is to valuate and post exchange rate differences.
For this, you need to have assigned the appropriate set of books to the foreign currency
remeasurement method. For more information, see Foreign Currency Remeasurement
Method.
Perform Foreign Currency Remeasurement for Cash
1. To create a new foreign currency remeasurement run, click New , then Foreign Currency
Remeasurement for Cash Run.
2. You have the following options for performing foreign currency remeasurement runs: ● Foreign Currency Remeasurement with Reference
To re-use the data from a previous foreign currency remeasurement run, select the
foreign currency remeasurement run that you want to use and click Copy . The
system copies the data directly to the input screen for the new foreign currency
remeasurement run. You can then adjust the data copied from the previously-executed
foreign currency remeasurement run.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 243
● Test RunTo perform the foreign currency remeasurement run as a test run, set the Test Run
indicator. The system previews the results of the test run but does not make any
postings. The postings are only simulated.
You can only delete foreign currency remeasurement runs that you either
scheduled or performed as a test run. To delete a test run, select a run you
want to delete and click Delete .
● Set of BooksYou can perform the remeasurement for a single set of books or for all sets of books.
If you use multiple sets of books with different fiscal year variants, you should ideally
perform the remeasurement separately for each set of books. The system determines
the key date on the basis of the fiscal year variant of the set of books.
● CurrencyYou can restrict foreign currency remeasurement to cash ledger accounts in specific
currencies.
● Closing StepYou select the closing step that you want the system to use when making the postings
on the key date to the corresponding accounting period. This accounting period must
be open for the closing step that you have selected. For more information, see Closing
Steps.
● Period / YearYou select the period and year for which you want to perform foreign currency
remeasurement.
3. Scheduling
You can either perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately or schedule it to occur
later: ● To perform foreign currency remeasurement immediately, click Start Immediately .
You have to wait until the foreground job finishes before you can continue
with your work. This may take several minutes depending upon the data
volume, which can cause the screen to time out. In such a case, you can go
to the main screen for the run and refresh the data. When the run status
changes to Finished, click View to view the logs. Alternatively, you can
clickLog Result in the Details section of a finished run.
● To schedule foreign currency remeasurement for a subsequent point in time, click
Schedule and specify the time when the system will perform remeasurement. If you
leave the Date and Time field empty, the run starts immediately.
You can continue with your work while the system executes the run as a
background job.
You can view scheduled foreign currency remeasurement runs and their respective times
in the subview Foreign Currency Remeasurement under Jobs .
Display and Check Log for Foreign Currency Remeasurement
1. Display Log
244 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
If you have performed foreign currency remeasurement immediately, the system issues a
status message. To display a list of the logs, click Display Log in the status message.
When you have scheduled foreign currency remeasurement, you can display the list of logs
in the Foreign Currency Remeasurement subview after the foreign currency remeasurement
has been performed. To do this, choose the relevant foreign currency remeasurement.
2. Check the LogThe log contains the following information:
● General
Shows the result of the foreign currency remeasurement run, the execution date, any
messages that were issued, and the extent of profit or loss from the valuation.
● Data Selection
Shows the information that you entered at the start of the foreign currency
remeasurement run.
● Messages
Shows a list of all messages that were issued (such as warning messages).
● Postings
Shows all the account movements and journal entries that the system posted for the
key date valuation and the valuation reversal.
● Remeasured Balances
Shows for each remeasured account all the documents with their source document ID,
historical value, and key date value, as well as gains and losses. You can also view the
term over which the valuation was performed.
● Not Remeasured Balances
Shows for each remeasured conciliation account the documents that were subject to
errors during processing, for example, because of missing account determination.
To verify whether a run has been completed successfully, you can run the following checks:
● LogYou find a log for a run in the corresponding subview. Each run has a status (Information,
Error). To display the details of a log, select the relevant run and click Display .
If errors occur during a run, you need to resolve them. You can find information on the errors
on the Messages tab. Once you have resolved the errors, start the run again. The system
repeats the postings that could not be made in the first run.
● Job MonitorIf a run has not been completed successfully and you cannot find and resolve the cause,
you can display the technical details relating to the run in the Job Monitor. Select the relevant
run and click Display Jobs . If a job finds errors, contact your system administrator.
5.7.6 Quick Guide for Direct Debit Rejection Runs
This document contains text that is relevant for Switzerland. To ensure that the system displays the correct
text, select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose
Switzerland. Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 245
5.8 Reports
5.8.1 Payment Statistics - Customers
Overview
The report provides an overview of the payment behavior of customers towards your company for a specific period.
Canceled items are not included.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data that you want to see by making value selections for variables. You
must make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk
(*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variable:
● Proposed Posting Date
The system takes the previous two weeks as the default value for the documents entered.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report displays the following: the number of days from the invoice receipt until payment (accounts receivable),
payment amount, average number of days until the net due date, number of overdue days in the specified period in
percent, and the permitted, claimed, and unclaimed cash discount. Furthermore, the report specifies the highest dunning
level for each customer and the average dunning level that was issued prior to the customer clearing the invoice.
The data in this report is displayed in table format.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, choose Filter.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From each customer displayed, you can drill down to the relevant details. To do this, select the appropriate value
and open the corresponding menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
246 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
5.8.2 Checkbook Register
Overview
The report displays all check numbers within a check lot that have already been used for outgoing checks or are not
available anymore because of other reasons.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. Additional
information is available for the following selected variables:
● Company ID
You can restrict the display to specific companies if you only want to see the check information concerning the
respective companies. You can use the input help to select one or more companies.
● Check Lot
You can restrict the display to specific check lots assigned to a certain bank.
● Status
You can restrict the display to checks with a specific status. This status indicates, for example, whether a check
has already been cashed by the payee.
The following statuses are available: ○ Ready for Transfer
The check has been created but not been printed yet.
○ In TransferThe check has been printed. Although the check has been issued, it can still be voided, for example if had been
damaged before it could be sent to the payee.
○ CanceledThe complete check payment has been canceled. In this case no new check number exists as a replacement.
○ VoidThe check has been voided either before or after assigning a payment to the check and, if the check was voided
after issuing, a new check number has been used.
○ ConfirmedThis status means that the check has been cashed by the payee. The outgoing payment has been confirmed
by a bank statement.
Analyzing the Report
This report displays all check numbers already used as well as the information relevant to these checks, such as voiding
dates, void reasons, or check statuses.
You have the following options for analyzing the report:
● You can restrict the data that is displayed. To do this, click on the filter symbol and select the required values.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
● From this report, you can navigate to details, such as company or bank master data or to the check screen.
Additional information is available for the following characteristics:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Payment Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 247
● Original Check NumberShows the number of the original check, in case it has been voided and replaced be a new check number.
Otherwise, no value is displayed in this field.
● Migration IndicatorShows whether a check has been transferred from a legacy system. If no migration has taken place, no value is
displayed in this field.
● Payment AmountShows the payment amount for the corresponding check, irrespective of whether it has been voided or canceled
at some point in the payment process. Only if you have voided a check already in the check lot, 0,00 is displayed
as payment amount in this field.
See Also
Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checks [257]
248 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Payment Management
6 Liquidity Management
6.1 Business Background
6.1.1 Cash Position
Overview
The cash position displays actual bank balance and transaction details as provided by prior-day bank statements. The
cash position reflects the short term liquidity status of the company. The system provides you with an integrated,
overview of your cash position in the Liquidity Management work center.
Features
The system automatically calculates the cash position for your company. This information is displayed in the Cash
Position view of the Liquidity Management work center.
You can drilldown from cash position line items the Cash Position – Transaction Details report by choosing a transaction
source, for example Customer Receipts, and choosing Go To, then Transaction Details from the context menu.
The system also allows you to adjust your cash position dynamically during the course of the business day. The system
partially automates many of the processes for managing your liquidity as outlined below;
● The bank-to-bank transfer feature allows you to initiate fund transfers between company accounts. This quick
activity is accessed from the Common Tasks pane of the Liquidity Managementwork center. Alternatively you can
create a new bank-to-bank transfer in the Payment Monitor work center view.
● The bank transfer feature allows you to initiate payments to third party bank accounts, to pay outstanding bills or
expenses. This quick activity is also accessed from the Common Tasks pane of the Liquidity Management work
center. A new outgoing bank transfer can also be created in the Payment Monitor work center view.
● You may receive notice of intra-day payment activity in the form of a bank payment advice. The system allows you
to record these, so that they are reflected in the cash position, with the New Bank Payment Advices quick activity.
This is also opened from the Common Tasks pane of the Liquidity Management work center.
The system also allows you to view the cash position from a number of different perspectives. You can display the total
transaction amounts for each payment method grouped by bank. To do so, choose the Show arrow, then choose Cash
Position – Payment Method.
You can also view the cash position grouped by transaction source. This shows total transaction amounts for each
transaction source. To do so choose the Show arrow, then choose Cash Position – Transaction Source.
It is important that you refresh the cash position after you transfer funds or create a new bank payment advice
to ensure that the cash position displayed reflects your changes. To do so, choose Option , then choose
Refresh.
Example
Daniel Dough is the cash manager for Akron Heating Inc. He wishes to check the cash position for the current day. He
opens the Liquidity Managementwork center, Cash Position work center view.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 249
He can see that there is a cash deficit of 10,000 Euro in the company’s Bank of America account. He wishes to transfer
this amount, from a company bank account with a surplus, to the Bank of America account to avoid paying the debit
interest on the deficit. He selects New Bank-to-Bank Transfer from the Common Tasks pane. He completes the quick
activity and releases the transfer. He creates a payment file and saves it to the appropriate location for processing by
the bank.
Daniel also wishes to pay an outstanding expense with bank transfer. To do so, he selects New Bank Transfer from the
Common Tasks pane. He completes the quick activity and releases the transfer. He creates a payment file and saves
it to the appropriate location for processing by the bank.
Daniel receives a phone call notifying him of an intraday payment. He wishes to see this incoming payment captured
by the cash position. He opens the New Bank Payment Advices quick activity from the Common Tasks pane. He
completes the quick activity and saves, then he releases the document.
Finally, Daniel now wishes to view his changes in the cash position. He opens the Cash Position view as before. Daniel
cannot see his changes reflected in the cash position immediately. He refreshes the screen and then sees his changes
reflected in the cash position. He then drills down to view the transaction details report for Wires In for the Bank of
America.
6.1.2 Bank Directory
Overview
You can use the Bank Directory to store all the bank information necessary for your daily business operations in a central
repository. This directory is fully integrated within the system and is used by the system to validate bank details included
in payment information and validate bank data in business partner data. You can access the bank directory in the
Liquidity Management work center, Master Data Bank Directory view.
Creating the Bank Directory
You have the following options for creating your bank directory:
● You can create bank directory entries manually
● You can upload a bank directory from a third-party provider
● You can use a migration tool to create entries from a data spreadsheet
Manually Create a Bank Directory Entry
You can manually create a bank directory entry at any time in the Master Data Bank Directory view. For
information about how to complete this task, see the Master Data Quick Guide [276].
Upload a Bank Directory File
You can acquire a bank directory from a third-party provider, such as Accuity or the Deutsche Bundesbank (German
Central Bank), and upload it to SAP Business ByDesign. You can acquire the bank directory from other sources, for
example from many state-controlled banks, but you must edit the file by ordering the bank data to match the specific
format used by SAP Business ByDesign. For information about uploading a file from a provider other than Accuity or
the Deutsche Bundesbank, see SAP Format for Bank Directory Upload.
For information about uploading a file from Six Interbank Clearing, see Bank Directory Upload for Six Interbank Clearing
– Switzerland [252]
250 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
While many state-controlled banks offer bank directory files free of charge, other third-party providers may
charge a fee for this service. For more information on partner solutions and details about acquiring bank
directory files from Accuity, refer to the Business ByDesign Business Center.
You can upload the bank directory file for processing, in the Master Data Bank Directory view. For information
about how to complete this task, see the Master Data Quick Guide [276].
After the processing of the file is finished, the bank data contained in the file is displayed in the Bank Directory with a
status of Active. To view the bank directory file and view the overall status of the processing of the file, click
File Upload History in the Bank Directory view. If the overall status is red, you can correct any errors within the file and
restart the file processing.
Migrate Bank Directory Data
You also have the option to migrate bank data into your system using a migration tool available during an implementation
project in the activity list in the Business Configuration work center. Note that data migration requires special user
authorizations. Your key user can grant the required authorizations using the Application and User Management work
center.
Updating the Bank Directory
Bank directory information, such as addresses, contact details, and routing information can become out of date over
time. By updating your bank directory, your company can avoid any problems associated with using incorrect or outdated
information. You can keep your bank directory up to date by regularly uploading bank directory files from your provider
of choice. You can update and overwrite all existing bank directory entries, including those from other providers and
entries created manually, by selecting the Overwrite Existing Entries checkbox. Bank directory entries from a provider
are always overwritten when you upload a bank directory file from that same provider.
Editing Bank Directory Entries
To edit a bank directory entry, open the Bank Directory view. Select the entry that you want to edit and click Edit .
If you are using the Manage and Control Projects implementation focus, you can access your bank directory
from the Business Partner Data work center.
The editor is explained below.
● Bank DataEnter the contact details for the bank in this section. You can enter the time period that the entry is valid for. You
can also choose the appropriate check digit calculation method from the list. This list is maintained as bank directory
master data.
● SWIFT CodeUnder Bank Control Data, you enter the SWIFT, or alternatively the Bank Identifier Code (BIC), and select the bank
group that the bank belongs to. The SWIFT or BIC code is a unique identifier used to identify banks, most often in
international wire transfers and other transactions.
If you have accounts with several affiliated banks or several subsidiaries of the same bank, these banks may share
the same SWIFT or BIC code. You click Identification via SWIFT/BIC in two situations: ○ If the bank directory entry is the only bank directory entry that uses this standard ID for automatic payments.
That is, where this bank directory entry is the only entry for a particular bank and its SWIFT or BIC identifier.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 251
○ There may be more than one bank directory entry using the same SWIFT or BIC identifier. In this situation, the
system is unable to identify the appropriate bank directory entry to use. Clicking Identification via SWIFT/BIC
identifies the particular entry as the leading entry for this SWIFT or BIC identifier.
Click Identification via SWIFT/BIC in both situations to specify this bank directory entry as the leading bank. The
SWIFT or BIC is a unique identifier used by banks to identify themselves in transactions. The system will now
reference this bank directory entry for every transaction that uses the SWIFT or BIC identifier
● National Bank CodesThe national bank code details are used to identify the bank directory entry. You enter the national bank code details
in the National Bank Code table cell.
You can maintain multiple national bank code details for a single bank directory entry. To add national bank code
details click Add Row.
Generally, the national bank code type is entered automatically after you select the bank country. However, in
certain cases, you may enter the national bank code and national bank code type manually. For example, in the
United States, banks use many national bank codes and bank code types. Thus it is possible to manually enter the
national bank code and bank code type for banks in the United States.
Click Default to select the national bank code and national bank code type displayed as the default selection to be
used for this bank directory entry. The selected national bank code details will now be used for automatic and
electronic payments involving this entry.
You click the Identification via National Bank Code check box in two situations: ○ If the bank directory entry is the only bank directory entry that uses this national bank code for automatic
payments. That is, where this bank directory entry is the only entry for a particular bank and its national bank
code.
○ There may be multiple bank directory entries that use the same national bank code. In this situation, the system
is unable to identify the appropriate bank directory entry to use in automatic payments. Clicking the checkbox
identifies the particular entry as the leading entry for this national bank code.
Click Identification via National Bank Code in both situations to specify this bank directory entry as the leading bank.
The national bank code is a unique identifier used by banks to identify themselves in domestic transactions. The
system will now reference this bank directory entry for every transaction using the national bank code.
● Assigned BranchesYou enter the contact details and assign a Branch Name for each branch of the bank directory entry in the Assigned
Branches tab. The Branch ID is entered automatically by the system. To assign more than one branch to an entry,
click Add Row and enter the details on the new row.
If a bank directory entry is no longer relevant you can set the status to obsolete. Select the relevant entry,
click Actions , then Set to Obsolete.
6.1.3 Bank Directory Upload for Six Interbank Clearing – Switzerland
This document contains text that is relevant for Switzerland. To ensure that the system displays the correct
text, select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose
Switzerland. Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
252 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
6.1.4 Bank Statements
Overview
Getting up-to-date information about the status of your bank accounts is an important element of effective cash-flow
management. To get an accurate picture of the status of your bank accounts, you need information about your current
bank balance. Your bank provides you with this information via bank statements in either electronic or physical (paper)
formats. The system supports both bank statement formats. Paper bank statements are entered and updated in the
system manually in the Bank Statements view of the Liquidity Management work center. The system displays bank
statements that have been entered in the system in the same view. You can upload electronic bank statement files in
the Inbound Files subview of the File Management view of the same work center.
Business Configuration
The following options are available in the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center and are relevant
for bank statements.
● Import Formats for Bank StatementsYou can maintain the available file formats for bank statements and assign these to particular company bank
accounts, banks or countries in the Business Configuration work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune
step, choose Cash Flow Management > Import Formats for Bank Statements. For more information see Electronic
Bank Statement File Formats [274]
● Release Bank StatementsIf you require bank statements to be approved before they are released, you can do so in the Business
Configuration work center in the Activity List view. If no assignment is configured, the system automatically selects
a country dependent format. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > Release Bank Statements.
You can maintain the setting individually for each company bank account. The approval check is only applied to
bank statements that have been uploaded as electronic bank statement files. If you do not complete the activity,
the approval check is activated by default.
Features
Bank statements are entered and updated in the system in the Bank Reporting view in the Liquidity Management work
center.
The system displays bank statements that have been entered in the system in the Bank Statements view.
In the Show list, choose Released to see all the bank statements that have been entered and successfully released.
Statements that have been released cannot be deleted.
To be able to display bank statements for the current day, choose Today’s Bank Statements. The list displayed
provides an overview of work completed on the current day. This data is not part of the list This Month’s Bank
Statements.
After you release a bank statement, the system matches the bank statement line items to open payment allocations (by
automatically creating a payment allocation for each bank statement item) and tries to release these payment allocations.
The status of this bank statement processing displays in the Bank statement processing status field. This can have the
following status Not Started, In Process, Finished and Finished with Errors.
The Bank statement processing finished with errors field indicates whether any technical errors occur during bank
statement processing.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 253
If the processing does not display a status of Finished or if the bank statement processing finished with errors , you can
choose Restart Bank Statement Processing to start the processing again.
You can also release the payment allocations individually in the Payment Management work center.
If the payment allocation cannot be released for business (non-technical) reasons, for example an incorrect posting date
or incomplete business partner data, you can process the individual payment allocation tasks in the Payment
Management work center.
If you choose In Preparation, the bank statements have been entered and saved but not released are displayed.
If you choose Cancelled, the bank statements that have been reversed are displayed.
If you choose Void, the bank statements that have been rejected are displayed.
Importing and Editing Bank Statements
The system supports the manual and electronic import of both bank statements. However, the process for uploading
the statement into the system is different for both;
● Manual import of bank statementTo manually enter the information from a paper bank statement in the Bank Statement subview, choose
New , then Bank Statement.
● Electronic import of bank statementTo import an electronic bank statement file in the Inbound Files subview, choose New , then Inbound File.
You can also edit existing bank statements (that have been entered manually and have a status of In Preparation) in
the Bank Statements view. Select the bank statement that you wish to edit and choose Edit .
You cannot edit automatically created bank statements, you can only approve or reject these statements.
Bank Statement Integration
The system saves bank account statements and then posts them in general ledger according to the account
determination rules set during business configuration.
Bank statement processing relies on a structure of clearing accounts for each bank account in the system.
The first posting derives automatically from due items processing and payment processing; the second is made
automatically by the bank statement. The bank statement is posted to the relevant bank account to offset the clearing
account posting.
This process is illustrated best by the most usual business example, a bank transfer;
● A completed and released bank transfer, (with a status of In Preparation), triggers the creation of a posting on the
bank clearing account.
● You receive a bank statement from your bank. The bank transfer is recorded as a payment line item in the bank
statement. When this bank statement is uploaded and released this creates a posting in the bank account. This
posting offsets the clearing account posting.
● The status of the bank transfer in the system changes from In Preparation to Confirmed.
There are some exceptions to this process, such as bank fees and interest.
Bank charges and interest are supported. However, manual payment allocation may be required, depending on where
the line items are included on the bank statement.
For example, you may receive a bank statement containing bank charges or interest line items that are included as
separate items in the statement, you need to perform manual payment allocation to assign these to the correct general
ledger bank account.
254 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
For more information see Payment Allocation and Clearing [188] .
Example
Businesses tend to receive their bank statements as either paper or an electronic file but not both. However, both are
mentioned below for the purpose of the example.
Daniel Dough is the cash manager for Akron Heating Inc. He receives a bank statement in the post.
He opens the Liquidity Management work center, Bank Statements view. He chooses New , then Bank Statement.
The Create Bank Statement guided activity appears. He manually enters the bank statement details and saves.
Daniel also receives an electronic bank statement via Akron’s banking software.
He opens the Inbound Files subview. He chooses New , then Inbound File. The New Inbound File quick activity
screen opens. He completes the quick activity and saves.
The bank statements are saved and released.
Additional Information on Processing Bank Statements
After bank statements have been confirmed or released, the system then posts the relevant items.
If the items confirm known transactions in the system (for example, cashing an existing outgoing check, confirming a
bank transfer or the credit memo of a check deposit), these items are then displayed in the Payment Management work
center in the Payment Monitor view in addition to the original payment. This means, for example, that the system displays
both the item of the original outgoing check, with the status “In Transfer,” and the item with the payment confirmed by
bank statement (the outgoing check with the status “Confirmed.”) Once the payment has been posted completely, the
system automatically allocates both items. (This process is started automatically each minute.) After the items have
been allocated successfully, only one payment is displayed in the payment monitor – in this case, the outgoing check
with the status "Confirmed."
You can track the processing status of the bank statement by accessing the Bank Statements view and selecting the
relevant bank statement. In the lower area of the screen, under Details, the Status of Bank Statement Processing field
shows the following phases:
● Not Started
● In Process
● Completed
Depending on the volume of the bank statement, processing may take some time. Once the allocation of the bank
statement items has been completed and the status "Completed" displayed, only the payment with the status
"Confirmed" can be viewed in the payment monitor. If technical problems cause processing to be terminated, you can
restart the process using Restart Bank Statement Processing.
6.1.5 Bank Transfers
Overview
You can use bank transfers to make both automatic and manual outgoing payments. There are two types of bank
transfer: bank transfers, which are used to make payments from a company account to third-party accounts; and bank-
to-bank transfers, which are used to transfer funds between company bank accounts. These are used mainly for
transfers relating to liquidity management.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 255
Business Configuration
The following options are available in the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center and are relevant
for bank transfers;
● Outgoing Bank TransfersYou can review and change some of the predefined settings for outgoing bank transfers in the Business
Configuration work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management >
Outgoing Bank Transfers you can adjust the settings for the following:
Country Groups; A country group exists where payments between members are considered domestic payments
for example the European Union. You can also create your own country groups.
Payment Formats; Shows the relationship between the internal and external codes used to convey payment
information between the system and the bank for each available payment format. These formats are standardized
so you should only need to change these settings if your company has a specialized arrangement with the bank.
Payment Correspondence Profiles; You can choose what fields to include in your correspondence forms for each
payment correspondence profile.
● Outgoing Wire TransfersYou can review and change the same settings for outgoing wire transfers in the Business Configuration work center
in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > Outgoing Wire Transfers.
Features
Bank transfers and bank-to-bank transfers can both be created from anywhere in the Liquidity Management work center
from the Common Tasks pane.
You can also create a new outgoing bank or bank-to-bank transfer in the Payment Monitor view of the Liquidity
Management and Payment Management work centers.
New bank transfers may also be initiated in the Payables and Receivables work centers manually or automatically as
part of a manual or automatic payment.
Payment File Integration
A bank transfer or a bank-to-bank transfer is not complete until the payment information contained in the transfer is
made available to the bank or banking software for collection and processing.
A new file in the appropriate file format must be created to complete the transfer. This file is then saved to a designated
location outside the system for collection by the bank or banking software.
The file can be created either automatically or manually.
The payment file media run will create the file automatically.
You can create the payment file created manually in the Outbound Files subview of the File Management work center
view by selecting the appropriate transfer and choosing Create Payment File .
256 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
6.1.6 Bank Payment Advice
Overview
A bank payment advice contains items in the cash position that are not captured automatically by the integrated
repositories. The bank payment advice acts like a memo, ensuring that the item is reflected in the current cash position.
You should replace the bank payment advice with a transaction record in the next bank statement.
SAP supports a number of national and international file formats (for example, format V11 in Switzerland or CREMULin Austria) for bank payment advices.
You can view the details for every bank payment advice entered in the system in the Bank Payment Advices view of
the Liquidity Management work center.
Cash Position and Liquidity Forecast Integration
The new bank payment advice is automatically captured by the cash position and liquidity forecast. However, it is visible
only after you refresh the Cash Position view. In the Cash Position view, click the Refresh button to refresh the cash
position.
You can view all existing bank payment advises for your company grouped according to their status in the Bank Payment
Advices view in the Liquidity Management work center. From here you can release bank payment advises that have a
status of In Preparation. You can also reverse (cancel) and edit existing payment advises.
Bank payment advises with a status of Released are the only advices captured by the cash position.
Example
Daniel Dough is the cash manager for Akron Heating Inc. Daniel has received a new bank payment advice in the post
detailing a future payment from a customer’s bank. He wishes to capture this in his cash position for the day.
He opens the Liquidity Management work center. He chooses New Bank Payment Advices from the Common Tasks
pane. He completes the quick activity and clicks Save.
The bank payment advice must be released. Daniel opens the Bank Payment Advices subview. In the Show list, he
chooses Bank Payment Advices In Preparation. He selects the relevant bank payment advice and clicks Release.
Daniel now wishes to see the effect of the new bank payment advice on his cash position. He opens the Cash
Position view and refreshes the screen. He can see his new bank payment advice captured by the cash position.
Daniel then drills down to view the Cash Position – Transaction Details report by right clicking on a transaction source,
for example Customer Receipts, and selecting Go To, then Transaction Details from the context menu.
6.1.7 Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checks
Check lots and the check number ranges are shown in the Liquidity Management work center under Master
Data My Banks . Double-click on your bank, and select View All Bank Accounts Check Lots .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 257
Automatic Check Number Assignment
So that the system can automatically assign check numbers, you must have created a check lot for the appropriate bank
account in the master data of the bank, and have set the indicator Used for Automatic Check Numbering. The automatic
check number assignment assigns consecutive numbers to checks while skipping already used check numbers and
recycling check numbers released by cancellations. The new check number is displayed in the check lot under Next
Check.
Manual Check Number Assignment
If, however, you enter the check number manually, the system checks whether a check lot exists for the relevant bank
account, and whether the number entered was not used yet. If this is the case, the system uses the check lot information
in the check entered. If no check lot or appropriate check number in the check lot was found for the relevant bank
account, the system generates a check without check lot assignment and displays an appropriate warning message.
Skip Next Check Number
If a check form becomes invalid before creating the check, you can skip the number displayed in the check lot under
Next Check. To do this, you must first remove the invalid number from the check lot. Select the check lot and choose
Void Unused Check. Enter the check number of the check to be voided, the void date, and void reason. The consecutive
number is now displayed under Next Check.
Overview of Check Numbers Used
To get an overview of the check numbers already used, proceed as follows:
1. Go to the Payment Monitor view.
2. Enter the relevant bank account and the payment method Outgoing Check as the filter values.
3. Sort the check numbers in the column Reference Number.
Change Check Numbers Subsequently
You can subsequently change the check numbers of one or multiple checks at the same time. Before you can perform
this action, the following prerequisites must be fulfilled:
● The checks to be changed must belong to one check lot.
● The selected number range must be in the value range of the check lot.
● The selected check numbers must be consecutive numbers.
● The checks to be changed have the status Ready for Transfer, In Transfer, or Cancelled.
● The check lot is not be indicated as Blocked.
● If you specify a number range, the difference between the highest and lowest value must correspond to the number
of checks to be changed.
To change check numbers, you first determine the next check number that has not been used. Under the Payment
Monitor view, select the relevant checks using <Ctrl>+left mouse button and choose Actions for
Checks Renumber . For one check, enter the lowest check number and for multiple checks, the check number range
to be used. The renumbering means that the values under Current Check and Next Check are automatically updated
in the check lot.
258 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Toggle Check Numbers
You can toggle the numbers of two checks within a check lot subsequently. Before you can perform these actions, the
following prerequisites must be fulfilled:
● The checks to be changed must belong to one check lot.
● The checks to be changed have the status Ready for Transfer, In Transfer, or Cancelled.
● The check lot is not be indicated as Blocked.
To toggle two check numbers in a check lot, select the relevant checks using <Ctrl>+left mouse button and choose
Actions for Checks Toggle .
Split Check Lot
You can split a check lot subsequently. This is useful, for example, if you want to create a check lot for automatically
created checks and a check lot for manually created checks. To do this, proceed as follows:
1. Go to Master Data My Banks and select the bank that you want to edit.
2. Go to Bank Accounts Check Lot .
3. Determine the next check number of the check lot to be split.
4. Select the row of the check lot to be split and choose Split Check Lot.
5. Enter a consecutive number and the first check number for the new check lot.
6.1.8 Monitoring Payment Allocation Processing
Overview
After bank statements have been confirmed or released, the system then posts the items. If the items confirm known
transactions in the system (for example, cashing an existing outgoing check, or confirming a bank transfer or the credit
memo of a check deposit), these bank statement items are then also displayed in the Payment Monitor view until the
payment allocation has been processed..
Once the payment has been posted completely, the system automatically allocates both items–the outgoing check,
bank transfer, or check deposit and the bank statement item. (This process is started automatically each minute.) After
the items have been allocated successfully, only one payment is displayed in the payment monitor – in this case, the
outgoing check with the status Confirmed.
To track the payment allocation processing status of the bank statement, proceed as follows:
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center, then choose the Bank Statements view.
2. Select the relevant bank statement.
3. In the lower area of the screen, under Details, the Status of Payment Allocation Processing field shows the following
phases: ● Not Started
● In Process
● Finished
Depending on the volume of the bank statement, processing may take some time.
4. Once the allocation of the bank statement items has been completed and the status Finished displayed, only the
payment with the status Finished can be viewed in the payment monitor.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 259
To restart the process in case technical problems cause processing to be terminated, choose
Restart Payment Allocation Processing .
6.1.9 Master Data
6.1.9.1 Clearing Houses and Clearing House Accounts
Overview
A clearing house (also referred to as acquirer) is a financial institution or service provider that acts as a third party in the
clearing of future payment contracts, for example credit card payments, for either the payer or payee or both. A bank
may act as a clearing house. However, a clearing house does not necessarily have to be a bank. Clearing houses are
maintained in the system in the Liquidity Management work center. Clearing house master data is maintained in the
Clearing Houses subview of the Master Data work center view. Individual clearing house account data is maintained in
the Clearing House Account subview, in the same work center view.
Business Configuration
The following options are available in the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center and are relevant
for clearing houses;
● Credit Card TypesYou can review and change predefined settings for the allowed credit card types, such as VISA or Diners Club in
the Business Configuration work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine-Tune step, choose Cash Flow
Management > Credit Card Types. You can also review and change the validity check for each credit card type
here.
● Credit Card Authorization and SettlementYou can review and change the authorization and settlement settings for credit cards in the Business
Configuration work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine-Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > Credit
Card Authorization and Settlement. From here, you can edit the following settings: ○ Credit Card Authorization Profiles
Review and change the predefined credit card authorization profiles . You can also assign authorization profiles
to your company.
○ Payment Authorization Threshold ProfilesReview and change the payment authorization profiles. Payments below the specified amounts do not require
authorization. You can also assign authorization profiles to your company.
○ Credit Card SettlementsSpecify the settings for settling incoming credit card payments, such as single or batch settlement. You can also
assign settlement profiles to your company.
Features
To create a new clearing house entry, open the Clearing Houses subview and click New , then Clearing House.
Enter the required data and click Save .
To create a new clearing house account, open the Clearing House Accounts subview in the Master Data work center
view and click New , then Clearing House Account. The New Clearing House Account screen displays.
260 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Enter the clearing house company’s ID in the Clearing House ID field and enter the number used by the clearing house
to identify your company in the Merchant ID field. You receive this ID from your credit card service provider. You select
the company ID of the company that will use the account in the Company ID field. You can also enter the time period
during which the account remains valid.
There are also three tabs to be completed, explained below.
● Account
You enter an internal identifier in the Account Number field. This is used for information purposes only. You select
the currency that the clearing house will use to report to your company in the Currency field. You must also select
the bank account ID of the account the clearing house will make payments to. You select your chosen credit card
service provider in the Payment Service Provider field, if applicable.
Credit cards are the only supported payment card category.
● Preferred Currency
You select the currencies that you would like this clearing house account to process. If, for example, you enter EUR
as a currency, then all credit card payments made in Euro will be processed by this account. If no currency is
selected, the account will process credit card payments in all supported currencies.
You may maintain multiple currencies for the same account.
● Credit Card Type
You select the particular credit card types, such as VISA or Mastercard, that will be processed by the account in
the Credit Card Type column.
You enter the authorization validity period in the Authorization Validity Days column.
Your credit card service provider will, in most cases, provide you with the number of days for which the authorization
will remain valid. The service provider receives this information from the acquirer (clearing house) and
communicates it to you. You then enter this information manually.
The system automatically references the authorization validity date contained in an electronic authorization request.
If the request does not contain this date, the system uses the authorization validity days entered by you to calculate
the authorization validity date. In this case, the system automatically calculates the authorization validity date by
summing the current date and the authorization validity days entered by you.
If you do not enter anything in the Authorization Validity Days column, the system then uses the current date as
the authorization validity date. The transaction will be processed in the system but the transaction will not be
authorized, as the authorization period will be zero.
You select the Default checkbox if you want to select this account as the exclusive processor for a particular credit
card type. All credit card payments made using this credit card type will be processed by this account.
After you complete the activity, you must save and activate the account.
Example
Daniel Dough is the cash manager with Akron Heating Technologies Inc. The company has recently opened a new
account with a new clearing house. He wishes to record this in the system.
Daniel opens the Clearing Houses subview of the Master Data work center view in the Liquidity Management work
center. He chooses New , then Clearing House. The New Clearing House screen opens. He enters the required data
and clicks Save .
Daniel now wishes to add the account details to the new clearing house. He opens the Clearing House Accounts subview.
The New Clearing House Account screen opens.
He enters the required data and saves his entries. Daniel now wishes to activate the account. He clicks Change
Status, then Active.
The new clearing house and clearing house account are now created in the system and are ready for use.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 261
6.1.9.2 Bank Directory
Overview
You can use the Bank Directory to store all the bank information necessary for your daily business operations in a central
repository. This directory is fully integrated within the system and is used by the system to validate bank details included
in payment information and validate bank data in business partner data. You can access the bank directory in the
Liquidity Management work center, Master Data Bank Directory view.
Creating the Bank Directory
You have the following options for creating your bank directory:
● You can create bank directory entries manually
● You can upload a bank directory from a third-party provider
● You can use a migration tool to create entries from a data spreadsheet
Manually Create a Bank Directory Entry
You can manually create a bank directory entry at any time in the Master Data Bank Directory view. For
information about how to complete this task, see the Master Data Quick Guide [276].
Upload a Bank Directory File
You can acquire a bank directory from a third-party provider, such as Accuity or the Deutsche Bundesbank (German
Central Bank), and upload it to SAP Business ByDesign. You can acquire the bank directory from other sources, for
example from many state-controlled banks, but you must edit the file by ordering the bank data to match the specific
format used by SAP Business ByDesign. For information about uploading a file from a provider other than Accuity or
the Deutsche Bundesbank, see SAP Format for Bank Directory Upload.
For information about uploading a file from Six Interbank Clearing, see Bank Directory Upload for Six Interbank Clearing
– Switzerland [252]
While many state-controlled banks offer bank directory files free of charge, other third-party providers may
charge a fee for this service. For more information on partner solutions and details about acquiring bank
directory files from Accuity, refer to the Business ByDesign Business Center.
You can upload the bank directory file for processing, in the Master Data Bank Directory view. For information
about how to complete this task, see the Master Data Quick Guide [276].
After the processing of the file is finished, the bank data contained in the file is displayed in the Bank Directory with a
status of Active. To view the bank directory file and view the overall status of the processing of the file, click
File Upload History in the Bank Directory view. If the overall status is red, you can correct any errors within the file and
restart the file processing.
Migrate Bank Directory Data
You also have the option to migrate bank data into your system using a migration tool available during an implementation
project in the activity list in the Business Configuration work center. Note that data migration requires special user
authorizations. Your key user can grant the required authorizations using the Application and User Management work
center.
262 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Updating the Bank Directory
Bank directory information, such as addresses, contact details, and routing information can become out of date over
time. By updating your bank directory, your company can avoid any problems associated with using incorrect or outdated
information. You can keep your bank directory up to date by regularly uploading bank directory files from your provider
of choice. You can update and overwrite all existing bank directory entries, including those from other providers and
entries created manually, by selecting the Overwrite Existing Entries checkbox. Bank directory entries from a provider
are always overwritten when you upload a bank directory file from that same provider.
Editing Bank Directory Entries
To edit a bank directory entry, open the Bank Directory view. Select the entry that you want to edit and click Edit .
If you are using the Manage and Control Projects implementation focus, you can access your bank directory
from the Business Partner Data work center.
The editor is explained below.
● Bank DataEnter the contact details for the bank in this section. You can enter the time period that the entry is valid for. You
can also choose the appropriate check digit calculation method from the list. This list is maintained as bank directory
master data.
● SWIFT CodeUnder Bank Control Data, you enter the SWIFT, or alternatively the Bank Identifier Code (BIC), and select the bank
group that the bank belongs to. The SWIFT or BIC code is a unique identifier used to identify banks, most often in
international wire transfers and other transactions.
If you have accounts with several affiliated banks or several subsidiaries of the same bank, these banks may share
the same SWIFT or BIC code. You click Identification via SWIFT/BIC in two situations: ○ If the bank directory entry is the only bank directory entry that uses this standard ID for automatic payments.
That is, where this bank directory entry is the only entry for a particular bank and its SWIFT or BIC identifier.
○ There may be more than one bank directory entry using the same SWIFT or BIC identifier. In this situation, the
system is unable to identify the appropriate bank directory entry to use. Clicking Identification via SWIFT/BIC
identifies the particular entry as the leading entry for this SWIFT or BIC identifier.
Click Identification via SWIFT/BIC in both situations to specify this bank directory entry as the leading bank. The
SWIFT or BIC is a unique identifier used by banks to identify themselves in transactions. The system will now
reference this bank directory entry for every transaction that uses the SWIFT or BIC identifier
● National Bank CodesThe national bank code details are used to identify the bank directory entry. You enter the national bank code details
in the National Bank Code table cell.
You can maintain multiple national bank code details for a single bank directory entry. To add national bank code
details click Add Row.
Generally, the national bank code type is entered automatically after you select the bank country. However, in
certain cases, you may enter the national bank code and national bank code type manually. For example, in the
United States, banks use many national bank codes and bank code types. Thus it is possible to manually enter the
national bank code and bank code type for banks in the United States.
Click Default to select the national bank code and national bank code type displayed as the default selection to be
used for this bank directory entry. The selected national bank code details will now be used for automatic and
electronic payments involving this entry.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 263
You click the Identification via National Bank Code check box in two situations: ○ If the bank directory entry is the only bank directory entry that uses this national bank code for automatic
payments. That is, where this bank directory entry is the only entry for a particular bank and its national bank
code.
○ There may be multiple bank directory entries that use the same national bank code. In this situation, the system
is unable to identify the appropriate bank directory entry to use in automatic payments. Clicking the checkbox
identifies the particular entry as the leading entry for this national bank code.
Click Identification via National Bank Code in both situations to specify this bank directory entry as the leading bank.
The national bank code is a unique identifier used by banks to identify themselves in domestic transactions. The
system will now reference this bank directory entry for every transaction using the national bank code.
● Assigned BranchesYou enter the contact details and assign a Branch Name for each branch of the bank directory entry in the Assigned
Branches tab. The Branch ID is entered automatically by the system. To assign more than one branch to an entry,
click Add Row and enter the details on the new row.
If a bank directory entry is no longer relevant you can set the status to obsolete. Select the relevant entry,
click Actions , then Set to Obsolete.
6.1.9.3 Banks and Bank Accounts
Overview
Your company bank and bank account data is maintained in the Liquidity Management work center, Master
Data My Banks view. The system assigns each bank a unique bank identifier, known as the Bank ID. Bank accounts
are also assigned a unique identifier known as the Bank Account ID.
The New Bank quick activity allows you to create a company bank record and related bank account(s).
Prerequisites
You have created your bank directory in the Master Data Bank Directory view. For information about creating
the bank directory, see About the Bank Directory [250]About the Bank Directory [262].
Each bank account that you create in the system must correspond to exactly one bank account at your bank.
You cannot create a new bank entry without an existing and corresponding bank directory entry for that bank. You must
assign a Bank ID from the bank directory to each new bank entry you create. This Bank ID is stored in the bank directory
and referenced by the bank entry. If a suitable bank directory entry does not exist, you can create a new bank directory
entry and assign the new Bank ID to the new bank entry as required.
Fine Tuning Settings
The following options are available in the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center and are relevant
for banks and bank accounts;
● Bank GroupsYou can review and change the settings for bank groups in the Business Configuration work center in the Activity
List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > Bank Groups. Bank groups are used for the
264 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
optimization of bank determination during the processing of automatic payments. Payments processed within a
particular bank group may have shorter processing times and reduced fees.
● Bank Account Determination and Prioritization for Automatic PaymentsYou can maintain a sequence of company bank accounts and payment procedures to be used in automatic
payments in the Business Configuration work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash
Flow Management > Bank Account Determination and Prioritization for Automatic Payments. You can also prioritize
bank accounts and payment procedures based on certain selection parameters to match your business
requirements.
For example you can change the settings so you pay large, infrequent expenses, such as a supplier payment, by
check. The check float may improve liquidity situation in the short term. However, check processing is also
expensive and time consuming. This may not be a suitable payment method for paying small, recurring expenses.
You can change the settings to have these expenses paid by electronic bank transfer.
General Ledger Posting
The creation of a new bank entry and related bank account(s) is recorded in the general ledger as follows;
● All bank transactions are documented as a journal entry. The system derives the general ledger and associated
subledgers automatically from the journal entries.
● Each individual bank account entry you create corresponds to a bank account in the cash ledger. This subledger
records all the transactions made to and from the bank account.
● These subledgers in the cash ledger are aggregated by the system into a single general ledger account that
represents the bank entry. This account details all transactions for all bank accounts assigned to the particular bank
entry.
Creating a New My Banks Entry
You can create a new bank by choosing New , then My Bank in the My Banks subview. The My Banks editor displays.
You can display all the relevant fields by choosing View All. The tabs displayed are:
● GeneralYou assign the Bank ID here. You must also enter a name and select the working day calendar that applies to this
bank. These fields are mandatory.
You can also enter address and communication details for the bank. The system uses the information you enter
here as the default main address on the next tab.
● AddressesYou can enter and edit multiple addresses for the bank and also select the address that will be used as the default
address for this bank.
● ContactsYou can enter and edit contact details for individual employees of the bank. You can also select an employee as
the default contact for communications with this bank.
● Payment FormatsYou select the allowed payment formats used for payments made from bank accounts held at this bank. You can
choose the payment format(s) used for payments made from this account. This is the allowed payment file format
such as bank transfer or direct debit. The payment methods available for the bank account are derived from the
payment formats you select for the bank. The available payment formats are displayed in a list. Only those formats
delivered with the system can be used. For more information see Electronic Payment Formats [274].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 265
This document contains text that is relevant for Austira only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize> My Settings. Select the Onscreen Help and choose Austria in the Country drop-down menu.
Save your settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
Check printing is available as a default payment method. You do not need to select a specific payment
format for the bank to select check printing as a payment method.
● Bank AccountsYou can enter and edit multiple bank accounts for a bank entry. You choose Add Row and enter the bank account
number, an account description, and a time period for which the account will remain valid. For more details see the
section below.
After you have completed the fields above choose Save . The new bank is automatically assigned a status of Active.
Click Close to close the quick activity.
The new bank is displayed in the My Banks subview.
You can edit a bank at any time in the same subview. Select the bank entry you wish to edit, choose Edit , then select
the particular data you want to edit.
This section contains text that is relevant for Austria only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text, select
Personalize> My Settings. Select the Onscreen Help and choose Austria in the Country drop-down menu. Save your
settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
Creating a New Bank Account
You enter the details for each bank account held with the bank on the Bank Accounts tab of the bank editor. You choose
Add Row to create a new bank account. The available tabs are explained below.
● AccountYou must select an account determination group for each bank account that you create. This determines which
bank group journal entries will be posted to in the general ledger accounts. This field is mandatory and must be
maintained for each bank account. You can also select an account type from the available list.
Your bank may supply you with details of the IBAN or BBAN or check digit calculation method for this account. You
can enter these in the relevant fields.
You can also enter a Minimum Amount, Maximum Amount and Overdraft Limit for the bank account. These limits
are usually agreed with your bank and help you to ensure that the liquidity levels in the account remain within the
thresholds agreed with your bank. The Overdraft Limit is mandatory and must be maintained. If this field is not
maintained, it is set to zero by default. For more information see Liquidity Check [268].
In some cases, you can hold several bank accounts at the same bank that use the same bank account number.
For example, your company may make a large number of foreign currency transactions and thus, use several
different bank accounts (each processing a different currency) with the same bank account number. You can enter
an alternative account number to distinguish this account from other accounts that may use the same bank account
number. in the Alternative Account Number field.
If you want to pay the bank fees for this bank account with another account, you can enter the bank account number
of the account that you wish to use to pay the fee in the Bank Account for Fee field.
You cannot delete a bank account from the system once it has been activated.
● Alternative CurrencyIf you want to maintain postings in a currency other than the main account currency, you can select the alternative
currencies on the Alternative Currency tab. You choose Add Row and select the appropriate currencies, as
required.
● Payment Methods
266 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
You select the payment methods that can be used to make payments from this account. The available payment
methods are defined by the payment formats you selected on Payment Formats tab earlier. For example, if you
select SEPA Credit Transfer on the Payment Formats tab, you can then select SEPA Credit Transfer on the bank
account’s Payment Method tab.
● Check LotsA check lot is a group of checks issued from the same bank account. You can maintain the details for each check
lot on the Check Lot tab.
You choose Add Row to create a new check lot. You must enter a check lot id, description, and the numbers of
the next and last check in the check lot. These fields are mandatory. The system automatically enters the check
ids of the current and next checks based on the outgoing checks issued.
You must also select one or more payment methods in the Allowed Check Lot Payment Method text box. You can,
for example, select printed check, bank checks or bank checks for international payments.
If you wish to issue outgoing checks from this check lot, you must select the Used for Automatic Check
Numbering check box. This also ensures that the system provides the appropriate check number for the Outgoing
Check quick activity.
You can also enter the ID of the next check lot that will be issued from this account in the Next Check Lot ID field.
The Receipt Date field is user maintained and for information purposes only. You may, if you want, enter the date
you received the particular check lot, for your own records.
If the check lot that you received was already numbered, you select the Prenumbered Check Forms check box.
You can also enter a description of the method of output, for example a printer, in the Output Device field. You can
also enter a description of the storage location and the check prefix and suffix.
● Payment Transaction ConditionsThis tab is only relevant if you process bills of exchange with this bank account. You may have preferential
arrangements with your bank for processing bills of exchange. You specify the terms of this arrangement on the
Payment Transactions Conditions tab. You select the particular type of bill of exchange (payable or receivable) in
the Document Type column. Then, you can select the transaction conditions agreed with your bank for the bills of
exchange payable and receivable processed by this account.
You can, for example, enter 50000 Euro per year as the Minimum Transaction Volume. This means that you have
agreed with the that this bank account must process at least 50000 Euro per year for this particular bill of exchange.
You can enter the lowest required number of transactions in the Minimum Transaction Number column.
You can also enter an agreed number of days that the Value Date may exceed the Due Date in the Agreed Delay
of Value Date after Due Date column. For example, if you enter two days, the bank will credit the account two days
after due date.
You can also enter the minimum of number of days that must exist between the deposit date and the due date in
the Minimum Advance of Deposit Date before Due Date column. For example, if you enter two days, the deposit
date should occur at least two days before the due date.
The Minimum Advance of Deposit Date before Due Date and the Agreed Delay of Value Date after the Due Date
are inter dependent. For example, you may have a bill of exchange receivable with a due date of May 15th. You
have entered three days in the Minimum Advance of Deposit Date before Due Date column and two days in the
Agreed Delay of Value Date after Due Date column for the relevant bank account. You must deposit this bill of
exchange by May 12th , three days before the due date. The value date will be May 17th , according to the payment
transaction conditions you specified for the bank account.
If you deposit the bill of exchange after May 12th, the value date is proportionally delayed. For example, if you
deposit the bill of exchange on May 15th, the value date will be May 20th. This is because the system still applies
the payment transaction conditions set for the bank account, despite the fact that you deposited the bill of exchange
before the due date. This means that the bill of exchange will not be processed before the agreed due date.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 267
6.1.9.4 ISR Payments - Switzerland
This document contains text that is relevant for Switzerland. To ensure that the system displays the correct
text, select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose
Switzerland. Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
6.1.10 Liquidity Forecasts
6.1.10.1 Liquidity Check
Overview
A liquidity check is performed each time an outgoing payment is created to verify that there are sufficient funds available
to facilitate the payment.
The liquidity check is performed for all outgoing payments created in the Payables, Receivables, Liquidity
Management, and Payment Management work centers. This includes the following payment methods:
● Outgoing Wire Transfer
● Outgoing Bank Transfer
● Outgoing Check
● Bill of Exchange Payable
No liquidity check is performed for tax payments and cash transfers.
You can choose not to perform the liquidity check by selecting the Release Without Liquidity Allocation check
box when you create the outgoing payment .
The section below explains how the liquidity check works.
Process Flow
When an outgoing payment is created, a liquidity check is performed on the relevant bank account.
The system adds the transaction amount to the balance of the relevant bank account and checks this against the
following fields on the bank account editor:
● Maximum Amount
● Minimum Amount
● Overdraft Limit
The system uses the confirmed bank account balance and the planned liquidity at a specified due date to calculate the
relevant bank account balance. The system uses incoming and outgoing payment advices, incoming and outgoing bank
payment advices, and outgoing bank transfers yet to be transferred, to calculate the planned liquidity. This means that
expected liquidity items, for example an outgoing bank transfer yet to be transferred, are captured when the system
268 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
calculates the bank account balance. However, incoming bank transfers yet to be transferred are not included as no
record of these exists in the system.
To calculate the transaction amount, the system compares the transaction currency and the bank account currency. If
these are different, the transaction currency is converted into the bank account currency.
The liquidity check is performed as follows:
1. The system sums the transaction amount and the bank account balance. If this amount is less than the Overdraft
Limit, the payment is rejected. If not, the next stage of the liquidity check is performed.
2. The system again sums the transaction amount and the bank account balance. If this is less than the Minimum
Amount, the payment is released but with limited liquidity.
Released with limited liquidity means that the system will allow the payment to be made from this account however,
an account with a more suitable liquidity position is preferred. The system prioritizes the preferred account ahead
of the other account when the payment proposal is created.
If the sum of the transaction amount and the bank account balance is greater than the Minimum Amount, the next
stage of the liquidity check is performed.
3. The system again sums the transaction amount and the bank account balance. If this amount is greater than the
Maximum Amount, the payment is released but with limited liquidity. If not, the payment is released with sufficient
liquidity.
6.1.10.2 Liquidity Forecast
The liquidity forecast displays expected cash inflows and outflows for an upcoming period of time. The exact time period
shown is defined in the system configuration. This information allows you to monitor your liquidity position, helping you
make short and medium term investment and financing decisions. The most recent liquidity forecast is created and
displayed in the Liquidity Forecasts view.
The default configuration setting for the time period for the liquidity forecast is ninety working days.
System Settings
Configuration settings are normally performed by a key user. If you do not have the required authorization,
contact your key user.
The following settings are relevant for the liquidity forecast:
● Ensure that Cash and Liquidity is activated in your system configuration. To find this business option, go to the
Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation
project and click Edit Project Scope. In the Scoping step of the project, ensure that Payment and Liquidity
Management is selected within the Cash Flow Management area.
In the Questions step, expand the Cash Flow Management scoping element and select Payment and Liquidity
Management. Select Cash and Liquidity and answer the questions related to liquidity forecasts.
● In the Fine Tune step, review and specify the settings under Global Settings for Cash and Liquidity Management.
● In the Fine Tune step, review and specify the settings of the optional Liquidity Forecast activity.
You can extend the time period for the forecast and, create new profile codes that you use in certain circumstances.
You can for instance set up liquidity forecast profiles by region (For example you can assign only European
companies to a dedicated profile).
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 269
Creating a Liquidity Forecast
As a matter of best practice, you should perform the liquidity forecast only after the relevant data has been processed
in the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management and Payment Management work centers, that is, later in the working
day. You should ensure that open clearing and allocation tasks are completed and payment reservations are released.
You should also enter and upload all available bank statements. This ensures that the liquidity forecast is as accurate
as possible.
1. Create a New Forecast RunThe liquidity forecast is based on data collected by the liquidity forecast run. You can create a new liquidity forecast
run in the Liquidity Management work center. You can also select whether you want to execute the run immediately
or at another point in the future. You may also schedule forecast runs on a frequent and recurring basis to avoid
having to repeat the same task each time you wish to create a new liquidity forecast.
The system then gathers all the data that exists within the system as defined by the parameters of the run. You
must create and release the relevant business documents, where necessary, to ensure the system can capture
the data, for example you must release all forecast planning items.
The system gathers data from the following sources: ● Trade Receivables such as Customer Invoices and Credit Memos
● Trade Payables such as Supplier Invoices and Credit Memos
● Released Travel Expense Reports
● Tax Payables and Receivables such as open items from released invoices and tax returns
● Incoming and Outgoing Payments
● Forecast Planning items that are released and have an expiry date in the future
The system collects the relevant data from the sources above and aggregates it. Then, the system calculates the
date of these items.
The system calculates the dates differently depending on the item, as outlined below: ● For Customer Invoices paid using an incoming direct debit, the date of the cash discount terms depending on
the payment strategy settings, is used. For customer invoices using all other payment methods except
incoming direct debit, the due date for the full payment is used.
● For Credit Memos, the due date is used.
● For open tax items from released invoices, the first day of the next month after the invoice date is used.
● For Tax Returns, the posting date of the tax return is used.
● For Incoming and Outgoing Payments, the value date is used. The system calculates the value date differently
for each payment method.
● For Forecast Planning Items, the value date is used.
Overdue PaymentsOpen receivables and payables with a due date before the date of the liquidity forecast, and payments that are not
yet assigned to a source document are displayed on the first date of the liquidity forecast under Overdue
Payments. To display the overdue items including their original value date select Liquidity Forecast – Transaction
Details from the context menu of the amount field. Drag and drop the Original Value Date attribute from the Not
Currently Shown section to the Rows section.
To display the liquidity forecast without overdue items you can start for example the Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity
Level report and set the Exclude Overdue Items checkbox.
Expired and closed forecast planning items are also not displayed in the forecast.
270 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
2. Forecast Data OutputThe forecast is displayed in the Liquidity Forecasts subview with a status of In Modification.
The system groups the transaction sources of the liquidity forecast according to the following logic.
All items with a positive value are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the categories listed
and explained below. ● Customer Receipts are derived from customer invoices, payments from customers such as a credit card
payment or check, and sent to you by your customers.
● Intercompany Receipts are derived from forecast planning items that are not expired.
● Tax Receipts are derived from tax receivables and the tax declaration, if this has a positive value.
● Other Receipts are derived from bank-to-bank transfers and supplier credit memos and payments.
All items with a negative value are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into categories that
are listed and explained below. ● Supplier Payments are derived from supplier invoices, payments to a supplier such as check or bank transfer,
and payment advices that you sent to your supplier.
● Employee Expenses are derived from travel expense reports and the payment of travel expense reports.
● Intercompany Payments are derived from forecast planning items.
● Tax Receipts are derived from tax payables and the tax declaration, if this has a negative value.
For the Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method view, the system groups the payment methods according to the
following logic.
All items with a positive value are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the categories listed
and explained below. ● Check Deposits are derived from check deposits received.
● ACH Credits are derived from incoming bank transfers.
● Wires In are derived from incoming wire transfers.
● Other Credits are derived from received credit card, direct debit and cash payments.
All items with a negative value are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into categories that
are listed and explained below. ● Checks Paid are derived from outgoing checks.
● ACH Debits are derived from all outgoing bank transfers.
● Wires Out are derived from outgoing wire transfers.
● Other Debits are derived from outgoing credit card, direct debit and cash payments.
You can view the forecast grouped by transaction source or payment method for daily, weekly or monthly time
periods in the Liquidity Forecasts subview.
To do so, choose the Show arrow and choose the view you wish to see.
You can also view the forecast reports from a number of perspectives depending on your business need.
To do so you select the Reports view in the Liquidity Management work center. For example, if you wish to make
currency management decisions you can view the forecast for each transaction currency for the selected time
period. You can do likewise for transaction sources and payment methods.
3. New Forecast Planning Item(This is an optional step). If you wish to include future items that will effect the liquidity forecast but which are not
captured by the system, for example human resource expenses, you must create a new forecast planning item.
After this item is entered you must refresh the forecast data for the relevant liquidity forecast. The new forecast
planning item is included only after the forecast data has been refreshed in this manner. For more information,
seeForecast Planning Item [272].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 271
You can only refresh a forecast on the same day that the forecast was created.
Forecast Data Collection Errors
If an error occurs during the creation of the forecast, the forecast is displayed with the status of Data Collection Failed.
You must choose on the Forecast ID to display the forecast data sources.
If any one or all of the three data sources are missing or have a status of Incomplete, the liquidity forecast has failed
and you should report an incident.
If the data sources have a status of Complete, you must choose Check and Finish to display an error message that
details the problem. After you correct the error, choose Check and Finish . The forecast should now display in the
Liquidity Forecasts subview with a status of In Modification.
For example, you choose Check and Finish and an error message displays that asks you to maintain missing exchange
rates. You need to edit some missing exchange rates. You open the General Ledger work center and choose Edit
Exchange Rates in the Common Tasks pane. You return to the Liquidity Forecasts subview and choose the Forecast
ID to display the forecast data sources. You choose Check and Finish . The forecast should now display with a status
of In Modification.
6.1.10.3 Forecast Planning Item
Overview
If you wish to include an expected liquidity item that is not captured by the system you must create a new forecast
planning item using the New Forecast Planning Item common task. You can view all your forecast planning items in the
Forecast Planning Items subview of the Liquidity Forecasts view of the Liquidity Management work center.
Features
You can create a new forecast planning item in the Forecast Planning Items subview of the Liquidity Forecast view in
the Liquidity Management work center. To do so, choose New , then Forecast Planning Item.
You can also create a new forecast planning item from anywhere in the Liquidity Management work center from the
Common Tasks pane.
The New Forecast Planning Item quick activity displays. Mandatory fields are denoted on the screen by a red asterisk.
The sections of the quick activity are explained below;
● General DataYou select the payment method and enter the amount of the expected liquidity item. You select Increase for a future
receivable and Decrease for a future payable in the Expected Cash Flow Direction field. You enter the date that
you expect to receive the item in the Expected Value Date field. The forecast planning item is no longer valid (no
longer captured by the liquidity forecast) beyond the date you enter in the Expiration Date field.
● Bank DataYou select the relevant company and bank account. After you have done so, the system enters the company name,
bank name and national bank code automatically.
● Source DataYou enter the origin of the planned payment or expense, for example employee expenses, in the Transaction
Source field. You enter the current state in the transaction life cycle of the expected planning item in the Transaction
272 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Progress field. If, for example, you receive notice of a future payables item, you choose Payables/Receivables from
the list.
● ReferenceYou can also enter a memo for your own reference in the Reference free text box.
After completing the quick activity, choose Save to save the forecast planning item.
The forecast planning item must be released before it can be captured by the liquidity forecast. Choose Actions , then
Release on the quick activity to release the item.
Alternatively you can release the forecast planning item in the Forecast Planning Items subview. In the Show list, choose
In Preparation. All the forecast planning items that have been created but not released are displayed. Select the forecast
planning item you want to release and choose Actions , then Release.
Liquidity Forecast Integration
It is not necessary to create a liquidity forecast before you create a new forecast planning item.
The system captures the new forecast planning item within the liquidity forecast in two ways, depending on whether the
liquidity forecast involved already exists or is to be created;
● If a new liquidity forecast run is created after the forecast planning item has been released, the newly created
forecast planning item will be automatically captured by the liquidity forecast run and will appear in the subsequent
forecast.
● You can capture the new forecast planning item in an existing forecast by refreshing the forecast data. To refresh
the forecast data, you open the Liquidity Forecasts subview. You select the relevant liquidity forecast and choose
Refresh Forecast Data. The liquidity forecast is updated with the new forecast planning item only after you refresh
the forecast data in this manner. The refresh may take some minutes, depending on the quantity of data.
The updated forecast, including your new forecast planning item, appears in the Liquidity Forecasts view of the Liquidity
Management work center.
You can only refresh a forecast on the same day that the forecast was created.
Example
Daniel Dough is the cash manager for Akron Heating Inc. He has received notice of future human resource expenses
via future planning information from the human resources department.
He opens the Liquidity Forecasts work center view and creates a new forecast planning item from. He completes the
quick activity and chooses Save . Daniel reviews the forecast planning item and then chooses Release .
After releasing the forecast planning item, he can refresh and open the liquidity forecast to see the expected human
resource expense is now captured by the forecast in the Liquidity Forecasts view.
See Also
Liquidity Forecast [269]
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 273
6.1.11 Payment Formats
6.1.11.1 Electronic Bank Statement File Formats
Overview
You can use the electronic bank statement function to automate the process of posting incoming and outgoing payment
items to your system for the purpose of cash allocation and reconciliation, as well as for updating your cash position.
Different banks supply electronic bank statements in a number of different formats and a variety of detail. SAP supports
a number of national and international file formats for bank statements, including the following formats listed in the table
below:
Country Format
Germany, United Kingdom, China All MT940 formats
United States, Canada, Australia BAI2
France AFB
Although these formats are preconfigured, there are usually bank-specific characteristics that have to be considered
and these may require further fine-tuning of your configuration settings (business transaction codes, for example).
Contact your bank to verify the format and communication settings that are sp,ecific to your relationship.
6.1.11.2 Electronic Payment Formats
Overview
You use the Electronic Payment Format feature to select the relevant file formats for the automated process of
transmitting electronic payments to your bank(s).
SAP supports the following outgoing payment formats:
Country Format
France AFB Domestic FormatAFB Foreign FormatVCOM Bill of ExchangeAFB Bill of Exchange DepositAFB Bill of Exchange Cashing Response
Germany DTAUS/DTIZV Domestic FormatDTAZV Foreign FormatSEPA Credit Transfer
United Kingdom BACSHSBCLloyds Bank
United States ACH CTXACH CCD
274 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
These formats are already preconfigured for your system. However, there are often bank-specific details that need to
be considered, which may require the file format to be further adjusted. Contact your bank to verify the format and
communication settings that are specific to your relationship.
You can also make payments using a manual payment format. For more information see Manual Payment
Formats [275]
6.1.11.3 Manual Payment Formats
Overview
When you create an outgoing payment the system needs to communicate this information to the bank. In most cases,
this is communicated directly to the bank using electronic data exchange, (for direct debits and wire transfers) or an
electronic payment file (for bank transfers). The system uses payment formats as a medium to communicate the payment
information to the bank.
For more information about the electronic payment formats used by the system see Electronic Payment Formats [274]
However, the system can also create outgoing payments without using the payment formats defined in the system.
These payments are created using manual payment formats.
The manual payment format can be used for outgoing payments that use the following payment methods:
● Bank Transfer
● Wire Transfer
● Direct Debits
Prerequisites
Before you can create the outgoing payment, you must select Manual Payment as an available Payment Format for the
relevant bank. For this, go to the Liquidity Management work center and navigate to Master Data My Banks (select
an entry) Edit General . Go to the Payment Formats tab, click Add Row and select Manual Payment from the list.
Payment Format Prioritization
The system prioritizes the payment formats delivered with the system. The system prefers to use the formats that are
defined in the system. It only uses the manual payment format if it cannot determine a particular payment format and
the manual payment format is allowed for the particular My Bank entry.
Some examples of how the system uses this logic to determine the payment format are:
● You create a bank transfer in USD from a bank account held at a German bank. The bank account currency is
Euro. The payment formats DTAUS0 and Manual are selected for the relevant My Banks entry. The system knows
that the DTAUS0 format cannot be used for USD payment so it automatically selects the Manual payment format.
● In some cases, you may select manual as the only allowed payment formats for your bank accounts. This can be
the case if you hold a bank account in a country that does not support a country-specific format. This payment
format must be used for all transactions made from this bank account.
● In other cases, you may have selected both the Manual and SWIFT International 103 payment formats. This can
be the case if you hold a bank account in a country that does not support a country-specific format but still need to
create international transfers.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 275
If the bank can process payments using the SWIFT payment format, it is assumed that the bank is independent of
the values, Domestic or International, that you enter when you create the outgoing payment. In this case, the system
always uses the SWIFT format for both international and domestic transfers.
● You may hold a bank account at bank in Germany. The payments formats DTAUS0 and Manual are selected for
the relevant My Banks entry. You create a bank transfer between two domestic accounts. However, the bank
account number is missing from the associated My Banks master data entry. The system expects to use the
DTAUS0 payment format. In this case it will not use the Manual payment format to process the transaction. Instead
the system generates an error message to inform the user that the master data is missing.
Payment Processing
The sections below describe the process flow for the payment processing of outgoing payments created using the
manual payment format:
After you release an outgoing payment, for example a bank transfer, go to the Liquidity Management or Payment
Management work center, then select the Payment Monitor work center view. The bank transfer displays with a status
of Ready for Transfer.
You cannot create electronic payment file for a bank transfer that uses the manual payment format. You need to select
the bank transfer, click Actions for Bank Transactions, then Set as Manually Downloaded. The status of the bank transfer
changes to In Transfer.
If the bank transfer is included in the next bank statement, the status will change to Confirmed.
The process is the similar for wire transfers and direct debit payments.
6.2 Master Data View
6.2.1 Quick Guide for Master Data (in Liquidity Management)
The views My Banks, Bank Directory, Clearing Houses, Clearing House Accounts, Check Storages, Bill of Exchanges
Storages and Petty Cash you can access from the Liquidity Management work center under Master Data.
Business Background
Banks and Bank Accounts
Your company bank and bank account data is maintained in the Liquidity Management work center, Master
Data My Banks view. The system assigns each bank a unique bank identifier, known as the Bank ID. Bank accounts
are also assigned a unique identifier known as the Bank Account ID.
For more information, see Banks and Bank Accounts [264].
Bank Directory
You can use the Bank Directory to store all the bank information necessary for your daily business operations in a central
repository. This directory is fully integrated within the system and can be accessed in the Bank Directory subview of the
Master Data view in the Liquidity Management work center.
For more information, see Bank Directory [250]Bank Directory [262] .
276 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Clearing Houses and Clearing House Accounts
A clearing house (also referred to as acquirer) is a financial institution or service provider that acts as a third party in the
clearing of future payment contracts, for example credit card payments, for either the payer or payee or both. A bank
may act as a clearing house. However, a clearing house does not necessarily have to be a bank. Clearing houses are
maintained in the system in the Liquidity Management work center. Clearing house master data is maintained in the
Clearing Houses subview of the Master Data work center view. Individual clearing house account data is maintained in
the Clearing House Account subview, in the same work center view.
For more information, seeClearing Houses and Clearing House Accounts [260].
Electronic Payment Formats
You use the Electronic Payment Format feature to select the relevant file formats for the automated process of
transmitting electronic payments to your bank(s).
For more information, see Electronic Payment Formats [274].
Manual Payment Formats
When you create an outgoing payment the system needs to communicate this information to the bank. In most cases,
this is communicated directly to the bank using electronic data exchange, (for direct debits and wire transfers) or an
electronic payment file (for bank transfers). The system uses payment formats as a medium to communicate the payment
information to the bank.
For more information about the electronic payment formats used by the system see Electronic Payment Formats [274]
However, the system can also create outgoing payments without using the payment formats defined in the system.
These payments are created using manual payment formats.
The manual payment format can be used for outgoing payments that use the following payment methods:
● Bank Transfer
● Wire Transfer
● Direct Debits
For more information, see Manual Payment Formats [275].
Tasks
Update a Bank Record
1. From the My Banks view select the bank that you want to update, choose Edit Bank
Accounts .
2. You update the bank account details on the Bank Accounts tab.
Choose Add Row and enter the bank account details to create a new company bank
account.
You enter the account details, such as account type and IBAN, on the Account tab. You can,
for example, specify another account to pay the bank charges for this account, if required
using the Bank Account for Fee field.
You may make frequent foreign currency transactions using this account. To facilitate this,
your bank may provide you with several bank accounts all using the same bank account
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 277
number. To differentiate these bank accounts internally, you may enter an alternative bank
account number in the Alternative Account Number field and the Bank Account ID field.
You must enter an overdraft limit for the liquidity check. This amount must be a negative
number. If you keep an agreed amount on deposit with your bank, you enter this in the
Minimum Amount field. Similarly, if you wish to keep amount on deposit below a certain
amount, you can enter this in the Maximum Amount field. These are not mandatory but they
are used by the liquidity check. For more information see Liquidity Check [268].
3. You can update the allowed payment formats for this bank on the Payment Formats tab.
These are the allowed payment formats, used to make payments from the company
accounts held at this bank.
You should update the Payment Formats tab before you update the Payment Methods for
the associated bank accounts. The available payment methods are defined by the payment
formats you choose. For example, if you enter US ACH on the Payment Formats tab of the
bank, then you can select ACH Credits on the Payment Methods tab of the bank account.
Choose the Bank Accounts tab, select a bank account and choose the Payment Methods
tab to display the chosen payment methods for the bank account. Clearing House and Check
are available as default because these do not require a specific payment format.
4. You can create and edit check lots issued to you for this account on the Check Lots tab. You
can split and remove check lots. However, you cannot split check lots that have been used
in automatic payments.
If you want to issue outgoing checks from this account, you must choose the Used in
Automatic Payments check box. This allows the system to draw check numbers
automatically from this account. This number will be used for checks used in automatic
payments. If selected, it also provides the check number automatically on the New Outgoing
Check quick activity.
5. This step is only relevant if you process bills of exchange with this bank account. You may
have preferential arrangements with your bank for processing bills of exchange. You specify
the terms of this arrangement on the Payment Transactions Conditions tab. You select the
particular type of bill of exchange (payable or receivable) in the Document Type column.
Then, you can select the transaction conditions agreed with your bank for the bills of
exchange payable and receivable processed by this account.
6. To save the updated bank records, choose Save , and then Close . To open the bank from
the list in the My Banks subview, choose the appropriate Bank ID.
This information is intended to explain how you can update your bank records in the
system. For more detailed information about the editor see Banks and Bank Accounts
[264].
Manually Create a Bank Directory Entry
1. Open the Bank Directory subview.
2. Choose New , then select Bank Directory Entry.
3. Enter the Bank Name and select the Country.
4. To display all the fields that can be edited, choose View All. The following additional
information is displayed: ● On the Assigned Branches tab, you can enter individual contact information for multiple
branches.
278 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
● In the National Bank Codes table, you can enter multiple national bank code details for
a single bank directory entry. You can then select one of these as the default national
bank code details for the entry.
5. Choose Save and Close . If the data entered is consistent, then the bank directory entry is
saved and displayed in the Bank Directory subview with a status of Active.
Upload a Bank Directory File
1. Open the Bank Directory subview.
2. Choose New , then select Bank Directory File Upload.
3. Select the Format. This specifies both the provider of the bank directory file, as well as the
format used, for example Accuity , Accuity (ZIP), Deutsche Bundesbank, or
SAPTemplate.
To upload a bank directory file from a provider not listed in the dropdown list fo
rthe Format field, select SAP Template. Before uploading the file, you must ensure
that the data contained in the file complies with the SAP-supported format
provided in the template. For more information, see SAP Format for Bank
Directory Upload.
4. You can enter a Description to help you identify the file later in the upload history.
5. To update and overwrite all existing bank directory entries, including those from other
providers and entries created manually, select the Overwrite Existing Entries checkbox.
Bank directory entries from a provider are always overwritten when you upload a
bank directory file from that same provider.
6. To upload the bank directory file, choose Add and select the file.
7. To review your entries and prepare your file for processing, choose Next .
8. To upload your file for processing, choose Finish .
After the processing of the file is finished, the bank data contained in the file is displayed in the
Bank Directory subiew. To view the bank directory file and the overall status of the processing of
the file, click File Upload History in the Bank Directory subiew. If the overall status is red, you can
correct any errors within the file and restart the file processing.
Create a Clearing House Account
1. Open the Clearing House Accounts subview.
2. Choose New , then Clearing House Account. The Clearing House Account editor displays.
3. Under Clearing House Account, enter the Clearing House ID and enter the number used by
the clearing house to identify your company in the Merchant ID field. Select the company ID
of the company that will use the account in the Company ID field. You can also enter the
time period during which the account remains valid.
4. There are also three tabs to be completed: ● Account
Enter an internal identifier in the Account Number field. This is used for information
purposes only. Select the currency that the clearing house will use to report to your
company in the Currency field. Also select the bank account ID of the account the
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 279
clearing house will make payments to. Select your chosen credit card service provider
in the Payment Service Provider field, if applicable.
● Preferred CurrencySelect the currencies that you would like this clearing house account to process. If, for
example, you enter EUR as a currency, then all credit card payments made in Euro will
be processed by this account. If no currency is selected, the account will process credit
card payments in all supported currencies. You may maintain multiple currencies for
the same account.
● Credit Card TypeSelect the particular credit card types, such as VISA or Mastercard, that will be
processed by the account in the Credit Card Type column. If you want to select this
account as the exclusive processor for a particular credit card type, select the Default
checkbox. All credit card payments made using this credit card type will be processed
by this account. Also enter the authorization validity period in the Authorisation Validity
Days column.
Your credit card service provider will, in most cases, provide you with the
number of days for which the authorization will remain valid. The service
provider receives this information from the payment processor (clearing
house) and communicates it to you. You then enter this information manually.
The system automatically references the authorization validity date
contained in an electronic authorization request.
If the request does not contain this date, the system uses the authorization
validity days entered by you to calculate the authorization validity date. In this
case, the system automatically calculates the authorization validity date by
summing the current date and the authorization validity days entered by you.
If you do not enter anything in the Authorization Validity Days column, the
system then uses the current date as the authorization validity date. The
transaction will be processed in the system but the transaction will not be, as
the authorization period will be zero.
5. Choose Save and then Close to activate the account.
Create a Check Storage
1. Open the Check Storages view.
2. Choose New Check Storage and enter the required data.
Note to Location Type: ● If the check storage is to be used as a check deposit, choose Internal. Note: We strongly
recommend that you create only one check storage for each company.
● If the check storage is to be used as a lockbox, choose Bank. Note: We strongly
recommend that you create only one check storage for each company and provider.
3. Save the new record.
For more information, see Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checks [257].
280 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
6.3 Cash Position View
6.3.1 Cash Position Quick Guide
You can access the Cash Position view from the Liquidity Management work center under Cash Position.
In the Cash Position view, the cash manager can see the cash position for the day. Setting the cash position involves
aggregating all scheduled inbound and outbound payments for the day and determining if there is excess liquidity or a
borrowing requirement. This normally occurs after cash flow information is collected and bank statement and lockbox
files have been processed. The cash position provides you with consolidated information for all expected cash inflows
and outflows across the organization. You can use it to get an overview of expected cash inflows and outflows for the
current business day broken down by payment method and by processing bank. The system displays opening balances,
collections, disbursements, net cash flow, and closing balance. For items and payments not included on the system,
you can enter manual bank payment advices to ensure that these payments are factored into the cash position.
Business Background
Cash Position
The cash position displays actual bank balance and transaction details as provided by prior-day bank statements. The
cash position reflects the short term liquidity status of the company. The system provides you with an integrated,
overview of your cash position in the Liquidity Management work center.
For more information, see Cash Position [249].
Cash and Liquidity Management
The Cash and Liquidity Management business scenario enables financial professionals at midsize companies to
quickly and efficiently meet cash flow deadlines and achieve better transparency in managing the company's liquidity
position. It comprises cash flow information from payables and receivables and tax, as well as payment and liquidity
management, and streamlines your daily cash management cycle by automatically collecting and aggregating this
information. This scenario covers the cash flow management cycle from the actual liquidity snapshot to forecasting, and
analyzes steps through to optimized cash flow from money transfers or other cash flow impacting strategies.
For more information, see Cash and Liquidity Management.
Tasks
Create a new Bank-to-Bank Transfer
1. Select the New Bank-to-Bank Transfer common task from the Common Tasks pane.
2. Select a payment method, for example bank or wire transfer. Then, you enter the transaction
amount and select the company. You must enter an execution date. The system
automatically enters the current date in this field by default. You can also enter a posting
date. The also system enters the current date here by default. This is because bank-to-bank
transfers are often completed on the same day as they are created.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 281
3. Select the Bank Account ID of the bank accounts that you would like to transfer money
between. If you select Bank Transfer as the payment method, the system automatically
enters the Debit Value Dates and the Credit Value Dates for both bank accounts.
4. After you have entered and reviewed the relevant information, choose Post . The bank
transfer is displayed in the Payment Monitor work center view with the status Ready for
Transfer.
5. A payment file must be created in the relevant file format and made available to the bank or
banking software for processing. This can be done either automatically or manually. The
payment file media run will complete the activity automatically.
The file can also be created manually in the Payment Monitor view of the work center. You
select the transfer and choose Actions for Bank Transactions , then Create Payment File . After
the new payment file has been created, go to the Outbound Files subview of the
File Management work center view. The outgoing file for your bank transfer displays here.
You select the file and choose Edit . The Outgoing File screen displays. The actual new
payment file for transmission to the bank can be seen on the Attachment tab of the payment
file screen. Save the file from the browser window to your local computer for submission to
the bank.
6.4 File Management View
6.4.1 File Management Quick Guide
You can access the Inbound Files view and Outbound Files view from the Liquidity Management work center under File
Management.
In the File Management view, the cash manager can monitor all inbound and outbound electronic files for processing,
such as bank statement files and payment files. Bank statement files can be manually entered into the system, where
they are then automatically processed. Payment files can also be downloaded for further processing, for example with
external banking software.
Business Background
Bank Statements
Getting up-to-date information about the status of your bank accounts is an important element of effective cash-flow
management. To get an accurate picture of the status of your bank accounts, you need information about your current
bank balance. Your bank provides you with this information via bank statements in either electronic or physical (paper)
formats. The system supports both bank statement formats. Paper bank statements are entered and updated in the
system manually in the Bank Statements view of the Liquidity Management work center. The system displays bank
statements that have been entered in the system in the same view. You can upload electronic bank statement files in
the Inbound Files subview of the File Management view of the same work center.
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
When a bank statement file is uploaded the system automatically copies the memo lines to the corresponding item
document descriptions. Before releasing a bank statement you can manually enter a document description (header text)
and adapt single item document descriptions. Item document descriptions are used for the automatic payment allocation
(assignments or postings). If the system could not completely allocate the bank statement a task is automatically created
in the Payment Management work list.
282 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
NOTE: If you want the system allways to create a task for releasing a bank statement you must make the corresponding
configuration settings in the Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity Management activity.
The document description (header text) and item document descriptions are finally shown in the journal entry.
Electronic Bank Statement File Formats
You can use the electronic bank statement function to automate the process of posting incoming and outgoing payment
items to your system for the purpose of cash allocation and reconciliation, as well as for updating your cash position.
For more information, see Electronic Bank Statement File Formats [274].
Bank Payment Advice
A bank payment advice contains items in the cash position that are not captured automatically by the integrated
repositories. The bank payment advice acts like a memo, ensuring that the item is reflected in the current cash position.
You should replace the bank payment advice with a transaction record in the next bank statement.
For more information, see Bank Payment Advice [257].
Tasks
Download an Outbound File
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center, choose the File Management view, and then
choose the Outbound Files subview.
2. Select the file that you want to view and choose Edit to open the outgoing file.
To show all outbound files that have been downloaded and sent to the bank,
choose Show , then choose Released for Transfer . To view all files that have
yet to be downloaded, choose Show , then choose In Release .
3. Review the outbound file details on the Attachment tab. To display the outbound file, click
on the file name in the Document Title column. You can also download the document view
using your banking software or a text program. To download the file, choose Download ,
then save the file to your computer.
If the file data is invalid or the bank rejects the payment file you can also reverse
(cancel) or discard the outbound file. Choose Actions and choose the
appropriate action to do so. The status of the payments contained in a reversed
or discarded file changes to Not Transferred. You can create a new file for these
payments after you have corrected the original error.
4. Choose Release to release the outbound file. This action allows you to differentiate
between files that have been downloaded and are being processed by the bank from files
that are yet to be downloaded.
Thus files with the status Released for Transfer have been downloaded and made available
for further processing whereas files with the status In Release are yet to be downloaded.
5. After you have received the bank statement file, verifying that the file has been processed
successfully by your bank, open the Outbound Files subview. Choose Actions , then
Confirm to change the status of the file to Confirmed.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 283
Upload an Inbound File
1. Navigate to the File Management view, and then choose the Inbound Files subview.
2. Select the company file register of the company for which you want to upload the bank
statement.
3. Choose New and then select Inbound File. The New Inbound File quick activity displays.
4. Select your File Type from the list and the sender bank.
5. In the Attachments section below, click Add File and enter the file data. Optionally,
you can enter a Title and specify a Document Type. Then choose Add .
You can verify that you have selected the correct document by selecting it and
choosing View .
6. Choose Start File Upload to import and save the file.
7. You now see your bank statement in the Inbound Files subview, with the status In
Process. If you have accidentally uploaded the incorrect file, you can choose Edit and
select a new one, otherwise you can confirm the bank statement file by choosing Actions
and then choosing Mark as Confirmed. The bank statement file should now have the status
Finished.
You can also mark a file as erroneous by choosing Actions and choosing Mark
as Erroneous.
If your bank statement file finishes with the status Error in Processing, refer to the
corresponding error messages to determine the problem.
To view the results of the bank statement import, you open the Bank Statements view and search
for the relevant bank statement.
The bank statement should have the consistency status of Consistent. The system performs
consistency checks to make sure that the opening balance of the bank statement file corresponds
to the closing balance of the last statement. The system also checks that the current bank
statement’s Statement Date is not before the previously entered bank statement’s Statement
Date, and verifies that the Statement ID is consecutive.
If the Statement ID is not consecutive and the system is configured to create tasks for such bank
statements, the system saves the bank statement with the current Statement ID with a status of
Consistent and creates a task to make the user aware of the discrepancy. If the previous bank
statement exists in the system, the system does not verify the opening and closing balances.
If the Opening Balance, Closing Balance or Statement Date are incorrect, the bank statement
saves with the status Inconsistent. If your system is configured to create tasks for inconsistent
bank statements, the system creates a task to review the inconsistent statement.
You can display the bank statement itself by choosing the bank statement’s Statement ID.
Import and Verify Lockbox Files
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center, open the Inbound Files subview of the File
Management work center view.
284 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
2. The lockbox file that will be uploaded does not contain company information or payee
account details, only payer account details. You therefore need to allocate the lockbox file
to a company so that the payment can be recognized in the system.
3. Choose New , then New Inbound File to display the New Inbound File quick activity.
4. Select the Lockbox file type from the File Type dropdown list. Enter the sender of the lockbox
file in the Sender field, or select one using the dropdown list. The sender can be a bank
offering a lockbox provider service, or a third-party lockbox provider. When you select the
Sender, the system automatically displays your bank account with the provider including the
bank code from the company payment file register.
5. Choose Add , then choose File. Enter the name of the file you want to upload, or browse
to its location. Additionally, you can enter a title in the Title field and specify a Document
Type if you wish. Then choose Add .
You can verify that you have selected the correct document by selecting it and
choosing View .
6. Choose Start File Upload . This function saves you a lot of effort as the system automatically
executes the following actions: ● The file is released
● Lockbox batches are created
● The checks contained in the batches are created in the system
● These checks are released for clearing (the file also contains advice data)
● Automatic payment allocation and clearing takes place for these checks
7. You now see your lockbox file in the Inbound Files subview, with the status In Process. If
you have accidentally uploaded the incorrect file, you can select a new one by choosing on
Edit, otherwise you can confirm the lockbox file by choosing Actions and then Mark as
Confirmed. The lockbox file should now have the status Finished.
You can also mark a file as erroneous by choosing Actions , then Mark as
Erroneous.
6.5 Bank Statements View
6.5.1 Bank Statements Quick Guide
You can access the Bank Statements view from the Liquidity Management work center under Bank Statements.
The Bank Statements view displays the status and transaction detail of the bank statements received from your banks.
You can view opening and closing balances for each statement for each reporting bank. You can also manually enter
paper bank statements into the system. You can also view bank statements imported from the File Management view.
Business Background
For more information, see Bank Statements [253].
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 285
Tasks
Manually Enter a Bank Statement
1. Choose New Bank Statement , enter the required data..
(Note: The system automatically fills the Bank Account ID field with the Bank Account ID of
the bank account used in the previous statement. The system does not automatically
calculate the Closing Balance. Enter this information from your most current bank
statement.)
2. Select Next to navigate to phase Select Items.
In this phase you can see self-initiated payments of the selected bank account. To directly
assign (allocate) a payment to the bank statement item set the indicator Selected. For this
reason, in the next phase the Further processing status of this item should be Not
Relevant.
To choose an item to be processed with this bank statement set the Selected indicator.
Individual bank transfers are displayed for each individual payment format. You can confirm
individual bank transfers in this step.
If the bank confirmed these bank transfers as a batch, you should manually enter the
individual bank transfers in the next step. You need to enter the Payment Message ID in the
Document ID field as a reference.
Choose Next to continue.
If the Advice check box is selected for an item, an advice entry exists for this item.
This means that you do not have to enter any information from the bank statement
to the remittance advice. The system does this automatically.
3. To edit a bank statement item that has already been created, or create a new bank statement
item.
To edit an existing item, select the item from the list and choose Item Details . You can enter
a Bank Charge Amount, Debit Amount, and Credit Amount data for the line item. You can
also edit transaction and bank account data for individual invoices contained in the line item.
To create a new item, choose Add Row . You enter the Payment Method, Issue Date,
Customer/Supplier ID, Invoice Reference ID, Bank Charge Amount, and the Debit or Credit
Amount as appropriate.
Choose Next to continue.
4. Check the statement details you entered. If you do not want to post the statement
immediately, choose Save to save a copy of the statement. Choose Post to release the
bank statement.
5. Choose Close to save the new bank statement and return to the Bank Statements work
center view.
Depending on your business configuration, the new bank statement is now either released for
approval, or added to the list of bank statements in the Bank Statements view.
286 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
6.6 Payment Monitor View
6.6.1 Payment Monitor Quick Guide
In the Payment Monitor view, you can track and maintain all your company's incoming and outgoing payments. You can
filter the payments by date, by payee, or by status, for example, to show obsolete payments which have been canceled,
returned, or rejected payments. You can create new payments, or enter payments that are created manually or outside
of the system. You can also view payment details for each item. These details vary depending on the payment method
and status of the payment, for example, deposit data for incoming checks, or the reason why a check was voided.
You can access the Payment Monitor view from the Payment Management work center or from the Liquidity
Management work center under Payment Monitor.
Business Background
Incoming Payments
The incoming payment process covers the acquisition of liquid funds in the company. Thus an incoming payment
increases the cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An incoming payment does not necessarily increase the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a receivable by an incoming payment increases the bank account balance, however at the
same time, the receivable expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Incoming Payments [31].
Outgoing Payments
The outgoing payment process covers the retirement of liquid funds in the company. Outgoing payments decrease the
cash and cash equivalents such as the cash balance or bank balance.
An outgoing payment does not necessarily decrease the financial assets, this includes short-term payables and
receivables. The clearing of a payable by an outgoing payment reduces the bank account balance, at the same time,
the payable also expires but this does not change the financial assets.
For more information, see Outgoing Payments [11].
Bank Transfers
You can use bank transfers to make both automatic and manual outgoing payments. There are two types of bank
transfer: bank transfers, which are used to make payments from a company account to third-party accounts; and bank-
to-bank transfers, which are used to transfer funds between company bank accounts. These are used mainly for
transfers relating to liquidity management.
For more information, see Bank Transfers [255].
Liquidity Check
A liquidity check is performed each time an outgoing payment is created to verify that there are sufficient funds available
to facilitate the payment.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 287
The liquidity check is performed for all outgoing payments created in the Payables, Receivables, Liquidity
Management, and Payment Management work centers. This includes the following payment methods:
● Outgoing Wire Transfer
● Outgoing Bank Transfer
● Outgoing Check
● Bill of Exchange Payable
No liquidity check is performed for tax payments and cash transfers.
For more information, see Liquidity Check [268].
Electronic Payment Formats
You use the Electronic Payment Format feature to select the relevant file formats for the automated process of
transmitting electronic payments to your bank(s).
For more information, see Electronic Payment Formats [274].
Manual Payment Formats
When you create an outgoing payment the system needs to communicate this information to the bank. In most cases,
this is communicated directly to the bank using electronic data exchange, (for direct debits and wire transfers) or an
electronic payment file (for bank transfers). The system uses payment formats as a medium to communicate the payment
information to the bank.
For more information about the electronic payment formats used by the system see Electronic Payment Formats [274]
However, the system can also create outgoing payments without using the payment formats defined in the system.
These payments are created using manual payment formats.
The manual payment format can be used for outgoing payments that use the following payment methods:
● Bank Transfer
● Wire Transfer
● Direct Debits
For more information, see Manual Payment Formats [275].
Cash and Liquidity Management
The Cash and Liquidity Management business scenario enables financial professionals at midsize companies to
quickly and efficiently meet cash flow deadlines and achieve better transparency in managing the company's liquidity
position. It comprises cash flow information from payables and receivables and tax, as well as payment and liquidity
management, and streamlines your daily cash management cycle by automatically collecting and aggregating this
information. This scenario covers the cash flow management cycle from the actual liquidity snapshot to forecasting, and
analyzes steps through to optimized cash flow from money transfers or other cash flow impacting strategies.
For more information, see Cash and Liquidity Management.
Tasks
Create a New Payment
288 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
1. Click New Payment By , then choose the appropriate payment method. You can create the
following types of payments: ● Incoming Check
● Outgoing Check
● Outgoing Bank Transfer
● Outgoing Wire Transfer
● Multiple Checks
2. Enter the relevant details for the payment method you selected. These details vary
depending on the payment method selected. Mandatory fields are indicated by an asterisk
(*).
3. Payments can be created with reference to an open item, customer, or supplier account, or
they can be posted directly to a general ledger account.
For selected incoming and outgoing payment types you can optionally define in the
configuration settings whether approval tasks should be generated for this work center
for specific payment methods and when you exceed a defined threshold amount. You
find these settings in fine-tuning under Business Task Management for Payment and
Liquidity.
Monitor Payment Allocation Processing
For more information on this activity, see here [259].
Create a New Outgoing Bank Transfer
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
You can also perform this task in the Payables work center, Supplier Account
Monitor view.
2. Click New Payment By , then Outgoing Bank Transfer.
3. Enter the relevant details for the bank transfer. The following fields are mandatory, as
indicated by an asterisk (*): Company ID, Payment Amount, Payee, Payee Bank, and select
a bank account ID to make the payment from.
If you do not wish to perform a liquidity check on the bank account before the
transfer is posted , select the Liquidity Allocation Not Required checkbox. For
information about liquidity checks, see Liquidity Check [268].
4. Click Complete Bank Data . The system automatically fills the other fields, where possible.
For example, if you have not selected a bank account in the Bank Account ID field, the
system automatically chooses the optimum bank account . To enter further details such as
payment instructions, or to change the type of bank transfer, for example to international
bank transfer, click View All to display all available fields.
Payment instructions are additional services provided by your bank that may
increase the security of the transaction, for example, calling the recipient bank
with notification of a payment. These services are only available for international
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 289
bank transfers. Your bank will inform you of the payment instructions it offers and
any additional fees they charge for using them.
If the bank transfer has already been completed outside the system, you do not need to
create a payment file. If you do not wish to create a payment file for this bank transfer, select
the Create Payment Manually check box. You can also choose the bearer of the bank
charges arising from the transfer.
If you do not want to execute the bank transfer immediately, you can enter the date that you
want the bank to execute the transaction in the Bank Processing Date field. If you click
Complete Bank Data after you enter this date, the system automatically fills the Expected
Bank Value Date and Posting Date fields.
5. Select whether you wish to allocate the transfer to open items or post it directly to the general
ledger account without allocating the payment. ● To allocate the bank transfer to open items, choose Reference to Items. The system
displays open items for the supplier or customer account. You can then match the bank
transfer to these open items. You can also add discounts to these items.
If you want to pay items on behalf of another customer or supplier, click Accounts then
Add Account. Now you can also choose from the open items belonging to the account
you selected in addition.
For more information on how to edit your open items, see Using the Open Items Table
[93].
● To use this bank transfer to make a payment that is not matched to any open items,
choose Direct Posting to G/L Account. Select a country and choose the entry type
Gross or Net. Click Add Row to manually assign the payment to the relevant general
ledger account. You can also enter a memo line in the bank transfer.
6. Click Post . The bank transfer is displayed in the Payment Monitor work center view with
the status Ready for Transfer.
7. A payment file must be created in the appropriate file format to be made available to the
bank or banking software for processing. This can be done automatically using a payment
file media run. For information on how to create a payment media run, see Create Payment
Media Run [238].
To create the file manually for transmission to the bank, proceed as follows:
1. In the Payment Monitor view, select the relevant bank transfer, and click
Actions for Bank Transactions , then Create Payment File.
2. Go to the File Management work center view, Outbound Files subview, select the new
payment file, and click Edit .
3. From the Outgoing File screen, go to the Attachment tab and select the payment file.
To download the file from the browser window to your computer, click Download .
This document contains text that is relevant for Austira only. To ensure that the system displays
the correct text, select Personalize> My Settings. Select the Onscreen Help and choose Austria
in the Country drop-down menu. Save your settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
Create an Outgoing Check
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
You can also perform this task in the Payables work center, Supplier Account
Monitor view.
290 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
2. Click New Payment By , then Outgoing Check to open the New Outgoing Check screen.
3. Enter the appropriate data for the fields Company ID, Payment Amount, and Payee.
4. Click Complete Bank Data . The system fills the Bank Account ID and Bank Name fields
automatically.
5. Ensure the Reference to Items radio button is selected, so you can match the check with
the appropriate open item. All open items on the customer or supplier account should appear
in the Open Items table, if you have previously entered the Payee. Select one or more open
items to be paid by the check using the Matched indicator.
Discounts or credits can be applied to the open items, if necessary, to ensure the payment
amount matches the open item amount by clicking Actions , then
Apply Discount or Credit .
For more information on how to edit your open items, see Using the Open Items Table
[93].
If the check you are issuing is not related to a customer or supplier account, select
the Direct posting to G/L Account radio button, then select an appropriate general
ledger account to which the check should be posted. You would do this if your
company wished to make a charitable donation, for example.
6. To save your check, click Post .
7. To manually print a check to send to the recipient, click Actions for Checks , then Print
Check Form.
Outgoing checks are printed automatically by the system on a regular basis. If you
create a check outside of the system, you can stop printing for the check (based
on the check information you enter into the system) by selecting the Set as
Manually Created indicator.
To void a check, for example if the check form is damaged in the printer and you need
to print a new one, click Actions for Checks , then Void. This option is possible while
the check has the status In Transfer. Note that voiding a check does not cancel the
payment; it simply invalidates the old check and generates a new check number. To
cancel a check, click Reverse . Note that you can only cancel a check while it has the
status Ready for Transfer.
For more information, see Check Lots and Check Numbers for Outgoing Checkes [257].
Enter an Incoming Check
1. Go to the Liquidity Management or Payment Management work center and open the
Payment Monitor work center view.
2. Click New Payment By , then Incoming Check to open the New Incoming Check screen.
To enter more than one new check, click New Payment By , then Multiple
Checks to open the New Multiple Checks screen. Note that with this action you
are not able to clear open items.
3. Enter the relevant payment details, including the data for the fields Payer, Check Number,
Payment Amount , and select the correct currency from the dropdown list next to the amount.
Enter other information as required.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 291
4. Under Payment Application Method, select whether you wish to allocate the check amount
to open items or post it directly to the general ledger account without allocating the payment. ● To allocate the check to open items, choose Reference to Items. The system displays
open items for the supplier or customer account. You can then match the check to these
open items. You can also add discounts to these items.
● To use this check to make a payment that is not matched to any open items, choose
Direct Posting to G/L Account. Select a country and choose the Entry Type. Click Add
Row to manually assign the payment to the relevant General Ledger account.
5. Click Post to save and post the new check. If you want to create more than one check you
can also use the Post and New button. The new check is saved in the system and added
to the payments listed in the Payment Monitor view.
Work with an Existing Payment
Depending on the payment method used for each payment, several editing options are available,
which influence the status of the payment or the payment itself.
1. Select the relevant payment and click Edit . The relevant screen for the selected payment
type opens.
2. To prevent the payment from being completed, click Reverse .
3. To create a remittance advice for the selected payment, provided the payment method
supports remittance advice, click Create Remittance Advice .
Depending on the status of each payment, it may not be possible to edit or reverse
the payment, or to issue a remittance advice.
4. In addition to the general functions listed above, each payment method has additional
possible actions: ● Actions for Checks
○ Set To in Transfer: Indicates that a paper check has already been created for the
payment.
○ Void: Cancels the specific check that has been issued, and leaves the open payment
in the system so that a new check can be issued.
○ Assign to Deposit: Adds the check to an appropriate check deposit, so it can be sent
to the bank.
○ Print Check Form: Instructs the system to print a check letter for the check.
○ Renumber: Allows a new check number to be assigned to a check, for example, due
to a mismatch between the check number in the system and the number printed on
the check.
○ Toggle: Switches the check numbers of two selected checks.
○ Set to Not Transferred: Indicates that a check has not yet been sent to a bank or
customer or supplier, so that it can be reissued. This may be necessary if a check
was incorrectly printed, for example.
● Actions for Bank Transactions ○ Create Payment File: Sends the payment file that will be sent to the bank to the
Liquidity Management work center. The payment file will be created in the next
scheduled payment media run if this action is not used.
292 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
○ Set to in Transfer: Indicates that the transfer has already taken place, using online
banking or a money transfer service, for example.
○ Set to Not Transferred: Indicates that a transfer has not yet been sent to a bank or
business partner, so that it can be reissued. This may be necessary if the payment
file was incorrectly transferred or was corrupted.
● Actions for Credit Cards ○ Settle: Settles a credit card payment that has not already been transferred.
6.7 Bank Payment Advices View
6.7.1 Quick Guide for Bank Payment Advices
You can access the Bank Payment Advices view from the Liquidity Management work center under Bank Payment
Advices.
In the Bank Payment Advices view, the cash manager can manually enter information received from the company’s
bank in the form of bank payment advices. Based on the information received from the bank, the cash manager can
enter the advice with or without a posting to accounting. If no posting is made in accounting, the advices are shown in
both the cash position and in the liquidity forecast.
Business Background
Bank Payment Advices
A bank payment advice contains items in the cash position that are not captured automatically by the integrated
repositories. The bank payment advice acts like a memo, ensuring that the item is reflected in the current cash position.
You should replace the bank payment advice with a transaction record in the next bank statement.
For more information, see Bank Payment Advices [257].
Cash and Liquidity Management
The Cash and Liquidity Management business scenario enables financial professionals at midsize companies to
quickly and efficiently meet cash flow deadlines and achieve better transparency in managing the company's liquidity
position. It comprises cash flow information from payables and receivables and tax, as well as payment and liquidity
management, and streamlines your daily cash management cycle by automatically collecting and aggregating this
information. This scenario covers the cash flow management cycle from the actual liquidity snapshot to forecasting, and
analyzes steps through to optimized cash flow from money transfers or other cash flow impacting strategies.
For more information, see Cash and Liquidity Management.
Tasks
Create a New Payment Advice
1. Choose New , then choose Bank Payment Advice.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 293
You can also create a new payment advice using the New Bank Payment
Advice common task from the Common Tasks pane.
2. Under General Data select either Bank Credit Advice or Bank Debit Advice as the Advice
Type .
3. The system automatically enters the current date as the advice date and posting date. You
can change this if necessary. You enter the date that the advice was created in the Advice
Date field. You can enter the date that you expect the bank payment advice to be posted to
your accounts in the Posting Date field.
4. If the advice represents an existing payment, choose the Payment Confirmed checkbox to
create the associated postings in accounting. If you do not select the checkbox, the advice
is considered as notice of a future payment and the system does not create any postings in
accounting.
5. Under Payment Data, select the payment method and enter the amount of the payment.
6. Enter the date that the transaction is reflected in your bank account in the Value Date field.
If you do not enter a value in this field, the system automatically enters the advice date.
The Value Date must be equal to or greater than the Advice Date.
7. You can also enter the ID from an advice sent to you by your bank or business partner in
the External Advice ID field.
8. Under Bank Data enter the business partner name and bank details, if applicable.
9. On the References tab, you can enter a note to reference individual items, such as an
invoice, on the Reference Items tab. If required, you can also enter a memo line on the Note
to Payee tab.
10.Choose Release to release the payment advice, or choose Save to release the payment
advice at a later time.
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria. To ensure that the system
displays the correct text, select Personalize —>My Settings. Choose
Onscreen Help and choose the relevant country using the Country drop-down menu.
Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
6.8 Liquidity Forecast View
6.8.1 Liquidity Forecasts Quick Guide
You can access the Liquidity Forecasts view, the Liquidity Forecast Runs view and the Forecast Plannning Items view
from the Liquidity Management work center under Liquidity Forecasts.
In these views, the cash manager can create and view the liquidity forecast for the company. This helps you make short
and medium term investment and financing decisions. The liquidity forecast shows expected cash inflows and outflows
for an period of time.
294 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Business Background
Liquidity Forecast
The liquidity forecast displays expected cash inflows and outflows for an upcoming period of time. The exact time period
shown is defined in the system configuration. This information allows you to monitor your liquidity position, helping you
make short and medium term investment and financing decisions. The most recent liquidity forecast is created and
displayed in the Liquidity Forecasts view.
For more information, see Liquidity Forecast [269].
Forecast Planning Item
If you wish to include an expected liquidity item that is not captured by the system you must create a new forecast
planning item using the New Forecast Planning Item common task. You can view all your forecast planning items in the
Forecast Planning Items subview of the Liquidity Forecasts view of the Liquidity Management work center.
For more information, see Forecast Planning Item [272] .
Tasks
Create and Refresh the Liquidity Forecast
For information about this task, see here [295].
6.8.2 Create and Refresh the Liquidity Forecast
Overview
In the Cash and Liquidity work center you can create the liquidity forecast for your business. This allows you to review
the expected cash balances for the next ninety business days (as a short-term forecast, for example, for the current
business week broken down in days). You can also refresh the liquidity forecast. However, you should only use this
feature when adding new forecast items to the forecast. The figure below provides an outline of this task. Select each
element to display step-by-step instructions.
The default setting for the time period for the liquidity forecast is ninety working days. This default setting can
be changed in your system configuration.
Procedure
1. Go to the Cash and Liquidity work center, then choose the Liquidity Forecast view. Before you can create or refresh
the liquidity forecast you need to create a new liquidity forecast run.
As a matter of best practice, you should perform the liquidity forecast only after the relevant data has been
processed in the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management , and Payment Management work centers,
that is, later in the working day. You should also upload all available bank statements. This ensures that
the liquidity forecast is as accurate as possible.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 295
2. To check and correct any data collection errors, proceed as follows:
1. In the Liquidity Forecast view open the Liquidity Forecast Run subview. Choose New and choose Liquidity
Forecast Run.
2. In the Description field enter the name of the run, select the Forecast Profile field and choose a profile from the
drop down list. Note the liquidity forecast run ID at the top of the screen.
3. Choose Save , then Activate . Then choose Schedule . Select whether you want to execute the run
immediately or in the future. Choose Save and then Close to close the quick activity.
You can schedule liquidity forecast runs on a frequent and recurring basis so that you do not have to
perform the steps above manually.
3. After the run has finished as scheduled, open the Liquidity Forecast subview. The forecast displays with a status
of In Modification. You can use the forecast as it is or add a new forecast planning item as required. If your new
forecast displays with a status of Data Collection Failed, an error has occurred you need to proceed as follows:
1. Choose the Forecast ID of the relevant forecast. The liquidity forecast data sources display. Choose
Check and Finish display an error message that describes the error. You can see a detailed description of the
error message in the application log. If the status of any of the data sources is not Complete, the forecast run
has failed and you need to report an incident.
2. If the error message refers to missing currency conversions, you need to maintain the missing conversion rate(s)
in the General Ledger work center. Choose Edit Currency Conversion from the Common Tasks pane in the
General Ledger work center. Enter the missing currency conversion information. Save and close the quick
activity.
3. After you have corrected the error, open the Liquidity Forecast subview and choose the Forecast ID of the
forecast. Choose Check and Finish to verify that the error was corrected.
4. In the Liquidity Forecast view select the Liquidity Forecast subview. The new liquidity forecast is displayed. You can
drilldown by choosing a particular cash flow item, then choosing Liquidity Forecast – By Transaction Details. For
example, you can drill down from a supplier payments line item for a certain date to the individual expected payment
transactions that the supplier payments balance consists of.
5. If you wish to include expected transactions that will affect the liquidity forecast in the future (but which are not yet
captured in the integrated repositories) you can do so by creating a new forecast planning item. This improves the
accuracy of the forecast. Select New Forecast Planning Item from the Common Tasks pane. When you have
completed the New Forecast Planning Item quick activity choose Save , then Release . Close the quick activity.
6. If you create the forecast planning item after you have created the forecast, you must refresh the forecast before
you can see the new forecast planning item in the liquidity forecast. To do so, open the Liquidity Forecast subview,
choose the relevant forecast, which is denoted by the liquidity forecast ID you noted earlier, and
choose Refresh Planning Items .
Only forecast planning items is refreshed, and it is only possible to refresh these items on the same day
when they are created. Data from payables and receivables processing is not refreshed. Thus, a refresh
is not a substitute for the creation of a new liquidity forecast. The refresh may take some minutes depending
on the volume of data to be processed.
Result
The updated liquidity forecast based on the new liquidity forecast run including the new forecast planning item is
displayed. To view the liquidity forecast, choose the Liquidity Forecast view, then choose the Liquidity Forecast subview.
296 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
6.9 Bank Transaction Status Notifications View
6.9.1 Quick Guide for Bank Transaction Status Notifications
In Switzerland, when a payment cannot be processed by the bank, it is possible for the bank to inform you of the details
of the failed transaction using an electronic file which you upload to your system. The file contains information on why
the payment failed, for example, due to insufficient funds or invalid information. On receipt of this file, you can then
decide on the corrective action to take in order to resolve the failed transaction and complete the payment.
In the Bank Transaction Status Notifications subview in the Liquidity Management work center, you can view the details
and status of failed bank transactions through bank transaction status notifications which you receive from your bank.
In these notifications, you can view all transaction details such as the file types, bank posting dates, and the reasons
behind failed transactions. This enables you to view why a transaction failed and to then take corrective action before
attempting to process the payment again.
A bank transaction status notification can have the status Canceled or Released.
Business Background
Payment Monitor Quick Guide
In the Payment Monitor view, you can track and maintain all your company's incoming and outgoing payments. You can
filter the payments by date, by payee, or by status, for example, to show obsolete payments which have been canceled,
returned, or rejected payments. You can create new payments, or enter payments that are created manually or outside
of the system. You can also view payment details for each item. These details vary depending on the payment method
and status of the payment, for example, deposit data for incoming checks, or the reason why a check was voided.
For more information, see Payment Monitor Quick Guide [194]Payment Monitor Quick Guide [287].
File Management Quick Guide
You can access the Inbound Files view and Outbound Files view from the Liquidity Management work center under File
Management.
For more information, see File Management Quick Guide [282]
Tasks
View Bank Transaction Status Notification
When the bank cannot complete a transaction, the bank creates a return file which you can upload
as an inbound file, called a Bank Transaction Status Notification. In the Business Transaction
Status Notification subview, you can view the details of this file.
To create a bank transactions status notification file, go to the Liquidity Management
work center, choose the File Management view, and then choose the Outbound
Files subview.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 297
For more information on uploading an inbound file, see File Management Quick Guide
[282]
1. Select the file and click View .
2. In the Business Transaction Status Notification screen, you can then view details about the
transaction, such as transaction amount, bank posting date, and return reason. Depending
on the reason outlined in the bank transaction status notification, you can perform
postprocessing activities to correct the issue. To resolve returned payments, you may need
to reopen payables or receivables that were already cleared. You can then include these
reopened payables and receivables in the next scheduled payment run and further payment
processing can be completed in the standard way.
3. Optional: To begin postprocessing, go to the Payment Monitor view.
You can access the Payment Monitor view from the Payment Management work center or
from the Liquidity Management work center under Payment Monitor.
1. Select the payment for postprocessing and click View All .
2. Under Actions , you have three choices for postprocessing: ● Select Reverse, if you need to recreate the payment, for example, because
changes are needed in the customer’s master data.
● Select Set to Not Transferred, if you would like to resend the payment to the bank
without making any changes. You can then include the payment in the next file you
create. This action affects your bank statement. If the rejected payment was
included in a file with successfully processed payments, then there will be a
discrepancy between the bank statement and the file. The bank statement will
contain the lump sum of the successfully processed payments, whereas the file
will show the lump sum of all payments in the batch.
● Select Set to In Transfer if you selected Set to Rejected by mistake.
For more information, see Payment Monitor Quick Guide [194]Payment Monitor Quick
Guide [287].
Reverse Bank Transaction Status Notification
For bank transaction status notifications whose status is Released, you can undo this by selecting
the bank transaction status notification and clicking Reverse . The status of the notification is
now Canceled and you need to redo the upload the inbound file and make any changes you
require.
Export Business Data Using Microsoft Excel
For more information about this task, see Export Business Data Using Microsoft Excel.
6.10 Reports
6.10.1 Cash Position by Payment Method
Overview
Shows the petty cash balances and the balances and postings for each bank account, grouped by payment method.
The amounts are based on the bank statements plus unconfirmed payments. It includes transaction details for the current
298 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
business day, as provided by the bank statement, and gives you all the information you need to make short-term funding
and investment decisions.
The transaction details are derived from bank statements and payments with a value date on or before the date entered.
This report displays the cash position total amounts for each of the payment methods that make up the cash position
aggregated by the bank.
Prerequisites
To ensure that the cash position is as accurate as possible, check that all available bank statements are uploaded into
the system.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Value Date
The system enters the current date by default. All payments with a value date on or before this date are captured
by the cash position.
● Bank
This selects the particular bank that you may wish to view the cash position of. If you do not specify a bank, the
report shows the cash position across all your company's banks.
● Currency
This selects the currency that you wish to see the report displayed in. This is filled by default with the company
currency assigned to the company during configuration.
● Display Currency Conversion Rate
This selects the exchange rate used to calculate currency conversions in the report.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report displays the cash position total amounts for each of the payment methods that make up the cash position.
It also displays total amounts for each payment method, for example check deposits, for each bank. You can analyze
the information in the cash-position report from multiple perspectives such as grouping bank transactions by bank and
payment method. In addition, you can customize the report and add further criteria.
The opening and closing cash balances are derived from the balance of bank accounts and cash on hand. You can
view the opening and closing balances for individual banks, bank accounts and cash on hand.
To show the sum from petty cash, use the quick filter for the Bank Account row to select # — Not Assigned.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 299
Petty cash payments are confirmed automatically, and are reflected immediately in the opening and closing
balances for petty cash accounts within this report. Thus, the opening and closing balances of these accounts
will always be equal.
The opening balance is the same as the closing balance from the previous bank statement. These bank statements
may contain items that are yet to be allocated. These items are displayed under Unallocated. Usually payment allocation
tasks exist for these items but the tasks are still to be processed.
Checks that are not assigned to a check deposit are credited to the bank account listed in the company’s
check storage.
Incoming cashflows (items with a positive value) are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the
categories listed and explained below.
● Check Deposits are derived from deposited checks.
● ACH Credits are derived from the incoming side of bank-to-bank transfers where Bank Transfer is the selected
payment method.
● Wires In are derived from the incoming part of bank-to-bank transfers where Wire Transfer is the selected payment
method.
● Other Credits are derived from incoming credit card and direct debit payments as well as cash-to-bank transfers
and incoming bills of exchange. Incoming cashflows where no payment method is selected, for example a bank
payment advice, are also displayed.
Outgoing cashflows (items with a negative value) are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into
categories that are listed and explained below.
● Checks Paid are derived from outgoing checks.
● ACH Debits are derived from all outgoing bank transfers and the outgoing side of bank-to-bank transfers where
Bank Transfer is the selected payment method.
● Wires Out are derived from outgoing wire transfers and the outgoing side of bank-to-bank transfers where Wire
Transfer is the selected payment method.
● Other Debits are derived from outgoing credit card and direct debit payments as well as bank to cash transfers and
outgoing bills of exchange. Outgoing cashflows where no payment method is selected, for example a bank payment
advice, are also displayed.
Bank and Payee/Payer Advices can display in every category for both incoming and outgoing cashflows. This
depends on the payment method that was selected when the advice was created.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Company
○ Bank
○ Cash
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Cash Position – Transaction Details report by clicking with the secondary mouse button on a
payment method line item, for example Check Deposits, and choosing Go To, then Transaction Details from the context
menu.
300 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
6.10.2 Cash Position by Transaction Source
Overview
Shows the petty cash balances and the balances and postings for each bank account, grouped by usage or origin of
the payments. The amounts are based on the bank statements plus unconfirmed payments.
The transaction details are derived from bank statements and payments with a value date on or before the date entered.
This report displays the cash position total amounts for each of the payment methods that make up the cash position
aggregated by the bank.
Prerequisites
To ensure that the cash position is as accurate as possible, check that all available bank statements are uploaded into
the system.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Value Date
The system enters the current date by default. All payments with a value date on or before this date are captured
by the cash position.
● Bank
This selects the particular bank that you may wish to view the cash position of. If you do not specify a bank, the
report shows the cash position across all your company's banks.
● Currency
This selects the currency that you wish to see the report displayed in. This is filled by default with the company
currency assigned to the company during configuration.
● Display Currency Conversion Rate
This selects the exchange rate used to calculate currency conversions in the report.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 301
Analyzing the Report
This report shows an analysis of the cash position total amounts for each transaction source, such as Customer Receipts,
Supplier Payments, Tax Payments and so on. It also displays these particular details for each bank and if required, each
bank account and petty cash account.
The opening and closing cash balances are derived from the balance of bank accounts and cash on hand. You can
view the opening and closing balances for individual banks, bank accounts and cash on hand.
To show the sum from petty cash, use the quick filter for the Bank Account row to select # — Not Assigned.
Petty cash payments are confirmed automatically, and are reflected immediately in the opening and closing
balances for petty cash accounts within this report. Thus, the opening and closing balances of these accounts
will always be equal.
The opening balance is the same as the closing balance from the previous bank statement. These bank statements
may contain items that are yet to be allocated. These items are shown under Unallocated. Usually payment allocation
tasks exist for these items but the tasks are still to be processed.
Checks that are not assigned to a check deposit are credited to the bank account listed in the company’s
check storage.
All items with a positive value are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the categories listed and
explained below.
● Customer Receipts are derived from customer payments such as a credit card payment, direct debit payment or a
check, bank payment advices and remittance advices sent to you by your customers.
● Intra/Intercompany Receipts are derived from payments, bank payment advices and remittance advices sent
between your companies.
● Unallocated displays all the payments that have an open payment allocation task. These items are not yet allocated
to an open trade or tax receivable item. The purpose of the payment is as yet undetermined in the system.
● Other Receipts are derived supplier payments.
All items with a negative value are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into categories that are
listed and explained below.
● Supplier Payments are derived from supplier payments, such as a check or bank transfer, bank payment advices
and remittance advices that you sent to your supplier.
● Employee Expenses are derived from travel expense report payments.
● Tax Payments are derived from tax payments.
● Intra/Intercompany Payments are derived from payments, bank payment advices and remittance advices sent
between your companies.
● Unallocated displays all the payments that have an open payment allocation task. These items are not yet allocated
to an open trade or tax payable item. The purpose of the payment is as yet undetermined in the system.
● Other Payments are derived from customer payments.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
302 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Company
○ Bank
○ Cash
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Cash Position – Transaction Details report by clicking on a transaction source with the secondary
mouse button, for example Customer Receipts, and selecting Go To, then Transaction Details from the context menu.
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
6.10.3 Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level
Overview
Shows the payments expected in the middle term, for example, the next ninety working days, for each bank account
grouped by liquidity level. You first need to have performed a liquidity forecast run to determine the liquidity forecast
data.
This is the default setting. If you wish to view the forecast for longer or shorter periods you can change this setting in
fine tuning.
The report aggregates and analyzes expected collections and disbursements by liquidity level to support investment
and financing decisions. The various liquidity levels show how liquid or close to cash your company’s assets and liabilities
are by displaying the current stage of a liquidity item in the transaction lifecycle.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level (Default)Shows the liquidity levels for each transaction source for the entire company and each bank, in the selected time
period. This is the default view.
● Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level DailyShows the same information as above except the calendar week and month for each day are not displayed.
● Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level WeeklyShows the same information as above except the transaction sources and relevant amounts are displayed for each
week of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level MonthlyShows the same information as above except the transaction sources and relevant amounts are displayed for each
month of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Liquidity Level Weekly - Overdue
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 303
Shows all overdue trade and tax payables and receivables items as well as all open payment items (payments that
are not cleared). An item is overdue when the expected payment date is previous to the forecast creation date. The
overdue payables and receivables items are displayed under Receivables/Payables. The open payment items are
displayed under Payments.
Prerequisites
The report is based on the data collected by the liquidity forecast run. You must create a liquidity forecast before using
the report. For more information on how to do so see Create and Refresh the Liquidity Forecast
You should perform the liquidity forecast only after the data from the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management and
Payment Management work centers has been processed, that is, at the end of the working day. You should also ensure
that all available bank statements are uploaded into the system. This ensures that the liquidity forecast is as accurate
as possible.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
The most important variables are explained below.
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Liquidity Forecast ID
Select the particular liquidity forecast on which the report will be based. This is filled by default with the ID of the
most recently created forecast. If you select a lower forecast ID you can display historical forecast data.
● Time Period
Select the time period that you want to analyze.
You cannot exceed the maximum time period as defined in the Forecast profile during business
configuration. You can review and change the liquidity forecast profiles in the Business Configuration
work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > LiquidityForecast Profiles.
● Display Currency
This selects the currency that you wish to see the report displayed in. This is filled by default with the company
currency assigned to the company during configuration.
● Display Currency Conversion Rate
This selects the exchange rate used to calculate currency conversions in the report.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report shows an analysis of expected cash inflows and outflows for the selected time period. It aggregates and
analyzes expected collections and disbursements by liquidity level, to support investment and financing decisions.
The system groups the report in two categories:
304 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
● Opening Cash Balance
● Payments
This category displays all incoming and outgoing payments using every payment method. These funds are usually
more liquid (closer to cash) than the due items displayed under Receivables/Payables. This is because they are
usually closer to the end of the transaction lifecycle. For example a bank transfer, displayed under Payments, is
more likely to be cash before an Invoice received from a supplier, displayed under Receivables/Payables.
● Receivables/Payables
This displays all payables and receivables items, for example invoices. Open tax items from trade receivables and
payables are also included. These transactions usually have a lower liquidity level than Payments because they
are closer to the beginning of the transaction lifecycle.
Each of these categories are further divided as below:
● Customers displays all payments and notifications of payments received from your customers. These can include
bank transfers, checks, remittance advices, credit card payments, and direct debits.
● Suppliers displays all payments and notifications of payments sent to your suppliers. These can include bank
transfers, remittance advices, credit card payments, and direct debits.
● Employees displays all payments made to employees.
● Tax displays all payments made to and received from a tax authority.
● Intra/Intercompany displays all payments made between and within your companies. For example, bank-to-bank
transfers are included here.
● Unallocated displays all the funds that have an open payment allocation task. These items are not yet allocated to
an open trade or tax payable or receivable item. The purpose of the payment is as yet undetermined in the system.
For more detailed information about how the liquidity process gathers data and calculates the dates for the forecast see
Liquidity Forecast.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Bank Account ID
○ Company
○ Value Date Week
○ Value Date Month
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Liquidity Forecast – Transaction Details report by clicking with the secondary mouse button on a
payment method line item, for example Check Deposits, and choosing Go To, then Transaction Details from the context
menu.
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 305
Although the report reads the forecast data in real time, the forecast itself is created from the Liquidity Forecast
Run that you create and schedule in the Liquidity Management work center. For more information see Liquidity
Forecast.
6.10.4 Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method
Overview
The Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method report displays expected cash inflows and outflows for the next twenty
working days.
This is the default setting. If you wish to view the forecast for longer periods you can change this setting in fine tuning.
The report aggregates and analyzes expected collections and disbursements by payment method to support investment
and financing decisions.
Views
The following views are available with this report:
● Liquidity Forecast by Payment MethodShows the details of the method of payment, for example ACH credits, used by each transaction source, for example
a bank, in the selected time period. This is the default view.
● Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method DailyShows the same information as above except the payment methods and relevant amounts are displayed for each
day of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method WeeklyShows the same information as above except the payment methods and relevant amounts are displayed for each
week of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Payment Method MonthlyShows the same information as above except the payment methods and relevant amounts are displayed for each
month of the selected time period.
Prerequisites
The report is based on the data collected by the liquidity forecast run. You must create a liquidity forecast before using
the report. For more information on how to do so see Create and Refresh the Forecast.
You should perform the liquidity forecast only after the data from the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management and
Payment Management work centers has been processed, that is, at the end of the working day. You should also ensure
that all available bank statements are uploaded into the system. This ensures that the liquidity forecast is as accurate
as possible.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
306 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
The most important variables are explained below.
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Liquidity Forecast ID
Select the particular liquidity forecast on which the report will be based. This is filled by default with the ID of the
most recently created forecast. If you select a lower forecast ID you can display historical forecast data.
● Time Period
Select the time period that you want to analyze.
You cannot exceed the maximum time period as defined in the Forecast profile during business
configuration. You can review and change the liquidity forecast profiles in the Business Configuration
work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > LiquidityForecast Profiles.
● Display Currency
This selects the currency that you wish to see the report displayed in. This is filled by default with the company
currency assigned to the company during configuration.
● Display Currency Conversion Rate
This selects the exchange rate used to calculate currency conversions in the report.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The data in the report is initially displayed in table format. You can also display the report as a chart.
This report shows an analysis of expected cash inflows and outflows for the selected time period. It aggregates and
analyzes expected collections and disbursements by payment method, to support investment and financing decisions.
All incoming cashflows (items with a positive value) are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the
categories listed and explained below.
● Incoming checks are derived from deposited checks.
● ACH Credits are derived from the incoming side of bank-to-bank transfers where Bank Transfer is the selected
payment method.
● Wires In are derived from the incoming side of bank-to-bank transfers where Wire Transfer is the selected payment
method.
● Other Credits are derived from incoming credit card and direct debit payments as well as cash-to-bank transfers
and incoming bills of exchange. Incoming cashflows, that result from open trade receivables items where no
payment method is assigned, are also displayed.
All outgoing cashflows (items with a negative value) are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into
categories that are listed and explained below.
● Checks Paid are derived from outgoing checks.
● ACH Debits are derived from all outgoing bank transfers and the outgoing side of bank-to-bank transfers where
Bank Transfer is the selected payment method.
● Wires Out are derived from outgoing wire transfers and the outgoing side of bank-to-bank transfers where Bank
Transfer is the selected payment method.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 307
● Other Debits are derived from outgoing credit card and direct debit payments as well as bank to cash transfers and
outgoing bills of exchange. Outgoing cashflows where no payment method is selected, for example a bank payment
advice, are also displayed.
Forecast Planning Items and Bank Payment Advices that are posting relevant can display in every category.
This depends on the payment method that was selected when the advice was created.
For more detailed information about how the liquidity process gathers data and calculates the dates for the forecast see
Liquidity Forecast.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Bank Account ID
○ Company
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Liquidity Forecast - Transaction Details report by clicking with the secondary mouse button on a
payment method line item, for example Check Deposits, and selecting Go To, then Liquidity Forecast – Transaction
Details from the context menu.
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
Although the report reads the forecast data in real time, the forecast itself is created from the Liquidity Forecast
Run that you create and schedule in the Liquidity Management work center. For more information see Liquidity
Forecast.
6.10.5 Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency
Overview
Shows the payments expected in the middle term, for example, the next ninety working days, for each bank account
grouped by transaction currency. You first need to have performed a liquidity forecast run to determine the liquidity
forecast data.
This is the default setting. If you wish to view the forecast for longer periods you can change this setting in fine tuning.
The report analyzes the balances by transaction currency to support currency management decisions.
Views
The following views are available with this report:
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency (Default)
308 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Shows the total amount for each transaction currency in the selected liquidity forecast for the selected time period.
The results are presented for each day of the selected time period. The relevant calendar week and month for each
day is also displayed. This view is the default view of the report.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency DailyShows the same information as above except the calendar week and month for each day are not displayed.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency WeeklyShows the same information as above except it displays the total amounts for each transaction currency for each
week of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Currency MonthlyShows the same information as above except it displays the total amounts for each transaction currency for each
month of the selected time period.
Prerequisites
The report is based on the data collected by the liquidity forecast run. You must create a liquidity forecast before using
the report.
You should perform the liquidity forecast only after the data from the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management and
Payment Management work centers has been processed, that is, at the end of the working day. You should also ensure
that all available bank statements have been uploaded into the system. This ensures that the liquidity forecast is as
accurate as possible.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
The most important variables are explained below.
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Liquidity Forecast ID
This specifies the particular liquidity forecast that you want to see the transaction currency details of. This is filled
by default with the most recently created forecast’s ID. If you select a lower forecast ID you can display historical
forecast data.
● Time Period
Select the time period on which the data is based.
You cannot exceed the maximum time period as defined in the Forecast Profile during business
configuration. You can review and change the liquidity forecast profiles in the Business Configuration
work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > LiquidityForecast Profiles.
● Transaction Currency
Choose the currency that you would like to view the liquidity forecast of. The transaction currency is the currency
that payment was made in.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 309
Analyzing the Report
The data in the report is initially displayed in table format. You can also display the report as a chart.
This report shows an analysis of the expected cash in- and outflows by transaction currency for the selected time period.
It displays aggregated balances by transaction currency, over future time periods, resulting from trade payables and
receivables, tax payables and receivables, all payment items, and manually entered forecast planning items.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Liquidity Level
This shows how liquid or near to cash the transactions are. It shows the current stage of the item in the
transaction lifecycle. For forecast planning items, this is derived from the Transaction Progress field.
○ Transaction Source
This shows the origin of the liquidity item. For example, a customer or a supplier.
○ Debit/Credit
Displays the incoming and outgoing cash flows.
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Liquidity Forecast - Transaction Details report by clicking with the secondary mouse button on a
transaction currency line item, for example Great British Pound, and choosing Go To, then Liquidity Forecast –
Transaction Details from the context menu.
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
Although the report reads the forecast data in real time, the forecast itself is created from the Liquidity Forecast
Run that you create and schedule in the Liquidity Management work center. For more information see Liquidity
Forecast
6.10.6 Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source
Overview
Shows the payments expected in the middle term, for example, the next ninety working days, grouped by purpose or
origin. You first need to have performed a liquidity forecast run to determine the liquidity forecast data.
This is the default setting. If you wish to view the forecast for longer or shorter periods you can change this setting in
fine tuning.
The report aggregates and analyzes expected collections and disbursements by transaction source to support
investment and financing decisions.
310 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
Views
This report offers you the following views:
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source (Default)Shows the liquidity forecast for the next four days per transaction source, for example customer receipts. The results
are broken down further per individual bank. The relevant calendar week and month for each day is also displayed.
This is the default view for this report.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source DailyShows the same information as above except the calendar week and month for each day are not displayed.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source WeeklyShows the same information as above except details are provided for each week of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source MonthlyShows the same information as above except details are provided for each month of the selected time period.
● Liquidity Forecast by Transaction Source – Weekly – OverdueShows all overdue trade and tax payables and receivables items as well as all open payment items (payments that
are not cleared). An item is overdue when the expected payment date is previous to the forecast creation date. The
overdue payables and receivables items are displayed under Receivables/Payables. The open payment items are
displayed under Payments.
Prerequisites
The report is based on the data collected by the liquidity forecast run. You must create a liquidity forecast before using
the report.
You should perform the liquidity forecast only after the data from the Payables, Receivables, Tax Management and
Payment Management work centers has been processed, that is, at the end of the working day. You should also ensure
that all available bank statements are uploaded into the system. This ensures that the liquidity forecast is as accurate
as possible.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
Additional information is available for the following selected variables:
The most important variables are explained below.
● Company
The system enters the company by default.
● Liquidity Forecast ID
Select the particular liquidity forecast on which the report will be based. This is filled by default with the ID of the
most recently created forecast. If you select a lower forecast ID you can display historical forecast data.
● Time Period
Select the time period that you want to analyze.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 311
You cannot exceed the maximum time period as defined in the Forecast profile during business
configuration. You can review and change the liquidity forecast profiles in the Business Configuration
work center in the Activity List view. In the Fine Tune step, choose Cash Flow Management > LiquidityForecast Profiles.
● Display Currency
This selects the currency that you wish to see the report displayed in. This is filled by default with the company
currency assigned to the company during configuration.
● Display Currency Conversion Rate
This selects the exchange rate used to calculate currency conversions in the report.
For more information on common variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The data in the report is initially displayed in table format. You can also display the report as a chart.
This report shows an analysis of expected cash in- and outflows by transaction source for the selected time period. It
displays opening and ending balances, collections, disbursements, and net flows over future time periods. These can
result from trade payables and receivables, tax payables and receivables, all payment items, and manually entered
forecast planning items.
Incoming cashflows (items with a positive value) are displayed under Collections. These are further divided into the
categories listed and explained below.
● Customer Receipts are derived from customer invoices and payments from customers such as a credit card
payment or check.
● Intra/Inter company Receipts are derived from forecast planning items that are not expired as well as invoices and
payments between your companies.
● Tax Receipts are derived from tax receivables and the tax declaration, if this has a positive value.
● Unallocated displays all the payments that have an open payment allocation task. These items are not yet allocated
to an open trade or tax receivable item. The purpose of the payment is as yet undetermined in the system.
● Other Receipts are derived from supplier credit memos and payments.
Outgoing cashflows (items with a negative value) are displayed under Disbursements. These are further divided into
categories that are listed and explained below.
● Supplier Payments are derived from supplier invoices and payments to a supplier such as check or bank transfer.
● Employee Expenses are derived from travel expense reports and the payment of travel expense reports.
● Intra/Intercompany Payments are derived from invoices and payments between your companies.
● Tax Payments are derived from tax payables and the tax declaration, if this has a negative value.
● Unallocated displays all the funds that have an open payment allocation task. These items are not yet allocated to
an open trade or tax payable item. The purpose of the payment is as yet undetermined in the system.
● Other Payments are derived from customer credit memos and payments.
Forecast Planning Items can display in every category for both incoming and outgoing payments. This
depends on the depending on the assigned transaction source
For more detailed information about the liquidity forecast see Liquidity Forecast.
To analyze the data in this report:
312 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Liquidity Management
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the display additional characteristics from the list of
characteristics not currently displayed. For this report, you can include these characteristics: ○ Bank Account ID
○ Company
○ Expected Value Date
○ Value Date Week
○ Value Date Month
To display further details, click the relevant item, then click the arrow to access use the context menu.
You can view the Liquidity Forecast - Transaction Details report by clicking with the secondary mouse button on a
transaction source line item, for example Check Deposits, and choosing Go To, then Liquidity Forecast – Transaction
Details from the context menu.
See also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
Although the report reads the forecast data in real time, the forecast itself is created from the Liquidity Forecast
Run that you create and schedule in the Liquidity Management work center. For more information see Liquidity
Forecast.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Liquidity Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 313
7 Tax Management
7.1 Business Background
7.1.1 Tax Management Work Center
The Tax Management work center supports you in creating the following tax returns:
● Advance Returns for VAT and Annual VAT Returns
● EC Sales Lists
● Withholding Tax Returns (Note: This tax return type is not relevant for Germany.)
● Sales and Use Tax Returns (US)
Corporate income tax, employment tax, trade tax, or other types of use tax are not considered in the Tax
Management work center.
The system selects the tax items to be reported for the selected reporting period in the tax return run, generates a tax
return, and determines the tax payable or tax receivable to be cleared. It does this based on the configuration settings,
business transactions, and manual tax entries. The tax returns in the system can be used as a template for creating
and sending your tax return forms or tax files. (Note: It is not possible to electronically submit tax data from the system.)
In addition, you can enter tax prepayments or the payment of a tax payable or receivable that was determined in a tax
return relevant for payment. To obtain an overview of the open or reported tax items of a selected reporting period, you
can use the various reports provided:
For more information about the Tax Management work center, see Help SAP Business ByDesign Library Business
Areas Financial Management Cash Flow Management Tax Management . You can find an overview of the views
available in the Tax Management work center in the following quick guides:
Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363]
Manual Tax Entries:
● Quick Guide for VAT / Sales Tax Entries [365]
● Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Entries (US) [364]
● Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Base Amount Entries (US) [367]
Tax Return Runs:
● Quick Guide for VAT Return Runs [391]
● Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Return Runs (US) [388]
● Quick Guide for EC Sales List Runs [393]
● Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Return Runs (US) [390]
Tax Returns:
● Quick Guide for VAT Returns [372]
● Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Returns (US) [368]
● Quick Guide for EC Sales Lists [374]
314 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Returns (US) [372]
Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382]
See Also
Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316]
Example Scenario for Tax Payments [325]
Example Scenario for Tax Entries [326]
7.1.2 Tax Returns
7.1.2.1 Tax Register
The system uses the tax register to continuously store all tax items and tax adjustment items that have been entered
automatically as a result of tax-relevant business transactions or that have been entered manually. The system uses
the data in the tax register to create your tax returns. Each tax item in the tax register represents a tax receivable or a
tax payable between your company and the tax authority. The reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT /
Sales Tax Items and All VAT / Sales Tax Items are based on the data in the tax register.
The tax register uses the Reported indicator to categorize the tax items into reported and open tax items. The system
uses this indicator to check whether a tax item is relevant for a tax return yet to be submitted. If the Reported status is
set for a tax item, that tax item is not included in the tax return run.
For each tax item, the journal entry type, journal entry ID, business partner, tax base amount, transaction date, and tax
due date [319] are defined. (Note: The system does not store the gross amount for each tax item; it only does so at the
journal entry level) In contrast to the tax subledger, no tax entries or posting data are considered in the tax register.
We strongly recommend against making tax entries directly in the General Ledger work center. These entries
are not entered in the tax register. You otherwise you have to manually add the tax items posted in the general
ledger in the return forms for submitting your tax returns to the tax authority.
Tax Subledger
The tax subledger is used to explain the tax G/L accounts in the general ledger. The tax subledger includes, in addition
to the valuated and posted tax items, other tax data and information about the underlying tax-relevant business
transactions. You find an overview of the tax entries in the General Ledger work center in the Tax – Line Items report.
7.1.2.2 Tax Codes and Tax Events
Tax codes represent specific tax use cases. You enter tax codes when you record business transactions (such as
customer invoices, manual tax entries).
Using the tax determination logic stored in the system, the system derives the tax type, tax event, and tax rate type
(such as standard tax rate or reduced tax rate) from the tax code and determines the correct tax amount.
The tax event determines the field in the tax return form in which the tax item (tax amount or tax base amount) is to be
displayed.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 315
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria and Germany. To ensure that the system displays
the correct text, select Personalize → My Settings. Select Onscreen Help, and, under Country, choose the
relevant country. Save your settings and logout to ensure the changes are made.
Configuration Settings
● In addition to the tax codes that are predefined in the system, you can create other tax codes and assign tax events
predefined by SAP. The settings for this can be viewed in the fine-tuning settings under Taxes on Goods and
Services Define Tax Codes .
● You can view the assignments of tax events and tax rate types to the form fields in the fine-tuning settings under
Tax Returns for Goods and Services. Here you can make other assignments.
For more information, see Tax Determination [342].
7.1.2.3 Example Scenario for Tax Returns
This example scenario describes a procedure that covers the typical steps from entering a business transaction relevant
for taxes to creating a tax return. In our example, you create a VAT return for the reporting period October 1 to October
31, 2010:
1. Enter Business Transactions:
You have entered invoice documents in the Customer Invoicing work center. The system applies the stored tax
determination logic to automatically determine the tax amounts from the tax data, the relevant tax event, and the
tax rate, and then posts these tax amounts in the general ledger. At the same time, the tax items relevant for the
tax return were transferred to the tax register.
2. Checks before the Tax Return Run:
We strongly recommend that you perform the following checks regularly (especially during quarter-end
and year-end closing) and during system implementation, system changeover, and after changes to the
system settings.
1. Run the VAT / Sales Tax Reconciliation report. This report compares the tax data relevant for the reporting
period in the tax register with the tax entries in the general ledger and analyzes whether any technically related
differences have occurred.
2. Check whether open tax items exist with a posting date after the reporting period. You avoid any balance
differences in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, choose the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report and
enter the following time periods: ● Tax Due Date: 1.1.2010 – 31.10.2010
● Posting Date: 1.11.2010 – 31.12.9999
3. Check whether open tax items exist with a tax due date after the reporting period. You avoid any balance
amounts in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, choose the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report and
enter the following time periods: ● Tax Due Date: 1.11.2010 – 31.12.9999
● Posting Date: 1.1.2010 – 31.10.2010
4. Determine the tax amount to be cleared for the reporting period. Choose the Open VAT /Sales Tax Items report
and enter the time period January 1, 2010 – October 31, 2010 for the tax due date.
316 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
5. Check which tax amounts were manually overridden and posted in the source documents. Choose the VAT /
Sales Tax Calculation – Details report and enter the month October under Proposed Posting Date. The report
calculates the tax amounts using the items in the source documents and compares them with the tax amounts
that were actually posted. If a tax amount was manually overridden, you can navigate directly in the report to
the journal entry of the relevant tax amount and navigate further to the source document.
3. Execute a Tax Return Run:
In the Tax Management work center, you create a tax return with a tax return run. The tax items relevant for the
reporting period are selected automatically from the tax register and then summarized and assigned on the basis
of the fields affected in the tax form.
Note: To make sure that all open tax items are taken into account, choose a period from January 1 of the current
calendar year for the run. You can display the open tax items in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
4. Check the Tax Return and Send Tax Data:
Select the tax return created in the system and check the correctness of the tax data. To do this, choose Preview
and Details on the Tax Return tab.
5. Release a Tax Return:
Once you have sent the tax data to the tax authority, select the tax return in the system and then Release. This
results in the following: ● The status of the tax return in the system is changed from In Preparation to Reported.
● The relevant tax items obtain the status Reported in the tax register and are now displayed in the Reported
VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
● The balance of the VAT / sales tax and input tax account is transferred to the tax payable account.
See Also
Example Scenario for Tax Payments [325]
7.1.2.4 Status of Tax Returns
Overview
Here is an overview of the changes to the status of tax returns following various actions:
Status of theTax Return Permitted Actions:
New Status ofthe TaxReturn
Submit taxreturn to thetax authority
Cancel a taxreturn
Create acorrectionreturn
Delete a taxreturn
Make a taxpayment(and releasethe paymentin thePaymentManagementwork center)
Cancel a taxpayment(in thePaymentManagementwork center)
In Preparation X Reported
In Preparation X (n/a)
Reported X Canceled
Canceled (n/a)
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 317
Status of theTax Return Permitted Actions:
New Status ofthe TaxReturn
Submit taxreturn to thetax authority
Cancel a taxreturn
Create acorrectionreturn
Delete a taxreturn
Make a taxpayment(and releasethe paymentin thePaymentManagementwork center)
Cancel a taxpayment(in thePaymentManagementwork center)
Reported X Completed
Reported X Replaced
Completed X Replaced
Completed X Reported(Status of thetax payment:Canceled
Additional Notes
● You can only delete tax returns that have the In Preparation status because no tax items have yet been updated
in the tax register and none have yet been posted.
● You can use a correction run to create an additional correction return for an existing correction return.
● The Completed status is assigned automatically once the tax return has been reported and the tax payment has
been requested and released.
See Also
Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316]
7.1.2.5 Generic Tax Return As Tax Return Type
You can use the generic tax return to report tax items and to initiate tax payments that are not considered in your regular
tax returns.
The system does not cover all legal tax rules of your country by generic tax returns. Additional steps to submit
a valid and correct tax return have to be performed outside the system.
Details
During a tax return run of a generic tax return, all tax items that are not considered in a regular tax return of the respective
country get the status Reported in the tax register. In addition, the system performs all related postings to clear the
input and output tax accounts against a tax liability account.
For countries that are either not supported by the system or are not included in the scope of your business solution,
the system selects all open tax items of the country of the tax authority during the tax return runs for generic tax returns.
Tax return types for generic tax returns are provided for the following countries:
318 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Bulgaria
● Finland
● Hungary
● Ireland
● Portugal
● Romania
The generic tax return does not provide a workaround for the input tax refund procedure within the European
Community. The generic tax return is applied to tax items within a country of the respective tax authority.
Compared to this, the input tax refund procedure allows to claim foreign taxes from a local tax authority.
Furthermore, the generic tax return does not support prepayments, tax reporting groups, or withholding taxes.
The generic tax return is a payment relevant tax return type. You can initiate and post an outgoing or an incoming tax
payment for the tax amount calculated by the generic tax return. For more information, see Quick Guide for Tax
Payments [382].
For a generic tax return you can create an amended tax return as with the regular tax returns. For more information,
see Correction Run and Amended Tax Return.
The function to carry forward a receivable from the tax authority is available in the generic tax return. This is only relevant
in the United States. For more information see Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319]. Carry forward must be activated in
the tax authority master data. For more information see Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363].
Prerequisites
Before creating generic tax returns make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority. For more information,
see Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363]. Note that you have to define a tax return arrangement for tax return type
“999 Tax Return”.
Create a Generic Tax Return
Navigate to the Tax Management work center, select the respective view under Periodic Tasks, choose New Tax
Return Run , and enter the required data. You can find exemplary information in the Tasks section of the documents
Quick Guide for VAT Return Runs [391] and Quick Guide for VAT Returns [372].
7.1.2.6 Tax Due Date of Tax Items
For each tax-relevant transaction, the system creates the related tax item(s) and determines the tax due date for each
tax item. The tax due date is used to specify the reporting period in which a tax item is submitted to the tax authority
with the tax return. In the system default settings, the tax due date usually corresponds to the posting date of the
underlying business transaction. There are the following exceptions:
● If you enter a Deviate Tax Due Date when entering customer invoices, supplier invoices, and manual VAT entries,
this date is then used as the tax due date.
● For VAT prepayments, the system always uses the clearing date as the tax due date. The clearing date determines
the advance return for VAT that is used to clear the prepayment.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 319
● If carry forward has been activated for a tax return type in the tax authority master data, as is usual in the US, the
tax receivable resulting from a tax return is cleared with the subsequent tax return. In these cases, the system sets
the tax due date to the start of the next reporting period by default.
Alternatively, you can specify that the tax due date can differ from the posting date. The setting required for this is in
the business configuration in the activity named Tax Due Date Determination. If you change the standard setting, the
system automatically determines the tax due date using the derivation rules implemented in the system.
● Changing the standard setting can lead to inconsistencies during the periodic reconciliation of tax items
with the tax accounts. We therefore strongly recommend that you only make this setting after a previous
thorough inspection.
● If you do decide to change the standard settings, we recommend that you refrain from doing so during
the current fiscal year.
● The change does not affect tax items already entered and posted.
Determining the Tax Due Date for Selected Transactions After Changing theStandard Setting
Customer Invoice and Customer Credit Memo
If you have not specified a tax due date in the Customer Invoicing work center for a customer invoice or a customer
credit memo, the system applies the Invoice Date as the tax due date by default.
Supplier Invoice and Supplier Credit Memo
If, in the Supplier Invoicing work center, you have not specified a Deviate Tax Due Date for a supplier invoice or supplier
credit memo but you have specified a posting date, the posting date is applied as the tax due date. If you have not
specified either a Deviate Tax Due Date or a Posting Date, the system applies the Invoice Date as the tax due date.
The Receipt Date is not relevant for determining the tax due date.
Incoming direct debit: The system uses the Document Date as the tax due date.
Outgoing bank transfer: The system uses the Expected Bank Value Date as the tax due date.
● If you have specified a Bank Processing Date, the system uses it to derive the Expected Bank Value
Date. Otherwise, the system applies the day after the Document Date.
● In the case of a Wire Transfer, the Expected Bank Value Date is derived - unchanged - from the
Document Date.
● In all cases, the system applies the factory calendar stored.
Bank statement: In the case of an incoming or outgoing payment that was entered by means of a bank statement in
the Liquidity Management work center and that can be cleared against an open item (such as an incoming bank transfer
and an outgoing credit memo), the system uses the Statement Date as the tax due date. For more information, see
Bank Statements [253].
● You have to enter bank statements in the system on a daily basis.
● If the date on a bank statement differs from the value date of an item, you have to manually post a tax
correcting entry for that item in the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax Entries.
Check: In the case of an incoming check, the system uses the Posting Date as the tax due date. In the case of an
outgoing check, the system uses the Date of Issue as the tax due date.
320 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
If the date on which the check leaves the control of the company differs from the Date of Issue, you have to
make a tax correcting entry in the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax Entries. .
Cash payment: In the case of an incoming cash payment, the system uses the Receipt Date as the tax due date. In
the case of an outgoing cash payment, the system uses the Payment Date as the tax due date.
Travel and expenses: In the case of an expense report, the system uses the Posting Date as the tax due date.
Manual clearing: When an open item undergoes manual payment clearing in the Receivables or Payables work centers,
the system uses the Document Date as the tax due date. Note that, with the standard settings, the system uses the
current date as the document date.
Debit/credit: In the case of a debit or credit entered in the Receivables work center by means of the Customer Account
Monitor [133], the system uses the posting date as the tax due date.
Tax prepayment: In the case of a tax prepayment performed in the Tax Management work center, the system uses the
Clearing Due Date as the tax due date.
Care (USA): If a tax return (such as sales and use tax return) produces a carryforward, the tax due date is the next day
after the end of the reporting period for that tax return.
Manual tax entry: In the case of a manual tax entry in the Tax Management work center, you explicitly specify the tax
due date. With the standard settings, the system proposes the current date by default.
Cancellation: In the case of reversals, the standard system applies the posting date of the reversal transaction as the
tax due date. If, however, the posting date specified falls before the tax due date of the original tax item, the system
applies the tax due date of the original tax item as the tax due date.
7.1.2.7 Tax Reporting
Overview
Companies must levy taxes on their products and services and they have to pay and report the collected tax to the tax
authority periodically. SAP business ByDesign helps you to file your returns for the various tax types in accordance with
the legal requirements of the country in which your company is located.
This document contains text that is region specific. To ensure that the system displays the correct text, select
Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose the relevant country.
Save your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.8 Subsequent Reporting of Tax Items
Overview
You have three options for subsequently reporting open tax items to your tax authority:
● You can create an amended tax return and specify the same reporting period for the correction run as that of the
tax return to be amended.
You create an amended tax return for the tax return relating to the reporting period 03/01 through 03/31. You enter
the reporting period 03/01 through 03/31 for the correction run (see also: Correction Run and Amended Tax Return).
● You include the open tax items from previous reporting periods in your next VAT return (such as your advance
return for VAT in Germany).
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 321
You create a tax return for March and want to include all the previous open tax items of the current year. You
therefore enter 01/01 through 03/31 for the tax return run.
● You take into account existing open tax items when you create your normal annual tax return.
7.1.2.9 Chamber Contribution Fee Calculation - Austria
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose Austria. Save
your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.10 Import Of Services – India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.11 Challan Processing - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.12 Purchase of Capital Goods - India
7.1.2.12
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
322 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
7.1.2.13 Prepayment of service tax - india
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.14 prepayment of VAT - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.15 Separate payment of CST and VAT - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.16 Service Tax Return - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.17 Tax ABATEMENT — INDIA
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 323
7.1.2.18 Withholding Tax - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.19 Import of goods - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.20 Stock Transfer - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.21 Unregistered Dealer Purchase - India
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
7.1.2.22 withholding tax 27Q - INDIA
This document contains text that is relevant for India only. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose India. Save your
settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
324 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
7.1.3 Tax Payments
7.1.3.1 Example Scenario for Tax Payments
This example scenario takes you through the typical steps of clearing a tax payable due to a tax return.
1. Check whether the tax payable in the reported tax return matches the value displayed in the report Reported VAT /
Sales Items.
2. Select the tax return and click Pay . If necessary, change the payment date and posting date proposed by the
system and choose OK . The payment is assigned an internal number and the status In Preparation.
3. If the data of the payment is consistent, a task Approve Tax Payment is sent to the manager's worklist
4. If the manager approves this payment, the system automatically performs the following actions: ● The payment is assigned the status Released and is posted to the appropriate tax account.
● A journal entry is generated and the journal entry ID is assigned to the payment.
● The tax return has the status Completed.
5. The amount to be transferred to the tax authority is now in Payment Management under Payment Monitor with the
status Ready for Transfer.
For more information, see Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382].
7.1.3.2 Status of Tax Payments
Here is an overview of the changes to the status of internally and externally-initiated tax payments depending on
performed actions:
Changes to the Status of Internally-Initiated Tax Payments
Action(Tax Managementwork center)
Status Action(Managing My Areawork center)
Status Action(Tax Managementwork center)
Status
Pay In Approval Send Back forRevision
In Preparation Submit In Approval
In Preparation Discard Release Discarded
In Approval Approve Released Reverse Canceled
Changes to the Status of Externally-Initiated Tax Payments
Action(PaymentManagementor LiquidityManagementwork center)
Status Action(TaxManagementwork center)
Status Action(ManagingMy Area workcenter)
Status Action(TaxManagementwork center)
Status
Release* In Preparation Accept*Submit*
In Approval Approve Released
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 325
Released Reverse Canceled
In Approval Send Back forRevision
In Preparation
Cancel* ReleaseDiscardedCanceled
* You perform this action by selecting the relevant task from the worklist.
Note: For selected incoming and outgoing payment types that are entered in the Payment Management or Liquidity
Management work centers, you can also optionally define in the configuration settings whether approval tasks should
be generated for this work center for specific payment methods and when you exceed a defined threshold amount. You
find these settings in fine-tuning under Business Task Management for Payment and Liquidity.
See Also
Tasks Relevant for Tax Payments in the Worklist (Overview)
7.1.4 Tax Transactions and Tax Postings
7.1.4.1 Example Scenario for Tax Entries
How the system enters a payment-relevant tax return and the clearing of a tax payable is described here. The entries
are presented in simplified form (diagram).
1. Business Transactions:
You have released a supplier invoice that has VAT / sales tax of EUR 19. This input tax is a receivable to the tax authority.
The system posts as follows:
Account Debit Credit
Goods 100
Input Tax (19%) 19
Payables 119
You have released a customer invoice that has VAT / sales tax of EUR 380. This VAT / sales tax is a payable to the tax
authority. The system posts as follows:
Account Debit Credit
Receivables 2380
Sales Revenue 2000
VAT /Sales Tax (19%) 380
2. Tax Return:
If the related tax return is released, the system posts to the VAT / sales tax account and input tax account as follows:
326 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Account Debit Credit
VAT / Sales Tax 380
Tax Payable Account 380
Account Debit Credit
Tax Payable Account 19
Input Tax 19
There is a balance of EUR 361 on the tax payable account.
3. Tax Payment:
Once you have entered the outgoing tax payment, the system posts as follows:
Account Debit Credit
Bank Clearing Account 361
Bank 361
If the tax payment is released, the balance of the tax payable account is cleared:
Account Debit Credit
Tax Payable Account 361
Bank Clearing Account 361
7.1.4.2 Goods and Services Granted Free of Charge
Under German VAT law, goods and services granted free of charge relate to the provision of a service or goods
without any payment or service in return being agreed upon or to the provision of a serice or goods exclusively for
private consumption or use. A distinction is made between deliveries that are free of charge (§3 para. 1b, German VAT
law) and other services that are free of charge (§ 3 para. 9a no. 1, German VAT law).
● Deliveries Free of Charge
The tax base amount for deliveries that are free of charge is generally the acquisition price or replacement cost,
including all overhead costs at the time when the goods were taken from stock. VAT does not form part of the tax
base amount. If it is not possible to calculate a purchase price, the cost of goods sold is used. The cost of goods
sold comprises all costs that were incurred in the service provision or production process up until the time when
the goods were taken from stock.
● Other Services Free of Charge
The tax base amount for taxable services that were provided free of charge comprises all costs incurred in direct
relation to performing these services, including any expenses that are not subject to VAT (such as proportional
personnel costs). This only holds when the company is completely or partially entitled to claim input tax deduction
for these costs.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 327
Recording the Business Transaction
To be able to post goods and services granted free of charge, the following data is required:
● The net value at the time when the goods were taken from stock.
● The balance sheet account, expense account, and equity account relevant for the posting, as well as the
corresponding account determination groups.
● The tax codes to be used.
You enter goods and services granted free of charge in the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax Entries In
certain cases, you might need to make additional postings in other work centers.
Application Examples
1. Posting Example: Other Services Granted Free of Charge
Debit Credit
Other Revenue Reserves (Account Type: EQUITY)
Travel Expenses (Account Type: COSEXP)
Value-Added Tax (Account Type: TAX)
Entering Tax Manually
AccountDetermination Group
Debit Credit Tax Code Tax Amount
Z-1000 – OtherRevenue Reserves
119
A-7100 – TravelExpenses
100 Z1 – Services GrantedFree of Charge
19
You set up the account determination group Z-1000 and the tax code Z1 as described below in the Business
Configuration section.
2. Posting Example: Low-value asset granted free of charge, originally entered as expense
Debit Credit
Other Revenue Reserves (Account Type: EQUITY)
Office Supplies (Account Type: COSEXP)
Value-Added Tax (Account Type: TAX)
Entering Tax Manually
AccountDetermination Group
Debit Credit Tax Code Tax Amount
Z-1000 – OtherRevenue Reserves
119
A-7420 – OfficeSupplies
100 Z2 – Goods GrantedFree of Charge
19
328 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
You set up the account determination group Z-1000 and the tax code Z2 as described below in the Business
Configuration section.
3. Posting Example: Warehouse Inventory Goods Granted Free of Charge
Debit Credit
Other Revenue Reserves (Account Type: EQUITY)
Costs for Finished Goods (Account Type: COSEXP)
Value-Added Tax (Account Type: TAX)
Entering Tax Manually
AccountDetermination Group
Debit Credit Tax Code Tax Amount
Z-1000 – OtherRevenue Reserves
119
Z-2000 – Costs forFinished Goods
100 Z2 – Goods GrantedFree of Charge
19
You set up the account determination group Z-2000 and the tax code Z2 as described below in the Business
Configuration section.
You also need to enter the retirement from the inventory. To do this, go to the Internal Logistics work center and choose
Common Tasks Consumption for Cost Center .
Posting the Retirement of Goods
Debit Credit
Costs for Finished Goods (Account Type: COSEXP)
Finished Goods (Account Type: INV)
Since the postings of the manual tax entry and the retirement of goods use the same expense account, the system
generates the following postings for each balance:
Debit Credit
Other Revenue Reserves (Account Type: EQUITY)
Finished Goods (Account Type: INV)
Value-Added Tax (Account Type: TAX)
Business Configuration
In the Business Configuration in the activity Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting Structures, Account
Determination, you find the charts of accounts and account determination groups predefined by SAP, together with the
assigned accounts. The rules for automatic postings are defined for each account determination group. For more
information on the general process for account determination, see Automatic Account Determination and Process Flow:
Business Configuration of Account Determination for a Business Transaction. The following sections only relate to
business transaction-specific processes and settings.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 329
Charts of Accounts and Accounts
You can enter additional accounts in the activity Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting Structures, Account
Determination under Maintain Chart of Accounts. Create the new accounts in every chart of accounts used. The required
accounts must belong to the following account types:
For Accounts Account type
For example: Office Supplies, Gifts, Telephone andCommunications
COSEXP – Costs/Expenses
For example, Finished Goods and Merchandise, Stock of RawMaterials, Unfinished Goods
INV – Warehouse Inventory
For example: Subscribed Capital, Other Revenue Reserves EQUITY – Equity
Account Determination Groups
To be able to post goods and services granted free of charge, you need to set up additional account determination
groups that can be used for manual tax entries.
Create a new account determination group for equity accounts (account type: EQUITY). In the fine-tuning settings
choose under Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting Structures, Account Determination Maintain Account
Determination Groups and then under Subledgers General Ledger Group for Other Payables Add Row .
Specify a group number (such as Z–1000) and a name for the new account determination group (Other Revenue
Reserves, for example). Then set the Used in Other Postings indicator.
Account Determination
For the Costs and Inventories subledgers relevant for posting as well as for the general ledger, check the settings
for the following group types and their assigned groups:
General Ledger / Subledger Group Type
General Ledger Groups for Other Payables
Costs subledger Groups for General Expenses
Inventories subledger Groups for Materials
Set up account determination for the account determination group Z-1000 – Other Revenue Reserves. To do
this, in the fine-tuning settings, choose Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting Structures, Account
Determination Account Determination General Ledger . Switch to the Other tab, under Subledgers select the filter
value General Ledger and then the filter value for the group type 4 — Other Payables. Enter the following data:
● Account Determination Group: Z-1000 – Other Revenue Reserves
● Account: 085500 – Other Revenue Reserves
Note:Note that the account determination groups can apply to different charts of accounts.
Tax Codes and Tax Determination
Tax codes represent a tax use case and are used automatically by the system to calculate tax amounts. For more
information, see Tax Codes and Tax Events [315] and Tax Determination [342].
To define tax codes for goods and services granted free of charge, use the following tax events:
330 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● 311 - Goods delivered free of charge §3 Ib
● 350 - Services provided free of charge §3 IXa
In this way, these transactions will also be displayed automatically in the correct field of the annual VAT report.
7.1.4.3 Postings for Down Payments (Gross Method)
Down Payments Made
You enter down payment requests for down payments made in the Supplier Invoicing work center (supplier invoices).
If a down payment is based on a purchase order defined in the Purchase Requests and Orders work center, you need
to enter a down payment request with a purchase order reference (while quoting the relevant purchase order number).
If you enter an invoice at a later point in time, the system uses the purchase order number to identify automatically the
referenced down payment. For more information, see Editing Down Payment Requests for Supplier Invoices.
For the creation of the final invoice, the system proposes for clearing all existing down payments made to the supplier
on the Down Payments tab page. Here, you can change the amount of the down payment. You can clear any remaining
amount with a future invoice from the supplier.
For more information on the tax due date, see Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319].
Example of Posting System (Schematized Display)
1. You post the outgoing bank transfer of your down payment for 1000 EUR:
Down Payments Made 1000
Input Tax 190
Credit Bank 1190
2. You enter the final invoice (supplier invoice):
Expense 3000
Input Tax 570
Credit Payables 3570
3. You assign the down payment to the final invoice (clearing):
Payables 1190
Credit Down Payments Made 1000
Credit Input Tax 190
After clearing, a payable of EUR 2380 gross (3570 – 1190) to the supplier remains as well as a tax payable of EUR 380
(570 — 190) to the tax authority (input tax deduction). The system automatically creates a corresponding receivables
item in the tax register [315] and in the tax ledger.
Down Payments Received
For information about entering and editing received down payments, see Down Payments from Customers.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 331
The net method is not supported.
Example of Posting System (Schematized Display)
1. You enter the down payment request of a customer:
For this down payment request, the system automatically creates an open item in the customer account (nocorresponding posting is made in the general ledger). For more information, see Customer Account Monitor [133] and
Open Items Receivables [132].
2. You post the receipt of a down payment:
Debit Cash Receipt 20
Credit Down Payments Received 16,81
Credit VAT 19% 3,19
3. You enter the final invoice (customer invoice):
Receivables 59,58
Credit Revenue 50,07
Credit VAT 19% 9,51
4. You assign the down payment to the final invoice (clearing):
Down Payments 16,81
Debit VAT 19% 3,19
Credit Receivables 20
Displaying Open Tax Items from Down Payments
You can display open tax items from down payments as follows:
1. In the Tax Management work center, call the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items [399] report.
2. In the selection screen, enter the company and use the tax due date to specify the reporting period.
3. Under Tax Event, select the criteria Incoming Down Payment Invoice and Outgoing Down Payment Invoice and
click OK.
Manual Tax Adjustment
To make a tax adjustment retroactively for a down payment request, switch to the Tax Management work center,
generate a posting under Manual Tax Entries, and enter the appropriate tax code for incoming or outgoing down
payments.
7.1.4.4 Intra-Community Movement
Intra-community movement concerns the intra-enterprise delivery of goods between two countries in the European
Union (see § 6a, German VAT law). Intra-community goods deliveries need to be recorded in EC sales lists and reported
to the German Federal Office for Taxes ( see § 18a, German VAT law).
332 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Internal stock transfers you enter in the Outbound Logistics Control work center. To do this, refer to Intracompany
Stock Transfer Processing.
Manual VAT Entries
For the system to calculate tax for the stock transfer to another EU country, you need to make a manual tax entry in the
Tax Management work center (in addition to performing the internal stock transfer described above). To do this, proceed
as follows:
1. Under Manual Tax Entries, go to the VAT Entries view and click New. Enter the company, country, and currency
data, as well as the posting date. Enter your VAT registration number for the EU country of destination.
2. Enter the following journal entry data in the lower screen area:
Account Debit Credit Tax codes Tax amount
Z — 9999Clearing Account -Manual Postings
100 507 — Intra-CommunityDelivery
0
Z — 9999Clearing Account -Manual Postings
100 5 — Intra-CommunityAcquisition (standardrate)
0
Note: The debit and credit values are used for the stock transfer of valued amounts.
3. To make the posting to the tax accounts and to enter the data in the tax register, choose Post.
See Also
Quick Guide for VAT Entries [365]
Quick Guide for EC Sales Lists [374]
Quick Guide for EC Sales List Runs [393]
7.1.4.5 Taxable Business Transactions Abroad
Tax returns and tax payments resulting from them are only supported for countries that are included in the current scope.
You can still enter tax entries and tax items for other countries.
Prerequisites
● In Business Configuration, in the Chart of Accounts, Reporting Structures, Account Determination task, two tax
clearing accounts (tax payable accounts) were defined of the G/L account type Receivables and OLIAB — Other
Receivables/Payables (for example, with the descriptions Clearing for foreign input tax and Clearing for foreign
VAT / sales tax).
● You have entered the master data of the foreign tax authority in the Tax Management work center.
● If the tax country has a different currency to your company currency, the corresponding values need to be defined
in the General Ledger work center under Common Tasks Edit Exchange Rates .
General Procedure
1. Determine the balance of the tax items for the relevant tax country in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items tax report.
Send the relevant tax data to the foreign tax authority outside of the system.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 333
2. Enter a manual tax entry and repost the tax receivable or tax payable to the respective tax clearing account.
3. Enter the bank statement with the incoming or outgoing tax payment. Then perform a payment allocation manually.
To do this, report the tax payment to the tax clearing account.
4. The balances in the tax clearing account and in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report are now cleared. The
individual tax items, however, are still displayed in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
Note: The system automatically posts a foreign currency difference resulting from exchange rate changes as profit
or loss.
Example Scenario "Tax Payable to Tax Authority in Italy"
A supplier invoice was entered with a foreign tax code. The foreign input tax is refunded by the relevant tax authority
during input tax refund processing.
The account descriptions used in the example can differ from the descriptions in the system.
1. At the end of the reporting period, you determine the balance of the tax items for the tax country Italy. To do this,
switch to the Tax Management work center, open the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report and select Italy as the
tax country. In this example, we assume that the report for the selected reporting period displays a tax payable of
EUR 200 to the Italian tax authority.
2. To repost the tax payable from the Foreign Input Tax account to the tax clearing account, enter the following
entry in the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax Entries:
Account Debit Credit Tax Code
Tax Clearing Account EUR 1,000 2 - Domestic Purchase 20 %
Tax Clearing Account EUR 1,200
The line item in the journal entry is tax clearing account to foreign input tax EUR 200.
For more information, see Quick Guide for VAT / Sales Tax Entries [365].
3. Once the Italian tax authority has refunded the input tax amount, it is displayed in the bank statement of your bank.
Enter the bank statement in the Liquidity Management work center with the incoming tax payment. The line item
in the journal entry is bank to bank clearing account EUR 200.
Switch to the Payment Management work center and perform a manual payment allocation for the corresponding
item in the bank statement. To do this, choose the Other Allocation tab and enter the tax clearing account as the
G/L account. The line item in the journal entry is bank clearing account to tax clearing account EUR
200.
For more information, see Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382].
4. The balance of the tax clearing account is now cleared. The Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report also has a zero
balance. The individual tax items were not cleared and are still displayed in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report
(but not in the Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items report).
7.1.4.6 Calculation of tax abroad for B2C sales
Overview
Tax on goods and services such as VAT or US sales tax occur in customer or supplier invoicing and activities like sales
order, purchase order, service order, project billing, and expense and reimbursement management. Tax Abroad is
applicable in a scenario where a company needs to apply foreign taxes. In case of selling goods, the company must be
registered with the tax authority of the customer's country in order to apply and declare tax abroad. In case of purchasing
334 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
it is possible to receive an invoice with foreign tax even if the company is not registered with the foreign tax authority.
The system automatically determines the applicable tax in transactions like customer invoice and supplier invoice.
B2C sales scenario for tax abroad occurs when a company of one European Union country sells to a private account
in a different country, where the company is registered for VAT. Goods should be delivered regularly to private persons
abroad where turnover in previous year is higher than a defined threshold.
A is a company that delivers goods to a private person B in a European Union country. The legal compliance means
that A must register with the tax authority of the customers country. Company A sends invoice in the customers invoice
format and with the VAT registration number of A. A needs to declare invoice to the customers tax authority. A needs
to declare the tax base amount as non-taxable to the tax authority in home country.
Prerequisites
The obligations to apply foreign taxes requires the company to register with the tax authority of the foreign country. In
fine tuning you should verify if the tax abroad settings are done for tax calculations (Tax on goods and services, Tax
settings for purchasing). The user should check for currency conversion types and exchange rates. You should make
sure that the tax classification, product classifications are properly maintained in material or service master data.
Process Flow
The process flow associated with tax abroad in B2C sales processes using the system is outlined below. During this
process, you can access the Tax Management and the Account Management work center to execute a sell from stock
scenario.
1. After the registration with the tax authority in the foreign country is obtained, you can open the Tax Management
work center and creates or edits the tax authority for the foreign European Union country where the customer is
located. Within European Union, companies from other European Union countries are required to register, if they
have exceeded a certain threshold of sales to private accounts in the past year. The threshold value varies from
country to country and is in the range of 35.000 to 100.000 EUR. The system saves the tax authority data.
2. You can create a company tax arrangement and enter the VAT registration number that is received from the tax
authority. The system saves the company tax arrangement.
Once you have created the company tax arrangement and specified the tax number, all subsequent
processes with private accounts in that country will be taxable in that country as domestic sales. Without
the registration, such sales scenarios would be taxable as domestic sales in the country of the company
that is known as distance selling.
3. You can open the Account Management work center to create a private account in the foreign European Union
country, where the company is registered.
From the tax abroad perspective, for an account to be a private account it is important that the country
is maintained in the address data of the account and that the account has no VAT registration number
in the country.
4. You can run any sales process, such as sell from stock with the private account in the country where the company
is registered.
5. In all the sales documents like sales order, customer invoice document, service order, down payment request and
so on the user needs to enter the ship-to party and also check the country specified in the address.
6. When you click the Taxes tab the tax code and the tax country should be automatically filled in by the system. This
helps in carrying out the tax calculations for the services.
7. You can verify whether a tax abroad scenario has occurred, by navigating to the Taxes sub-tab. There, the taxable
country should be the country where the account is located. Other possibilities are:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 335
● If the system has specified a different tax country, such as the country where the company is located, you can
overwrite the tax country using the value help and assign a tax code for the changed tax country.
● If the value help does not offer the desired tax country for the customer, it is an indication that a company tax
arrangement does not exist for that country. You can check in the Tax Management work center.
● If a tax arrangement exists, but the desired country key is not offered, it may be that the tax configuration does
not exist for the respective country. You can verify this in fine-tuning. If the country is not available in fine-
tuning, this country is not supported by the system. In this case, it is not possible to use the tax abroad scenario
with that country.
● If you select the desired foreign country as tax country , but it is not proposed by the system for the sales, the
reasons may be: ○ If the company is not located in an European Union country, sales to private persons are usually exports
from the departure country and not subject to tax abroad.
○ The customer account is not a private account.
○ The account is a private account, but not located in the European Union.
7.1.4.7 Calculation of tax abroad for services
Overview
Tax on goods and services such as VAT or US sales tax occurs in customer or supplier invoicing and activities like sales
order, service order, project billing, and expense and reimbursement management. Tax abroad is applicable in a
scenario where a company needs to apply foreign taxes. In the case of selling services, the company in principle must
be registered with the tax authority of the customer’s country in order to apply and declare tax abroad. For purchasing,
it is possible to receive an invoice with foreign tax even if the company is not registered with the foreign tax authority.
The system automatically determines the applicable tax in transactions like customer invoice and supplier invoice.
Services scenarios for Tax abroad occurs especially for specific types of services related to immovable property or
transportation services.
A company constructs a building for a customer B in a European Union country. The building is located in a foreign
country. The customer is not a taxable person. The legal compliance means, that the service provider company in
principle must register with the tax authority of the country where the service is provided. The company sends the invoice
with the VAT registration number from the service rendered country. The company declares the invoice amount to the
tax authority in the service rendered country applying the local legislation for invoicing. The company declares the tax
base amount as non-taxable to the tax authority in the company’s home country.
Prerequisites
Within the European Union, companies are in principle required to register with the tax authority of the foreign European
Union country under special circumstances. In fine tuning, you should verify that the tax abroad settings are done for
tax calculations (Tax on goods and services, Tax settings for purchasing). You should also check for currency conversion
types and exchange rates. You should ensure that the tax classification and product classifications are properly
maintained in material or service master data. The number ranges must be assigned for the combination of selling
company and tax country.
The currency conversion rates are officially provided by the tax authorities in several countries. Using other
exchange rates may only be allowed with the permission of tax authorities.
336 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Process Flow
The process flow associated with tax abroad for services using the system is outlined below:
1. After the registration with the tax authority in the foreign country is obtained, open the Tax Management work center
and create or edit the tax authority for the foreign country where the customer is located. The system saves the tax
authority data.
2. You have to create a company tax arrangement and enter the VAT registration number that is received from the
tax authority. The system saves the company tax arrangement.
Once you have created the company tax arrangement and specified the tax number, all subsequent sales
processes with private accounts in that country will be taxable in that country as domestic sales. Without
the registration, such sales scenarios would be taxable as domestic sales in the country of the company.
3. You can create a new service or edit an existing service by going to the Product Data work center and the
Services view. The system checks in purchasing and sales scenario where these services are taxable. Service can
be taxable at: ● Destination: In this case, you have to add a row for each country that is a part of transaction and select the
Taxable At Destination checkbox.
● Supplier/Customer: In this case, the service is taxable in country where the supplier is registered. You have
to add a row for each country that is a part of the transaction and deselect the Taxable At Destination checkbox.
● Service subject to reverse charge: In this case Services are subject to reverse charge and the buyer owes the
tax in the country where the tax is due. This is shown by Tax Exemption Reason.
● Service subject to reverse charge and taxable at destination: In this case, services are subject to reverse
charge and also taxable at the destination. The user has to add the Tax Exemption Reason and also select
Taxable At Destination checkbox for all countries in the transaction.
You need to make entries in either the Sales view or the Purchasing view. The system then copies this
data to the other view.
4. The entries to be made in the Sales view or the Purchase view are as follows: ● Sales: In all the sales documents like sales order, customer invoice document, service order, down payment
request and so on, you need to enter the ship-to party and also check the country specified in the address.
● Purchases: In all purchase documents like purchase order or supplier invoice, service order, down payment
request, the system verifies the country of the supplier by comparing the master data with the invoice data.
5. When you click the Taxes tab, the system displays the tax code and the tax country. This helps in carrying out tax
calculations for the services.
6. You can verify whether a tax abroad scenario has occurred by navigating to the Tax sub-tab. The tax country is
the country displayed when you select the ship - to party on the sales or the country of the supplier for purchasing.
Other possibilities are: ● If the system has specified a different tax country, such as the country where the company is located, you can
overwrite the tax country using the value help and assign a tax code for the changed tax Country.
● If the value help does not offer the desired tax country for the customer, it is an indication that a company tax
arrangement does not exist for that country. You can check this in the Tax Management work center.
● If a tax arrangement exists, but the desired country key is not offered, it may be that the tax configuration does
not exist for the respective country. You can verify this in the fine-tuning. If the country is not available in fine-
tuning, this country is not supported by the system. In this case, it is not possible to use the tax abroad scenario
with that country.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 337
● If you can select the desired foreign country as tax country, but it was not proposed by the system for the sales
or purchase documents, the reasons may be: ○ That the company is not located in an European Union country. In this case, sales to private persons are
usually considered as exports from the departure country and hence, not subject to tax abroad.
○ The customer account is not a private account. In this case the reverse charge is applicable
○ The account is a private account, but not located in the European Union.
7.1.4.8 Different Tax Rates in Invoices
Overview
For invoices that have goods and services with different tax rates, it is necessary to assign a correct tax rate to each
item, and to display the totals for each tax rate in the invoice (§14 UStG Absatz 4 Nr. 7 und § 32 USt-
Durchführungsverordnung), so that you can issue an invoice that entitles your customer to claim tax deduction.
In order that a tax rate can be assigned to a particular invoice item, we recommend the following procedure for release
FP1.2:
In the master data, add the correct tax rate to the product description, using brackets; for example, the reduced tax rate
of 7% for printed media or food (see Appendix 2 of the value-added tax (VAT) law), or the standard tax rate for all
products that are not covered by § 12 Abs. 2 UStG. If a tax rate is specified in the product description, it is easy and
clear to see in the invoice at which tax rate each invoice item has been taxed. The tax amount is displayed in the invoice
for each tax rate. The product or service master data is located in the Product and Service Portfolio work center, in the
Products or Services view.
● Instruction Manual for Installing Heaters (7%)
● Heater (19%)
● Note that there can be deviations if parts of the service represent non-independent ancillary services. In
this case, the taxation method used is based on the principal service, and the tax rate of the ancillary
service must be adjusted.
● Change of Tax RateIf a tax rate law is changed, you must also change the tax master data for your products and the product
descriptions. Enter a new product with the new tax rate, and start using it on the effective date when the
tax rate is valid.
You can use products with old tax rates for transactions such as cancellations or returns.
● The product description and the tax exemption notice must be maintained in the language of the debtor,
so that both texts appear on the invoice. If these are not maintained, the product description and the tax
exemption notice will not appear on the invoice.
Prerequisites
● You specify the print settings for taxes in the Business Configuration work center, Activity List view, Fine-Tune
phase, Configure Price Strategy step. Select the following value for the Tax pricing element (step 90) in the Total
Print column: Only if <> 0.
The remuneration accrued for each tax rate is then printed at the end of the invoice. Tax amounts with the value 0
are not printed.
338 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● If there is a tax exemption according to §4 UStG or deliveries and services, you specify this in the product master
data. Choose a service or a product in the Product and Service Portfolio work center, Products or Services view;
then choose Edit > View All, and navigate on the Sales tab to the Taxes tab. Enter the tax exemption here as
described below: ○ Country: DE
○ Tax Type: MWST
○ Tax rate: Null
○ Tax exemption reason: Steuerbefreit gem. § 4 UStG, 8–28 or Steuerbefreit gem. § 4 UStG,
2-7
If a tax exemption according to §4 Nr. 8-28 UStG is applicable, the relevant tax exemption reason such
as Steuerfreie Vermietung (tax exempt rent) must be specified in the Notes field of the invoice. In
certain cases, a notice of transfer of tax debt must also specified in the Notes field of the invoice
forReverse Charge Mechanism [355].
7.1.4.9 Discounts: Cash Discounts and Bonuses
Overview
Cash Discount
Cash discounts are deductions on the invoice amount when the invoice is paid within a certain cash discount period.
The amount eligible for cash discount can differ from the invoice amount because cash discount is only valid for the
material costs; services are not eligible for cash discount
You will find further information under Cash Discounts for Supplier Invoices in Financials [78] and Cash Discounts for
Customer Invoices in Financials [142].
Fixed Assets
Only the acquisition and production costs plus incidental costs are costs that must be capitalized in the fixed assets. If
you draw on a cash discount you should reduce the amount of the fixed asset accordingly.
Payment Terms for Cash Discounts
Payment terms for cash discounts specify the cash discount percentage, the discount availability period and the final
payment date. You can specify multiple cash discount terms. For example, a supplier can offer a discount of 3% for
payment within 10 days and 2% for payment within 20 days. Beyond 20 days the discount expires, and the whole amount
is payable within 30 days.
In the United Kingdom, payment terms with multiple cash discount terms are not used. If more than one set
of discount terms is defined, the system uses the first set of terms for processing the discounts. For example,
if the payment terms stipulate that a 3% discount is offered for payment within 10 days and a 2% discount for
payment within 20 days, the system applies the terms that stipulate a 3% discount for payment made within
10 days.
Bonuses
Bonuses are handled as credit memo for example at the end of the year as volume credit memo and treated like cash
discounts with respect to the tax law.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 339
Gross or Net Procedure
There is the possibility to reduce the invoice amount by taking the gross or the net amount:
● If cash discount is taken from the gross amount also the tax amount has to be corrected when the cash discount
is taken.
● If cash discount is taken from the net amount, the tax amount is not discounted, therefore there is no correction of
the tax amount required.
In the United Kingdom, the cash discount is taken from the net amount. However, the tax amount is
calculated for the discounted net amount. For payments made within the cash discount period, the
payment due is the discounted net invoice amount plus the discounted tax. For payments made after the
cash discount period, the payment due is the full net invoice amount plus the discounted tax. Therefore
it is not necessary to correct the reporting of the value-added tax in the United Kingdom because the
same discounted tax is applied before and after the discount period.
In the following examples we assume that the tax base amount is gross.
● Gross Procedure
Net invoice amount EUR 1,000.00 plus value-added tax EUR 190.00 is EUR 1,190.00: Cash discount of 3% here
is EUR 35.70. The discounted amount payable is EUR 1154.30. The tax declared at the time of the invoice is EUR
190. If at payment time the cash discount is taken, then the tax amount is adjusted by EUR 5,70. This results in a
tax amount to be declared of EUR 184,30.
● Net Procedure
Net invoice amount EUR 1,000.00 plus value-added tax EUR 190.00 is EUR 1,190.00: Cash discount of 3% here
is EUR 30.00. The discounted amount payable is EUR 1160.00. Therefore the tax declared during or after the cash
discount period is EUR 190.00. The tax amount is not adjusted.
In the United Kingdom, cash discount is applied to the net amount. Therefore a cash discount of 3% on
GBP 1000 is GBP 30, which equals GBP 970. The tax is always applied to the discounted net invoice
amount therefore 17.5% tax on 970 GBP is GBP 169.75. Therefore the amount payable during the cash
discount period is GBP 1139.75. After the cash discount period the discounted net invoice amount returns
to the full amount, GBP 1000, but the tax remains at GBP 169.75. Therefore the gross amount payable
is GBP 1169.75.
Prerequisites
Create your deduction reasons for cash discounts in the work center Business Configuration. In the Activity List view,
choose Fine Tuning in the Activities Deduction Categories - [Country] under Deduction Categories for [Country] > Cash
Discount. You will find the activities for all countries for which you did your scoping.
Assign the deduction category Cash Discount to tax type Value Added Tax (VAT) in the work center Business
Configuration. In the Activity List view, choose Fine Tuning in the Activity Tax Adjustments for Deductions. In this way,
you define for each tax country how the VAT is corrected if a cash discount is posted.
With the deduction category the system determines:
● Whether for this country a backdated tax calculation should be processed or not
● The account for cash discounts on costs and revenues using the account determination. The determined accounts
are specified in the account determination and can be changed if necessary.
340 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
7.1.4.10 Exchange Rate Differences in Journal Entries
If you enter and post business transactions with foreign currencies, the conversion date defined in the system and the
predefined conversion type are used for the automatic currency conversion of the individual line items of a journal entry
into company currency.
The system uses different rules and settings to determine the conversion date and type for tax line items and other line
items. The differences are displayed in the following table:
All line items without tax line items Tax line items
ConversionDate
The posting date is used as the conversion date for all sets of booksand companies by default.
The conversion dates are defined in the activity Fine-
Tuning Currency Conversion Profiles .The assignment of a currency conversion profile to the set of books
and company is specified in the fine-tuning activity Integrate and
Extend Set of Books .
The tax date of the business transactionis used as the conversion date by default.You cannot change the configurationoptions.
ConversionType(value for bidrate, middleexchangerate, or askrate)
The conversion type Middle Exchange Rate is used for all sets ofbooks and companies.
The conversion types are defined in the activity Fine-
Tuning Currency Conversion Profiles .The assignment of a currency conversion profile to the set of books
and company is specified in the fine-tuning activity Integrate and
Extend Set of Books .
The conversion type Middle ExchangeRate is used for all tax countries.The conversion type is defined for eachtax country and entered in the activity
Fine-Tuning Tax on Goods and
Services Define Currency
Conversions .
For almost all business transactions and postings, the tax date and posting date match. With the standard
settings mentioned above, no exchange rate differences are displayed in the journal entries. Therefore, we
recommend that you do not change the standard settings to avoid unwanted exchange differences in the
accounting documents.
Special Features:
● The most recent tax date of all invoice items is used for currency conversion of the invoice amounts in customer
and supplier invoices.
● You can change the tax date for each invoice item manually for customer invoices.
● For supplier invoices, the following order sequence is used to determine the tax date: ○ If the invoice document is assigned to a posted goods receipt, the system uses the invoice date (and not the
goods receipt date) as the tax date.
○ If the invoice document is assigned to a posted goods receipt confirmation, the system uses the goods receipt
date (delivery date) as the tax date.
○ If there is neither a goods receipt confirmation nor a goods receipt, the system uses the invoice date as the tax
date.
○ If you change the posting date in the invoice document, the changed posting date is also used as the tax date.
● You can enter exchange rates manually for supplier invoices. However, these only have an effect on the conversion
of the tax items and can therefore cause exchange rate differences.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 341
● For a goods return, the system uses the invoice date of the related invoice document as the tax date. If no invoice
document can be assigned to the goods return but a purchase order is assigned, the system uses the order date.
Example - Supplier Invoice with Different Conversion Date
You enter and post a supplier invoice in foreign currency that is referenced to a previous goods receipt.
Goods Receipt Date Invoice Date Posting Date Conversion Date forGross and Net Amount
Conversion Date for TaxItems
01.06. 03.06. N/A 03.06. 01.06.
The system uses the invoice date which corresponds to the posting date by default, as the conversion date for posting
the gross and net amount. The system uses the goods receipt date of the delivery as the conversion date for posting
the tax item. If different exchange rates are defined on June 1 and June 3, an exchange rate difference is portrayed in
the accounting document for the supplier invoice.
See Also
Currency Conversion Profile
7.1.5 Tax Determination
7.1.5.1 Tax Determination
7.1.5.1.1 Tax Determination
Overview
Business ByDesign provides a tax event and uses the resulting figures to generate tax reports. This
automatically-created report does not replace the customer or user’s own tax appraisal. SAP does not assume
liability for the accuracy of the automatically-created report or the tax report that is generated.
As a rule, companies are legally required to calculate taxes on products that they buy or sell or services used, and to
levy these taxes on their customers. After the products or services have been provided, the taxes must be declared and
paid to the relevant tax authorities.
The taxes are calculated for business documents such as orders, invoices, credit memos or down payments.
Since taxation laws differ in each country, your company is faced with the challenge of calculating the correct tax for a
particular business transaction. The system supports you by automatically calculating the tax for the following tax types:
● Value-Added Tax (VAT)
This tax is levied in many countries, especially countries in the European Union. Many regional differences exist.
For example, in some countries such as Canada and Australia, value-added tax is levied as "Goods and Services
Tax".
● Sales and Use Tax
This tax is levied, for example, in the United States, and in a similar form in Canada (Provincial Sales Tax).
● Withholding Tax
342 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
This tax is levied in different forms in different countries. The system is able to calculate withholding tax for the
United States.
The system also offers a reporting tool that gives you effective control over your mandatory declaration of these taxes.
Prerequisites
● You have created the Master Data for Tax Determination [347].
● Defining the Solution Scope for TaxationThe following activities are necessary to define the solution scope for taxation: ○ The solution scope for taxation is specified in the system in Business Configuration under Built-In Services and
Support. The Tax Calculation business topic is located in the Business Environment business package.
○ If you are also required to have taxes calculated in your quotes, activate the relevant option in Scoping. In the
Questions step, navigate to the Sales business area, and choose New Business > Quotes with Tax
Calculation.
Elements
The system collects the relevant data from the available business documents to correctly calculate the taxes applicable.
As the user, you have to configure your system with the information that is required for your business cases. A lot of
standard business cases are pre-configured by SAP, but in some cases you have to enhance your system.
For more detailed information about tax determination and how the system merges and classifies data, see Elements
for Tax Determination [349].
Tax Number Determination
In the following cases the tax number is determined again:
● Tax date has been changed
● Buyer, seller or tax reporting group has been changed
● Tax number is wrong
● Tax country has been changed
Value-Added Tax (VAT) Numbers
For Export Deliveries
To obtain tax exemption for intra-community deliveries, you need to record, among other things, the service recipient’s
VAT number to be used for the receipt of goods.
If several VAT numbers are assigned to a customer master record, the system selects the VAT number according to
the following criteria:
● The VAT number of the country in which the ship-to party is located.
● If the VAT number of the ship-to country is not entered in the master data, the system searches for other numbers
entered in the master data and selects a number that is different from the number of the country from which the
goods are sent.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 343
● If there is only one VAT number for the country where the transport of goods starts, or if there is no number at all,
the prerequisites for an intra-community delivery have not been fulfilled, and the delivery must be taxed at the
relevant tax rate.
If a VAT number is entered in the master data, it will be displayed automatically on the invoice. You can
overwrite it on the Taxes tab in the document. However, you can only overwrite using those numbers that
have been previously entered in the account master record.
For Other Services, Performed Abroad
According to the EU directive 2008/8/EG and country-specific tax legislation, there is new regulation particularly for B2B
commissions. that relates to the place in which services are performed.
Generally the place in which services are provided serves as the service recipient’ address. If the service is provided at
a branch abroad, then the address of the branch abroad is valid. § 3a (2) UStG in Germany can be consulted as an
example.
In order to distinguish between companies and individuals as the service recipient, the system (tax decision tree) checks
whether a VAT number has been entered in the account master data. If the VAT number is missing, the business case
is regarded as a service that was performed for an individual.
Therefore it is important to remember to enter the VAT number when you enter the account master data.
Reverse Charge Mechanism
Reverse charge mechanism means that, in certain cases, the customer is required by law to be liable for VAT, and to
pay it to the relevant tax authority. In this case, the entrepreneur issues an invoice without VAT, but with a notification
indicating that the tax debt is being transferred to the customer. The customer must calculate and pay the VAT to the
tax authority, and can claim input tax deduction at the same time as usual. The transfer of tax debt to the service recipient
is called reverse charge mechanism.
For more information, see Tax Determination with Reverse Charge Mechanism [355].
Third-Party Order Processing Taxation
In typical sales scenarios, transactions take place directly between a company and an account, both business partners
are located in the same country, and the company produces and delivers a good or service directly to the account. In
such scenarios, there is no need for special tax regulations. However, in the event that one or more parameters of this
business scenario differ from the typical situation and, for example, account address and ship-to addresses are not the
same, special regulations apply, depending on how complex the scenarios are.
For more information, see Third-Party Order Processing and Chain Transaction Taxation [358].
Relevant Date for the VAT Tax Return
The date used for the VAT tax return depends on the business document. For example, in the supplier invoice the
Receipt Date is used, and in the customer invoice the Invoice Date is used. But if you want you can also enter a Changed
Tax Due Date.
For more information on the tax due date, see Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319].
344 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Entering or Changing Tax Codes in Journal Entry Vouchers
You can enter or change tax codes in journal entry vouchers as follows:
● Sales OrdersGo to the Sales Orders work center and choose New Sales Order or an existing sales order for editing. Choose
View All. Go to the Items tab page and from there to the Taxes tab page. Choose an appropriate entry for the order
item selected under Tax Code.
● Invoices or Credit MemosGo to the Customer Invoicing work center and choose New Manual Invoice or an existing invoice or credit memo
for editing. Go to the Items tab page and from there to the Taxes tab page. Choose an appropriate entry for the
invoice item selected under Tax Code.
● Purchase OrderGo to the Purchase Requests and Orders work center and choose New Purchase Order or an existing purchase
order for editing. Choose View All Items . In the Basic Data tab page, select under Taxes the appropriate
tax code for the selected purchase order item.
● Supplier InvoiceGo to the Supplier Invoice work center and choose New Invoice Without Purchase Order or an existing invoice for
editing. In the Overview tab page, select the appropriate tax code for the selected invoice item.
Tax Decision Tree
The system uses a tax decision tree to correctly determine a tax event. The tax decision tree consists of a sequence of
logically connected questions that the system determines as being true or false by comparing them with data entered
in the documents. In this way, the facts are narrowed down until the tax event and the correct taxation method has been
determined.
The questions are answered by comparing data entered in the document, and the underlying process can be represented
as a process flow. The questions in the following example are used to determine the tax event “Export to Third Country”
for a company based in Germany.
A tax decision tree is assigned to each country.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 345
Process Flow
The process flow for tax determination describes a sample of how the tax event is determined for an invoice:
1. The sales representative creates and saves a manual invoice.
2. After the required data is entered, the system transfers tax-relevant data to tax determination, such as: ● Location of supplier and buyer
● Tax attributes of the business partner
One of these attributes is the tax exemption reason that depends on certain country-specific laws.
● Tax attributes of products
Tax rate type and tax exemption reason can be different for each country, region, and tax type. In the United
States, for example, services are not normally subject to tax, so the tax exemption reason should be assigned
in the product master data. Products are normally taxed at the standard tax rate and no other entries are
required.
3. The system uses the tax-relevant data to activate tax determination, and the data is processed automatically in a
tax decision tree.
4. The system calculates tax on the basis of the following components: ● Tax event
● Tax types
● Tax rate types such as standard value-added tax rate
● Tax rate as a percentage
● Taxable amount
5. The system includes the result of the tax determination and calculation in the sales order. The calculated tax is
displayed on the Pricing tab and on the Taxes tab of the Items tab.
All tax details determined by the system are displayed on the Tax tab. Examples are: ● Tax country
● Tax code
● Tax jurisdiction code in case the tax country is United States
346 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Tax region in case the tax country is Canada
● Tax date
● A table with one row for each tax type that lists the following: ○ Tax base
○ Tax rate type
○ Tax rate
○ Tax exemption reason, if necessary
○ Tax amount
○ Deductibility type (only for purchasing documents)
○ Country-specific parameters (if necessary), such as indicators for deferred tax (in France or India), tax
jurisdiction code (United States), or region (Canada).
However, not all tax-relevant transactions can be recognized automatically and correctly by the system.
Therefore, we recommend that you overwrite the data manually in the document, in case the system
does not determine the correct tax country or the correct tax code for the transaction. If you have to
change the tax country in the document manually, the input help displays only the countries for which a
tax authority is created and tax arrangements are maintained for your company. However, you can also
enter another tax country in which sales need to be reported for tax purposes. The system then displays
the specific tax codes for this country. Remember that you need to create the tax authority for this country.
You then need to trigger tax determination again in the document so that the correct tax number of your
company is found for the transaction. For countries that have multiple tax rates, you can enter the tax
criteria manually.
Note that if tax-relevant data such as the country of the service location or of the goods recipient has
been changed in a follow-up document of a business transaction, the Tax Country and Tax Code is not
redetermined. This affects, for example, changes in the address data in a service confirmation that is
created for a service order, or in a project invoice that is created for a sales order.
See Also
Party Processing
Tax Determination — US [361] (This document covers topics specific for the United States, such as delivery taxation
in Texas and California, Nexus.)
7.1.5.1.2 Tax Determination Details
7.1.5.1.2.1 Master Data for Tax Determination
To ensure that the determination within your sales processes is running properly, you have created the following master
data:
Tax Authority
In the Tax Management work center, you have created a master data record for each tax authority that is responsible
for your company.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 347
Company Tax Arrangements
You have assigned a company tax arrangement in the master data record for the tax authority. You enter your tax
number for the tax type to confirm that your company is registered and that you have declared tax to the relevant tax
authority.
Tax Exemption Certificate in Account Master Data
In countries such as the United States, France, and Italy, accounts such as non-profit organizations can be exempt from
tax payments for a certain period of time. For these accounts, you define the appropriate exemption certificate number
and the validity date in the account master data. These entries are required for payment transactions. If the exemption
is valid on the day of payment, no tax is posted. The exemption certificate number is automatically entered in the payment
document. A reason for tax exemption can be entered in the account master data.
Tax Jurisdiction Code in Account Master Data for the United States
You have created a tax jurisdiction in the account master data.
Company
Company data, such as the company, address, and the tax jurisdiction code is entered in organizational management.
Products
If you do not enter any other information in a product master record, the product is taxed at a standard tax rate. If you
want to change the standard tax rate for certain countries, you must assign the tax rate type and, if necessary, a tax
exemption reason to the relevant product in the master data.
Services
For services, you must specify which types of services you offer, and how these are to be taxed, or who is liable for tax
for a particular business transaction, so that the system determines the relevant tax codes. Enter your services in the
Services view of the Product and Service Portfolio work center under, and if necessary, assign them to the relevant tax
exemption reason on the Taxes tab, or specify whether the service is taxable at the location where the service is to
be provided:
Specifics for European Union
● Certain services are always taxed at the head office of the company that provides the services, even if these
services are provided for an account located abroad. In the master data records of such services, ensure that
nothing has been entered in the Tax Exemption Reason field on the Taxes tab, and that the Taxable at
Destination indicator has not been set. According to Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation under the Annual
Tax Act 2009 from January 1, 2010 onwards, this is the basic rule for services that are provided for a private end
consumer abroad.
● Certain services must always be taxed at the location where the service is provided, such as construction works
on buildings. For such services, set the Taxable at Destination indicator on the Taxes tab. Here, the system
checks the location of the goods recipient (or the location at which the service is provided). The transaction is not
taxable domestically if the location at which the service is provided is abroad. In such a case, the company providing
348 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
the goods or services must tax the business transaction in the receiving country and also be registered there.
According to Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation under the Annual Tax Act 2009 from January 1, 2010
onwards, this is required, for example, for work on movable tangible property for a private end consumer abroad.
● Other services such as those provided by a company located abroad or specific work deliveries are taxed according
to the reverse charge mechanism. For more information, see Reverse Charge Mechanism [355].
From the seller's perspective, the transaction must be reported, but the tax debt transfers to the account. If this tax
exemption reason is entered in the services master record, the system applies the reverse charge rule for a
corresponding sales transaction. The note referring to the reversal of tax debt (reverse charge mechanism) is
printed on the invoice. The relevant tax exemption reason must be entered for the service on the Taxes tab.
According to Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation under the Annual Tax Act 2009 from January 1, 2010
onwards, this is the basic rule for services that are provided for a company abroad. This basic rule is determined
automatically, if the head office of the company providing the goods or services is in any EU member state. In the
case of domestic accounts, however, the system does not automatically recognize the reverse charge rule. Where
applicable, the user must manually overwrite the tax code in the sales document (§13b (1) No. 2 - 5). For this you
can create your own tax code and legal phrase in business configuration. For more information, see Tax on Goods
and Services — Configuration Guide [359]. The corresponding tax event and tax exemption reason code are
already available in the system.
See Also
Tax on Goods and Services — Configuration Guide [359]
Tax Determination [342]
7.1.5.1.2.2 Elements of Tax Determination
Overview
The following sections provide you with an overview of the tax determination elements and their relations:
Tax Type and Tax Rate Type
Every tax type in a tax event has a tax rate type and a tax rate that is applied to the tax base (in most cases the net
amount) to calculate the tax amount for the relevant tax type.
Tax rates are represented in the system by tax rate types – in the example of Germany, the tax rate of 19% for value-
added tax corresponds to the Standard tax rate type. This makes it easy to represent time-dependencies. If the tax rate
for this tax type changes because of a new law, you can define a new tax rate in the system for a specific validity date
without having to create a new tax code.
Country Specifics
● India and CanadaFor tax jurisdictions such as India and Canada, where more than one tax type exists, the following fields can be
used: Tax Rate Type and Tax Exemption Reason, as well as Deductibility Type for purchasing documents.
● GermanyThe Standard tax rate type is calculated for the Value-Added Tax tax type on the basis of the net amount. This
means that if the tax rate is 19%, a tax amount of EUR 19 is calculated for a net amount of EUR 100.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 349
Tax Rate
Country Specifics
● Canada and United StatesFor Canada, tax rates are preconfigured for each province and territory in Canada, and for each state in the United
States. However, before using the system, you must check whether these tax rates are still valid according to any
recent legislative amendments.
Tax Event
In the tax event, the system determines the method of taxation to be used for the business transaction according to:
● Which tax types are applicable
● Whether the business transaction is taxable or not
● Whether the business transaction is subject to tax or not
● Which tax rate is applicable
For transnational business transactions, the system uses a tax decision tree for both the ship-from country and the ship-
to country to determine the taxation method used in the tax event for each country. The relevant decision trees are
determined by the tax countries entered in the document, in particular by the countries of the supplier and the goods
recipient. Other tax jurisdictions can be the:
● Location of the business residence of the seller who provides a service
● Location of the business residence of the buyer for whom a service is provided
● Location where the service is to be provided
Implications of the tax event for other areas:
● To calculate tax, the tax event takes the following into account: ○ Due tax type
○ Procedure for tax calculation
○ Tax exemption reasons, if required
● To determine tax, the tax event specifies the following: ○ Allocation criteria for the tax reports
○ The field in which the tax is displayed on the tax return:
You can assign tax events to the fields of the tax return form for the relevant country. For more information see,
Tax Returns for Goods and Services.
● In accounting, the tax event controls account determination.
There are, of course, more tax events in the system for other common business transactions. However, you cannot
create your own tax events.
Country Specifics
● GermanyExamples of tax events ○ 10: Domestic Acquisition (§15 I 1 Nr. 1)
○ 100: Intra-Community Acquisition
○ 310: Domestic Supply Of Goods And Services
350 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
○ 400: Intra-Community Supply (§4 Nr. 1b UStG)
In accordance with Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation under the Annual Tax Act 2009, intra-community
service provision must also be declared in VAT tax returns as of January 1, 2010. For this purpose, new fields have
been introduced in the VAT tax return: fields 21, 46, and 47. To use these fields for services provided in a foreign
member state of the European Union, there are two new tax events for Germany and all other EU member valid
as of January 1, 2010. ○ Sale 455 "EU Sale of Services, Reverse Charge"
○ 155 "EU Purchase of Services, Reverse Charge"
Errors may occur, if you use these tax events with an earlier tax date.
Deductibility Type
In addition to the tax rate, the percentage rate at which input tax is deductible plays a part. Depending on the type of
company or the type of outgoing sales volume in which a certain incoming sales volume is incorporated, input tax can
be deducted at a rate of 100%, 0% or a rate determined specifically for the company. For this purpose, you define
deductibility types that represent the percentage rate. The two most frequently used deductibility types are Fully
Deductible (100%) and Not Deductible (0%).
Tax Code
The appropriate method for calculating tax is determined by a combination of tax type, tax event, and tax rate type, and
by the deductibility type for the input tax of the sales volume. You can define tax codes in the system to avoid errors
when these parameters are entered manually.
Each tax code represents a unique combination of the following parameters:
● In sales ○ Tax event
○ Tax types
○ Related tax rate types
● In purchasing ○ Tax event
○ Tax types
○ Related tax rate types
○ Deductibility types
This makes it possible to define all parameters represented by a tax code in the document by selecting a tax code,
without having to enter each parameter individually.
Taxes can be calculated automatically only for those products in the product master. This is why you may sometimes
have to enter the tax code manually, especially in purchasing. Alternatively, you may enter a product category so that
the tax rate type for this category can be used, thus enabling automatic tax calculation.
The system uses one unique tax code for a tax event only for those countries that have one tax type.
Country Specifics
● Canada and IndiaIn both countries several tax types can be taken into consideration for a tax event. India, for example, uses multiple
tax types, and each tax type has multiple tax rate types and deductibility types. The number of possible combinations
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 351
resulting from this makes it impossible to work efficiently with tax codes. In these countries, the tax code
corresponds to the tax event.
● GermanyIn accordance to Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation under the Annual Tax Act 2009, intra-community
service provision must also be declared in VAT tax returns as of January 1, 2010. For this purpose, new fields have
been introduced in the VAT tax return: fields 21, 46, and 47.
To use these fields for services provided in a foreign member state of the European Union, there are two new tax
codes for Germany and all other EU member valid as of January 1, 2010: ○ Purchasing: 430 "EU Purchase of Services, Reverse Charge, standard rate, fully deductible
○ Sale: 530 "EU Sale of Services, Reverse Charge"
○ Exception for Italy: There the tax code for sales is: 540 "EU Sale of Services, Reverse Charge"
Exempted Region
In many countries there are regions and areas that have special status under tax law. For example, Büsingen and
Helgoland are exempt from German value-added tax. In business configuration you can define the regions that are
exempt from national tax regulations, or have a special status. Such regions can correspond to political regions,
communities, or tax-free zones and are derived directly from the postal code.
Tax Jurisdiction Code
Tax jurisdiction levels are taken into account in tax calculation when taxes are in states, counties, and cities, but not on
national levels of government. The different levels in a tax jurisdiction code represent different administrative levels.
Fine-tuning this activity ensures that the system uses all administrative levels to determine the tax rate for each authority.
In some countries, however, other government levels have tax jurisdiction. In these cases, you can adapt them.
Define tax rates after you have maintained jurisdiction code.
Country Specifics
● United StatesIn the United States, taxes are collected not only by states, but also by counties and cities; for domestic sales,
taxation therefore depends on the state, county, and city in which your company and the goods recipient are located.
For this purpose, you can enter a tax jurisdiction code in the master data of the company and the customer.
The tax jurisdiction code represents the location of your company, your customer, or your supplier in a hierarchical
structure, so that one country can have multiple states that, in turn, can have multiple cities and municipalities.
The tax jurisdiction code is structured as follows: ○ 2 alphanumeric characters for the first level; this is the standard state code
○ 6 alphanumeric characters for the second level; for example, the county
○ 6 alphanumeric characters for the third level; for example, the city
○ 1 alphanumeric character for the fourth level, for example, the location or the area
It is not necessary to use all four levels. The number of levels used depends on the state.
This function is currently used only in the United States.
For the United States, tax jurisdiction codes have been preconfigured in the system on U.S. state level. You must
enter further levels as required. If a tax jurisdiction code has not been assigned to a customer, the system uses the
U.S. state in the address as a tax jurisdiction code.
Example
352 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Tax Jurisdiction Code - Description Tax Jurisdiction Code Taxation in %
New York State NY 4%
Albany County NYAL0181 4%
Allegany County NYAL0221 4,5%
In the NYAL0181 tax jurisdiction code, NY stands for New York State, AL0181 stands for Albany County in New
York State. For Albany County, two levels of the tax jurisdiction code are taken into consideration, and 8% (4% +
4%) of tax is levied. For Allegany County, 8.5% (4% + 4.5%) tax is levied.
● CanadaOther countries such as Canada have tax rates that depend on regions. This is because Canada is divided into
provinces and territories. In these cases, use the Region field.
Tax Exemption
Tax exemption is an exemption from all or certain taxes that are levied in a country. In most cases, the basis for tax
exemption is determined by legal requirements. In some cases, these may apply without having to account for them.
To ensure transparency, many legislators require that the reason for tax exemption be specified on relevant documents
such as invoices. Tax exemption reasons are provided in the system, cannot be changed, and are assigned to a tax
type.
A customer's direct payment and exempt organization certificates are applicable until they are revoked.
The tax exemption certificates are determined automatically in a sales document.
You can assign relevant tax exemption reasons to product and customer master data by selecting the relevant entry in
the Tax Exemption Reason fields.
For more information, see Tax Exemption Certificate Processing [354].
Country Specifics
● United StatesFor the United States, several tax exemption certificate types are available: ○ Direct Payment Certificate - continuous
○ Exempt Organization Certificate - continuous
○ Exempt Use Certificate - continuous
○ Exempt Use Certificate - single
○ Resale Certificate - continuous
○ Resale Certificate - single
The state must be added also.
Only the following tax exemption certificate types can be found automatically, since only in these cases is it certain
that the exemption certificates always apply: ○ Direct Payment Certificate – continuous
○ Exempt Organization Certificate – continuous
For all the other certificate types, you need the information from the customer whether the certificate can be used
for the current transaction.
You must then assign the types manually in a sales transaction.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 353
Legal Text Information
Legal text information is a textual explanation of the exemption reasons printed on invoices. These texts explain why
certain transactions are exempt from tax, thus allowing you to meet legal requirements.
The legal text information is printed on a customer invoice, if, for example, a tax exemption is applicable. However, if
the texts are not available in the required language, the system uses the English text for the invoice.
7.1.5.1.2.3 Tax Exemption Certificate Processing
Overview
A tax exemption is an exemption from all or certain taxes of a state or nation in which part of the taxes that would normally
be collected from an individual or an organization are instead foregone.
A tax exemption certificate is a certificate sent by a customer to a company claiming exemption from tax on sales. In
this system, the tax exemption certificate:
● Indicates the period of time during which the tax exemptions can apply
● Indicates if the tax exemptions apply to a single sales transaction or multiple sales transactions
● Indicates if the exempted (cumulated) amount exceeds a maximum amount when the exemptions apply in multiple
sales transactions
This applies to the Tax Exemption Certificates for France only.
● Indicates the reason for tax exemption
In France, a customer can apply to the authorities for exemption from VAT. If the exemption is granted, the customer
receives a letter of confirmation including a license number and the period for which he is exempt from VAT. The
customer sends this letter to a vendor, who must then take the tax exemption into account when invoicing the customer.
The vendor may not include any tax in customer invoices for the validity period of the tax exemption license.
Prerequisites
Your customer has registered with the tax authority for tax exemption and received a tax exemption certificate from
them. This certificate has been assigned to the account.
Process Flow
The following steps explain the typical process flow for the Customer Tax Exemption Certificate in customer invoicing.
1. When you create a sales/service order or customer invoice, the system searches for existing tax exemption
certificates and automatically assigns a valid certificate. You have an option of rejecting the proposal and prevent
the exemption to apply at header/line item level.
You can manually assign an existing certificate and the relevant exemption reason at header/line item level.
You can see a set of elements (fields, links, push button, check box) related to tax exemption certificates
when you create or view a sales/service order or a customer invoice. These elements are only visible if
the seller company is located in the US or France.
354 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
2. You can also create a new certificate if it does not exist and assign it immediately to the sales/invoicing document.
The system allows you to enter the relevant tax exemption information sent by the customer directly in the business
document.
For more information, see, Create Tax Exemption Certificates
3. The certificate records and shows the sum of the amounts which were exempted. The amount exempted by each
certificate during the invoicing process is cumulated on the corresponding certificate.
In France, you can set a maximum tax amount that cannot be exceeded. The system prevents the
cumulated amount to exceed the limit during the invoice creation process if a certificate only allows a
limited amount to be exempted. The cancellation of invoices including certificates reverts the
accumulation performed previously.
In the Account Management work center, under the Reports view, you can monitor in real time the tax exemption
certificates created in the system and sent to the company.
7.1.5.1.2.4 Tax Determination with Reverse Charge Mechanism
Overview
Value-added tax (VAT) is charged revenue from the sale of goods and services. This means that an entrepreneur issues
a customer (as the service recipient) with an invoice that includes VAT, and pays the VAT to the responsible tax authority.
As a result of this, the entrepreneur is the tax payer who is liable for VAT.
In certain cases, however, the customer is required by law to be liable for VAT, and to pay it to the relevant tax authority.
In this case, the entrepreneur issues an invoice without VAT, but with a notification indicating that the tax debt has been
transferred to the customer. The customer must calculate and pay the VAT to the tax authority, and can claim input tax
deduction at the same time as usual. The transfer of tax debt to the service recipient is called Reverse ChargeMechanism and reverses the tax liability.
Automatic Tax Determination with Reverse Charge Mechanism
Country Specifics for Germany
Some services, such as those provided by a company located abroad, or services that are provided for a service recipient
located abroad are taxed according to the reverse charge mechanism. From the perspective of the seller, the transaction
must be reported, but the tax debt transfers to the account. According to Directive 2008/8/EC and its implementation
under the Annual Tax Act 2009 as of January 1, 2010, this is the basic rule for services that are provided for a company
abroad. This basic rule is determined automatically, if the head office of the company providing the goods or services
is in any EU member state. No tax exemption reason code must be entered in the service master.
For Germany, the system currently only covers the transfer of tax debt for other services provided by an entrepreneur
located abroad if these services are provided domestically (§ 13b Abs. 1 Nr. 1 UStG), or if a German company provides
other such services for a service recipient located abroad.
The process flow for tax determination describes the determination of tax event 240 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b
II 1 Nr. 1 UStG, tax event 312 – Export of Service, Reverse Charge, and the anomalies to be taken into account:
1. Create a sales order, a purchase order, or an invoice.
2. While the document is being processed, the system transfers the tax relevant data to tax determination. Examples
of tax relevant data for reverse charge mechanism are: ● Location of supplier and buyer
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 355
○ Sale of a service ○ The seller company must be located in Germany.
The address of the seller is used, and the system normally uses the standard address of your company
unless you have overwritten the address in the sales order on the Involved Parties tab.
○ The service recipient must be located abroad.
The location where the service provision takes place is used and must not be in Germany. If the recipient
is a private individual, the service can only be subject to reverse charge mechanism if it is provided in
the European Union (EU). If items in an invoice contain services that have been provided at different
locations (according to the address of the service or goods recipient on the Involved Parties tab), these
addresses are used first.
○ Purchasing a Service ○ The supplier must be located abroad.
The address of the supplier is used as a basis, and the system uses the standard address.
○ The service recipient must be located in Germany.
The location where the service is provided is decisive. It is also possible that individual invoice items
contain different locations where the services have been provided (according to the address of the goods
recipient). In this case, this is used as a priority.
● Tax attributes of products
Tax rate type and tax exemption reason can be different for each country, region, and tax type. In the United
States, for example, services are not normally subject to tax, so the tax exemption reason should be assigned
in the product master data.
Enter the following settings for reverse charge mechanism in the master data for services on the Sales >
Taxes and Purchasing > Taxes tabs as required: ○ Tax Exemption Reason: Buyer liable for VAT
○ The Taxable at destination checkbox must not be selected.
3. The system processes all tax-relevant data in tax determination.
4. The system calculates tax using the following components: ● Tax event, for example 240 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 1 UStG for purchasing or 312 – Export
of Service, Reverse Charge for sales
● Tax codes
● Tax type
● Tax rate type such as the complete value-added tax rate with which the tax rate is determined as a percentage,
for example 19%
● Taxable amount
5. The system enters the result of the tax determination and the tax calculation in the document currently being
processed. The calculated tax is displayed on the Pricing tab. All tax details determined by the system are displayed
on the Tax Details tab, such as the Tax Country and the Tax Code of the tax country.
If reverse charge is determined for a sales order or a manual invoice, a note is displayed on the printed
invoice that the customer must pay tax.
For more information on the general process of tax determination, see Tax Determination [342].
The system cannot process other reverse charge mechanism scenarios in the automatic tax determination, so these
must be checked manually.
356 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Manual Control for Reverse Charge Mechanism
For some countries there are also other sales or purchasing processes that are subject to reverse charge but cannot
be determined automatically by the system, as for example, in Germany sales according to §13b (5) UStG or purchases
according to §13b (2).
Country Specifics for Germany
● For mobile radio units and integrated circuits with a tax date as of July 1, 2011 and an invoice amount of at least
5000 Euros, reverse charge applies according to § 13b (2) Nr.10 UStG.
In this case you have to change the tax code manually to one of the following: ○ 15 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 10 UStG
○ 515 – Reverse Charge Supply §13b II 1 Nr. 10 UStG
● For these processes, the system provides the tax events 313 – Reverse Charge Supply §13b V UStG and 50 –
Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 4, 6 - 9 UStG, 11 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 2 UStG, 12
– Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 3 UStG, 13 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 5 UStG and 240
– Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr 1 UStG. But you need to create your own tax code in your system.
● If you obtain your sales revenue according to §13b (5) UStG, you must enter the tax code manually.
Tax Events Stored in the System
Country Specifics for Germany
The following tax events are currently stored in the system and can be used to create tax codes for Germany:
● Purchase: ○ 11 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 2 UStG
○ 12 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 3 UStG
○ 13 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 5 UStG
○ 50 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 4, 6 – 9 UStG
○ 240 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr.1 UStG
○ 15 – Reverse Charge Acquisition §13b II 1 Nr. 10 UStG
● Sales: ○ 312 – Export of Service, Reverse Charge
○ 313 – Reverse Charge Supply § 13b V UStG
○ 315 – Reverse Charge Supply §13b II 1 Nr. 10 UStG
The following tax code and tax events combinations are provided by the system and determined automatically:
● Tax code 504 – Not taxable (reverse charge mechanism) is linked to tax event 312 – Export of Service, Reverse
Charge
● Tax code 530 – EU Sales of Service, Reverse Charge is linked to tax event 455 – EU Sale of Service, Reverse
Charge
For purchasing, tax code 430 – EU Purchase of Services, Reverse Charge, Standard Rate, Fully Deductible with tax
event 155 is available.
If you need further tax codes, you can create them under Define Tax Codes of the Tax on Goods and Services activity
in Business Configuration Implementation Projects Activity List Fine-Tune .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 357
When you create a tax code, ensure that you provide the tax type under Details.
7.1.5.1.2.5 Third-Party Order Processing Taxation
Overview
Third-party order processing scenarios involve at least three parties: Seller, account, and supplier.
A Third-Party Order Processing is a sales transaction that is conducted by several parties for one item, where the item
is shipped directly from the supplier to the account or ship-to party.
For more information concerning the general processing in the system, see Third-Party Order Processing.
Chain transaction means consecutive supplies of goods between three or more legal entities, where the contractual
obligations of all parties in the chain are discharged by a single movement of goods from the first supplier in the chain
to the final customer.
From a taxation point of view, the scenarios where the sales transaction crosses borders and the subject to tax has to
be determined, are of interest.
This also has an impact onto the country where the taxes have to be paid. In the following processes, the system supports
the user by displaying warning messages and triggering a check of the tax codes:
● You are a supplier in a chain transaction and you enter a ship-to party that is different from the account. The system
displays the message if the head offices of the ship-to party and your company are in different countries.
● In a third-party deal, you are the company that creates a sales order to which an external supplier is assigned. The
external supplier delivers the goods directly to the customer. These transactions are generally not invoiced
automatically during an invoice run.
Country Specifics in case the seller and supplier are different:
● Germany: These transactions are not invoiced automatically during an invoice run if the head office of your
company is in Germany.
Value-added tax for chain transactions is treated differently, especially if the item is transported across a state border.
It is necessary to decide on a case-by-case basis, which of the companies involved is allowed to issue a tax-exempt
invoice. If the tax has not automatically been calculated correctly in this transaction, or if tax has been calculated even
though the transaction is tax-exempt, change the tax code and, if necessary, the tax country, on the Taxes tab
accordingly.
Intra-Community Triangular Trade
An Intra-Community Triangular Trade is a special kind of third-party order processing, where all three participants are
located in different EU member states. Under certain circumstances, a simplification can be applied to intra-community
triangular trades. The prerequisites for the application of this process are:
● The three companies transact business for the same item.
● All participating companies are registered in different EU member states for value-added tax purposes.
● The item goes straight from the first supplier to the final account.
● The item goes from one EU member state to another.
● The first supplier or the first company is responsible for the transport of the item.
Country Specifics
358 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Germany: If the simplification can be applied to the triangular transaction, then the 512 - Triangular Transaction
tax code can be entered manually in the invoice.
7.1.5.1.2.6 Tax on Goods and Services - Configuration Guide
In this configuration activity, you can create and change parameters required for the tax determination in sales,
purchasing, and service processes such as tax jurisdictions, currency conversions, exempted regions, legal text
information, and tax codes. These parameters are required for the system to determine the tax due for a business
document.
To comply with country specific legal requirements, currency conversion types are required. This includes the exchange
rate type and conversion types that must be used to convert tax amounts from the document currency to the reporting
currency.
To find the Tax on Goods and Services activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the
Implementation Projects view. Select your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune
phase, then select the Tax on Goods and Services activity from the activity list.
Prerequisites
You have completed the Tax Settings for Purchasing activity for purchasing processes.
To find this activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementations Projects view. Select
your implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-Tune phase, then select the Tax Settings for
Purchasing activity from the activity list.
Business Background
Tax Determination
As a rule, companies are legally required to calculate taxes on products that they buy or sell, and to levy these taxes
from their customers. After the products have been provided, the taxes must be declared and levied to the respective
tax authorities. The system supports you by providing a substantially automated tax calculation for the following tax
types: Value-Added Tax (VAT), Sales and Use Tax, Withholding Tax. The system also provides a reporting tool that
gives you effective control over your obligatory declaration of these taxes.
For more information, see Tax Determination [342].
Master Data for Tax Determination
For more information, see Master Data for Tax Determination [347].
Tasks
Define Currency Conversion Type
1. To create a new currency conversion, click Add Row .
2. Select the country for which the exchange rate is valid.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 359
3. Enter the date for the end of the validity period for the exchange rate type and conversion
type.
4. Enter the type of exchange rate used such as Historical Currency Rate or EMU Regulation
Fixed Exchange Rate.
5. If necessary, change the conversion type which is defaulted to Mid Value to either Bid
Value or Ask Value.
6. Save your entries.
Define Exempted Regions
1. To define an exempted region, click Add Row .
2. Select the country of the exempted region.
3. Enter a code for the exempted region.
4. Enter a description for the region.
5. Select the status of the exempted region.
6. Optional: Under Details, enter the Postal Code.
7. Save your entries.
Define Tax Rate Schedules
1. To define tax rates and validity dates, click Add Row .
2. Select a country for which you want to create a tax rate schedule.
3. Select the applicable tax type of the taxes that must be declared and paid to the respective
tax authorities such as value-added tax, sales and use tax, and withholding tax.
4. Select the tax rate type, for example, Standard, Reduced, or Exempt Rate.
5. Enter the date from which the tax rate is valid.
6. Enter the rate as a percentage.
7. Save your entries.
Define Standard Phrases for Legal Text Information
We recommend that you create a standard phrase specifically for each country since
exemption reasons can differ for each country. If a standard phrase is not available for
the required language, the English text is printed in the invoices. All languages are
displayed in this view.
To enter the legal texts for a specific language, you must be logged on to the system
in that language.
1. To define standard phrases for legal text information, click Add Row .
2. Select the country for which the legal text information is valid.
3. Select the applicable tax type for which legal texts are required such as value-added tax,
sales and use tax, and withholding tax.
4. Select the number of the Tax Exemption Reason.
5. Check the selection of the Language field. It is preset according to the language in which
you are logged on and must correspond to the language of your legal text.
6. Enter the legal text explaining the legal basis of the exemption.
360 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
This text is then included on the invoices where required.
7. Save your entries.
Define Tax Codes
For more information, see here.
Follow-On Activities
After you have completed the tasks here, we recommend that you check the tasks of the country-specific activities that
are required for countries that you have scoped.
7.1.5.1.3 Tax Determination — US
Here you can find tax information specifically for the United States.
Delivery Taxation
Taxes on materials deliveries within the United States are levied according to the law of the destination state (Ship-to).
Only in California and Texas are the deliveries taxed according to the state of origin (Ship-from). Taxes on service
deliveries are levied according to the law of the state of destination.
You can add your own combinations in business configuration and decide which combination is origin-based or
destination-based for an intrastate transaction, which means that ship-to and ship-from are the same US state. To find
the activity, go to the Business Configuration work center and choose the Implementation Projects view. Select your
implementation project and click Open Activity List . Select the Fine-tune phase, then select the Tax on Goods and
Services — US activity from the activity list.
Nexus
Nexus is a connection between a taxpayer and a state where the taxpayer has to pay taxes. The rules to establish the
connection between the two differs from state to state. However, with this nexus a state is required to collect sales tax
for sales.
Therefore a sale within a particular state is only taxable in the system if the seller company has nexus in the state.
If the seller does not have a nexus, no sales tax will be determined and the system assigns tax code 507 – Non Taxable
Sale Under Nexus Rules to the sales document.
This means the seller company issues an invoice without tax for nexus reasons. The transaction is recorded statistically
in the tax register.
If your company has nexus in a state, you must have the following settings prepared:
● You created a tax authority for this state in the Tax Management work center. For more information, see Quick
Guide for Tax Authorities (Tax Management) [363].
● You created entries in the system for every tax authority to which tax returns have to be submitted.
● You created a company tax arrangement for every tax authority that is relevant.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 361
● You entered a tax registration number for the company tax arrangement. This documents that the company is
registered in the state where the tax authority is located, and provides the basis for nexus determination in the tax
determination.
If a company tax arrangement has been created properly for a state, and a sale takes place in this state, the tax
determination works as described in Tax Determination [342].
7.1.6 Access to Tax Data by Tax Authorities (GDPdU)
Overview
This text describes how the SAP Business ByDesign system ensures that tax authorities can access tax data in the
system as required by law.
Prerequisites
Tax payers must allow tax authorities to access all tax-relevant data in their data processing systems. The applicable
regulations are described in a paper by the German Federal Ministry of Finance, 16 July 2001 - IV D2 – S 0316 – 136/01,
published in the Bundessteuerblatt (Federal Tax Gazette) part I, page 415 as the German Principles of Data Accessand Auditing of Digital Documents (GDPdU).
Similar regulations also apply in other countries. For example, in Austria, tax-relevant data must also be made accessible
on data carriers for the tax authorities, according to the regulations stipulated in Section 131 (subsection 3) and Section
132 (subsection 3) of the Bundesabgabenordnung (Federal Tax Code) of Austria.
The GDPdU contains rules for complying with the right of access to data.
The GDPdU stipulates that tax auditors are to be granted the following means of access:
Z1: Direct Read-Only Access
The GDPdU grants tax auditors the right to access the company's data processing system directly. That is, they are
authorized to evaluate tax-relevant data themselves directly in the system. Tax auditors are authorized to access the
stored data (including master data and links) in read-only mode using the tax payer's hardware and software. Only this
hardware and software may be used by tax auditors to access the electronically stored data. Remote (online) access
to the data processing system by the tax authority is therefore not allowed.
Read-only access includes reading, filtering, and sorting the data using the reports and evaluation tools available in the
data processing system.
For this, you use the Audit work center in SAP Business ByDesign.
Z2: Indirect Access
For the purpose of enabling read-only access by the tax auditor, the data is collected and electronically processed by
the tax payer, or by a third party authorized by the tax payer, following the tax auditor's instructions.
The tax auditor can only request electronic evaluation using the evaluation tools available in the tax payer's data
processing system.
In SAP Business ByDesign you can implement Z2 access organizationally using the reports available in the work centers
to prepare the data requested by the auditor. The selection options should be used in such a way as to ensure that the
report contains all tax-relevant data in non-condensed form. If you are in doubt about which data to select, consult with
the auditor in advance. You can then download the reports into Microsoft Excel. To ensure that the data in the Microsoft
362 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Excel file matches that in the system, you can set up a check process for generating the reports and downloading them
to Excel based on the dual control principle.
Z3: Data Carrier Release
The tax payer shall create data records for the tax auditor containing the tax-relevant data and save it to a data carrier
that can be electronically processed. This data carrier shall be handed over to the auditor for evaluation.
In SAP Business ByDesign, you can implement Z3 access by using the extraction run for financial data that you can
find in the General Ledger work center under Periodic Tasks.
The Z3 - Data Carrier Release also enables the electronic processing of the Austrian tax-relevant data as required
according to the Bundesabgabenordnung (Federal Tax Code). The Austrian-specific reporting package contains the
reports which are usually required by tax authorities and from which you therefore have to extract and retain data from.
The tax authority can claim any of these rights individually or in combination. The right to access data is restricted
exclusively to data related to taxes. The data must be in the German language.
Tax-Relevant Data in SAP Business ByDesign
The regulations contained in the GDPdU grant to tax authorities the right to access tax-relevant data. In particular, this
means you must allow access to financial and management accounting data.
The following overview contains standard reports that cover typical auditing objectives. As the user, you must clarify
with the auditor which data is tax-relevant in your case and which reports you must select to provide the requested
information.
Overview of Reports in SAP Business ByDesign
7.2 Tax Authorities View
7.2.1 Quick Guide for Tax Authorities (Tax Management)
This view enables you to enter and edit master data for domestic and foreign tax authorities as well as financial data
relevant for VAT/sales tax or withholding tax and your company tax arrangements.
In addition to VAT-related or withholding tax-related data, the tax authority master data can also include
information that is relevant for other work centers, such as the Payroll Processing work center).
Business Background
The tax authority master data is required for the system to be able to make tax entries, create tax returns, and enter
payments from or to the tax authority correctly.
An integral part of the tax authority master data is the company tax arrangement. It covers all regulations between the
company and the tax authority On the Company Tax Arrangement tab, you enter all tax numbers of your company and
store the rules applicable to the creation and submission of tax returns for VAT or withholding tax (US), which have been
agreed upon between the company and the relevant tax authority.
The Company Tax Arrangement screen provides you with an overview of all tax authorities to which your company or
subsidiary is registered.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 363
So that the system can trigger and post tax payments, you must have entered the data for the payment transaction and
have marked the relevant tax return type in the Tax Return Arrangement tab as relevant for payment.
For externally-initiated tax payments, that is tax payments entered in another work center to the Tax Management work
center, the system can only use the automatic payment allocation (Payment Management work center) to identify a
payment as a tax payment if a tax authority is specified as a payee or payer. Then the tax payment can be assigned
correctly in the Tax Management work center or posted as a tax prepayment. For more information, see Quick Guide
for Tax Payments [382].
Tasks
Enter Tax Authority Master Data
1. Choose Tax Authorities New Tax Authority . Enter the address and communication
data and save your entries. The system assigns a unique number to the tax authority.
2. Choose View All, switch to the Financial Data tab and enter the relevant payment methods
for your company or subsidiary.
3. Enter the accounts that are used for payment transactions with the tax authority under Bank
Data.
4. Switch to the Company Tax Arrangements tab and enter the standard settings of the tax
return types that are valid for your company. Here you store all subsidiaries that are
registered with the selected tax authority: ● Valid From / Valid To enables you to define the general period of validity of the company
tax arrangement.
● If you are registered with a tax authority abroad, you also enter your foreign VAT
identification numbers on the Tax Numbers tab.
Note: If you trade with a third country or EU country, or if intra-community goods and
services are provided, companies need to be registered with the relevant tax authority
abroad in some cases. If this applies to your company, you also have to enter the master
data of the foreign tax authorities and the respective tax numbers (see also Intra-
Community Movement [332]).
● Switch to the Tax Return Arrangements tab. For a payment-relevant tax return type,
enter the amount up to which a difference from an externally initiated tax payment and
determined tax amount is entered directly as an expense under Tolerance for Tax
Payments (see also Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382]).
● The Carry Forward indicator is only relevant for the US. Set this indicator if a receivable
from the tax authority needs to be cleared in the subsequent period.
5. Save your entries. The master data record of the tax authority is now active.
7.3 Manual Tax Entries View
7.3.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Entries (US)
In this view, you enter sales and use tax items that the system does not include automatically with business transactions.
You can access the Sales and Use Tax Entries view from the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax
Entries.
364 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● We strongly recommend that you do not make any entries to tax accounts directly in the general ledger.
These entries do not create entries in the tax register and are not entered in the tax subledger. You
otherwise have to manually add the tax amounts posted in the general ledger in the VAT return forms
before they are sent to the tax authority.
● Note that when you make a manual tax entry, the system does not check whether the combination of G/
L account and tax code that you have entered is permitted.
Business Background
Each manual tax entry is entered automatically in the tax register [315] as an open tax item, posted to the relevant tax
account, and included in the tax return run for the affected reporting period.
You make manual sales and use tax entries in the following cases, for example:
● You have created an invoice without tax data. The tax item or items were not yet reported to the tax authority.
● You execute a tax correcting entry for a delivery or service granted free of charge.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
● Make sure that the tax-relevant data of the company is defined for your tax authority (see
also Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363]).
● To display the reported or open tax items for a selected period, you can use the reports
Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All VAT / Sales Tax
Items.
Make a Sales and Use Tax Entry
1. Click New and enter the company and currency data as well as the posting date. The
current date is proposed as the tax due date.
2. In each line item, enter the appropriate account determination group (G/L Account column),
the tax code to be used, tax jurisdiction information (State and Tax Jurisdiction Code) or ZIP
code, and also the credit or debit amount to enable the gross amount balance to be cleared.
3. To test the validity of the entries, choose Check .
4. If you do not want to make the entry yet, choose Save . The system automatically assigns
an ID to the manual tax entry.
5. To make the posting to the tax accounts and to enter the tax items in the tax register, choose
Post . The system creates a journal entry for which you can now display the journal entry
ID.
7.3.2 Quick Guide for VAT Entries
You make these tax entries to enter tax items manually or to make tax adjustments to VAT or input tax that the system
does not include automatically with business transactions.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 365
You can access the VAT Entries view from the Tax Management work center under Manual Tax Entries.
● We strongly recommend that you do not make any entries to VAT accounts directly in the general
ledger. These entries do not create entries in the tax register and are not entered in the tax subledger.
You otherwise have to manually add the tax amounts posted in the general ledger in the VAT return
forms before they are sent to the tax authority.
● Note that when you make a manual tax entry, the system does not check whether the combination of G/
L account and tax code that you have entered is permitted.
Business Background
Each VAT entry is entered in the tax register [315] as an open tax item, posted to the relevant VAT account, and included
in the VAT return run for the affected reporting period.
You make manual VAT entries in the following cases, for example:
● You have created a business transaction and entered the incorrect tax rate or tax code by mistake. The tax item
or items were not yet reported to the tax authority.
● Goods and Services Granted Free of Charge [327] (withdrawals from stock for private use)
● Intra-Community Movement [332]
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
● Make sure that the tax-relevant data of the reporting company is defined for your tax authority
(see also Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363]).
● To display the reported or open tax items for a selected period, you can use the reports
Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All VAT / Sales Tax
Items.
Manual VAT Entries
1. Click New and enter the company and currency data as well as the posting date. The
current date is proposed as the tax due date.
2. In each line item, enter the appropriate account determination group (G/L Account column),
the tax code to be used, and the credit or debit amount so that the gross amount balance is
then cleared.
3. To test the validity of your entries, choose Check .
4. If you do not want to make the entry yet, choose Save . The system automatically assigns
an ID to the manual tax entry.
5. To make the posting to the tax accounts and to enter the tax items in the tax register, choose
Post . The system creates a journal entry for which you can now display the journal entry
ID.
For information on how to report tax items for a previously created tax return, see Subsequent
Reporting of Tax Items [321].
366 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
7.3.3 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Base Amount Entries (US)
In this view, you enter sales relevant for withholding tax together with your suppliers if the sales were not included when
the supplier invoices were entered. This applies only to sales for which no withholding tax was retained.
You can access the Withholding Tax Base Amount Entries view from the Tax Management work center under Manual
Tax Entries.
Business Background
Sales relevant for withholding tax (withholding tax base amounts) are entered automatically as tax items in the tax
register [315] and taken into account for the relevant reporting period in the tax return run for withholding tax.
You make manual corrections to sales relevant for withholding tax in the following cases, for example:
● You selected the incorrect withholding tax code when entering a supplier invoice without a purchase
order reference.
● At the time the supplier invoice was posted, you had not classified the relevant supplier as being relevant for
withholding tax.
● You accidentally indicated a supplier as being relevant for withholding tax, but had already posted the
invoices for that particular supplier.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
To be able to enter withholding tax base amounts manually, you need to have made the following
settings:
● Make sure that the tax-relevant data of the company is defined for your tax authority (see
also Quick Guide for Tax Authorities [363]).
● You have specified in the system that the company has to report withholding tax. To do this,
go to the Tax Authorities view and choose an entry that you want to edit. Switch to the
Company Tax Arrangement tab and set the Withholding Tax indicator.
● You have specified in the relevant supplier master data that the supplier is subject to
withholding tax. To do this, in Supplier Base work center under Suppliers, select the relevant
rows and choose Edit Financial Data Tax Data and enter the data. At this stage,
you also need to have entered the tax number of the supplier.
Enter a Withholding Tax Base Amount
1. Click New and Tax Entry and enter the company and currency data as well as the posting
date. The current date is proposed as the tax due date.
2. Generate a new line item in the lower area of the screen, select Withholding Tax Code , and
enter the sales revenue under Debit Amount or Credit Amount .
3. Save your entries. The system automatically assigns an ID to this manual entry.
4. To create an entry in the tax register, choose Release .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 367
7.4 Tax Returns View
7.4.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Returns (US)
You can access the Sales and Use Tax Returns view from the Tax Management work center under Tax
Returns Sales and Use Tax Returns .
This view displays the sales and use tax returns that were created previously in the Sales and Use Tax Return Runs
[388] view.
Business Background
Sales and Use Tax
Sales Tax is levied on the sale of taxable goods and services for transactions made within a state (intra-state
transactions), or if the seller's subsidiary business is located in the state of the buyer (inter-state transaction). In both
cases, the seller collects the taxes from the buyer and pays the VAT to the state tax authority.
Use Tax is levied on the purchase of goods and services for purchases from other states (inter-state transaction). If
the seller does not have a separate subsidiary in the same state as the buyer (that is, no nexus), the seller then has
no authorization to collect or pay taxes. The buyer pays the use tax in the state in which the goods are consumed.
Certain goods, interim references, and materials intended for resale or further processing are tax-exempt and not subject
to use tax.
Self-Assessment generally affects large-scale businesses that are in possession of a tax exemption certificate (such
as a direct payment permit). These companies do not transfer taxes to the seller when making a purchase, but instead
pay the taxes directly to the tax authority. The tax exemption certificate must be presented to the seller.
Entering Sales and Use Tax Items
In the following cases, the system determines and enters the sales and use tax items:
● You have entered a customer invoice for a customer located in your state (intra-state transaction). Your tax return
displays sales tax that you need to report and pay to your state tax authority.
● You have entered a customer invoice for a customer located in a different state (inter-state transaction). You
company has a subsidiary (and therefore a nexus) in the state where the customer is located. Your tax return
displays sales tax that you need to report and pay to the tax authority located in the state of the customer.
● You have entered a supplier invoice for a supplier in a different state who does not have a business presence (or
nexus) in your state. Your return displays the use tax that you need to pay.
● For a customer in the Receivables work center or a supplier in the Payables work center, you have manually entered
a New Charge/Credit with a tax code for sales and use tax. The tax return displays a Manual Payables/Receivables
Entry. (Note: The system always uses the state in which the business residence of the customer or supplier is
located.)
● You have made manual tax entries for sales and use tax.
In the following cases, the system does not determine and enter any sales or use tax items:
● In the Supplier Invoicing work center, you have entered a New Invoice Without Purchase Order using a product
that is tax-exempt in your state. In this case, your tax return displays the tax base amount but not the sales tax.
368 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● You have entered a purchase or customer invoice using a product that is intended for resale or further processing.
In this case, your tax return displays only the tax base amount but not the use tax.
● You have entered a customer invoice for a customer with a tax exemption certificate (such as a direct debit permit).
Your tax return displays only the tax base amount but not the use tax.
Payments for Sales and Use Tax
For your regular tax prepayments, you determine the amount to be paid by creating a tax return in a Test Run. (Note:
You cannot release test returns. The tax items of these test returns are not entered.)
You create a tax return to be reported for the total reporting period in a sales use tax return in which the system
determines the remaining tax payable to be paid.
To trigger tax payments, you have the following options:
● You trigger a tax prepayment without rounding amount in the Tax Management work center under Common
Tasks New Tax Prepayment .
● You trigger a tax payment for a tax return without rounding amount in the Tax Management work center using
the tax return.
● If rounded tax payments are mandatory in a state, you trigger the payment in the Payment Management work
center (for example, with an outgoing check).
For more information about the individual procedures, see below in the section Tasks.
Error in the Tax Return
If you determine an error in a tax return, you have the following options:
● You can delete a sales and use tax return with the status In Preparation at any time. (Note: You can use this option
for the tax returns that you created in the test run. Note that tax returns created in the test run cannot be released.)
● A sales and use tax return with the status Reported can only be canceled. Alternatively you can create an amending
tax return for the same reporting period in a correction run. All tax items of the same reporting period are entered
again in this run. For more information about how tax items can be subsequently taken into account, see
Subsequent Reporting of Tax Items [321].
● A sales and use tax return with the status Completed for which an externally-initiated tax payment was already
triggered can only be canceled if you have removed the payment allocation in the Payment Management work
center. A tax return for which payment clearing was already performed cannot be canceled.
For more information, see:
● Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Entries (US) [364]
● Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Return Runs (US) [388]
● Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319]
● Status of Tax Returns [317]
● Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382] (in particular the Business Background section)
● Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316]
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 369
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
To be able to create sales and use tax returns correctly in the system, you need to have entered
the following settings and master data:
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for the Tax Authorities (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]). You need to have entered your tax information for sales and use tax under
Company Tax Arrangement Tax Numbers , and also under Tax Return
Arrangement.
● You have entered the regions and tax exemption reasons for sales and use tax in the Product
Data work center for the appropriate material or services on the Purchase or Sales tab under
Taxes.
● In the Business Partner work center, you have entered the tax-relevant data for a supplier.
To do this, select a supplier and choose Edit Financial Data . Go to the Tax Data tab
page. Enter the tax number applicable in the state of the supplier as well as an existing tax
exemption, for example, if the supplier has no business presence (or nexus) in your state.
(Note: For the supplier, you need to specify the use tax in the invoicing document using
explicitly the tax code.)
● In the Business Partner work area, you have entered the tax information for use tax
applicable to a customer. To do this, select a customer and choose Edit Financial
Data . Enter the tax data on the Tax Data and Tax Exemption Certificate tabs.
Check Tax Data
To display the open or reported sales tax items for a selected period and the sources documents,
you can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All
VAT / Sales Tax Items.
To check the details of a tax return, proceed as follows:
1. Select the value by which you want to filter from the filter display.
2. Select the row of the tax return. The system displays the tax information for the tax return in
the lower screen area.
3. To obtain an overview of the individual sales revenues with their source documents and tax
events, choose View , switch to the Tax Return tab, and click Details in a field in the
tax form.
Submit Tax Data and Release Tax Return
Note: The function for submitting tax data to the tax authority directly from the system is notprovided.
Once you have sent the tax data to the tax authority, you must release the tax return in the system.
The release results in the following:
● The status of the tax return is changed from In Preparation to Reported.
370 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● The tax items of the tax return obtain the status Reported in the tax register and are now
displayed in the Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
● The balance of the relevant tax accounts is transferred to the tax payable account (tax
clearing account).
Trigger Tax Prepayment for a Test Run Tax Return (InternallyInitiated)
To trigger a tax prepayment, the amount of which you have already determined in a tax return
test run, proceed as follows:
1. Choose Common Tasks New Tax Prepayment .
2. Enter the company tax arrangement, tax amount, and posting date. Enter a date of the
affected reporting period as the clearing date.
3. Choose Execute. The payment is assigned an internal number. The released payment is
automatically entered and posted as a clearing item in the tax register. The journal entry ID
of the generated journal entry is now displayed in the payment.
Note: If the payment has inconsistent data or payment or bank information is missing in the
master data of the tax authority, a task Review Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
4. You find the payment with the status Ready for Transfer in the Payment Management work
center under Payment Monitor .
Trigger Tax Payment for a Tax Return (Internally Initiated)
To trigger a tax payment for a reported tax return, proceed as follows:
1. Select a tax return with the status Reported and then choose Pay .
2. If necessary, change the payment date and proposed posting date and choose OK .
The payment is assigned an internal number and the status In Preparation. The released
payment is automatically entered and posted as a clearing item in the tax register. The
journal entry ID of the generated journal entry is now displayed in the payment.
Note: If the payment has inconsistent data or payment or bank information is missing in the
master data of the tax authority, a task Review Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
3. You find the payment with the status Ready for Transfer in the Payment Management work
center under Payment Monitor . Once the payment is made, the tax return is given the status
Completed.
Trigger Check Payment to Tax Authority (Externally Initiated)
Rounded tax payments are mandatory in some states. To trigger a check payment for this,
proceed as follows:
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose under Common Tasks → New
Outgoing Check.
2. Enter the payment and bank data and the payee of your tax authority. If necessary, change
the posting date and date of issue proposed by the system and choose Release.
3. You find the payment under Payment Monitor with the status Ready for Transfer. If the check
was issued, you change the status of the check payment to In Transfer.
4. The system has automatically identified the payment as a tax payment using the Payment
Allocation of the payment to the tax authority. It is now displayed in the Tax Management
work center under Tax Payments.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 371
If the system could not find an appropriate tax return for the payment or the amount of the
assigned tax amount differs from the amount of the tax payment, a task Review and Release
Tax Payment is sent to the worklist of the Tax Management work center. Proceed as
described under Task - Review and Release Tax Payment.
If the tax payment is released, the status of the underlying tax return is automatically changed
from Released to Completed.
7.4.2 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Returns (US)
This document contains text, that is specific to the US. To ensure that the system displays the correct text, select
Personalize My Settings Onscreen Help . Choose US — United States in the drop-down menu, save your
settings and login again.
Important tasks
See the US specific document.
7.4.3 Quick Guide for VAT Returns
You can access the VAT Returns view from the Tax Management work center under Tax Returns.
This view displays the advance returns for VAT and annual VAT returns that were created previously in the system using
VAT return runs. You can monitor the status of your VAT returns, use the created VAT returns as a template for the
electronic submission to the tax authority, and trigger the payment of the determined VAT payable to your tax authority.
Business Background
The entrepreneur has to submit an annual VAT return and regular advance returns for VAT to the tax authority and
execute VAT prepayments. The system helps you to comply with the taxation procedure in accordance with § 18,
paragraph 3 of German VAT law, according to which the entrepreneur has to calculate the tax payable or surplus and
report it to the tax authority.
The tax returns created in the system include all tax items from VAT-related business transactions and manual VAT
entries that are to be reported for the respective reporting period. Once you have submitted that tax return data to your
tax authority and have changed the status of the return to Reported in the system, you can trigger a tax payment to
clear the determined tax payable in this view.
If you determine an error in a tax return, you have the following options:
● You can delete a VAT return with the status In Preparation at any time.
● A VAT return with the status Reported can only be canceled. Alternatively, you can create an amending tax return
for the same reporting period in a correction run. All VAT items of the same reporting period are entered again in
this run. For more information about how tax items can be subsequently taken into account, see Subsequent
Reporting of Tax Items [321].
● A VAT return with the status Completed for which an externally-initiated tax payment was already triggered can
only be canceled if you have removed the payment allocation in the Payment Management work center (see also
372 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382]). A VAT return for which payment clearing was already performed cannotbe canceled.
See also:
● Quick Guide for VAT / Sales Tax Entries [365]
● Quick Guide for VAT Return Runs [391]
● Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319]
● Status of Tax Returns [317]
● Electronic Submission of Tax Return
● Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382] (in particular the Business Background section)
● Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316]
Important tasks
Check Predefined Settings
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]).
Check Tax Data
To display the open or reported sales tax items for a selected period and the sources documents,
you can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All
VAT / Sales Tax Items.
To check the details of a tax return, proceed as follows:
1. Select the value by which you want to filter from the filter display.
2. Select the row of the VAT return. The system displays the tax information for the sales list
in the lower screen area.
3. To display the form created in the system, click Preview .
4. To obtain an overview of the individual sales revenues with their source documents and tax
events, choose View , and then switch to the Tax Return tab and click Details in a field
in the tax form.
Submit Tax Data and Release Tax Return
Note: The function for submitting tax data to the tax authority directly from the system is notprovided. For more information on the procedure for sending your VAT returns, see Electronic
Submission of Tax Return.
Once you have sent the tax data to the tax authority, you must release the tax return in the system.
The release results in the following:
● The status of the tax return is changed from In Preparation to Reported.
● The tax items of the tax return obtain the status Reported in the tax register and are now
displayed in the Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 373
● The balance of the relevant tax accounts is transferred to the tax payable account (tax
clearing account).
Trigger Tax Payment for a Tax Return (Internally Initiated)
1. Select a reported VAT return and choose Pay .
2. If necessary, change the payment date and posting date proposed by the system and choose
OK . The payment is assigned an internal number and the status In Preparation. The
released payment is automatically entered and posted as a clearing item in the tax register.
The journal entry ID of the generated journal entry is now displayed in the payment.
Note: If the payment has inconsistent data or payment or bank information is missing in the
master data of the tax authority, a task Review Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
3. You find the payment with the status Ready for Transfer in the Payment Management work
center under Payment Monitor . Once the payment is made, the tax return is given the status
Completed.
7.4.4 Quick Guide for EC Sales Lists
You can access the EC Sales Lists view from the Tax Management work center under Tax Returns EC Sales
Lists .
This view displays the EC sales lists that were generated in the system using EC sale list runs. You can monitor the
status of your EC sales lists in the system and use them as a template for the electronic submission to the German
Federal Office for Taxes.
Business Background
The EC sales lists show for the selected reporting period all domestic goods deliveries within the EU tax community,
other services, and deliveries for intra-community triangulations. For each acquisition, the system lists the remuneration
accrued for the goods and services supplied as well as the corresponding VAT registration number.
The EC sales lists are used only for monitoring goods movements within the EU and are not relevant for payment. VAT
payments made to the tax authorities are triggered in the system on the basis of advance returns for VAT or annual tax
returns. The EC sales lists are submitted either monthly or quarterly in electronic form to the German Federal Office for
Taxes (for Germany).
The system takes the following activities into account in the EC sales list:
● In the Customer Invoices work center, you have entered a goods delivery to a customer in another EU country.
● In the Customer Invoices work center, you have entered an intra-community service that you have provided.
(Note: Note the legal change to Directive 2008/8/EC, which came into effect as of January 1st, 2010, concerning
the service location and related VAT reverse charge.)
● In the Tax Management work center, you have entered a VAT entry manually for an intra-community goods delivery
or for an intra-community triangulation.
● You have delivered goods to your branch office in another EU country for your own, permanent use. (See also:
Intra-Community Movement [332]).
If you determine an error in a tax return, you have the following options:
● You can delete an EC sales list with the status In Preparation at any time.
374 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● An EC sales list with the status Reported can only be canceled. Alternatively, you can create an amending tax
return for the same reporting period in a correction run. All VAT items of the same reporting period are entered
again in this run. For more information about how tax items can be subsequently taken into account, see
Subsequent Reporting of Tax Items [321].
For more information, see:
● Quick Guide for VAT Entries [365]
● Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319]
● Quick Guide for EC Sales List Runs [393]
● Status of Tax Returns [317]
● Electronic Submission of Tax Return
● Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316]
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
To enable EC sales lists to be created correctly in the system, you need to have entered the
following settings and master data:
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]). You need to have entered your tax information and the VAT registration
number of the target EU states under Company Tax Arrangement Tax Numbers , and
also under Tax Return Arrangement.
● You have entered a valid tax exemption (due to a reverse charge, for example) for a product
or service. To do this, choose the item you want to edit in the Product Data work center and
choose View All > Sales. Select the row of the sales organization, switch to the Tax tab,
and enter the tax data and tax exemption reason.
● In the Business Partner Data work center, you have entered the VAT / sales tax information
for a customer. To do this, select a customer for editing and choose Financial Data. Enter
the tax-relevant information under Tax Data.
Check the Tax Data
To display the reported or open tax items and the source documents for a selected period, you
can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All VAT /
Sales Tax Items.
To check the details of an EC sales list, proceed as follows:
1. Select the value by which you want to filter from the filter display.
2. Select the row for the EC sales list. The system displays the tax information for the sales list
in the lower screen area.
3. To display the form created in the system, click Preview .
4. To obtain an overview of the individual sales revenues with their source documents and tax
events, choose View , and then switch to the Tax Return tab and click Details .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 375
Note: The tax events used in the EC sales lists for Germany are as follows: , , 400 — Intra-
Community Supply (§4 Nr. 1b UStG), 403 — Triangulation Sale, and
455 — EU Sale of Services, Reverse Charge.)
Submit EC Sales List
At present, a function to electronically submit EC sales lists directly from the system is notavailable. For more information on the procedure for submitting your EC sales list, see Electronic
Submission of Tax Return.
7.4.5 Quick Guide for GST Returns – Australia
This view displays the periodic GST returns that were created previously in the system using the GST return runs. You
can monitor the status of your GST returns, use the created GST returns as a template for the form submission to the
tax authority, and trigger the payment of the determined GST payable to your tax authority.
You can access the GST Returns subview from the Tax Management work center under the Tax Returns view.
Business background
The entrepreneur has to submit a periodic GST return to the tax authority and execute the payment. The system helps
you to comply with the taxation procedure in accordance with the laws of the Australian Taxation Office. The tax returns
created in the system include all tax items from GST -related business transactions and manual GST entries that are
to be reported for the respective reporting period. Once you have submitted that tax return data to your tax authority
and have changed the status of the return to Reported in the system, you can trigger a tax payment to clear the
determined tax payable in this view.
If you determine an error in a tax return, you have the following options:
● You can delete a GST return with the status In Preparation at any time.
● A GST return with the status Reported can only be canceled. Alternatively, you can create an amending tax return
for the same reporting period in a correction run. All GST items of the same reporting period are entered again in
this run. For more information about how tax items can be subsequently taken into account, see Subsequent
Reporting of Tax Items.
● A GST return with the status Completed for which an externally-initiated tax payment was already triggered can
only be canceled if you have removed the payment allocation in the Payment Management work center (see also
Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382]). A GST return for which payment clearing was already performed cannot be
canceled.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority. For more information, see Quick
Guide for Tax Authorities [363]
376 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Create a New Tax Return Run
1. Go to the Tax Management work center, choose the Tax Returns view, and then open New
Tax Return Run under Common Tasks.
2. In the New Tax Return Run quick activity, enter the Description field.
3. In the Tax Return Arrangement field, select the relevant arrangement. The system will
retrieve the tax return details.
4. Enter the From and To dates.
5. Click Save to set the status of the tax return run to In Preparation. The system will give
you a Run ID.
6. Click Activate to set the status to Active. Click Schedule and then click OK to run the
declaration immediately. You can also specify a date and time in the Schedule field to run
it later.
7. Click Close to return to the Tax Returns view.
Any tax items posted after the date selected for the return run are not considered
in the tax return run. Therefore, if you want to post in the period that is still open
after the tax return run, you need to create a correction return.
You can reschedule any return runs that have been already scheduled but not
performed yet. To do this, enter a new start time for the tax return run.
Check Tax Data
To display the open or reported sales tax items for a selected period and the sources documents,
you can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and All
VAT / Sales Tax Items.
To check the details of a tax return, proceed as follows:
1. Go to the Tax Returns view and choose the VAT Returns subview. The return is in status
In preparation.
2. Select the return and click Edit to view the details of the return.
3. Click Release to mark your tax return as declared in the system. The release results in the
following: ● The status of the tax return is changed from In Preparation to Reported.
● The tax items of the tax return obtain the status Reported in the tax register and are
now displayed in the Reported VAT/Sales Tax Items report.
● The balance of the relevant tax accounts is transferred to the tax payable account (tax
clearing account).
You find the payment with the status Ready for Transfer in the Payment
Management work center under Payment Monitor. Once the payment is made, the
system updates the status of the tax return to Completed.
4. Click Preview to check the details of the form created in the system.
Submit Tax Data
1. Take a print out of the form template and fill your legal form manually.
2. Submit it to the tax authority.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 377
7.4.6 Quick Guide for Service Tax Returns - India
You use this view to display and update all the service tax challans/returns that you created using the service tax return
runs [396] in the system.
You can access the Service Tax Returns subview from the Tax Management work center, Tax Returns view.
Business Background
Companies in India are obliged to levy service tax on their services and to pay the collected service tax to the tax
authority. In addition to the monthly tax payment (Challan), the company should also submit a Service Tax return (ST–
3) form with details of tax payment. The service tax return is to be submitted every half year, the period being April toSeptember or October to March. For more information see, Service Tax Return — India [323]
If you determine an error in a tax return, you have the following options:
● You can delete a service tax return with the status In Preparation at any time.
● A service tax return with the status Reported can only be canceled. Alternatively, you can create an amending tax
return for the same reporting period in a correction run. All service tax challans of the same reporting period are
entered again in this run. For more information about how tax items can be subsequently taken into account, see
Subsequent Reporting of Tax Items [321]
● A service tax return with the status Completed for which an externally-initiated tax payment was already triggered
can only be canceled if you have removed the payment allocation in the Payment Management work center (see
also Quick Guide for Tax Payments [382]). A service tax return for which payment clearing was already performed
cannot be canceled.
● If the service tax return (ST-3) for this reporting period is not yet created, the correction challan will be
automatically included in the normal service tax run.
● If the service tax return (ST-3) for this period is already created, then create a correction service tax return
for the same period. The correction challan will be automatically included in the correction service tax
run.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services, Tax Settings for Purchasing and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Ensure that the master data is defined for your tax authority. For more information, see
Company Tax Arrangement-India
● Ensure that you have entered tax data for the supplier master and the customer master in
the Supplier Base and Account Management workcenters respectively.
● Ensure that you have entered the service tax accounting code in the Product Data
workcenter.
378 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Ensure that you have entered tax data for Sales and Purchasing in the Product Data
workcenter.
Check Service Tax Challan/Return Data
1. Select the value by which you want to filter from the filter display.
2. Select the row of the Service Tax Challan/return. The system displays the tax information
for the Service Tax list in the lower screen area.
3. Click Preview to display the ST-3 form created in the system.
4. Choose View , and then switch to the Tax Return tab and click Details to obtain an overview
of the individual service tax items with their source documents and tax details.
Update Challan Details
The bank provides you with a Challan number that you must update in the system. To do this,
follow the steps below:
1. Select the row with the tax return for which you want to enter the challan details and click
View to open the Service Tax Payment screen. Click Save to save the challan details.
2. Open the Tax Return tab to see the Challan Details field.
You can edit the fields on this screen only after the payment is approved.
3. Enter the Challan Identification Number, Challan Date and the BSR code for each service
type for which the payment has been made.
4. Click Save to save the challan details.
Submit Service Tax to the Tax Authority
1. Select the row with the tax run for which you want to generate the ST–3 form. Click
Release to mark your tax return as declared in the system.
2. Click Preview to see the details of the ST–3 form.
3. Take a print out and submit to the tax authority.
7.4.7 Quick Guide for Tax Adjustments — India
This view displays the tax adjustments that were created previously in the system using the service tax return runs. You
can monitor the status of your tax adjustments and cancel them if necessary.
You can access the Tax Adjustments subview from the Tax Management work center under the Tax Returns view.
Business background
The tax adjustment feature is used for the following scenarios primarily:
● Import of service: The system activates the input tax once the corresponding output tax of an import invoice is
paid to the tax authority. For more information, see Import of Services — India [322]
● Purchase of Capital Goods: The system activates the deferred input excise tax in two parts:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 379
○ The first 50% is activated when you create the first service tax challan after the capital goods invoice is posted
in the system.
○ The subsequent 50% is activated when you create the first service tax challan in the next financial year.
For more information, see Purchase of Capital Goods — India [322]Purchase of Capital Goods — India [322]
Tasks
Verify Tax Adjustments
1. Go to the Tax Returns view and choose the Tax Adjustments subview.
2. Select the adjustment (in status Released) and click the Adjustment ID to open the Tax
Adjustments Overview screen. Check the details of the tax adjustment that you have chosen.
3. Click Close to return to the Tax Adjustments subview.
Cancel Tax Adjustments
1. Go to the Tax Returns view and choose the Tax Adjustments subview.
2. Select the adjustment (in status Released) that you would like to cancel. Click Action —>
Cancel to cancel the tax adjustment.
The system changes the status of the tax adjustment to Release Canceled.
7.4.8 Quick Guide for A-29 Reports – Mexico
In this view you can monitor your A-29 reports that were created previously in the A–29 Report Runs [398] view.
Companies in Mexico who are liable to pay taxes need to submit the A-29 report every year. This report gives a
consolidated view of all the taxes paid by the company through the year. There is no payment associated with the report.
You can access the A–29 Reports subview from the Tax Management work center in the Tax Returns view.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority. For more information, see Quick
Guide for Tax Authorities [363].
Create Tax Return Runs
1. Go to the Tax Management work center, and then open New Tax Return Run under Common
Tasks.
2. In the New Tax Return Run quick activity, enter the Run Description field.
3. In the Tax Return Arrangement field, select the relevant arrangement. The system will
retrieve the tax return details.
380 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
4. Enter the From and To dates.
5. Click Save to set the status of the tax return run to In Preparation. The system will give
you a Run ID.
6. Click Set to Active to set the status to Active. Click Schedule to open the Schedule Job
screen. Select Start Immediately to run the declaration immediately. You can also specify
other job schedules to run later, in recurrence or a single run.
7. Click Save and Close to return to the Tax Returns view.
Any tax items posted after the date selected for the return run are not considered
in the tax return run. Therefore, if you want to post in the period that is still open
after the tax return run, you need to create a correction return.
You can reschedule any return runs that have been already scheduled but not
performed yet. To do this, enter a new start time for the tax return run.
Check Tax Data and Release Tax Return
1. Go to the Tax Returns view and choose the A-29 Reports subview.
2. Select a report (in status In Preparation) and click View to open the report.
3. Click Tax Return and then select a row to view the corresponding tax details of a
combination of supplier and transaction type.
4. Under Transaction Summary, click the link to the individual amount to view the details
corresponding to that field.
5. Select a row and click Details to see the consolidated summary of both the VAT and
Withholding Tax documents.
6. Click Export — > To Microsoft Excel to download all the details that you can see on the
screen.
7. Click Release to mark your tax return as reported in the system. The release results in the
following: ● The status of the tax return is changed from In Preparation to Reported.
● The tax items of the tax return obtain the status Reported in the tax register and are
now displayed in the Reported VAT/Sales Tax Items report.
● The system creates a file with all the details.
Upload File to the Website
The function for submitting tax data to the tax authority directly from the system is not
provided.
1. Select the return and click View to view all the details of the run.
2. Go to the Attachments tab to view the link to the electronic file that is created in the system.
Click the file to download it to your system or open it directly. You can also upload the file
to the Mexican Tax Authority Web Site http://www.sat.gob.mx to comply with legal
requirements defined by the Servicio de Administración Tributaria (SAT), the Mexican tax
authority.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 381
Update Acknowledgement Details
Once you have submitted the tax data, the Mexican Tax Authority provides you with a FolioReceipt Number and a Transaction Number that you must update in the system. To do this,
follow the steps below:
1. Select the report for which you want to upload the details and click View
2. In the Overview tab, under Acknowledgement Information, update the corresponding
numbers that you have received from the tax authority.
3. Click Save to save the information in the SAP Business ByDesign system.
If you create a correction return and file it to the government, you need to refer to
the original tax return. Along with the submission date, you have to mention the
Folio Receipt Number and Transaction Number of the original return in the
correction return.
7.5 Tax Payments View
7.5.1 Quick Guide for Tax Payments
About this document
You can access the Tax Payments view from the Tax Management work center under Tax Payments.
This view displays all incoming and outgoing tax payments that were triggered in the Tax Management work center
(internally initiated) or in the Payment Management and Liquidity Management work centers (externally initiated).
Business Background
Tax Payments in the System
Tax payments are differentiated by the system due to the type and place of origin of VAT-relevant payments as follows:
● Tax payments are triggered within (internally initiated) or outside of (externally initiated) the Tax Management
work center.
● Tax payments can be triggered as manual, flat-rate payments (for example, VAT prepayments) or due to tax returns.
● Tax payments can match the determined tax amounts of tax return(s) or differ from them (tax payment difference).
The distinction whether the payments are triggered within the Tax Management work center (internally initiated) or
outside of it (externally initiated) determines the release and approval process and business task management for tax
payments, status assignment of tax payments and tax returns, and the process for entering and canceling tax payments.
Examples:
● Internally initiated: You enter a VAT prepayment or a tax payment for a tax return in the Tax Management work
center.
● Externally initiated: You enter a bank transfer or check payment (US) to the tax authority in the Payment
Management work center.
382 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● Externally initiated: You enter a direct debit or tax refund of the tax authority with a bank statement in the Liquidity
Management work center.
Note on tax refund (Germany): Note that a tax receivable is only considered legal upon approval by the tax authority;
that is when there is an incoming payment or corresponding notification. If there is no such approval by the tax
authority by the closing key date, you need to make an accrual when you perform year-end closing.
NOTE: Tax payables or tax receivables are not cleared in the Payables and Receivables work centers.
Internally Initiated Tax Payments
For internally initiated tax payments the bank account to be used is determined automatically by the system and cannot
be entered manually. The bank account selection can be configured in the optional activity Bank Account and Payment
Method Determination and Prioritization for Payment Methods. If you want to use a specific bank account, we
recommend that you create an externally initiated payment in the Payment Management work center as described under
'Tasks' below. If you select the tax authority as payee, the tax payment is automatically allocated (payment allocation)
and recorded in the Tax Management work center. Afterwards you have to assign the reported tax return to your tax
payment so that the tax payable of the tax return can be cleared.
Externally Initiated Tax Payments
Payment Allocation
In the Payment Management work center, the system first attempts to automatically assign payments either to the
appropriate business transactions (original payments), business partners, other expenses (fees, interest) or to the
appropriate general ledger or expense accounts. The type of payment allocation is determined by the underlying
business transaction and the source document of a payment. Payment allocation needs to be performed manually if
there is missing information or data inconsistencies (see also Payment Allocation and Clearing [188] and Perform a
Manual Payment Allocation [202]). For some payments that are initiated in Payment Management, for example, bank
transfer or outgoing check, the system attempts to find an suitable payment order and to assign the original payment
(source document). Once payment allocation has taken place and been released, the status of the payment order is set
to Confirmed.
For entering the clearing of a tax payable with a bank statement in the Liquidity Management work center, the system
does not look for a suitable payment order, instead it attempts to directly and automatically assign the payment to the
business partner. If a tax authority was specified in the bank statement, the payment is automatically assigned to the
Tax Management work center. A tax payment is then created with the status In Preparation in the Tax Management
work center. If the bank statement is released and the system could uniquely assign a tax return to the tax payment,
the tax payment gets the status Released.
Tax Payment Differences
For externally initiated tax payments, the system automatically determines suitable, reported tax returns. Once the
system has either determined none or multiple tax returns, or the tax payable determined in the tax return differs from
the tax payment, a task Review and Release Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
You can specify that a tax payment difference up to a certain amount is posted immediately as an expense.
In this case, no task is created in the worklist. For this, in the master data for the tax authority, you define a
Tolerance for Tax Payment Difference in the Company Tax Arrangement under Tax Return Arrangements.
If a determined tax payment difference falls below this value, the tax payment difference is immediately
released with the approval and entered automatically as an expense.
Tax payment differences can occur, for example, for the following reasons:
● You have entered a bank statement with a credit memo or direct debit from your tax authority in the Payment
Management work center that is not VAT/sales tax-relevant (for example, corporate income tax or income tax).
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 383
Since in the payment the tax authority is entered as the business partner, the system has mistakenly assigned the
payment to the Tax Management work center using the automatic payment allocation.
● The system has assigned a tax return to an externally initiated tax payment. Since the tax payment differs from the
determined tax amount of the tax return, there is a tax payment difference.
● The system has assigned more than one tax return to an externally initiated tax payment. This also results in a tax
payment difference.
Useful Tax Reports
Before you trigger a tax payment to your tax authority, check in the Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report whether tax
items are still to be considered for the selected reporting period. If necessary, perform a new tax return run (or correction
run). After you have changed the status of the tax item to Reported with Release, it is displayed in the Reported VAT /
Sales Tax Items. This report displays the tax receivable or the surplus amount for the selected reporting period that is
to be refunded by the tax authority (tax refund).
Note: We recommend that you always enter a reporting period beginning with the current calendar year for your tax
return runs so that the system can reliably determine all open tax items in your tax returns.
Canceling Tax Payments and Reversing Payment Allocations
The procedure how a tax payment is canceled and whether before this happens, a payment allocation is reversed,
depends on the status and origin (externally/internally initiated) of the payment and whether the tax payment was
triggered due to a tax return. You need to reverse or cancel payment allocations or tax payments for the following
reasons:
● An incorrect amount was entered for the tax payment.
● A tax payment was mistakenly triggered as a tax prepayment and not due to a monthly tax return (or the other way
round).
● The incorrect tax return was assigned to a tax payment.
● A payment was triggered to a tax authority by mistake and thus mistakenly classified as a tax payment.
You cancel externally initiated tax payments in the Payment Management work center. Then the appropriate payment
also gets the status Canceled in the Tax Management work center. You need to have first reversed an existing payment
allocation [200]. For externally initiated payments for which payment clearing was already performed, you can only
change or reverse an existing payment allocation, or assign it to another bank statement using a new payment allocation.
(Note: Payments that were entered using bank statements are considered as performed and cannot be canceled.) If a
released payment allocation is reversed subsequently, the system automatically generates a new payment allocation
with the status In Preparation and a task in the worklist for payment allocation
You cancel internally initiated tax payments in the Tax Management work center. The referenced payment in Payment
Management work center then gets the status Canceled. Only tax payments with the status Released can be canceled.
You need to reverse tax payments with the status In Preparation.
If you want to cancel or reverse a tax payment initiated due to a tax return, an existing assignment to the tax return
is automatically removed in the Tax Management work center. The status of the relevant tax return is then changed
from Completed to Reported.
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
To enable tax payments to be determined, triggered and entered in the system, you need to have
defined the following settings and master data:
384 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● You have defined the account determination settings in Business Configuration (see also
Automatic Account Determination).
● You have defined the master data for your banks and bank accounts in the Liquidity
Management work center.
Valid for US: For check payments, you need to have defined the data relevant for checks
here.
● You have defined the master data of the tax authority (authorities), bank details, and
standard payment methods (for example, bank transfer or check payment). For more
information, see : Quick Guide for Tax Authorities (Tax Management [363].
● You need to have marked a tax return type that is relevant for tax payments. To do this, go
to the Tax Authorities view under Company Tax Arrangement Tax Return
Arrangement and set the Payment Required indicator for a tax return type relevant for
payment.
Enter a Tax Prepayment (Internally Initiated)
1. Under Common Tasks, choose New Tax Payment. (Alternatively, under Tax Payments,
select New Tax Prepayment).
2. Enter the Tax Return Arrangement and the required data under the Prepayments tab.
3. Choose Release. The system generates an internal payment ID and posts the payment. The
journal entry ID of the created journal entry is displayed now .
4. Now, you find the payment with the status Ready for Transfer in the Payment
Management work center under Payment Monitor.
If the payment has inconsistent data or payment or bank information is missing in the master data
of the tax authority, a task Review Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
As long as your tax prepayment has not been released yet, under the Tax Payments tab you can
assign tax returns to this payment. This payment conversion is only possible for the completeamount.
Additional Notes:
● In Germany, special prepayments are usually cleared with the last advance return for VAT
of the year (usually in December). For this, you enter a date in the December of thecalendar year as the Clearing Due Date.
Special Prepayment Amount (1/11–Payment): To manually calculate the special
prepayment amount, determine the total of the tax prepayments and the special prepayment
of the last year, then divide the total by 11.
● If, contrary to expectations, the company cannot be continued until the end of year but, for
example, only until August and a special prepayment was executed at the start of the year,
the last advance return for VAT takes place in August. To ensure that the special prepayment
is included in this advance return, the time frame selected for the last advance return run
must be August 1 to December 31 (not August 1 to August 31).
Enter a Tax Payment to Clear a Tax Return Directly (InternallyInitiated)
1. Select a tax return with the status Reported to which no tax payment ID has been assigned.
Choose Pay .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 385
2. If necessary, change the payment date and posting date proposed by the system and choose
OK . The payment is assigned an internal number and the status In Preparation. (Tip: To
see the newly assigned Tax Payment ID, you have to reload the current view. Now you can
directly navigate to the tax payment view by using the displayed link.)
A task Approve Tax Payment is sent to your manager.
If the payment has inconsistent data or payment or bank information is missing in the master
data of the tax authority, a task Review Tax Payment is created in your worklist.
3. Once the payment is approved, it receives the status Released. The payment is
automatically entered as a clearing item in the tax register and posted to the appropriate tax
items. A journal entry is generated and the journal entry ID is assigned to the payment.
The tax return has the status Completed. You find the payment with the status Ready for
Transfer in the Payment Management work center under Payment Monitor.
Enter a Bank Transfer to Tax Authority (Externally Initiated)
1. Go to the Payment Management work center and choose Common Tasks New
Outgoing Bank Transfer .
2. Enter the payment and bank data and the payee of your tax authority. Choose Release .
3. The payment is assigned an internal number. You find the payment under Payment
Monitor with the status Ready for Transfer.
4. Under Payment Allocations you find a payment allocation with the status Released using
which the related payment order was automatically confirmed. The payment is automatically
assigned to the Tax Management work center using the specified tax authority.
5. A task Review and Release Tax Payment is sent to the worklist of the Tax Management
work center for this payment. Proceed as described under Task - Review and Release Tax
Payment.
Note: This procedure is the same as for entering an outgoing check. Note here that the system
derives the tax due date from the date of issue of the check. The tax due date determines the
reporting period for this tax item. If the date on which the check leaves the control of the company
differs from the date of issue, you have to manually make a tax correcting entry in the Tax
Management work center under Manual Tax Entries.
Enter a Tax Payment with Manually Created Bank Statement(Externally Initiated)
1. Go to the Liquidity Management work center and choose under Common Tasks New
Bank Statement .
2. Enter the Closing Balance of your bank statement and save your entries.
3. Choose Next to go to the Create and Edit Items phase and choose Add Row . Select
the payment method Outgoing Direct Debit (tax payable) or Incoming Direct Debit (tax
refund), enter the tax authority and the debit or credit amount. Enter all other items of the
bank statement and save your entries.
4. Go to the Review phase and choose Release .
5. You can now find the payment in the Payment Management work center under Payment
Monitor with the status Confirmed. (Note: Payments that were entered with a bank statement
and where the data is consistent, immediately get the status Confirmed upon release.)
386 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
If the payment could not be confirmed, check in the Payment Management work center under
Payment Allocation whether the payment could be correctly assigned to your tax authority
and the appropriate payment allocation has the status Released.
Otherwise you find a task to manually process the payment allocation in your worklist.
6. Finally, switch to the Tax Management work center and select the task Review and Release
Tax Payment in your worklist. Proceed as described under Task - Review and Release Tax
Payment.
Enter a Tax Payment with Uploading a Bank Statement (ExternallyInitiated)
Your bank has sent you a file with bank statement data which also shows a direct debit or a tax
repayment from the tax authority. To transfer the payments of the bank statement into the system,
proceed as follows:
1. Once you have saved the text file for the bank statement locally, go to the Liquidity
Management work center and choose under File Management Inbound
Files New Inbound File .
2. Under File Type, select the valueBank Statement and enter your bank.
3. Choose Add and select the file that you have saved locally.
4. Choose Start File Upload. You receive the message that a new bank statement was created
in the system. You find it under Bank Statements in the status In Preparation. A task to
release the bank statement was created in the worklist.
5. Once you have released the bank statement, you find the payments of the bank statement
in the Payment Management work center under Payment Monitor in the status Confirmed.
If an item of the bank statement could not be assigned, an appropriate task to edit the
payment allocation is created in the worklist.
6. Finally, switch to the Tax Management work center and select the task Review and Release
Tax Payment in your worklist. Proceed as described under Task - Review and Release Tax
Payment.
Processing a Direct Debit Over Multiple Tax Payments (ExternallyInitiated)
If a bank statement has two (or more) tax payments in only one direct debit, the payment
allocation cannot identify the tax payments individually. In this case, you create a bank transfer
to the tax authority for each tax payment so that the tax payments can be individually identified
using the payment allocation, and correctly assigned and entered in the Tax Management work
center. For example, if a direct debit contains two tax payments, proceed as follows:
1. Create two bank transfers in the Payment Management work center under Common
Tasks New Outgoing Bank Transfer .
2. After your manager has approved the task, you find the payments in the payment monitor
with the status Ready for Transfer.
3. For each bank transfer, choose Actions for Bank Transactions → Set to In Transfer. The status
of the bank transfers is set to In Transfer.
4. Select the appropriate payment allocation for editing under Payment Allocations. Under
Payment Allocation, set the filter Bank Transfers, copy the previously entered bank transfers,
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 387
save your entries, and release the payment allocation. The payments receive the status
Confirmed.
5. The payment allocation identifies both bank transfers as tax payments with the tax authority
as payer. A task Review and Release Tax Payment is sent to the Tax Management work
center for each bank transfer.
7.6 Periodic Tasks
7.6.1 Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Return Runs (US)
You can access the Sales and Use Tax Return Runs view from the Tax Management work center under Periodic
Tasks Sales and Use Tax Return Runs .
In this view, you perform VAT return runs to automatically create your sales and use tax returns (as required in the US).
Business Background
In the tax return run, the open tax items from the selected reporting period are derived automatically from the tax register
[315], then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the tax return. As a result of the run,
a sales and use tax return is created in the system.
For more information, see Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Returns (US) [368].
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for the Tax Authorities (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]). You need to have entered your tax information for sales and use tax under
Company Tax Arrangement Tax Numbers , and also under Tax Return
Arrangement.
● In the Product Data work center for the appropriate product under Purchases Tax ,
you have entered the tax jurisdictions and tax exemption reasons for sales and use tax.
● You have entered a valid tax exemption for a product and the respective seller. To do this,
choose the item you want to edit in the Product Data work center and choose View All >
Sales. Select the row of the seller, switch to the Tax tab, and enter the tax data.
● In the Business Partner Data work center, you have entered the tax-relevant data for a
supplier. To do this, select a supplier for editing and choose Financial Data. Go to the Tax
Data tab page. Enter the tax number applicable in the state of the supplier as well as an
existing tax exemption, for example, if the supplier has no business presence (or nexus) in
your state. (Note: For the supplier, you need to specify the use tax in the invoicing document
using explicitly the tax code.)
388 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● In the Business Partner Data work area, you have entered the tax information for use tax
applicable to a customer. To do this, select a customer for editing and choose Financial
Data. Switch to the Tax Data and Tax Exemption Certificate tabs and enter the tax data and
Tax Exemption Reason.
● To display the unreported or reported VAT items for a selected period and the source
documents, you can use the reports Unreported VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT /
Sales Tax Items and All VAT / Sales Tax Items.
Prepare a Tax Return Run
We strongly recommend that you perform the following checks regularly (especially
during quarter-end and year-end closing) and during system implementation, system
changeover, and after changes to the system settings.
1. Run the VAT / Sales Tax Reconciliation report. This report compares the tax data relevant
for the reporting period in the tax register with the tax entries in the general ledger and
analyzes whether any technically related differences have occurred.
2. Check whether open tax items exist with a posting date after the reporting period. You
avoid any balance differences in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, choose the
Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
3. Check whether open tax items exist with a tax due date after the reporting period. You avoid
any balance amounts in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, also choose the Open
VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
4. Determine the tax amount to be cleared for the reporting period. Choose the Open VAT /
Sales Tax Items report and enter the time period for the tax due date.
5. Check which tax amounts were manually overridden and posted in the source documents.
Choose the VAT / Sales Tax Calculation – Details report and enter the reporting period under
Proposed Posting Date. The report calculates the tax amounts using the items in the source
documents and compares them with the tax amounts that were actually posted. If a tax
amount was manually overridden, you can navigate directly in the report to the journal entry
of the relevant tax amount and navigate further to the source document.
For more information, see Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316].
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks New Tax Return Run .
You can also reuse the data of an existing VAT return run. To do this, under Periodic
Tasks Sales and Use Tax Return Runs , select a run and then choose Copy . The
data is copied automatically for the new run and you can adjust it accordingly.
Alternatively, you can use an existing tax return as the basis for a new run. To do this, under
Tax Returns Sales and Use Tax Returns , select a tax return and choose
Actions and Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
Note: We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account during
the run.
To create an amended tax return for a tax return that you have previously submitted to the
tax authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 389
3. To create the tax return run, click Save . The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. To perform the run immediately or schedule it for a later date, it needs to have the status
Active. To do this, choose Activate and perform one of the following actions: ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a tax return, click
Save and Close .
● To perform the run at a later date, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the
Single Run indicator and enter the time entries and choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items were found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
5. Under Tax Returns Sales and Use Tax Returns , you find a new tax return with the
status In Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for Sales and Use Tax Returns
[368].
7.6.2 Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Return Runs (US)
You can access the Withholding Tax Return Runs view from the Tax Management work center under Periodic
Tasks Withholding Tax Return Runs .
In this view, you perform withholding tax return runs to automatically create your withholding tax returns.
Business Background
In the tax return run, the unreported sales relevant for withholding tax from the selected reporting period are selected
automatically from the tax register [315], then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the
tax return. As a result of the run, the system creates a withholding tax return (MISC 1099 - form or file) with the status
In Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for Withholding Tax Returns (US) [372].
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
To be able to create withholding tax returns in the system, you need to have entered the following
settings and master data:
● Check the fine-tuning settings for withholding tax and withholding tax returns in Business
Configuration.
● Under Tax Authorities Company Tax Arrangement , you have set the Withholding
Tax indicator and entered tax-relevant data.
● In the Supplier Base work center, you have entered suppliers with withholding tax
information. To do this, select the relevant supplier and choose Edit Financial Data
Tax Data .
In the Withholding Tax Classification section, define the withholding tax rate type. If for the
US, for example, you do not withhold amounts but report payments in the 1099-MISC, you
select No backup withholding. Else, if you have to withhold a certain percentage, you select
Liable to withholding.
390 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
● You have defined an income type for withholding tax in the Product Data work center. Select
the relevant item for processing under Materials or Services, choose View All, and then
switch to Purchasing Withholding Tax .
● To display the withholding tax base amounts and related invoices for a selected period, you
can use the Withholding Tax Items report.
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks New Tax Return Run .
You can also reuse the data of an existing run. To do this, under Periodic Tasks
Withholding Tax Return Runs , select a run and then choose Copy . The data is copied
automatically for the new run and you can adjust it accordingly.
Alternatively, you can use an existing withholding tax return as the basis for a new run. To
do this, under Tax Returns Withholding Tax Returns , select a tax return and choose
Actions and Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
Note: We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account during
the run.
To create an amended tax return for a withholding tax return that you have previouslysubmitted to the tax authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
3. To create the tax return run, click Save . The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. To perform the run immediately or schedule it for a later date, it needs to have the status
Active. To do this, choose Activate and perform one of the following actions: ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a withholding tax return,
click Save and Close .
● To perform the run at a later date, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the
Single Run indicator and enter the time entries and choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items were found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
5. Under Tax Returns Withholding Tax Returns , you find a withholding tax return with
the status In Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for Withholding Tax
Returns (US) [372].
7.6.3 Quick Guide for VAT Return Runs
You can access the VAT Return Runs view from the Tax Management work center under Periodic Tasks VAT
Return Runs .
In this view, you perform tax return runs or correction runs to automatically create your advance returns for VAT and
annual tax returns.
Business Background
During the run, the system determines the tax items relevant for the selected reporting period from business transactions
and manual tax entries. The Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319] is used for this.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 391
In the tax return run, the open tax items from the selected reporting period are derived automatically from the tax register
[315], then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the tax return. An advance return for
VAT annual VAT return is created in the system as a result of the run.
For more information, see Quick Guide for VAT Returns [372].
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]).
● To display the open or reported sales tax items for a selected period and the sources
documents, you can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales
Tax Items and All VAT / Sales Tax Items.
Prepare a Tax Return Run
We strongly recommend that you perform the following checks regularly (especially
during quarter-end and year-end closing) and during system implementation, system
changeover, and after changes to the system settings. End of the note
1. Run the VAT / Sales Tax Reconciliation report. This report compares the tax data relevant
for the reporting period in the tax register with the tax entries in the general ledger and
analyzes whether any technically related differences have occurred.
2. Check whether open tax items exist with a posting date after the reporting period. You
avoid any balance differences in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, choose the
Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
3. Check whether open tax items exist with a tax due date after the reporting period. You avoid
any balance amounts in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, also choose the Open
VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
4. Determine the tax amount to be cleared for the reporting period. Choose the Open VAT /
Sales Tax Items report and enter the time period for the tax due date.
5. Check which tax amounts were manually overridden and posted in the source documents.
Choose the VAT / Sales Tax Calculation – Details report and enter the reporting period under
Proposed Posting Date. The report calculates the tax amounts using the items in the source
documents and compares them with the tax amounts that were actually posted. If a tax
amount was manually overridden, you can navigate directly in the report to the journal entry
of the relevant tax amount and navigate further to the source document.
For more information, see Example Scenario for Tax Returns [316].
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks New Tax Return Run .
392 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
You can also reuse the data of an existing VAT return run. To do this, under Periodic
Tasks VAT Return Runs , select a run and then choose Copy . The data is copied
automatically for the new run and you can adjust it accordingly.
Alternatively, you can use an existing tax return as the basis for a new run. To do this, under
Tax Returns VAT Returns , select a tax return and choose Actions and
Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
Note: We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account during
the run.
To create an amended tax return for a tax return that you have previously submitted to the
tax authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
3. To create the tax return run, click Save . The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. To perform the run immediately or schedule it for a later date, it needs to have the status
Active. To do this, choose Activate and perform one of the following actions: ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a tax return, click
Save and Close .
● To perform the run at a later date, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the
Single Run indicator and enter the time entries and choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items were found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
5. Under Tax Returns VAT Returns , you find you VAT return with the status In
Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for VAT Returns [372].
7.6.4 Quick Guide for EC Sales List Runs
You can access the EC Sales List Runs view from the Tax Management work center under Periodic Tasks EC
Sales List Runs .
In this view, you perform tax return runs to automatically create your EC sales lists.
Business Background
In the tax return run, the open tax items from the selected reporting period are derived automatically from the tax register
[315], then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the EC sales list. As a result of the
run, the system creates an EC sales list with the status In Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for EC
Sales Lists [374].
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
To enable EC sales lists to be created correctly in the system, you need to have entered the
following settings and master data:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 393
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]). You need to have entered your tax information and the VAT registration
number of the target EU states under Company Tax Arrangement Tax Numbers , and
also under Tax Return Arrangement.
● You have entered a valid tax exemption (due to a reverse charge, for example) for a product
or service. To do this, choose the item you want to edit in the Product Data work center and
choose View All > Sales. Select the row of the distribution chain, switch to the Tax tab,
and enter the tax data and tax exemption reason.
● In the Business Partner Data work center, you have entered the VAT / sales tax information
for a customer. To do this, select a customer for editing and choose Financial Data. Enter
the tax-relevant information under Tax Data.
● To display the reported or open tax items and the source documents for a selected period,
you can use the reports Open VAT / Sales Tax Items, Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items and
All VAT / Sales Tax Items.
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks New Tax Return Run .
You can also reuse the data of an existing run. To do this, under Periodic Tasks EC
Sales List Runs , select a run and then choose Copy . The data is copied automatically
for the new run and you can adjust it accordingly.
Alternatively, you can use an existing EC sales list return as the basis for a new run. To do
this, under Tax Returns EC Sales List Returns , select a tax return and choose
Actions and Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
Note: We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account during
the run.
To create an EC sales list return that you have previously submitted to the tax authority,
set the Correction Run indicator.
3. To create the tax return run, click Save . The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. To perform the run immediately or schedule it for a later date, it needs to have the status
Active. To do this, choose Activate and perform one of the following actions: ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create an EC sales list return,
click Save and Close .
● To perform the run at a later date, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the
Single Run indicator and enter the time entries and choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items were found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
5. Under Tax Returns EC Sales List Returns , you find a new EC sales list return with
the status In Preparation. For more information, see Quick Guide for EC Sales Lists [374].
394 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
7.6.5 Quick Guide for GST Return runs – Australia
In this view, you perform tax return runs or correction runs to automatically create your periodic GST return.
You can access the GST Return Runs subview from the Tax Management work center in the Periodic Tasks view.
Business background
During the run, the system determines the tax items relevant for the selected reporting period from business transactions
and manual tax entries. The Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319] is used for this.
In the tax return run, the open tax items from the selected reporting period are derived automatically from the tax register
[315] , then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the tax return. A periodic return for
GST is created in the system as a result of the run.
For more information, see Quick Guide for GST Returns – Australia [376]
See Also:
● Mass Data Runs (MDR)
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363]).
Check Tax Data
We strongly recommend that you perform the following checks regularly (especially
during quarter-end and year-end closing) and during system implementation, system
changeover, and after changes to the system settings.
1. Run the VAT/Sales Tax Reconciliation report. This report compares the tax data relevant
for the reporting period in the tax register with the tax entries in the general ledger and
analyzes whether any technically related differences have occurred. .
2. Check whether open tax items exist with a posting date after the reporting period. You
avoid any balance differences in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, choose the
Open VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
3. Check whether open tax items exist with a tax due date after the reporting period. You avoid
any balance amounts in the tax accounts with this check. To do this, also choose the Open
VAT / Sales Tax Items report.
4. Determine the tax amount to be cleared for the reporting period. Choose the Open VAT /
Sales Tax Items report and enter the time period for the tax due date.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 395
5. Check which tax amounts were manually overridden and posted in the source documents.
Choose the VAT / Sales Tax Calculation – Details report and enter the reporting period under
Proposed Posting Date. The report calculates the tax amounts using the items in the source
documents and compares them with the tax amounts that were actually posted. If a tax
amount was manually overridden, you can navigate directly in the report to the journal entry
of the relevant tax amount and navigate further to the source document
For more information, see Example Scenario for Tax Returns. [316]
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks → New Tax Return Run. You can also reuse the data of an existing
GST return run. To do this, under Periodic Tasks → GST Return Runs, select a run and then
choose Copy . The data is copied automatically for the new run and you can adjust it
accordingly. Alternatively, you can use an existing tax return as the basis for a new run. To
do this, under Tax Returns → GST Returns, select a tax return and choose Actions and
Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account
during the run.
To create an amended tax return for a tax return that you have previouslysubmitted to the tax authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
3. Choose Save to create the tax return run. The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. Choose Activate and perform one of the following actions : ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a tax return,
choose Save and Close .
● To perform the run later, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the Single
Run indicator and enter the time entries and then choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items are found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
Under Tax Returns → GST Returns, you find your GST return with the status In Preparation. For
more information, see Quick Guide for GST Returns – Australia [376]
7.6.6 Quick Guide for Service Tax Return Runs – India
In this view, you perform Service Tax return runs to create your advance returns automatically for Service Tax and
annual tax returns.
You can access the Service Tax Return Runs subview from the Tax Management work center, Periodic Tasks view.
Business background
During the run, the system determines the tax items relevant for the selected reporting period from business transactions
and manual tax entries. The Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319] is used for this.
396 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
In the tax return run, the open tax items from the selected reporting period are derived automatically from the tax register
[315] , then summarized and assigned with the tax events to the relevant fields in the tax return. A periodic return for
GST is created in the system as a result of the run.
For more information, see Quick Guide for Service Tax Returns — India [378]
See Also:
● Mass Data Runs (MDR)
Tasks
Predefine Settings
● Ensure that you can view the settings for your tax returns in the Business Configuration
under Implementation Projects in the activity Tax Returns for Goods and Services.
● Ensure that you can view the settings for the tax calculation in the Business Configuration
under Implementation Projects in the activity Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that the company data relevant for tax is defined in the Company Tax
Arrangement.
● Ensure that the following data is maintained: ○ Tax Return Arrangements:
This data forms part of the master data of the selected tax authority and includes the
standard settings for submitting your tax returns to the tax authority as well as tax
payments resulting from tax returns.
○ From: / To:With these entries, you specify the period that the system should use for selecting open
tax items.
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Click New and then Tax Return Run.
You can also select a row that applies to an existing run and click Copy . The
data is copied automatically for the new run and you can adjust it accordingly.
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
3. To create the tax return run, click Save . The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. To perform the run immediately or schedule it for a later date, it needs to have the status
Active. To do this, click Activate .
You can now perform the following actions: ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a tax return, click
Schedule and OK. If no open tax items are found in the selected period, then no tax
return is created.
● To perform the run later, (to distribute the system load, for example), click Schedule
and enter the Date and Time.
● To check the validity of the data in your tax return, you can:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 397
○ Check the tax return created with the status In Preparation. You can delete the tax
return with this status if required.
○ Set the Test Run indicator. Note that a tax return created in a test run cannot be
processed further.
● To create an amended tax return for tax data that you previously submitted to the tax
authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
5. To be able to display the new tax return with the status In Preparation, you can: ● Select the row for the affected run in the Service Tax Return Runs view. In the details
that appear below, go to the Execution Details tab and choose the link displayed under
the Tax Return Number.
● Go to the Service Tax Returns view, filter to Tax Returns in Preparation and select your
tax return.
7.6.7 Quick Guide for A-29 Report Runs – Mexico
In this view, you perform the A-29 Report runs to automatically create your A-29 Report as is the legal requirement in
Mexico.
You can access the A-29 Report Runs subview from the Tax Management work center under the Periodic Tasks view.
Business Background
● Tax Due Date of Tax Items [319]
● Quick Guide for A-29 Reports – Mexico [380]
● Mass Data Runs (MDR)
Tasks
Check Predefined Settings and Tax Data
● Check the fine-tuning settings in Business Configuration in the tasks Tax Returns for Goods
and Services and Tax on Goods and Services.
● Make sure that master data is defined for your tax authority (see also Quick Guide for Tax
Authorities [363] ).
Prepare a Tax Return Run
We strongly recommend that you perform the following checks regularly (especially
during quarter-end and year-end closing) and during system implementation, system
changeover, and after changes to the system settings.
1. Run the VAT/Sales Tax Reconciliation report. This report compares the tax data relevant
for the reporting period in the tax register with the tax entries in the general ledger and
analyzes whether any technically related differences have occurred. .
398 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
2. Determine the tax amount to be cleared for the reporting period. Choose the Open VAT /
Sales Tax Items report and enter the time period for the tax due date.
3. Check which tax amounts were manually overridden and posted in the source documents.
Choose the VAT / Sales Tax Calculation – Details report and enter the reporting period under
Proposed Posting Date. The report calculates the tax amounts using the items in the source
documents and compares them with the tax amounts that were actually posted. If a tax
amount was manually overridden, you can navigate directly in the report to the journal entry
of the relevant tax amount and navigate further to the source document
For more information, see Example Scenario for Tax Returns. [316]
Create and Perform a Tax Return Run
1. Choose Common Tasks → New Tax Return Run. You can also reuse the data of an existing
A–29 report run. To do this, under Periodic Tasks → A–29 Report Runs, select a run and then
choose Copy . The data is copied automatically for the new run and you can adjust it
accordingly. Alternatively, you can use an existing tax return as the basis for a new run. To
do this, under Tax Returns → A–29 Reports, select a tax return and choose Actions and
Schedule Tax Return Run for Next Period .
2. Enter the Company Tax Arrangement and the period to be taken into account for the run.
We recommend that you always choose a period from January 1 to the end of the
current reporting period to make sure that all open tax items are taken into account
during the run.
To create an amended tax return for a tax return that you have previouslysubmitted to the tax authority, set the Correction Run indicator.
3. Choose Save to create the tax return run. The system automatically assigns a number to
the run as well as the status In Preparation.
4. Choose Activate and perform one of the following actions : ● To start the run immediately (with status Active) and create a tax return, choose
Save and Close .
● To perform the run later, (to distribute the system load, for example), set the Single
Run indicator and enter the time entries and then choose Save and Close .
If no open tax items are found in the selected period, then no tax return is created.
Under Tax Returns → A–29 Reports, you find your A–29 reports with the status In Preparation.
For more information, see, Quick Guide for A-29 Reports – Mexico [380]
7.7 Reports
7.7.1 Open VAT / Sales Tax Items
You use this report to display the tax receivables and tax payables to be reported for a selected reporting period.
The source for all amounts displayed in the report is the Tax Register [315]. The amounts are shown in tax return currency
and thus can deviate from the transaction currency:
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 399
● Per default the report shows the tax base amounts and the applicable tax amounts. The Applicable Tax Amount is
the actually posted tax amount with deductibility taken into account. The tax base amount is the base amount
directly used for the tax calculation.
● In addition, you can optionally display the following keyfigures or characteristics: ○ Internal Tax Amount: The internal tax amount is automatically calculated when entering the business
transaction or source document.
○ Difference: A difference amount between the internal tax amount and the tax amount.
○ Tax Amount: Amount that was actually posted.
○ Document Amount: Gross amount of the items in the original transaction or source document
○ Exemption Amount: Tax base amount that is exempt from tax.
○ Tax Amount Overridden: If the tax amount was manually changed in the business transaction or source
document and thus differs from the internal tax amount, this indicator is automatically set in the report. To display
the Tax Amount Overridden indicator in the report, you must first drag and drop this field from the Not Currently
Shown section to the Rows section.
To display Internal Tax Amount, Difference, Tax Amount, Document Amount or Exemption Amount in the
report, click on the multiple selection symbol in the left menu area under Columns and add the missing entries.
If your company is a parent company of a tax reporting group you can also display the tax items of the tax
reporting group. To do this, on the selection screen set the Include Subsidiaries Indicator.
For more details you can directly navigate to the line item reports. To do this, click (left mouse button) on an
entry to display the context menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
7.7.2 Reported VAT / Sales Tax Items
You use this report to display for a selected reporting period all reported tax receivables and tax payables as well as
the related tax returns.
The source for all amounts displayed in the report is the Tax Register [315]. The amounts are shown in tax return currency
and thus can deviate from the transaction currency:
● Per default the report shows the tax base amounts and the applicable tax amounts. The Applicable Tax Amount is
the actually posted tax amount with deductibility taken into account. The tax base amount is the base amount
directly used for the tax calculation.
● In addition, you can optionally display the following keyfigures or characteristics: ○ Internal Tax Amount: The internal tax amount is automatically calculated when entering the business
transaction or source document.
○ Difference: A difference amount between the internal tax amount and the tax amount.
○ Tax Amount: Amount that was actually posted.
400 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
○ Document Amount: Gross amount of the items in the original transaction or source document
○ Exemption Amount: Tax base amount that is exempt from tax.
○ Tax Amount Overridden: If the tax amount was manually changed in the business transaction or source
document and thus differs from the internal tax amount, this indicator is automatically set in the report. To display
the Tax Amount Overridden indicator in the report, you must first drag and drop this field from the Not Currently
Shown section to the Rows section.
To display Internal Tax Amount, Difference, Tax Amount, Document Amount or Exemption Amount in the
report, click on the multiple selection symbol in the left menu area under Columns and add the missing entries.
If your company is a parent company of a tax reporting group you can also display the tax items of the tax
reporting group. To do this, on the selection screen set the Include Subsidiaries Indicator.
For more details you can directly navigate to the line item reports. To do this, click (left mouse button) on an
entry to display the context menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
7.7.3 All VAT / Sales Tax Items
You can use this report to display all VAT / sales tax items (that is, all reported and open tax receivables and tax payables,
their tax base amounts, and the underlying source documents) for a selected reporting period.
The source for all amounts displayed in the report is the Tax Register [315]. The amounts are shown in tax return currency
and thus can deviate from the transaction currency:
● Per default the report shows the tax base amounts and the applicable tax amounts. The Applicable Tax Amount is
the actually posted tax amount with deductibility taken into account. The tax base amount is the base amount
directly used for the tax calculation.
● In addition, you can optionally display the following keyfigures or characteristics: ○ Internal Tax Amount: The internal tax amount is automatically calculated when entering the business
transaction or source document.
○ Difference: A difference amount between the internal tax amount and the tax amount.
○ Tax Amount: Amount that was actually posted.
○ Document Amount: Gross amount of the items in the original transaction or source document
○ Exemption Amount: Tax base amount that is exempt from tax.
○ Tax Amount Overridden: If the tax amount was manually changed in the business transaction or source
document and thus differs from the internal tax amount, this indicator is automatically set in the report. To display
the Tax Amount Overridden indicator in the report, you must first drag and drop this field from the Not Currently
Shown section to the Rows section.
To display Internal Tax Amount, Difference, Tax Amount, Document Amount or Exemption Amount in the
report, click on the multiple selection symbol in the left menu area under Columns and add the missing entries.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 401
If your company is a parent company of a tax reporting group you can also display the tax items of the tax
reporting group. To do this, on the selection screen set the Include Subsidiaries Indicator.
For more details you can directly navigate to the line item reports. To do this, click (left mouse button) on an
entry to display the context menu.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
7.7.4 VAT / Sales Tax Calculation Overview
This report is used to compare, at the journal entry level, the proportional tax amount determined against the tax amount
that was actually posted.
For this report, all business transactions are used where the transaction date is within the posting period that you have
specified as the selection parameter for the report. If differences are found, the related journal entry numbers are also
displayed. You can trace the differences displayed in the report back to the journal entry or source document.
The data source for all amounts displayed in the report is the Tax Register [315].
Features
● For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
● You can save the values you specify on the selection screen as a report variant that you can use the next time you
run this report.
● You can use the context menu of selected fields (for example, journal entry ID) to navigate to the journal entry or
journal.
Tax Variances in the Report
The report calculates the tax amounts first based on the journal entries. A tax difference is displayed in the report when
the calculated tax amount differs from the tax amount posted. The internal tax amount is already calculated by the
system when you enter the business transaction. If the internal tax amount was manually changed in the business
transaction and thus differs from the amount posted, the Tax Amount Overridden indicator is set in the report.
For journal entries that were created in a previous release, no values are displayed under Internal Tax
Amount.
To display the internal tax amounts for any existing differences, you first need to show the appropriate column in the
report. To do this, in the left menu area under Columns, click on the multiple selection symbol and copy the entry Internal
Tax Amount.
You check an Internal Tax Amount that differs from the Posted Tax Amount by choosing the context menu (left mouse
button) for the selected amount and switching to the source document by choosing Journal Entry. Check the tax data
and reverse the entry, if necessary, or perform a correcting entry.
You can enter tax amounts manually in the following transactions and journal entry vouchers:
402 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
Work Center Transaction or Journal Entry Voucher
Payables, Receivables Invoice/credit memoManual entry of a receivable/payable
Supplier Invoice Supplier Invoice
Payment Management Payment allocationIncoming cash payment/outgoing cash paymentIncoming check/outgoing checkOutgoing bank transferOutgoing wire transfer
Travel and Expenses, Costs and Revenues Expense report
Tax Management Manual tax entry
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
7.7.5 Withholding Tax Items
You can use this report to display all payments relevant for withholding tax for a specified period. The display includes
the underlying invoices, the withholding tax amounts, and the tax base amounts relating to each payment. With the
default settings, the values are displayed in the currency of the withholding tax return. For this report, the tax register
serves as the source of data for the withholding tax amounts and the tax base amounts.
Before withholding tax reports can be created, you must make the following settings for master data:
● Supplier Base work center:
You need to have stored suppliers with data relevant for withholding tax. For this, you choose Common Tasks → New
Supplier. Choose View All to switch to Financial Data → Tax Data. Enter the tax number, the withholding tax
classification, and an existing tax exemption.
● Product Data work center:
You need to mark the products and services from suppliers as relevant to withholding tax so that the system can
automatically determine the withholding tax data for these products and services and copy it into the withholding
tax return. For this, select the relevant item for processing under Services or Materials and then switch to Purchasing
→ Withholding Tax.
Features
When you have run the report, default values are displayed for the required entry fields in the selection screen. Make
any necessary changes.
See Also
● Reports View
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Tax Management PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 403
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
404 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Tax Management
8 Travel and Expenses
8.1 Business Background
8.1.1 Travel Advances
Overview
You can provide your employees with travel advances for upcoming business trips. When the employee returns from
the trip and submits the actual travel expenses for reimbursement, the advance is deducted from the reimbursement
amount.
This document describes the preparatory steps required in business configuration and the steps in the process itself.
Only the basic process is described, since the exact procedure differs from company to company.
Prerequisites
To enable the use of advances, log on to the Business Configuration work center as a key user and perform the following
steps:
Create a clearing account for advances
1. In the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center, go to the Fine-Tune phase.
2. In the Financial and Management Accounting area, choose Chart of Accounts, Financial Reporting Structures,
Account Determination > Edit Chart of Accounts.
Check whether the chart of accounts that you want to use contains an account for advances. If no such account
exists, create a new account for advances with open item management in the required chart of accounts. For
more information on editing charts of accounts, see Display and Edit Charts of Accounts.
3. Choose Edit Financial Reporting Structures. Under Financial Reporting Structures, add the new account to your
reporting structure.
4. Choose Maintain Account Determination Group. Go to General Ledger > Account Determination > Costs, and set
the indicator for use in the expense report.
5. Select the account determination profile. In the detail screen for costs, go to the General Costs tab.
Add the Account Determination Group for General Costs and assign to this the account for advances. Note the
name (alias code) of the account determination group. For more information, see Automatic Account Determination.
Create a receipt type for advances
1. In the Activity List view of the Business Configuration work center, go to the Fine-Tune step.
2. Select the Cash Flow Management business area.
3. Choose Expense Reporting > Edit Receipt Types.
4. Create a receipt type named Advance and enter the required data.
5. Assign the receipt type to an expense reimbursement group so that its usage is restricted to a particular group of
employees.
6. Assign the name listed for the account determination group (alias code) to the Expense receipt type.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 405
Check the expense arrangement
To make sure an employee can use the new expense type, check the employee’s expense arrangement in the Business
Configuration and change the expense reimbursement group if necessary.
Process Flow
Once you have completed the above fine-tuning steps, you can create and process advances as follows:
Creating an advance
A travel advance can be applied for by an employee or by an expense clerk on the employee's behalf:
1. If you are the expense clerk, in the Travel and Expenses work center, go to the Expense Reports view.
2. Choose New. In the dropdown list, choose Expense Report on Behalf.
3. Enter the employee’s data, the type of expense report, the business purpose, and the start and end dates. Then
enter a receipt with the receipt type Advance and the amount of the advance.
4. Click Confirm to finish.
Approving an advance
Managers perform the following steps to approve an advance:
1. In the Managing My Area work center, go to the Approval view.
2. Select an advance and click Approve. This generates a payable to the employee and posts the expense in the
general ledger.
Paying out an advance
For the accountant to pay out an advance to an employee, either manually or by means of an automatic payment run,
follow these steps:
1. In the Payables work center, go to either the Suppliers view (for a manual payment) or the Periodic Tasks view (for
an automatic payment run).
2. The advance can now be paid out to the employee in the standard payment process for payables.
Submitting actual travel expenses after a business trip
To submit your actual travel expenses after returning from a business trip:
1. In the Travel and Expenses work center, go to the Expense Reports view.
2. Open the expense report for editing and go to the Receipts tab.
3. Delete the advance from the list of receipts and enter the actual expenses.
4. Go to the Review tab. The recalculated payment and the open reimbursement amount are displayed.
Approving the reimbursement
After the travel expense clerk has checked the expense report, the employee’s manager performs the following steps
to approve the reimbursement. The expense clerk or accounts payable clerk then triggers the payout to the employee.
1. From the Travel and Expenses work center, go to the Managing My Area work center.
2. Go to the Approval view.
406 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
3. Approve the reimbursement. This generates a payable to the employee for the open reimbursement amount and
books the expense in the general ledger. The reimbursement is then paid out as a manual payment or in a payment
run.
If the travel expenses are less than the amount of the travel advance, the system generates a receivable for
the difference. This receivable is then applied against the employee’s next expense report.
If an expense report is created for a date in the future, the reimbursement rates are deactivated.
8.1.2 Review and Approval of Expense Reports
Overview
SAP Business ByDesign System supports the complete expense reporting and reimbursement process. This includes
creating an expense report, reviewing and approving it, as well as paying out the reimbursement amount. Depending
on the scenario, the roles and the configuration settings, different approval workflows are possible.
Prerequisites
The standard settings in the business configuration define a review of an expense report by the expense clerk and the
approval by the responsible line manager, cost center manager or project responsible. Additionally you can define
threshold amounts for a review or an approval of the expense report, so that the system only triggers a review or an
approval when the expense report exceeds a given amount.
If an approval is defined, a dual control is also in place. This means that the approver of an expense report cannot be
the same person that created it. An exception of this principle exists only for those employees who are the responsible
manager, cost center manager or project responsible. They can approve their own expense reports. If an additional
control is wanted for these managers, an alternative approver has to be set up in the Application and User
Management work center. There you first assign the work center Managing my Area to the employee you want as
alternative approver, and then restrict the employee's authorization to the respective company in the same work center
under Task Distribution > Employee Work Distribution.
Features
The following table shows the standard approval workflows that are in place for the different combinations of
configuration settings, role of the expense reporter and work center used:
Approval Workflows
BusinessConfiguration
Scenario Every employee inthe Home workcenter > EmployeeSelf-Services(ESS)
Expense clerk inthe Travel andExpenses workcenter
Manager, costcenter manager orproject responsiblein the Managingmy Area workcenter
Payablesaccountant in thePayables workcenter
With approval Employee reports hisown travel expenses inHome work center withESS
Creates and saves Reviews Approves Pays
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 407
With approval Expense clerk reportsexpenses on behalf of acolleague in Travel andExpenses work center
Creates, saves,reviews
Approves Pays
With approval Expense clerk reportsown expenses in Homework center with ESS
Creates, saves,and reviews
Approves Pays
With approval Manager reportsexpenses for anemployee in theManaging my Area workcenter
Reviews andrevises, ifnecessary
Creates andapproves
Pays
With approval Manager reports ownexpenses with ESS
Reviews andrevises, ifnecessary
Approves Pays
Without managerapproval
Employee reports ownexpenses in Home workcenter with ESS
Creates and saves Reviews Pays
Dual control Expense clerk reportsown expenses in Homework center with ESS
Creates and saves Approves Pays
Approvaldepending onthresholdamount forexpense report
Employee reports ownexpenses in Home workcenter with ESS
Creates and saves Reviews Approves, ifexpense reportamount exceedsthreshold
Pays
Reviewdepending onthresholdamount forexpense report
Employee reports ownexpenses in Home workcenter with ESS
Creates and saves Reviews, ifexpense reportamount exceedsthreshold
Pays
No review, noapproval
Employee reports ownexpenses in Home workcenter with ESS
Creates and saves Pays
8.1.3 Rule of 183 - Austria
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose Austria. Save
your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
8.1.4 Rule of 5/5/15 - Austria
This document contains text that is relevant for Austria. To ensure that the system displays the correct text,
select Personalize My Settings . Select Onscreen Help and, under Country, choose Austria. Save
your settings and logout to ensure these changes are made.
408 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
8.1.5 Nonmonetary Compensation - Germany
Overview
Employment income that is paid in forms other than money (such as free meals) is called nonmonetary compensation.
Nonmonetary compensation is treated as imputed income for tax purposes. Any compensation that an employee
receives in the form of free meals is treated as income to which employment and social insurance apply. The value of
nonmonetary compensation is set by law in the Ordinance Regulating the Value of Nonmonetary Compensation
(Sachbezugsverordnung).
Nonmonetary compensation does not reduce the meals per diems that employees receive on business trips.
In the expense report there is a Free Meals link where you can enter meals per diem deductions in cases
where employees receive free meals during a business trip. The link is only visible if you have defined
corresponding company-specific deductions in configuration.
Features
Nonmonetary compensation is entered by employees in their expense reports. You can handle nonmonetary
compensation in the following ways:
● Nonmonetary compensation is automatically transferred to the employee's payroll and taxed there.
● Employees must pay tax on nonmonetary compensation themselves.
● You deduct the nonmonetary compensation from the reimbursement amount so that it does not have to be taxed.
Taxation of Nonmonetary Compensation
To ensure that the nonmonetary compensation is taxed, you enter the values for free meals as receipts.
SAP provides the following receipt types for this purpose:
● Nonmonetary Compensation for Breakfast, Taxable Benefit
● Nonmonetary Compensation for Lunch, Taxable Benefit
● Nonmonetary Compensation for Dinner, Taxable Benefit
Taxable benefits are treated as wages for tax purposes, which increases the employee's taxable income.
If you want the employee to pay tax on the nonmonetary compensation, you can use these receipt types for that purpose.
If your solution scope includes Payroll, the system transfers these amounts to Payroll automatically. If Payroll is not part
of your solution scope, you need to take steps to ensure that the employee pays tax on these amounts.
Deduction of Nonmonetary Compensation from Reimbursement Amounts
You can enter nonmonetary compensation as deductions in the following ways:
● Define separate deduction receipt types for nonmonetary compensation in configuration
If you want to use nonmonetary compensation amounts as deductions, define three new receipt types: ○ Nonmonetary compensation for breakfast, deduction
○ Nonmonetary compensation for lunch, deduction
○ Nonmonetary compensation for dinner, deduction
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 409
To do this, proceed as follows:
1. In the Business Configuration work center under Activity List > Fine-Tuning > Cash Flow Management, select
the Expense Reports Germany activity.
2. Choose the Edit Receipt Types link.
3. Add the receipt type Nonmonetary compensation for breakfast, deduction.
4. Make the following settings: ● Definition tab:
○ Expense Category column: Other
○ Taxation column: Domestic purchase (exempt)
○ Payment and Taxation column: Reimbursement amount (payment, no taxation)
● Expense Reimbursement Groups tab: Add the Employees and Managers groups.
● Maximum Amounts tab: For each expense reimbursement group, enter the value of -1.50 EUR (2008)
and in the Reaction column select the option No reaction (amount is default value).
● Account Determination tab: Add an account determination group and select an account in the Account
Determination Group for Expense Account column.
5. Add the receipt types Nonmonetary compensation for lunch, deduction and Nonmonetary
compensation for dinner, deduction. Proceed as described above, but on the Maximum Amounts tab
enter a value of -2.67 EUR (2008).
The receipt types you define are then available in Expense Reports with the corresponding default values.
You can remove the receipt types delivered by SAP from the Receipt Type value help offered for
selection in Expense Reports by delimiting their validity in the following way:
1. In the Available Receipt Types table, select the receipt type to be removed.
2. In the Details section, on the Definitions tab, click Add Row to make the Valid To date of the
selected receipt type editable. Otherwise it is a read-only field.
3. Enter a new Valid To date for the selected receipt type to delimit it as of the date you require.
4. Select the new row you added below this and delete it.
● Enter as Other Expenses in Expense Reports
As a temporary solution, you can use the receipt type Other Expenses with a negative value.
This deduction reduces the reimbursement amount, not the meals per diem. This is necessary because a
deduction is needed even if the meals per diem is 0.00 EUR (if the employee was traveling for less than eight
hours).
8.2 Expense Reports View
8.2.1 Expense Reports Quick Guide
You can access the Expense Reports view from the Travel and Expenses work center.
This view gives you a central location for managing and reviewing expense reports. You can then submit these expense
reports for management approval and subsequent reimbursement. In addition to creating your own travel or other
expenses reports, you can create these reports on behalf of other employees.
410 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
Business Background
For a complete overview of the scenario and its single process steps, see Expense and Reimbursement Business
Scenario.
The system supports the complete expense reporting and reimbursement process of creating an expense report,
reviewing and approving it, as well as paying out the reimbursement amount to the employee. Depending on the
scenario, the roles and the configuration settings, different approval workflows are possible, see Expense Report Review
and Approval [407].
Expense and reimbursement also allows to pay out travel advances for upcoming business trips. For more information,
see
Travel Advances [405].
Employment income that is paid in forms other than money (such as free meals) is called nonmonetary compensation.
Nonmonetary compensation is treated as imputed income for tax purposes. Any compensation that an employee
receives in the form of free meals is treated as income to which employment and social insurance apply. The value of
nonmonetary compensation is set by law in the Ordinance Regulating the Value of Nonmonetary Compensation
(Sachbezugsverordnung). For more information, see Nonmonetary Compensation — Germany [409].
Tasks
Create a New Expense Report
The New Expense Report guided activity allows you to record your business expenses in the
system, so you can be reimbursed by your company. The guided activity allows you to create
reports for travel, weekly, or other expenses. To complete an expense report, you enter the details
of the expenses incurred, attach your receipts, and review the details you entered. The report is
then sent for review by an expense clerk, and approval by the appropriate manager. Once the
report has been approved, the reimbursement is processed. For more information, see Create a
New Expense Report.
Create a New Expense Report on Behalf
The New Expense Report guided activity allows you to record business expenses in the system
for a colleague, so they can be reimbursed by your company. The guided activity allows you to
create expense reports for travel, weekly, or other expenses. To complete an expense report,
you enter the details of the expenses incurred, attach your receipts, and review the details you
entered. The report is then sent for approval by the appropriate manager. Once the report has
been approved, the reimbursement is processed. For more information, see Create a New
Expense Report on Behalf [412].
Create a Travel Request Using an Expense Report
In cases where you want to submit a travel request before your trip, because you need approval
by your manager or because you need travel advances, you can create an expense report for
this purpose. For details on the prerequisites for advance payments, see Travel advances
[405].
1. Go to the Expense Reports view and click New .
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 411
2. Enter Business Trip as the type of expense report, a business purpose, and the start and
end dates.
3. You do not need to enter any receipts. If necessary, you can enter receipts for advance
payments. You should not enter other receipts because that would result in reimbursements
being generated, which is not wanted in this case.
4. Finish the expense report and click Close .
The expense report is saved and the review and approval process is started.
8.2.2 Create New Expense Report on Behalf
Overview
The New Expense Report on Behalf guided activity allows you to record business expenses in the system for a colleague,
so they can be reimbursed by your company. The guided activity allows you to create expense reports for travel, weekly,
or other expenses. To complete an expense report, you enter the details of the expenses incurred, attach your receipts,
and review the details you entered. The report is then sent for approval by the appropriate manager. Once the report
has been approved, the reimbursement is processed. .
Procedure
1. In the Expense Reports view of the Travel and Expenses work center you select New Expense Report on Behalf.
The New Expense Report screen opens and you are first prompted to enter the employee ID. Click Next to display
the other entry fields.
2. To specify the type of expense report and to enter the general information associated with the expense report, click
the drop-down arrow next to the Type of Expense Report field, then choose an expense report type.
● If you choose Business Trip from the drop-down list, the system automatically displays fields associated with
the report type, including business purpose, dates and location, and mileage. Enter details in those fields, then
click Next to go to the next step.
● For some countries, you can choose Period-based report (receipt and mileage reimbursement) from the drop-
down list. The system allows you to enter several trips as well as other business expenses. It automatically
displays fields associated with the report type, including business purpose, dates, and mileage. Enter details in
those fields, then click Next to go to the next step
● If you choose Receipts only from the drop-down list, the system automatically displays fields associated with
the report type, including business purpose and comments.
Depending on your selection the entry screen is adapted.
3. For a business trip you must enter at least a Business purpose, start date and country. It is possible to use the
function Copy data from other expense report to fill in all data that match a prior trip.
4. To change the standard cost assignment defined in the employee master data for this expense report, click Edit Cost
Assignment to open the cost assignment dialog.
5. With a click on Add Row two entry fields appear, where you can enter a percentage and an account assignment
type such as cost center, project, sales order. Use the value help to select the appropriate account assignment
type from the list.
6. When you select an account assignment type, the system automatically offers you the corresponding entry fields for
this type, so that you can enter further details of your cost assignment.
412 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
if you select Sales Order, for example, you will be able to enter the sales order and sales order item. If you select
the account assignment type project task, you will be able to enter the project task. To select the project task, you
can use the value help for this field. As a standard it shows all project tasks to which the employee is assigned directly
or indirectly, including project tasks performed for the buying company. If you enter such a project task, the system
automatically finds the corresponding intercompany project, purchase order, and purchase order item and displays
these under Intercompany Information. If you want to see a wider range of available project tasks, you have to use
the Advanced search. Here you can delete the Employee ID and use only the Company ID to search all available
project tasks.
7. Click Next to go to the Receipts step.
8. In the Receipts step under Expense Receipts, click Add Row to add a receipt. The system automatically assigns a
receipt ID number in the ID field. In the Receipt Type field, click the value help and choose a receipt type. The system
automatically displays fields associated with the receipt type. Enter details in those fields. In the Receipt Amount
field, enter the receipt amount and select a currency.
9. If you want to add attachments for the individual receipts you have entered, go to the Attachments tab in the
Receipts step and click Add .
You need to decide how you want to attach your receipts.
● If you choose File, the Add File dialog box displays. Browse for the file you want to upload and click
Add . Click Next to go to the next step.
● If you choose Link, the Add Link dialog box displays. Enter the details associated with the link and
select Add. Click Next to go to the next step.
10
.
In the Attachments step, on the General Attachments tab, you can add any other general attachments as required.
Go to the Attachments Overview tab to display an overview of all attachments added.
11
.
After you have reviewed the details, expenses, and receipts you have entered, save your expense report to the
system. Your new expense report is saved to the system, and sent for review and approval.
Example
Jack Ingersoll has received expense details from a colleague who is currently on vacation. Jack needs to create an
expense report for his colleague so they can be reimbursed. To begin creating the expense report for his colleague,
Jack opens the New Expense Report on Behalf guided activity and begins to enter the employee and expense details.
Once he has added all the expenses, he attaches the relevant receipts, and reviews his entries. He then saves the
expense report, which is sent for approval by the relevant manager for his colleague, who receives the reimbursement
in due course, once the expense report has been approved.
8.3 Expense Arrangements View
8.3.1 Expense Arrangements Quick Guide
You can access the Expense Arrangements view from the Travel and Expenses work center.
In this view you can maintain central settings that define the reimbursement entitlements for employees. Each employee
is assigned an expense arrangement and these arrangements define their expense reporting entitlement. Expense
arrangements are valid for a defined period of time. Expense reporting only works when a valid arrangement exists for
the time period of the trip.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 413
Tasks
Create New Expense Arrangement
1. In the Expense Arrangement view you click New and then Expense Arrangement. The
expense arrangement screen opens.
2. Enter the employee data. In the Validity Assignment section you can add a new set and
assign the appropriate validity.
3. Under Details, you can assign an Expense Reimbursement Group for receipts from the
predefined groups available, depending on what receipt types the employee should be
authorized to see and submit. For example: ● All: Employees assigned to this group are authorized to see and submit all receipt types.
● Restricted: Employees assigned to this group are authorized for only a limited set of
receipt types.
4. In the Cost Assignment section you can change or delete available cost assignments or add
a new one.
5. In the Bank Details section you can choose from available bank details and select a payment
method. If no payment method is selected, the standard payment method is used by the
system.
Edit Expense Arrangement
1. In the Expense Arrangement view you select an existing expense arrangement from the list
and click Edit . The expense arrangement screen opens.
2. In the Validity Assignment section you will see the available sets for this expense
arrangement which you can either restrict in validity or activate. You can also add a new set
here and assign the appropriate validity.
3. In the Cost Assignment section you can change or delete available cost assignments or add
a new one.
4. In the Bank Details section you can choose from available bank details and select a payment
method. If no payment method is selected, the standard payment method is used by the
system.
8.4 Expense Settlement Recalculation View
8.4.1 Quick Guide for Expense Settlement Recalculation Runs
You can access the Expense Settlement Recalculation Runs view from the Travel and Expenses work center under
Exception Handling.
This view enables you to manage and review reports of expenses that are already settled. If, for example, legal changes
for reimbursement rates are issued too late and are consequently not delivered by SAP, expense reports may contain
outdated reimbursement rates. You can use the Expense Settlement Recalculation run to recalculate the affected
expense reports after the legal changes have been implemented.
414 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
The system recalculates all expense reports for a given period and independent of their status. The results are then
sent to the financial accounting for posting and to payroll for payout.
The Exception Handling view does not exist for the United States, as expense reimbursement is based on
receipts.
Business Background
You can find more information about automatic mass processing in Mass Data Runs (MDR).
8.5 Mileage Accumulation View
8.5.1 Mileage Accumulation Quick Guide
You can access the Mileage Accumulation view from the Travel and Expenses work center under Exception Handling.
In this view, you can see the mileage and reimbursement accumulation of an employee. You can also set the initial
value for mileage accumulation and reimbursement amount accumulation for an employee.
Tasks
Set Initial Value for Mileage Accumulation
1. Open the Mileage Accumulation view and select an employee from the given list. Click
View to open the Mileage Accumulation Overview quick activity.
If the employee is not in the list, click New to open the New Mileage
Accumulation quick activity. Enter the employee ID and click Save and Close to
add him to the list of employees.
2. Click Set Mileage to Initial Value and enter the relevant details and then click OK . Click
Close to return to the Mileage Accumulation subview.
The initial value for your mileage accumulation is set in the system and will be taken into account
for all expense settlements of this employee.
This functionality is valid for the following countries:
● UK
● France
● Canada
● Switzerland
Set Initial Value for Reimbursement Amount Accumulation
1. Open the Mileage Accumulation view and select an employee from the given list. Click
View to open the Mileage Accumulation Overview quick activity.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 415
2. Click Set Reimbursement Amount to Initial Value and enter the relevant details and then click
OK . Click Close to return to the Mileage Accumulation view.
The initial value for your reimbursement accumulation is set in the system and will be taken
into account for all expense settlements of this employee.
This functionality is valid for Austria only.
8.6 Day Accumulation View
8.6.1 Quick Guide for Day Accumulation - Austria
In this view, you can see the total accumulated days for business trips to various communities in Austria for an employee.
You can also set the initial value for day accumulation for an employee.
You can access the Day Accumulation subview from the Travel and Expenses work center under the Exception
Handling view.
background
● Rule of 5/5/15 - Austria [408]
● Rule of 183 - Austria [408]
Task
Create Business Trip History
1. Open the Day Accumulation view and select an employee from the given list. Click View
to open the Day Accumulation Overview quick activity.
If the employee is not in the list, click New to open the New Day Accumulation
quick activity. Enter the employee ID and click Save and Close to add the
employee to the list of employees.
2. Click Create Business Trip History and enter the relevant details and then click OK . Click
Save to save the changes. Click Close to return to the Day Accumulation subview.
The initial value for your day accumulation for each community is set in the system and will be
taken into account for all expense settlements of this employee.
416 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
8.7 Reports
8.7.1 Expense Reports By Cost Object
Overview
This report provides an overview of cost distribution for travel and other expenses for different cost centers, projects,
sales orders, and service orders.
Views
This report offers you the following views:
By Cost Center (default)
Shows the expense reports by grouped by cost center.
By Project
Shows the expense reports grouped by project as well as the total expenses for each employee by project.
By Sales Order
Shows the expense reports grouped by sales order as well as the total expenses for each sales order.
By Service Order
Shows the expense reports grouped by service order as well as the total expenses for each employee by service order.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Country
The country that was the destination of the trip.
● Created On
The date range in which the expense reports were created.
● Expense Report Category
The following categories are available: ○ Trip-Based: The expense report is for a single business trip.
○ Receipt-Based: The expense report contains receipts only.
○ Period-Based: The expense report is for expenses that were incurred during a particular period of time, such
as a week or month. This category can only be selected if you specified US01 - US settlement as the country
of reporting.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 417
● Expense Report Start Date
The date on which the business trip began. This variable is only relevant if you have selected Trip-Based or Period-
Based as the Expense Report Category. Receipt-based expense reports do not have an expense report start date.
● Expense Report ID
If you want to restrict the displayed data to particular expense reports, enter their IDs here.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report shows the expense reports created by your employees, along with the relevant cost centers, projects, sales
orders or service orders. An expense report is listed under more than one cost center if the expenses affect multiple
cost centers. Duration is the length of the business trip in days.
The Posted Amount is the amount that is posted and assigned to the cost center, project, sales order or service order.
Note that this amount includes VAT.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the relevant expense report with the secondary mouse button and
choose Goto > Display Details from the context menu.
By default, the data is displayed grouped by cost center. You can also view the data grouped by project: Drag the
Project characteristic to the table as a column to the left of Employee.
To restrict the data to a single cost center, choose Filter > Choose Filter Value and enter the cost center.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.2 Expense Reports – Overview
Overview
This report provides an overview of the expense reports created by your employees or expense clerks in a selected
period.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
418 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Created On
The date on which the expense reports were created.
● Expense Report Category
The following categories are available: ○ Trip-Based: The expense report is for a single business trip.
○ Receipt-Based: The expense report contains receipts only.
○ Period-Based: The expense report is for expenses that were incurred during a particular period of time, such
as a week or month. This category can only be selected if you specified US01 - US settlement as the country
of reporting.
● Expense Report Start Date
The date on which the business trip began. This variable is only applicable if you selected Trip-Based or Period-
Based as the Expense Report Category.
● Expense Report ID
If you want to restrict the displayed data to particular expense reports, enter their IDs here.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
You can save the values you specify on the selection screen as a report variant that can be used to run exactly the
same report again in the future.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays expense reports created by your employees, along with details such as the expense amounts
claimed and the employee names.
The settlement amount includes all expenses, including those that were paid by the company in advance. Note that
this amount includes VAT.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To add additional details to the content area of this report as columns, select an expense report with the secondary
mouse button and choose Attributes > Characteristic. On the Attributes tab, select the attribute you want to add and
choose Add and OK.
To display further details of an expense report, use the secondary mouse button and choose Goto -> DisplayDetails. The expense report opens.
From this report, you can navigate to the Receipts and Reimbursements report which contains additional details such
as the reimbursement amount, the receipt type, and the amount that was prepaid by the company. To open this report,
select an item with the secondary mouse button and choose Goto > Receipts and Reimbursements in the context
menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 419
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.3 Expense Reports – Receipts and Reimbursements
Overview
This report displays details of the expense reports created by your employees.
The details include the receipt types for each settlement and the reimbursements.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Created On
The date range in which the expense reports were created.
● Expense Report Start Date
The date on which the business trip began. This variable is only relevant if you have selected Trip-Based or Period-
Based as the Expense Report Category. Receipt-based expense reports do not have an expense start date.
● Expense Report Category
The following categories are available: ○ Trip-Based: The expense report is for an individual business trip.
○ Receipt-Based: The expense report contains receipts for miscellaneous expenses only.
○ Period-Based: The expense report is for expenses that were incurred during a particular time period, such as
a week or month. This category can only be selected if you specified US01 - US settlement as the country of
reporting.
● Expense Report ID
If you want to restrict the displayed data to one or more expense reports, you can specify the expense report IDs
here.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The settlement amount includes all expenses, including those that were paid by the company in advance. The
reimbursement amount is the amount reimbursed to the employee who claimed the expenses.
These amounts include value-added tax.
To analyze the data in this report:
420 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
● Use the filters to manipulate how the data is displayed in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the expense report with the secondary mouse button and choose
Goto -> Display Details from the context menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.4 Expense Reports - Taxable and Tax-Exempt Amounts for Payroll
Overview
This report displays the reimbursed expenses based on taxability.
The data is divided into tax-exempt amounts, taxable benefits, amounts taxable at a flat rate, and income-related
expenses.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you can specify the data you want to see by making value selections for variables. You must
make a value selection for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Changed On
If an expense report is changed after the taxable reimbursements have been processed in payroll, the payroll results
for the employee need to be recalculated.
● Expense Report ID
If you want to restrict the selection to one or more particular expense reports, enter the expense report IDs here.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays the expense reports that contain tax-relevant reimbursements, and a breakdown of the tax details
for those reports. The following amounts are displayed:
● Payout to EmployeeAmount reimbursed to the employee based on the expense report.
● Tax-Exempt Amount
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 421
Amount on which no taxes are due.
● Taxable BenefitExpense reimbursed to the employee that exceeds the tax-exempt amount. Taxable benefits are treated as wages
for tax purposes, which increases the employee's taxable income.
● Taxable at Flat RateThis amount is taxed at a fixed percentage defined by the local tax authority. In Germany, for example, meals per
diem are taxed at a flat rate if the reimbursement amount is no more than twice the tax-exempt amount.
● Income-Related ExpensesThis amount reduces the employee's taxable income. Per diems and reimbursements are tax-exempt up to a legal
limit. If the company's expense reimbursement rates are less than the tax-exempt amount, employees can deduct
the difference in their tax returns as income-related expenses, which reduces their taxable income.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate how the data is displayed in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the expense report with the secondary mouse button and choose
Goto -> Display Details from the context menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.5 Expense Reports – Input VAT Refund
Overview
This report provides an overview of expenses that include tax, such as VAT, and that are incurred by your employees
during a business trip abroad.
Your company can request reimbursement of these taxes from the foreign tax authority.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Country
422 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
The country in which the expenses were incurred.
● Receipt Date
The date of the receipt.
● Receipt Type
You can select the receipt type, such as Hotel or Taxi.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays expenses that were paid in a foreign country. It also shows the total amount for each receipt type.
You can use this information to submit requests for reimbursement of taxes from foreign tax authorities.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate the display of data in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the relevant expense report with the secondary mouse button and
choose Goto > Display Details from the context menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.6 Expense Reports – Itinerary
Overview
This report provides an overview of business trips undertaken by your employees and is based on destination.
Shows only expense reports for business trips, but not including expense reports that contain receipts only.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Country of Reporting
The country of reporting is the country in which your company is located. For a company in the United States, for
example, you select US01 - US settlement.
● Country
The country that was the destination of the trip.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 423
● City
The city that was the destination of the trip.
● Created On
The date on which the expense reports were created.
● Arrival Date
The date of arrival at the destination city.
● Expense Report ID
If you want to restrict the displayed data to one or more particular expense reports, enter their IDs here.
This report displays the destinations of your employees. If you want to see all employees who traveled to an event such
as a trade fair, specify a City and enter an Arrival Date Range.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
This report displays the destinations of the business trips. To further analyze data in this report, you can include in the
display additional characteristics from the Not Shown Currently area.
To display further details of an expense report, click the expense report and choose Display Expense Report from the
context menu.
To view the itinerary of the individual business trips, drag the Employee and Expense Report ID columns to the left. This
enable you to see the data arranged by business trip and the itineraries with all destinations of the individual business
trips.
See Also
● Reports View
● Overview of Reports in Financial Management
● Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.7 Expense Reports - Overview of Trips to Communities in Austria
Overview
This report provides a list of business trips that employees make to the different communities in Austria. You can use
this report to check the accuracy of the taxable and tax-exempt values.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below:
● Municipality ID
A number sequence for the identification of politically independent municipalities or communities in Austria.
● Expense Report ID
424 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
The unique identifier for an expense report.
If you want to restrict the selection to one or more particular expense reports, enter the expense report IDs here.
● Trip Within the Same Week
Indicates whether the employee has traveled to one particular community within the same week.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management .
Analyzing the Report
● Duration of Stay (Days)
Indicates the number of days an employee stays in a community in Austria
● Interval Between Stays (Days)
Specifies the time interval between two trips to the same community in Austria.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate how the data is displayed in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the expense report with the secondary mouse button and choose
Goto -> Display Details from the context menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
Reports View
Overview of Reports in Financial Management
Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
8.7.8 Expense Reports - Taxable and Tax-Exempt Amounts for Austria
Overview
This report displays a list of taxable and tax-exempt amounts. The tax-exempt values shown in the report can be
considered as income-related expenses and the employee can ask the tax authority for tax exemption. This is decided
by the employer based on § 16 para 19 Income Tax Act 1988.
Features
Running the Report
Before running the report, you specify the data you want to see by selecting values for variables. You must specify a
value for all mandatory variables. In the system, mandatory variables are indicated by an asterisk (*).
The most important variables are explained below.
● Expense Report ID
The unique identifier for an expense report.
If you want to restrict the selection to one or more particular expense reports, enter the expense report IDs here.
● Changed On
The date on which the expense reports were changed. If you change an expense report after the taxable
reimbursements have been processed in payroll, the payroll results for the employee need to be recalculated.
SAP Business ByDesign FP3.5Travel and Expenses PUBLIC • © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. 425
● Created On
The date on which the expense reports were created.
● Trip Type
The type of trip depending on the distance traveled by the employee. For example: Short business trip, long distance
business trip.
For more information about the standard variables, see Overview of Reports in Financial Management.
Analyzing the Report
The report displays the expense reports that contain tax-relevant reimbursements, and a breakdown of the tax details
for those reports. The following amounts are displayed:
● Payout to Employee
Amount reimbursed to the employee based on the expense report.
● Tax-Exempt Amount
Amount on which no taxes are due.
● Taxable Benefit
Expense reimbursed to the employee that exceeds the tax-exempt amount. Taxable benefits are treated as wages
for tax purposes, which increases the employee's taxable income.
● Taxable at Flat Rate
This amount is taxed at a fixed percentage defined by the local tax authority. In Germany, for example, meals per
diem are taxed at a flat rate if the reimbursement amount is no more than twice the tax-exempt amount.
● Income-Related Expenses
This amount reduces the employee's taxable income. Per diems and reimbursements are tax-exempt up to a legal
limit. If the company's expense reimbursement rates are less than the tax-exempt amount, employees can deduct
the difference in their tax returns as income-related expenses, which reduces their taxable income.
● Tax-Exempt Meals Per Deim
Meals per diem amount on which no taxes are due.
To analyze the data in this report:
● Use the filters to manipulate how the data is displayed in the content pane.
● To further analyze data in this report, you can drag characteristics to rows and columns.
To display further details of an expense report, click the expense report with the secondary mouse button and choose
Goto -> Display Details from the context menu.
You can filter and sort the data by all columns.
See Also
Reports View
Overview of Reports in Financial Management
Overview of Data Sources in Financial Management
426 © 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved. • PUBLICSAP Business ByDesign FP3.5
Travel and Expenses
http://www.sap.com/contactsap
© 2011 SAP AG. All rights reserved.
No part of this publication may be reproduced ortransmitted in any form or for any purpose without theexpress permission of SAP AG. The informationcontained herein may be changed without prior notice.Some software products marketed by SAP AG and itsdistributors contain proprietary software components ofother software vendors. Microsoft, Windows, Excel,Outlook, and PowerPoint are registered trademarks ofMicrosoft Corporation. IBM, DB2, DB2 UniversalDatabase, System i, System i5, System p, System p5,System x, System z, System z10, System z9, z10, z9,iSeries, pSeries, xSeries, zSeries, eServer, z/VM, z/OS,i5/OS, S/390, OS/390, OS/400, AS/400, S/390 ParallelEnterprise Server, PowerVM, Power Architecture,POWER6+, POWER6, POWER5+, POWER5, POWER,OpenPower, PowerPC, BatchPipes, BladeCenter,System Storage, GPFS, HACMP, RETAIN, DB2Connect, RACF, Redbooks, OS/2, Parallel Sysplex,MVS/ESA, AIX, Intelligent Miner, WebSphere, Netfinity,Tivoli and Informix are trademarks or registeredtrademarks of IBM Corporation. Linux is the registeredtrademark of Linus Torvalds in the U.S. and othercountries. Adobe, the Adobe logo, Acrobat, PostScript,and Reader are either trademarks or registeredtrademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated in the UnitedStates and/or other countries. Oracle and Java areregistered trademarks of Oracle and/or its affiliates.UNIX, X/Open, OSF/1, and Motif are registeredtrademarks of the Open Group. Citrix, ICA, ProgramNeighborhood, MetaFrame, WinFrame, VideoFrame,and MultiWin are trademarks or registered trademarks ofCitrix Systems, Inc. HTML, XML, XHTML and W3C aretrademarks or registered trademarks of W3C®, WorldWide Web Consortium, Massachusetts Institute ofTechnology. SAP, R/3, SAP NetWeaver, Duet,PartnerEdge, ByDesign, SAP BusinessObjectsExplorer, StreamWork, and other SAP products andservices mentioned herein as well as their respectivelogos are trademarks or registered trademarks of SAPAG in Germany and other countries. Business Objectsand the Business Objects logo, BusinessObjects,Crystal Reports, Crystal Decisions, Web Intelligence,Xcelsius, and other Business Objects products andservices mentioned herein as well as their respectivelogos are trademarks or registered trademarks ofBusiness Objects Software Ltd. Business Objects is anSAP company. Sybase and Adaptive Server, iAnywhere,Sybase 365, SQL Anywhere, and other Sybase productsand services mentioned herein as well as their respectivelogos are trademarks or registered trademarks ofSybase, Inc. Sybase is an SAP company. All otherproduct and service names mentioned are thetrademarks of their respective companies. Datacontained in this document serves informationalpurposes only. National product specifications may vary.These materials are subject to change without notice.These materials are provided by SAP AG and itsaffiliated companies ("SAP Group") for informationalpurposes only, without representation or warranty of anykind, and SAP Group shall not be liable for errors oromissions with respect to the materials. The onlywarranties for SAP Group products and services arethose that are set forth in the express warrantystatements accompanying such products and services,if any. Nothing herein should be construed asconstituting an additional warranty.